Home
        grandMAnual 6.0
         Contents
1.                                   w     a None As AGE PAN TILT For this types of lamps grandM A can create an virtual dimmer This means  that the software simulates the  TO legos oor Space NONAME NTL dimmer function The user only has to choose this function and can operate these lamps as any other dimmer     No  Break _ Attribute vals come type lamp   pj oi a e   Sign on the new lamp in FULL ACCESS  o mee H If no lamp of this type is in the library  create your own lamp          n CHANNELS of FIXTURE TYPES create 3 channels with attribut COLORM IX and switch the column INV to YES   Create another channel with attribute DIM and select Virtual in the SELECT ATRIBUTE menu  Confirm with OK     In the Fixture Sheet the dimmer channel and the 3 colour channels are displayed and can be operated  although  only 3 DM X  channels are covered  the virtual dimmer channel does not cover an own physical channel        f other channels than Colormix 1 3 should be affected b y the dimmer  set collumn REACT on DIM M ER to li   near or invers        RGB   44 28 56  CH  Y   56 72 44  HSB  275 50 56        Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand A  25    2 3 DMX List  Single Channel  specific Adjustments for the Current  Show    Press the PATCH SHEETS key in the Full or Live Access menu to activate this menu     This menu will only display the actually patched channels  All changes made here will only affect the c
2.                  the fixture    Delete Folder  from Floppy rom Disk   using DELETE FOLDER FROM DISK to delete the chosen folder from the hard disk  Delete Image   using DELETE IMAGE FROM DISK to delete the bitmap from the chosen folder  s from Disk  a l     The bitmaps and folders for those bitmaps will be permanently deleted can not be  oopsed  again             GOBO1       MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    LIGHTING    DMX Configuration SAVE   x    Menu      serie B   xin c   xXLRD  r  DMX Output                    DMX Input   gt         DMX Output  via Ethernet             WYSIWYG  Config D       DMX Output  via marana  Show            DMX via Ethernet      DMX Output  On  Enabled if  Stang              Mate Ell Hii e BURR zg iia Eiai ei         DHX Input  Universe Source Configuration          2 9 DMX Output and Ethernet Configuration    There are 4 DM X output sockets on the rear of the grandM A  These sockets can be assigned to any of the DM X  universes A to H  It is also possible to output the same universe on more than one output socket    By using Ethernet data transmission more DM X outputs can be assigned    DM X universes E to H are only available with the optional channel expansion upgrade to 4096 channels  As of  serial number 156  a dongle  hardware protection  has to be installed within the grandM A  for serial numbers  under S N 156  a plug in card has to be exchanged    For this operation  the unit can only be opene
3.              Fix Ch       SL300 6  60         T  5L300 7 60       Programmer genet  gJ  Only Sequence    dodulator   Modulator  Modulator  Auta  Size Speed Phase    l  i a E E u i  Pan Tilt Dimmer l Gobo Color Focus       Hone              Wissets Fade     amp  Values    Executor    Delay D    Qutput              hlodulator  Table          Sequence  E          LIGHTING    3 3 Creating and calling up Fixtures and Dimmer GROUPS  Important and frequently used combinations of fixtures and dimmer channels can be stored in groups    max  999  groups   M akes selecting of group of lamps very easy and quick  The same Imap can be member of several groups     3 3 1Creating fixture or dimmer groups   Create a GROUP window on one of the TFT touchscreens  See Creating a Window     Use the touch screen or make a left mouse click on the individual Fixture within the FIXTURE SHEET or click on  the Dimmer channels in the CHANNEL or FADER SHEET      The Fixtures and   or dimmer channels that make up a group can be recalled one at a time in sequence  The  order in which they are recalled is same as the order in which they were selected when the group was originally  stored  When selecting Fixtures or Channels for a group  make use of their order so that you can step through  them individually using the NEXT PREV key    Or       Press the FIXTURE key for a fixture group or the CHANNEL key for dimmer groups  LED is on       Pressing the ENTER key will lock the Fixture or Channel in the Command Li
4.            dot  key and then the page number  confirm with ENTER    A window will open  here  confirm the deleting operation with the DELETE key   Deleting Pages with Executor fader and buttons   Press the DELETE key once to delete Pages  LED is on     Press the PAGE key once  LED is on     Enter the page number on the keypad and confirm with ENTER    A window will open  here  confirm the deleting operation with the DELETE key     If there are programmed Macros or Timecode Shows  in which the moved or deleted Pages were to be  used  these assignments may no longer work     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    Hunting  horas    uf 5 6 OFF menu  RUNNING PROGRAM S   ee TA   Pressing the OFF key twice will open the RUNNING PROGRAM S window   CARA ma All active chasers  sequences  effect groups  timecode shows and M acros are displayed here   A A   CHASES ALL OFF  Switches off all     active CHASERS   n An   SEQUENCES ALL OFF  Switches off all     active SEQUENCES     EFFECTS ALL OFF  Switches off all     active EFFECTS     TIMECODE ALL OFF  Switches off all     active TIMECODE SHOWS     MACROS ALL OFF  Switches off all     active MACROS     hiker    Mr ot eam  in Hi  bas oa gin nn a   gt   O inian    Pressing the DETAILS key will open the View ALL RUNNING EFFECTS menu  See View ALL RUNNING EFFECTS menu    CURRENT PAGE OFF  Switches off all     Executors of the current Page     ALL FADERS OFF  Switches off all     active EXECUTOR Faders     
5.         Delete  Line                    Take  Selection  Sine                AS  Adaptive Speed   If this function is activated  the speed will automatically be adjusted when the number  of Fixtures or Dimmers changes  That means  the individual Effects of this Effect Group do not run at different  speeds when working with different numbers of Fixtures or Dimmers  but always at the same step speed    To activate the function  select the cell  Press the Encoder right of the display once    Or    Activate by making a short right mouse click into the cell below AS  This will be indicated by a YES in this cell      Part  Partly   he sequence of an Effect can be subdivided 16 times  and an Effect can then be assigned to the  first individual subdivision  This colomn displays what the subdivision ratio this part of the Effect Group  belongs to    Example  With a setting of 1 5  the individual Effect would always be executed in the first fifth of a Effect Group   sequence  Before modifying the subdivision value  select the Effect first  Press the PART key once  green   background   Now  you can set the subdivision of the Effect Group for the individual Effect by pressing and  holding the Encoder below  You cannot designate a section in which a particular Effect is to be executed  it  will always be executed as the first subdivision   Pressing the Encoder once shortly will set the value to ALWAYS and the Effect will be executed during the whole   period     6 2 2 Deleting individual 
6.       Normal    Ch Fader Functi  oose Fader Func ion Kiado ekgo                                              Cuelist   press SETTINGS  always   never   PrePos   When touch on the FADER symbol key  a selection will appear where you can assign the respective function to   ____Restart Options   Loops   oe the Fader by another touch   all SA CS   Master  The Fader controls all programmed dimmer values of this Sequence      i   Swap  With the Fader  HTP channels in the sequence can be faded in  All HTP dimmers  stored in this cue with  Normal eae value    0    are set to    0     in spite of HTP  modus and used by other sequences with values higher than    0      oia   tent Default opie _ Master   Edit    ce Ee Eee Eer A F    tis only possible to use the SWAP or Master fader       FADE  With the Fader  the fade  in time between cues can be set manually  when using Chasers      Speed  Chaser speed can be set with the Fader      Xfade  With the Fader  you can manually crossfade all parameters in to the next cue of the sequence      XF A  If Split Crossfade is active  you can fade out the Cue that is currently playing back when pushing the fa   der upwards or downwards    If Split Crossfade is not active  you can fade out to the darkening Dimmer channels of the next Cue when   pushing the fader upwards or downwards      XF B  If Split Crossfade is active  you can use the Fader to fade in the next Cue when pushing the fader upwards   Exec 218 Seq 4    seq 4 or downwards    If Split Cr
7.       Views that contain single screens can be called back also on other screens     VIEW BTN  As starting keyword  given view buttons will be called   VIEW BTN  range list  ENTER  Viewbutton numbers in the range list must be in the interval   1  30    Each screen has 6 view buttons  3 build in and 2 external monitors make a to   tal of 30 view buttons   As target for the following commands     ASSIGN Assign a view or a macro to a view button  Syntax Is   ASSIGN VIEW X VIEWBTN Y ENTER  ASSIGN MACRO X VIEWBTN Y ENTER   COPY Copy one view button to another   DELETE Delete  Empty  a view button    MOVE M ove one view button to another   STORE STORE a view and assign it to the view button     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn          Quick Save ENTERA 11 Saving and loading a SHOW          OM  Increments Automatically A unnamed show will always saves as NEW SHOW  rename it immediatelley  for the next show will saved with  Show File Number    cteate Backup  this nameand will overwrite the previous show  Write protection is noct possible   OFF creates Backup    Flies avery         Please make sure to frequently save the current show on harddisk during the programming procedure  A   Enumerate 15 good idea is to change the name of your show on a regular basis so that you can go back to previous days   OM S EE he programing  A back  up on floppy disk is always a good idea   if 4   14 19  J Automatic save    Additional Drive Additonal Liive With 
8.      Adding additional Attributes to a Feature     Select a Preset group and then an Feature      Click into the free cell below the available Attributes      Enter a name for the new Attribute using the keyboard  e g   Gobo 4  and confirm with Enter  The same name is  automatically taken over and will be displayed in the Fixture window on the right side  If you want to use a different  name  change it as indicated further above    Inserting  deleting or moving Features or Attributes     Select a Feature or Attribute  blue background   Pressing the buttons below will have the indicated results      Add Line will add a new Feature or Attribute in front of the selected one      Delete Line will delete the selected Feature or Attribute  Only self  created Features or Attributes can be deleted      Moves Lines will move the selected Feature or Attribute to another place in the table  The different ways to move  Features or Attributes will be explained in the two following items    Moving a Feature to another Preset group     Click on a Feature  e g   Gobol      Press the Moves Lines button  will be displayed in red      Select a Preset group  to which the Feature is to be moved      Select the position in the Features table by clicking on it  The Feature will now be displayed in this Preset group    Some Features cannot be moved  e g   Color Mix   This is indicated by the words    Fixed Attributes  in the table on   the right of the respective Feature     The changes will take ef
9.      terminated due to a hardware problem either on the M aster or on the Slave    M aster unit   You can resolve the complete Session by pressing the Leave Session button on the M aster    You can also exclude a unit from a Session  to do so  click on this unit in the right table  blue background   By  pressing the Disconnect Station button  it will be excluded    Slave unit   When pressing the Leave Session button  this unit will leave the Session    You can also exclude a unit from a Session  to do so  click on this unit in the right table  blue background   By  pressing the Disconnect Station button  it will be excluded    15 4 Full Tracking   When a Session is in Full Tracking  all data relevant for the Show plus the operations will be executed  simultaneously on all units  except when currently working with Worlds next page   15 5 Multi User   No Pages on other units will be switched over  no Selections of Fixtures transferred  and no View switchings  transferred  Using Worls will have a major effect in this case next pages     Abort or Reconnection of a session  Autoconnect    If a session was disconnected  for example OFF without leaving the session   slave desk tries to reconnect to the   session after switching on    Abort Autoconnection      press Abort  Connection will not re  established  desk works as stand  alone with the current show   Allow Autoconnection      press X or after approx   4 Seconds automatically  Connection with session  see picture  session GM 
10.     2    MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    6 8  Modulators INDEX    While the modulators that are used for the effects will only influence the whole effect  it is now possible for each  feature to use a modulator for effects  and for the speed  size and shifting of effects within the modulators of the  Fixture and Channel Sheets  The modulators run within the Programmer  i e  they are not permanent  You can only  save changes as Cues  effects transferred with the TOP button to the modulators will remain unchanged  For each     Dutpt attribute of a fixture  four modulator settings are available  each of them being individual         EDET Sheet Modulator Speed sorted by Nu           Moduli Salues  Phase   N iny      Pavitt fee    Gabel Kolord     Pan Tilt m A    deat         gt I Assigning modulators to a fixture            Modulator  Modulator h d  Table Size        Fade Delay                Name              SC300 1    select fixtures  here the fixtures 3 5 from the Channel Sheet     open FIXTURE or CHANNEL SHEET      in OPTIONS  press the LAYER CONTROL button  it has a violet background and shows  which values are displayed  in the Sheet  in the SPEED graphics of the Channel Sheet  and in PHASE in the FIXTURE Sheet   the violet or white  triangle shows  which value is being entered into the active Sheet using the Encoder  in the SPEED graphics in the    els   Modulator Modulator Waaa AN  P Table Size   Speed       Presets    8 alies
11.     Controlling Fixture attributes    GROUP window   Select a fixture by its key  or click on the name of a fixture in the fixture sheet     GOBO  COLOUR     window   Open a preset for the selected unit  if no presets are displayed  run the selected function via an encoder    Pressing and turning the encoder allows for fine tuning    Storing Settings   The STORE key of the grandM A is very flexible    If the STORE key is flashing  you can switch it off with a second press or use ESCAPE    Example  Select some fixtures and set the color wheel     STORE   one of the buttons above or below an EXECUTOR fader  make sure you have toggled back from  CHANNEL to EXECUTOR   Stores the color setting as a cue on that Executor      STORE   one of the buttons of an EXECUTOR fader  where a cue was already stored  gives you the option to  overwrite  merge information or create a second cue  See CREATE LIST     STORE   a cell in the GROUP window  Stores the chosen Fixtures as a new group  enter a name via keyboard     STORE   any cell in the preset COLOUR window  Stores the values as a color preset  enter name via keyboard     STORE   one of the VIEW keys on the right hand side of the displays  Stores the layout of the screen  the mouse  position  etc  as a view  enter a name        With STORE   VIEW key you can store screens individually or all console wide   In the ASSIGN menu  you can enter names sequences of cues     Selecting and activating channels  fixtures and functions   Selecting an
12.     Current  1    Name  Out A          i    Identify By  Backlight    Edit Nodes    Legend     Used by internal  Slot    Unus    ed       Configuration  next page   If Artnet converters are connected  they will be searched for and displayed in the chart when calling up this menu   If the converter is being activated after opening the menu  you can search for the converter by pressing the Scan  for Nodes key to insert the converter in the chart  if one is found    In the left chart  all converters found will be displayed with the respectively set address for each DM X OUTPUT  The  number in front of the colon is the SUBNET address  the number following is the address for the DM X OUTPUT   Choose an address for the DM X OUTPUT    In the right chart  one line is displayed for each converter  The selected DM X OUTPUT will be displayed on a green  background    If an output is displayed on a red background  this indicates that it is already being assigned and can not be used   Pressing the Save button will save all modifications    Press the key X  Now  the converter for this DM X port is configured and the menu will be closed    For the    DM X Hub    from the Artistic Licence Company  this button must be on    Delayed Output     for all other units   this setting is not relevant    If further ports are to be assigned  repeat all steps  When all settings are completed  press the SAVE key in the   DM X  OUTPUT CONFIGURATION menu  The modified settings are now stored  Now  the blue
13.     Press the GROUP key once  Pressing the ENTER key once will lock GROUP as preset in the Command Line    Then  enter the group number on the numeric keypad and call it up pressing ENTER     By pressing the CLEAR key once  all selected Fixtures and Channels are deselected  no longer displayed in  yellow    Proceed as follows to separately activate selected Fixtures Dimmers or called  up groups in the desired stored order       NEXT key once within a group or selection  forwards     PREV key once within a group or selection  backwards     Pressing the SET key once reselects all Fixtures and dimmer channels in the group    If there are more groups than can be displayed in the GROUP window  you can scroll down within every    active       window  title bar in dark blue  on every screen  by using the encoder wheel on the right of the respective  touchscreen or the up down key        move 3 3 3 Moving GROUP keys within a window        Press the MOVE key once  M OVE LED lights up     Using the touch screen or left mouse key  click on the GROUP key and hold it down  a small hand appears        Drag the key to another location within this window and then release it    or     press MOVE twice  LED flashes      Using the touch screen or left mouse key  click on the GROUP key and hold it down  a small hand appears     Drag the key to another location between two buttons within this window and then release it     3 3 4 Copying groups       Press the COPY key once  LED is on       Select
14.     Selected  The selected Fixtures will be moved upwards      Active  Fixtures for which a value is activated  will be moved upwards   Sort Directions      Values  Fixtures will be sorted according to highest dimmer value      Sort Upwards  Sorting by ascending values      Sort Downwards  Sorting by descending values     Display      READOUT  Pressing this function  you can switch between the following display options           Fixture Sheet Vas  amp  Presets sorted by TREG on Aae   Percent  Values will be displayed as percentages   t Cok Powe  l   l   i    AR 7 r i ia   Percent    Values will be displayed as percentage values  interim values will be displayed next to the figure in  CHI CH  CM3 Si   form of 3 dots       Decimal  Values will be displayed as decimal numbers  0 255      HEX  Values will be displayed as hexadecimal numbers  0  FF      FONT  By pressing this function  you can switch the font size in the FIXTURE window between Huge  very big    TER Big and Small   Oh This window can be deleted by pressing the DELETE WINDOW key     J i Eo a ie  P i ho  Co a e a Sd X   Pressing the X key will close the Option Window   These settings will all be stored when VIEWS are stored  Storing VIEWS         Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand  TA 6     If the Settings button is pressed  displayed with text in green      Using the respective button  you can display the following items  Micay  
15.     ey If the green LED on the button is lit  a Cue or a Sequence of cues is stored on this button    T 1  90   ifthe yellow LED is lit or is flashing  this Cue  Sequence of cues or Chaser  a sequence which as been told to run  automatically  is activated    The yellow LED indicates the beat of a Chaser    Push up the respective M aster Fader for the EXECUTOR faders to see the dimmer values  Playback Cues using the   Go  button  standard setting is button below the Fader   If the green LED in the button above the Fader is on  a   Cue or a Sequence is stored on this button    If the yellow LED is on or is flashing  this Cue  the Sequence or the stored Chaser is activated  The yellow LED   indicates the beat of a Chaser    Using the PAGE keys  you can select other pages  5 5 PAGE Administration  PAGE    With the Fader to the right of the EXECUTOR buttons  you can either set fixed fade times or perform manual fade    in when playing back Cues using the EXECUTOR buttons    Press the key above the Fader once  red LED is on   Set the desired fade time using the Fader  When selecting the   Sequence using the EXECUTOR buttons  only the fade time set here will be used  this also applies to SNAPDELAY   times     Press the key above the Fader again  green LED is on   Select the sequence using the EXECUTOR button  Using   the Fader  you can now fade in the selected sequence  Default setting for the Fader can be changed to fade just   upwards or in both directions  See Settings in the DEF
16.     gt   __   By pressing the button on the left of Cue Only  you can choose between   f  Normal Copying  with or without Status        Will copy the values of the step before into the step after  but only to a position having no value     98 MEN this wouldn t be     LIGHTING    MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    i Ants  TENH    Hha  POER  ali   4    te       KUC cei  ay   S g 1    Pian Ena  Tn fon    Naw Mumbar i   orig Width     Delete Cue    Deleting Cue       Delete Cue    Deleting Cue       4 3 6 Deleting and renumbering Cues   Right click with the mouse on the respective Cue in the NO  column    The following window will open      From Cue  Display of the first selected Cue  The number can be modified by clicking on it      To Cue  Display of the last selected Cue  The number can be modified by clicking on it      New Number  Display of the first new number of the selected Cues  The number can be modified by clicking on it      Step Width  Display of the steps  in which the Cues    new numbers will be placed  The number can be modified by   clicking on it    Deleting Cues     Select the Cue to be deleted  By pressing the Delete Cue   key  the Cue will be deleted  If you want to delete not  only one but several Cues  select the respective Cues      By pressing the Delete Cue  key  the Cues will be deleted       With CUE ONLY S  the cue will be deleted without changing the following cue       With CUE ONLY K the cue will be delete
17.     press Load Show       type the new name and confirm with Enter   The PLEASE CONFIRM window with the options will open      YES  To save the current Show before loading the new one      NO  To load the new Show without saving the current one    A complete new and empty show will opwn    Additionally  you can save an  empty    Show to hard disk or floppy so that you can use it later when needed  This  way  you can also transfer demo shows  standard settings  etc  to others         11 4 Deleting the current show  The currently loaded Show cannot be deleted  In order to delete the currently loaded Show  you have to load  another Show first     11 5 Deleting a Show from the internal harddisk    press BACKUP    press LOCAL DRIVE      press DELETE Show  In the list  click on the Show that is to be deleted  the Show will be deleted  immediately     If you press the Stay button  before deleting a Show  the Delete menu will not close automatically     11 6 Saving the Current Show on floppy disk   All data necessary for the SHOW can be saved on to floppy disk  even all Fixtures to be used in the show and all  users with all settings for this show   Thus  you can transfer the whole show to another grandM A console or for  archive storage  The current Show will be saved including its name      press BACKUP     press IMPORT   EXPORT and insert floppy  if no USB drive is connected  floppy drive is selected    Format the floppy disk     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D
18.    Can be  defined as M aster  Swap M aster   X  Fader etc    List keys   Faders  will bring up small   Executor windows   for the EXECUTOR   FADERS    Buttons  will bring up small  Executor windows  for the EXECUTOR    BUTTONS     Executor buttons can also be  defined as e g  Go  Go   Pause   Flash  etc      Manual setting of times for  Executor buttons    Socket for console lamp  12V 5W    MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    1 7 4COMMAND WINDOW  micro pico     This menu contains most of the Functions of a    big    grandMA desk   Pressing the Background   button the Command Window can temporary be removed from the screen  Commands  are still waiting for completion    Command Window                  e  Align   Preview       rO        lo       A             Fo    dod       NOTE  Working with the REPLAY UNIT the COMMAND WINDOW is very usefull  Start COMMAND WINDOW F7   fuctionkey on the external keyboard     1 8 Replay  Unit  see Chapter 14    Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand A  11      Select Feature       Pans Tilt  Dimmer   je  aie        2obo    olor   olor   Color Mix  ColorPicker  Beam l  Focus  Speed       12    LISHTING    1 9 General Operation   Touch screen     Keys can directly be selected      In charts  individual cells can be selected  By using the Lasso function on the touch screen  you can also select  several cells      You can sim
19.    Deleting an object that is assigned to an executor will also delete the executor   Deleting an object that is assigned to a viewkey will also delete the viewkey     Object Comment   CUE If no Sequence or executor is specified  the sequence of  the default executor is used  If the last cue of a sequence  is deleted  the whole sequence is deleted    DM X_BIN   EFFECT Do not delete effects which are used by sequences    EXEC Deleting an executor does not delete the sequence   group etc  assigned to It    FORM Do not delete forms which are still in use byeffects    GROUP Deleting a group will also delete its submaster  functionality    MACRO You can not delete a macro that is currently recording    MIDI_BIN   PAGE Deleting a page will delete all executors on that page    PRESET Deleting single presets is done with the syntax PRESET X Y  with X preset type and Y preset  number  DELETE PRESET X will ask for confirmation and  delete all presets of the given type    SEQU   TIMECODE   TOUCH_ BTN   VIEW   VIEWBTN    Simulating a right click of the mouse for editing an input field or a cell in    MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    a grid    EDIT  use touchscreen to click Somewhere  or   EDIT  left  mouse  click somewhere    Starting EDIT   UPDATE procedure    The whole procedure works as follows      EDIT object ENTER     Only one object can be edited at once  If the edit   update procedure is still  running for another object  you will be as
20.    EFFECT Pause an effect   PAGE Pauses all executors on the page    SPEEDM ASTER Pauses all chasers using this speed master   executor assigned to a speed master    SUBM ASTER    Park    all channels involved in this group     CHANNEL FIXTURE and GROUP    Park    all given devices    PRESET X  Preset Type     Park    all channels of current selection of  that preset type       Park    means to freeze the output for a channel with its current value  Parked   channels are shown with a bright blue background in the sheets  Although a   channel is parked  it can still be used normally for programming purposes     PRESET    As starting keyword   PRESET ENTER    Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 gad MALTS    PRESET becomes the DEFAULT KEYWORD    PRESET T X ENTER   Call Preset X of type T    X Preset number in range   1   999  T Preset type in range  1   9   As target for the following operational commands     PREVIEW    COPY Copy one preset to another   DELETE Delete a preset   EDIT Start edit   update procedure for preset   IF Deselect devices which are not part of the preset    FOUTPUT Search for stage output of preset   LABEL Change name of preset   M OVE INSERT M ove preset to another position   PREVIEW  object   ENTER     Only one object can be previewed at one time    Preview will show the content of the object in the fixture   channel sheets  without outputing to stage  blind   Programmer con
21.    LIGHTING    rand  i    nual       full size   light   ultra light   micro   pico  replay unit   onPC    Version 6 0 02 2009    1 Introduction 3 4 6 INFO   Window 104 11 9 Saving show to external harddisk 182  1 1 General Information 3 4 7 REPORT Window 104 11 10 Loading show from external hard disk 182  1 2 General Comments 3 5 Cues  Sequences and Chasers 106 11 11 Deleting show from external hard disk 182  1 3 Specifications 4 5 1 ASSIGN menu l 106 11 12 Saving show on USB storage device 182  1 4 Installation 4 5 2 Small EXECUTOR Window 115 11 13 Loading show from USB storage device 182  1 5 Safety Requirements  Important  read carefully  5 5 3 EXECUTOR Sheet 115 11 14 PARTIAL SHOW READ 183  1 6 General Safety Instructions 6 5 4 TRACKING Sheet  117 12 Update Software 185  1 7 Layout and Controls grandMA light 7 5 5 Page Administration 119 13 Utility M enu 187  1 8 Replay  Unit 11 3 6 OFF menu  RUNNING PROGRAMS  121 14 grandMA replay unit 188  1 9 General Operation 12 5 7 CONTENT Menu 122 14 1 Introduction 188  1 10 Quick Reference 15 6 Effects 124 14 2 General Instructions 190  2Setup 18 6 1 Effect Pool 124 14 3 Specification and Technical Data 190  2 1 Selecting and creating of fixturesanddimmers 18 6 2 Editing Effect Groups 125 15 Network connections 193  2 2 Menu Full Access or Live Access 19 6 3 Executing an Effect Group 128 15 2 Preparing a Session 194  2 3 DMX List 26 6 4 Customizing an Effect Group 129 15 3 Creating a Session 195  2 4 ATTRIBUTE SETUP 27 6 5 Effect 
22.    THRU can only be used within other commands to create ranges     X THRU Y Range from X to Y  X THRU Range from X to the end  THRU Y Range from the beginning to Y  THRU Range from the beginning up to the end     The meaning of    beginning    and    end    depend on the context   FIXTURE 10 THRU ENTER will select all fixtures from 10 upwards   Thru can of course also be used to create ranges of values like  CHANNEL 1 THRU 10 ATO THRU FULL ENTER   or   CHANNEL 1 THRU 10 AT FULL FADE 1 DELAY 0 THRU 5 ENTER    As starting keyword    SEQU ENTER   SEQU becomes the DEFAULT KEYWORD    SEQU  range list  ENTER   Select devices included in sequences    Sequence numbers must be in the range of   1   999   SEQU  range list  AT     See AT    Apply values to devices included in sequences    As target for the following operational commands     ENTER you can   for example   choose the appropriate answer in a message box  EDIT Opens edit menu for sequence  If no device is selected  PREVIOUS will bring the fixture having the lowest ID into IF Deselect devices which are not part of the sequence   the selection  on the next PREVIOUS  the fixture with the next lower ID will be IFOUTPUT Search for stage output of sequence  selected  With NEXT  the selecting direction will be reversed  Proceeding from the INVERT Invert selection of sequence  fixture with the lowest ID  on the next PREVIOUS  the selection will jump to the LABEL Change name of sequence  dimmer with the highest ID  MOVE Move sequenc
23.    VIEWS  Displaying and Calling up Views  See View Pool     QUIKEY  Displaying and creating soft versions of existing console keys and commands  See M acros and QUIKEY     TIMECODE  Recording  Playing back  Editing and Storing SM PTE LTC Timecode controlled operations  See Time    code     MAtricks  Here  you can create  save and directly call up different selection groups  And you can copy or move  values that were set by the Circular Copy function from one fixture to another  See M Atricks     Worlds  Here  you can create  call up or manage so  called    Worlds    Worlds are important  when you e g  want to  work in the Multi User M ode  or you just want to make some Fixtures    invisible    See Worlds     Channel Pages  In these pools     buttons    will be displayed for all pages  The pages can be called up quickly     Fader Pages  by just clicking on them  Here  you can change the names of the pages      Button Pages  you can copy or delete them  See M anaging Pages     Bitmap Effects  Here  you can create  call up or manage Bitmap  Effects     Presets   PAN   TILT  DIMMER  GOBO  COLOUR  BEAM   FOCUS  CONTROL  SHAPERS and ALL   Creates new  edits and calls up individual PRESETS with name and number  See Creating and Calling up Presets    COMMAND LINE  Lists executed commands by their names  Also to enter commands using the keyboard  See  Command Line    CLOCK  Display window analog or digital clock  Switch by pressing the Analog button     AGENDA  In this menu  you can 
24.    select a scaling     SCALE 1 1  will transfer the bitmap 1 1 into the selected layout     SCALE TO FIT WIDTH  will scale the bitmap to the optimum width for the selected layout     SCALE TO FIT HEIGT  will scale the bitmap to the optimum height for the selected layout     SCALE TO BEST FIT  will scale the bitmap to the optimum appearance for the selected layout      using the Encoders below the screen to set the bitmap starting position  after switching the page  you can also turn  the bitmap around and change its rotation point     The cross  wires and the projection frame are very useful when setting up the bitmap effect      OFFSET  here  you can change the bitmap  to  matrix position   the projection frame will be offset along the x or y axis    ROTATION OFFSET  here  set the pivot point for a rotaton   the cross  wires will be offset along the x or y axis     ROTATION  here  enter the bitmap position     WIDTH  here  enter the bitmap width     HEIGHT  here  enter the bitmap height    MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    BitMap Wizard    Scale to  best fit  Scale to  fit width    Grey Scale Scale to  Correction t fit height                                                                                        Edit Bitmap Effect 16    Bitmap Effect       E Eimar E igor  Preset     Mone   te  mi Preset  Mone                                          press  X   to return to the EDIT menu     enter the values for the individual functi
25.    setting  to be found in options menu   it is worth taking into consideration how long  your show should be    The length of the timecode show can be changed in the options menu     8 1 5 Manual Editing of a Timecode Show   Editing is only enabled  if the timecode show is NOT write  protected  options menu     Track Management   A timecode show consists of TRACKS    A TRACK has a specific function  At the moment  only EXECUTOR TRACKS are implemented  but in the future   it is conceivable to have tracks implimented for submasters  global speeds etc   too  This way  one track would    MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    always relate to one specific executor  It is not possible to have two tracks for the same executor    A TRACK consists of SUBTRACKS    A SUBTRACK has a specific function that relates to its    parent track     For example  a subtrack for an executor  track could have the crossfade function  One subtrack always relates to one specific function  It is not possible to  have two subtracks for the same function    Every executor track has at least one subtrack for executor commands  Subtracks for fader movements are added  if needed    A SUBTRACK contains EVENTS    An EVENT contains specific TIM E and DATA information  The DATA is interpreted according to the function of the  assigned subtrack    Adding Tracks   When recording TRACKS are automatically added  but of course you can also add tracks manually      Press the TRAC
26.   14 3 14 Fader working modes      Align option for proportional change of any group of values     Preset softkeys for the moving light features      Keys can be freely moved within the window      Presets grouped together for the 10 different function types     Keys of different preset groups with different colours      Free assignment of channels to be controlled in which preset  14 3 15 Button working modes      Direct access even during Playback    ON OFF  GO   GO   Pause  Flash up and Flash down     Fast GO and GO    lt  lt  lt  and  gt  gt  gt   without fades       Brightness M aster in HTP or LTP M ode     Manual X  Fade     Speed  Fade Time  Rate for chaser and sequences     14 3 10 Automatic effect generator    A number of complex effects applicable to any channel  14 3 16 Output Listings and Cuelist Protocols      Library of all different movements    Infading or outfading values of main sequence is marked in different colours in the channel list     Lists of sequences including names of steps and times    14 3 11 Store Options   Parameter modifications directly in the spreadsheet      Single cues  chase effects  sequences or effects      Selective programming for LTP and tracking mode  14 3 17 Overwriting a program sequence    Basic fade times for fading channels and basic delay for switching parameters  _ Constant access to all effects and channels       Optional individual fade and delay for every single channel    CLEAR and RELEASE functions       Overwrite  M e
27.   179  Hard key 159  Hardware 4   High  session priority 194  HIGHLIGHT 26  172  Highlight 30  47  172  Highlight is SOLO 47  Highlight Normal 47  History 98  158  HOLD OFF 48  HOTLINE 15   Hz 34  47       DELAY 94  101  IFADE 94  100  ID session number 194  IF 172    FOUTPUT 173  Illumination 45  Import Effect 44  Import Show 44  Incremental 45  INFO 104   INSERT 173  Installation 4  INTENS 94  101  INTENSITY 128   Inv 30   INVERT 156  173  IP address 39  207    K    Keep Activation 75   KEYBOARD GERM AN   ENGLISH 48   Keyword 159   Kill 108   Kill Protect 111    L    LABEL 173   Lasso function 12  118   Last universe  STRAND  41   Layer 43   Layer Control 67   Layer Display 66   LAYER TO DISPLAY 66  73   LEARN 108  173   LI  DEL 94  101   Library 18   LIN 124   Line  command 158   LINK 94  100  101   LINK DEFAULT 116   Link Fader  Function in the  CHANNEL window 73   LIST 7  56  119   List Button fixed   normal 47   List Button normal  fixed  47   Live Access 18  27   LOAD 174   Location Auto 49   Locking the Desk 50   LOOP 94  101   LOOP  COUNT  99   LOOP  TIMED  99   LOOPDELAY 94  99  101   LOOPS 99  111  116   Loss of Data 5   Low  session priority 194    LTP Dimmer 110  LTP principle 110  Lumen 30    M    MACRO 174   Macro  asign to an  executor  154   MACRO button 8   Macro  creating a 153   MACRO  deleting a 79   Macro  editing a 155   MACRO  inserting a  ina  Cue 99   MACRO TIMED 155   MACROS 54  114  153   M acros auf Executor  speichern 154   Manufacturer 30   Mask
28.   Presets    GMA Remote a x 10 50 v    csi  als Be Pull Dowm menu of the Features    toggle  Groups   Presets  toggle  Fixture   Presets Pool       jump to the next   gt  Preset button      am jump to the next  Preset area         press  OPTIONS will be displayed    218       MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    LIGHTING    Declaration of Conformity  according to directives 89 336 EWG and 92 31 EWG    Manufacturer s name  MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Manufacturer   s address  Dachdeckerstrake 16  D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn  Germany    declares that the product    Product category  Control unit   Name of product  MA grandM A  grandM A light  grandM A ultra light  grandM A RPU  grandMA  Micro   Type  MAGM    complies with the following product specifications     Safety  EN60065  EN60950  EMV  EMC   EN55103 1  E1   EN50081 1  EN55103 2  E2   EN50082 1    Additional information  DM X512 and analogue inputs and outputs must be shielded and the shielding  must be connected to the earthing resp  to the housing of the corresponding  plug     Dipl  Ing  M ichael Adenau    Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 gad A 213    FAQ    TROUBLE    SHOOTING    220    L   GH TIN G    Question    Why will my console  on which   have created  a session  suddenly become SLAVE  after  inviting another console     Why will the 3D not function     Will only boot up to the message  COUL
29.   Status     the current priority will be displayed  In this  case  for the Light only    Slave    will be displayed  the same priority as for the Master  For the RPU     Slave will be    Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand HAAIS    MA Network Connections    Sessions Stations in Session    grandMA     No    Name   IP   Versi   Name Status     Vers   0 Unconnected Master 192 168 0 111 3 940  1 Slave 192 168 0 145 3 940   Slave  192 168 0 1  0  3 940    192 168 0 111 3 940                My Station My SOSoIon  IP  Address 197 1RN A 1714 IE  Hame fullsire Hame    Priwiti   Fdornarn  Patewond       Invitation Style    Local Hatan Acmote Station  e Invite    Le    Stations           iSsconnect  ta thoes       p         Password    Style       ee Ae     ee Session Collision    Your session is colliding with   as   Showfile    ss GMA START SHOW         Choose an Acton     Join Take Over  Other Session s  Other Sessionis   Change biy ID    LIGHTING    displayed  i e  the set priority of the RPU is    low     i e  lower as that of the M aster    As soon as the connection is established  the normal operation of the units can start   Differences between Full Tracking  Multi User and Playback next page    The Session will be kept  if not      interrupted manually by pulling the EtherNet cable  or deactivating the EtherNet converter     terminated automatically due to of a detected communication problem
30.   With this function  you can transfer the real fixtures  positions to the SETUP of the grandM A console  The STAGE view  will then display the actual position of the fixtures to the stage  This light setting procedure should always be    performed  if it is not clear whether or not fixture positions had been exactly defined in the SETUP eingetragen  E   wurde  Important for the FOLLOW FUNCTION        to offset the formation on 3 axes  without changing the form itself                to offset the formation on 3 axes  without changing the form itself          to offset the formation on 3 axes  without changing the form itself              Define the light setting frame      On the stage  mark the corners of a sqaure  light setting frame      Enter the stage dimensions in SETUP   FULL ACCESS   STAGE SETUP      Enter the dimensions of the light setting frame and its position relatively to the stage as such in the STAGE  CALIBRATION menu  The frame will appear as green square in the STAGE window     Move the first fixture to point A of the stage  using the Encoder or track ball       Press STORE and Button A of the menu     Move the fixture to B C  and D and press STORE plus the respective button when you reach these points    Repeat this procedure for all fixtures     Then press the CALCULATE button  The true fixture positions will be inserted into the SETUP menu and the  visualization in the STAGE window adapted accordingly               86       MA Lighting Technology GmbH   D
31.   d Reset   e MIDI OUT  THROUGH   IN   f Remote  for touch board    g Ethernet   h Extern Monitors  left and right    System Monitor  center   for service only      2x Serial Ports   k 1x Parallel Port  Printer      USB Ports  not Micro  For USB storage device and or mouse  Do not use  keyboard with this port    n Main switch   o Power and fuse       LIGHTING    10 Select key to address the Selected  Sequenz    TT Keys   To directly process Go   Go  etc  for any  Executor  or to lock Executors    12 Page change over   For Channel faders   Executor faders and Executor keys    13 Executor buttons can be defined e g  as Got   Go   Pause  Flash etc      15 Select   Cues  Groups  Executors etc  in  combination with numeric keypad   14 Manual Timing   Setting for Executor  Buttons   16 Blind  Freeze  Clear keys   17 Blackout key for Dimmer channels   18 Grand Master for Dimmer channels   19 Numeric keypad   20 Intensity wheel    21 Cursor keys NEXT  PREV  Choosing Fixtures or  Channels one by one within Groups     22 Trackball for Pan Tilt  or mouse function    23 Trackball ON If the LED in the key is on  the  trackball can be used to modify the PAN TILT value   if the LED is off  you can use the mouse cursor  arrow  if the LED blinks  the mouse function can  also be controlled using the PREV SET NEXT keys   The functions can be switched on off in the Default  menu see 2 13        Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 
32.   malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand ITA 95    Ee     ME TRIGGER FAD  FADE SNAP  RT SOUKD 86 396 1 96 0 76     FOLLOW   ee 60   TER 7 8 Hit    3 GO 46 4 6 16 6 4            Edit Cue  Number s   From Cue 1 Cite  7 EN Ta Cue 2  lopi Todal Crarslirris  ies l  bul Range   Was lin 24H    iis Bie     _ New Number   eae Width      ma    Sequ  15 Seq 15 Times      Name it MIB  Trig  Fade    Outfade  1 Cue 64 4s                    c 3 19  Segu i    5    seq 13    Trig     Fade  a 780 480       667 ds 7  Gs 3s      16s 4s           Effects   toons  imme        Dim Path                            HL High Low      User 2      96 MA    LIGHTING                            Outfade                       Move Path i IF  i      Linear  00 OverOver   SS LN Low Normal    i        4 3 2 Changing the TRIGGER  Call up  of individual Cues within a Sequence   Select the respective cue within the Trig column  red cell     Enter the following with the left Encoder or via the keyboard and confirm with ENTER      F  for FOLLOW mode     G  for GO button     S  for SOUND signal     No   Automatically according to set time  e g  if the set time is 1 5  this Cue will be called up after 1 5 seconds  automatically      4 3 3 Changing the FADE or DELAY times of individual steps within the   Sequence     Select the respective cue  red cell       Here  the duration for this cue can be changed with the In  Fade  In Delay or Snap encoder      Pressing the Basics 
33.  1 Empty                            Fader  1 12  Off    Fader  1 13  Off    Fader  1 14  Off    Fader  1 15  Off    Fader  1 16  Off    Fader Fader  1 18    Off    _      j                          Press the STORE key once  LED is on      Press a key on the Touchboard  where a Playback key is to be assigned to  once     Select a key in the REM OTE CONFIGURATION menu  Press the Playback button that you want to assign  The  selected button will now be assigned        Off       Syntax for assigning keys  STORE  RemoteButton   ExecutorButton     Remote    Touchboard       o In the TOOLS menu  you can switch the Touchboard function on or off using the ON   OFF key     Deleting assignment       press DELETE    Press the Touchboard key or the appropriate key once        The assigned playback keys will always be executed directly    The assigned playback keys will be executed in combination with the previously selected commands    Example  If an OFF key is programmed on a TOUCHBOARD key  but PAUSE is activated  See Layout and Controls   item 11   not the OFF command  but the PAUSE command will be executed when pressing this key     150 MA    LIGHTING    MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelorunn    TOOLS    Remote  DM  in           Remote DMxX Input Configuration PAGE 1  ty np y    6 2 6 233  FD 1 20 FD 1 20 FD 1 19 FD 1 18  Off Go Off Off                                                    Syntax  S l aT Al page number  Pr  Use Right Mouseclick or EDIT 
34.  10 3 3     Plus      Ranges and Range Lists  Many commands are able to operate on a list of objects   Instead of typing  DELETE SEQU 1 ENTER  DELETE SEQU 2 ENTER  DELETE SEQU 10 ENTER  you can write DELETE SEQU 1 THRU 2  10 ENTER   A range can have the following formats   X only object X    X THRU Y from object X to object Y  X THRU from object X to the last object  very dangerous    THRU Y from the first object to object Y  very dangerous      THRU all objects  very dangerous     Please note that ranges have a direction  This is particularly important when  creating selection  FIXTURE 1 THRU 10 is very different than FIXTURE 10 THRU  I    Ranges can be combined to Range Lists    OB  ECT KEYWORD Rangel      OBJ ECT KEYWORD  Rangez2      It is not necessary to repeat the OBJ ECT KEYWORD in the range list     Detailed keyword list    As starting keyword    enlarges the current selection  Everything that  follows after the plus will be interpreted as a selection      CHANNEL FIXTURE GROUP SEQU CUE EXEC PRESET EFFECT   In object lists it is including objects        OBJ ECT 1   OBJ ECT 2       In front of values it is changing the value to a positive relative value   CHANNEL 1 AT  10 ENTER will increase the dimmer value by 10     As a starting keyword  and repeated    is increasing the dimmer values  of the current selection by 10  every time you press          Minus     As starting keyword    reduces the current selection  Everything that follows  after the minus will be interpr
35.  123   MASTER 107   Master priority 194   MASTER Sequence 92   MASTER START 110   MASTER STOP 110   Mathematical Functions  132   MAtricks 55  80   M Atricks Interleave 80   MAtricks Mirror 81   M Atricks Next Prev 80   MAtricks Wings 81   maximal cue number 167   MIB 31   MIB Fade 30   MIDI Channel  selecting the  152   MIDI Control 153   MIDIIN 152   MIDI Input 152    MIDI Note 153   MIDI note 152   MIDI Programm 153   MIDI  Remote Control by  152   Midi Show Control 152   Midi Timecode 142   MIDI _BTN 174   MIDIOUT 153   MIRROR 132   Mode 33   Monitor  external 45   Motorfader 45   Mouse 35   M ouse Button  middle  70  75   Mouse function 45   MOVE 97  156  174   MOVE IN BLACK 94   Moving path 96   MSC  Midi Show Control   152   MTC  M idi Timecode  142   Multi User 18  196   Multipatch 23    NAME 94  100   NAME Field 74   NDP Configuration 205   NEGATIVE INHIBIT   groupmaster  112   Network Configuration 193   Network connections 193   NETWORK DIMMER 55   NETWORK MASTER 55   NEW START 99   New Timecode 141   NEXT 9  59  156  174   NMEA 49    No 29   NO MASTER 74   NO SWAP 66   No  94  100   NoM aster 27   NON TRACKING 17   Normal  session priority  194    0    ODD 43  156  174   OFF 17  108  174   OFF button  keep pressed  121   OFF menu  RUNNING  PROGRAM MS  121   Off On Overwritten 129   Off Overwritten 111   OFF Time 47   OFF EXECUTOR 121   OFF PAGE 121   ON 107  175   On Overwritten 111   One Shot 129   ONLY DIRECT 76   ONLY DIRECT  76   OOPS 13  175   OOPS settings 4
36.  168   Delay 94   Delay after 3 Packets 41   DELAY times in the  CHANNEL window 72   DELAY times in the FIXTURE  window 64    Delayed Output 39   DELETE 56  156  168   Delete Point 35   Desk Lamp 45   Desk  Locking the 50   DESK STATUS 55   Dim Path 96   DIMMER CHANNELS   accessing directly 70   Dimmer channels   assigning colors 25   Dimmer  creating a 18   Dimmer  editing a 18   Dimmer Group  creating a  58  112   Dimmer Option 74   Dimmer  patching a 18   Dir  direction  126   Direct DM X access 42   Discrete Values 34   Display language 46   Display Panel  Adjusting the  Viewing of the 5   DMX 4  27   DM X Addresses 66   DM X Channels  assigning  151   DMX hub 39   DM XIN  Remote Control by  151   DM X Input  using the 151   DMX LINES 54   DMX List 26  34   DM X Output Window 42   DMX Pan 24   DM X Hub 40   Dongle 37   Dot  Zero 48   Dots in Preset button 75   DOUBLE SPEED 101    Dropout Elimination 143   DUAL DIGIT VALUE ENTRY  46  215   DUMMY Function 31    EDIT 156  168   EDIT EFFECT 125   EDITFORMS 124  131   EDIT menu 94   EDIT PROFILES 35   Editing Macros 155   EFFECT 54  169   Effect  creating an    automatically 42   Effect  deleting individual  an 128   Effect  editing an 125   Effect Group  assigning a  106   Effect Group  customizing  an 129   Effect Group  editing a 125   Effect Group  executing an  128   Effect Group  switched off  131   Effect groups in Cues 130   Effect Pool 124  125   Effect run backwards 128   Effect Speed 47   EFFECTS 94  101  116   EFFE
37.  3 2 STAGE LIGHT 300 S  Create  single Groups       only       Clone          select Fixture Layer    Qty  Hame          Select       1 15  Hew Device Layer  2 15 newnewdimmer  3   testdevice Effects  amp     ns    USITT ASCII  Show File     x     MAtrick      USITT ASCH Show Import       Insert  Disk with    SHOW  ALO        What happens  Presets  1  Your current Show will be saved    2 A NEW Show will be created    3  Your Default User Settings will be loaded     Groups    Clone    aaa   Pret    eu   ene    Please Change the Show Name      AscuShow    before    You Save the NEW Show      Import Show File  USITT ASCH Format    Effects a  MA tricks        USITT ASCII       Show File    Export Show File  USITT ASCI Format       44 MA    LIGHTING    Select the fixture s  to which you want to clone the data  Fixture Sheet   If you want to clone several fixtures   you have to observe the sequence in which you select them  Pressing the left Take Selection button will display  the fixtures in the right table      To Fixtures     By pressing the  gt  gt  gt   Clone  lt  lt  lt  button  you can clone all data     Attention  All target fixture data created sofar will be overwritten deleted     2 11 4 Auto Create Effects     Press Auto Create Effects button  green background  to open the Auto Create Effects menu    By pressing the Create Built in Dafault Effects menu  you can create preset effects that will then be  available in the EFFECT pool  6 Effects   By pressing the Import Effec
38.  4   This is very diffe   rent to the  previous example      As helping keyword  See COPY MOVE and INSERT     2x AT    Will set the defaul value for selected fixtures  set in SETUP   DEFAULTS  DEFAULT    CHANNEL    as starting keyword     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    CHANNEL ENTER CHANNEL becomes the DEFAULT KEYWORD  Currently there are some limitations for copying CUES     CHANNEL  range list  ENTER Select channels in range list  1  A range list of cues can be  CHANNEL  range list  AT      see AT  Apply values to channels in range list  a  A single cue e g  CUE 1  Channel numbers in the range list must be in the interval   1     9999   b  A range of cues  e g  CUE 1 THRU 10  as target for the following executing commands  2  Also the destination object must be a CUE   ON activate dimmer value in programmer  Therefore the syntax COPY CUE 1 SEQU 1 ATSEQU 2 ENTER is not allowed   OFF deactivate dimmer value in programmer and deselect channel  Instead you must write COPY CUE 1 SEQU 1 AT CUE 2 SEQU 2 ENTER   PAUSE PARK dimmer value of channel  Please note  that CUE 1 SEQU 1 equals the term SEQU 1 CUE 1  Whenever the  GO UNPARK dimmer value of channel  term contains CUE  you are copying CUES    CLEAR CUE      Progressively performs  General Format     1  If there is a selection    gt  CLEAR_SELECTION Expression orma meaning   2  If there is an activation    gt  CLEAR_ACTIVE a of STORE o a o aaa  3  If there is stage output from progr
39.  5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand  TA 13    ie Sort Direction    BIOS Jollee S S     Sort Upwards  Sorting by ascending numbers      Sort Downwards  Sorting by descending numbers    Readout    By pressing this function  you can choose the display criteria for the values      Percent  Values will be displayed as percentages      Percent   Values will be given as percentage values  interim values will be displayed next to the figure inform of  dots      Decimal  Values will be given as decimal numbers  0 255       HEX  Values will be given as hexadecimal numbers  0  FF     Font  By pressing the function  you can switch the font size in the Channel or Fader window between Huge  very  big   Big and Small  The Settings button must be pressed  displayed with a green font     Orientation  By pressing this function  you can choose between sorting the channels from left to right or from top to  bottom    Wrap Around  If    On    has been selected  the size of the Channels will be adjusted automatically  when the  number of Channels changes    Namefield  If    On    has been selected  the Channel names are displayed    Show Cue Colors    ON  Colors of tracked   blocked values are shown   OFF  Colors of tracked   blocked values are not shown  Numbers are shown in yellow and fader bars in grey   Column  The figure indicates  how many channels will be displayed in one column  Clicking on that figure  you  can enter a new number via keyboard  confirm with ENTER  The new number will automat
40.  97297 Waldbuttelbrunn      press FORMAT  to make sure that the show will be saved safely       Saving a show     press Save Show  confirm with OK or cancel the operation with Cancel     press Save Show  enter a new name for the show  and confirm with ENTER   ae aT Tee F   insert an empty IBM  PC formatted 3 5  floppy disk  remove the write protection  small opening on the floppy     Load Compressed Show    E must be closed      confirm with OK   The SHOW will be saved  after the window has been closed  The whole operation can take some minutes  You can  only save 1 show to a floppy     if needed  use YES to save the same show on a second floppy   or finish the operation with NO     inthe end  remove floppy from the drive                11 7 Loading a Show from Floppy disk   E  gt    press BACKUP  SS     press IMPORT   EXPORT  FOF press LOAD Show  If USB storage device is inserted  the console tries to load from thi sdevice  In this case  press the green arrow and select    FLOPPY       insert the floppy containing the Show     press OK  operation can take some minutes   The Show is being loaded     inthe end  remove floppy from the drive  as otherwise the console will not boot on the next restart   In order to avoid loading all users plus their respective profiles when loading a Show  you can choose one of the  following options     accept all user profiles   EVERYTHING    do not accept any user profile   NOTHING    accept only the user who had created the Show   DISK CREATO
41.  A Chaser is a Sequence which runs automatically  During the editing process  you will be able to modify  add or  delete all the values of the individual Cues  Speed  X  FADE and SNAP  DELAY times can also be adapted globally   Apart from what is indicated in this chapter  there are three other ways of editing   See Overwriting  expanding  removing Cues and Update Cues or Presets EXECUTOR window    Press the EDIT key  LED is on      Select a Chaser with the respective EXECUTOR key  Or     Left click with the mouse into the small window above the EXECUTOR Fader   The EDIT menu appears on the right TFT display  giving a listing of the individual cues   The selected EXECUTOR fader or button is now listed in the headline  giving the page number and the name of  the sequence   In the second line  the column functions are indicated    No   The number of the individual Cues    NAME  Name of the Cue    MIB  Activate MIB  M ove In Black function  individually for each cue  Activate it by selecting a cell and shortly  pressing on the encoder on the right side of the display  Activation is confirmed by YES   MIB can only be used in cells where a           is displayed     TRIGGER  Has no effect on a Chaser  If the TIMES key on the title bar is pressed     FADE  Has no effect on Chaser    OUTFADE  Has no effect on Chaser    SNAP  Has no effect on Chaser       FADE  Has no effect on Chaser    MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn        DELAY  Has no ef
42.  ACTIVE LED at the  assigned DM X converter is on and the DM X outputs can be used  When at the node data is received  the red LED is  on    Artnet   Node Configuration    First  choose a DM X converter to be edited in the table    Pressing the Edit Nodes button for this Ethernet DM X converter will open the menu    As Shortname and Longname  you can enter any name for this converter    The IP address of the grandM As does not have to be adapted to this IP address here    For Manufacturer  IP and version  only internal data from the converter will be displayed    For SubSwitch  the DM X converter SubNet number can be changed  This change will overwrite the settings in the  converter    In the Output table  the available DM X outputs of the Ethernet  DM X converters will be displayed    In the Input table  the available DM X inputs of the Ethernet  DM X converters will be displayed  DM X input two  pages earlier     In the tables  you can adjust the SubNet and Channel addresses for every DM X output or input  This change will  overwrite the settings in the Ethernet  DM X converter    By pressing the Reset to Local Control button  the Ethernet  DM X converter will be reset to its standard  setting  Defaults     Pressing the Save button will save the modifications    By pressing the X button  you will leave this menu     PathPort DM X  ETHERNET  CONFIGURATION    You can call up this menu by pressing a button in the CONFIGURATION column  if the PathPort protocol has been  selecte
43.  ALL BUTTONS OFF  Switches off all     active EXECUTOR buttons      EVERYTHING OFF  Switches off all     EXECUTORS      CLOSE  Will close this window            EERIE a You can also switch off Executors or Pages directly   A ters vi Alaotra   merama e g      OFF key   EXECUTOR button   3   TIME key   2   Enter       OFFkey   PAGE key   3   TIME key   2   Enter        Fixtures or Groups can be released  knocked out  from direct access   e g      OFF key   FIXTURE key   3   Enter      OFF key   GROUP key   3   Enter     For quick switch off     Keep OFF button pressed  then press    GO  Switches off everything  compare with EVERTHING OFF     EXECUTOR  all executors are switched off    EFFECT  all running effects are switched off    MACRO  all running macros are switched off    Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand 4 121    Show Auto Link Auto    Mext Last  Cue    Cue eel Sort   Last A Scroll    Dimmer       sL300 2                        Display  Type   No  Page Name Typ Layer       Fader 14 1 Seg d  Fader 16 1 Seq        Sorting  amp        Settings       elect    oeoence    Last Link Auto  Cue   Tracking  Sort   Last Gos  Scroll       SC30    MIA    LIGHTING             5 7 CONTENT menu  and COMPRESSED CONTENT     These sheet is a special version of the Tracking Sheet  Not only the values for the running cue ca be  displayed  but also the values for the next or the previous    The colors of t
44.  BTN X ENTER  Linking a TOUCH _ BTN to an executor   STORE TOUCH BTN X EXEC FADEREBUTTON1 2 3 Y Z ENTER  Using EXEC in this command will always link the remote to the middle executor  button   X must be in the range from 1 to 16     UNPRESS  UNPRESS is used only in combination with functions of executor   s buttons that  Cause an action upon unpress  These functions are  FLASH _UP FLASH DOWN SWOP and TEMP   Please look at these commands for details about UNPRESS     UPDATE  UPDATE does the following things  sorted by priority   If the UPDATE dialog is open  it closes the UPDATE dialog   If the EDIT   UPDATE procedure Is active  the edited object is updated  and EDIT    UPDATE procedure is finished   It loads the UPDATE dialog   where you can update changed PRESETS and CUES     VALUE  VALUE has no other meaning than switching back to value mode if desk is in a  time mode such as FADE or DELAY     VIEW  As starting keyword  given views will be called   VIEW  range list  ENTER  View numbers in the range list must be in the interval   1     999    As target for the following commands     ASSIGN A view can be assigned to a VIEWBIN   COPY Copy one view to another   DELETE Delete a view   INSERT M OVE Change visible number of view   STORE Store a view  You will be asked for the screens that    Should be contained in the view     178 MA    LIGHTING    Views can store and restore the window arrangement on the  screens of your desk      A View can contain one screen or multiple screens
45.  Chapter 5  you will learn how to  execute Cues  Sequences and Chasers  In Chapter 6  you will learn how to create  store and  execute effects  chapter 7 with creating bitmap effects  Chapter 8 is dedicated to the Remote  Control  abbreviated as    Remote     and Timecode  while Chapter 9 explains the function of  Macros and the Quikey  Chapter 10 deals with the Command Line  Saving and loading your show  is described in chapter 11  Chapter 12 explains the updating of the operational software as well  as the fixture library  while chapter 14 is dedicated to the operation of the grandMA replay unit   Chapter 15 deals with True Tracking Backup and Playback Functions  the options in a network  environment  in chapter 16 Full  Tracking Backup  in chapter 17 how to use the Remote Control  with PocketPCs  in chapter 18 you ll find notes on the 3D Visualizer  Different usage of the MICRO  is marked by   or     and you can have a reference manual for the MICRO  too     We are sure that you will enjoy working with the grandMA and we wish your  show every success     Technical Service and Hotline   MA Lighting and its extensive distributor network offer an unparalleled technical service  Call on  our expertise for help with any problem  no matter if it is regarding operation  software features   software installations or trouble shooting    Please check our Frequently Asked Questions first  that you can find online at www malighting com   If there are any questions left  just send us a
46.  FIXTURE  odd  numbered or    even numbered 125  FIXTURE OPTION 66  FIXTURE  patchinga 18  FIXTURE SCHEDULE 18  FIXTURE  selected 64  FIXTURE  selecting a 18  Fixture Start Id 19  FIXTURE TYPES 29  FIXTURE window 60  Fixtures  Defining DM X   Addresses 54  Fixtures Inserting  deleting   or moving 24  Fixtures Library Updating   31  FIXTURES TYPES 31  FIXTURES window  colors   used for the screen   displa   233 205 230  Flash 108  FLASH_DOWN 171  Flashdisc 3  Flightcase 5  FLIP 156  Flip Stage 87  Floppy 181  FOLLOW 96  FOLLOW mode 84  FONT SIZE 67  74  115  FORM 131  171  FORWARD 101  FREEZE 9  77  From 126  FTP  File Transport Protocol    access 105  FULL 172  Full Access 31  217  Full Tracking 196  Full Tracking Backup 199    Full World 197   Function Pan 24   Function Sets 33   Functions 26   Functions  mathematical  132    G    GAIN 48  Global User Profile 53  GM A  REM OTE 208  GO 96  107  172  Go fast backwards 165  Go fast forward 165  Gobos 33  GOTO 172  GOTO   ENTER 159  GPS 49  grandMA 3D 33  grandMA 3d 31  grandMA light  7  13  115  187  grandM A replay unit 188  grandM A ultra  light  5  7  50  115  187  grandM A 3D 193  GRANDM ASTER  17  47  66  74  87  GRANDM ASTER FADER 24  Graphic parameters 33  GROUP 172  Group Button  creating a    automatically 42  Group  calling upa 58  Group  deleting a 79  Group M aster  assigning a  112  Group  moving a 59  Group Name  changing a  112    Group Overview 112  GROUPS 54  Grp  Group  127    H    HALF SPEED 101   Hard Disk 3
47.  Fade          Fixture Sheet       select the FEATURE to be executed by the modulator   here  Dimmer in the Fixture Sheet   Single   Inthe Select menu  select for which features the modulator values are supposed to be valid  In order to do so  press  Single For Active     on the right arrow and select using the Encoder  confirm by pressing on the Encoder  or select the menu by pressing  Feature    on the text button   Feature For Active  All l   SINGLE only the attribute selected from the Fixture or Channel Sheet will be changed  eile is   SINGLE for ACTIVE only the attributes selected from the Fixture or Channel Sheet and now being active will be    Defined For Active changed  l Fonture   gt  i   FEATURE only the feature selected from the Fixture or Channel Sheet will be changed            FEATURE for ACTIVE only the features selected from the Fixture or Channel Sheet and now being active will be  changed      ALL all attributes of the selected fixture will be changed    ALL for ACTIVE all attributes selected from the Fixture or Channel Sheet and now being active will be changed      DEFINED only the defined attributes will be changed In order to do so  press on the left arrow and select the desired  attributes from the menu  attributes with a green background have been selected   this setting remains valid for the  period that the show remains loaded     Modulator Table Ie  Modulator Size    Modulator Speed    Modulator Phase   DEFINED for ACTIVE only the defined and active
48.  Fix and press the Encoder  A window will open  in which you can  enter the IDs that will then be accepted  when Enter is pressed  Pressing    None    will delete them  Please  avoid any overlappings     Switching the Master  GRANDMASTER FADER  off      Select one or more cells under M aster and press the Encoder      Now  select    No    and press the Encoder one more time  If GRANDM ASTER FADER Is switched off  this will be  indicated by a    No    in the respective cell    Func  Pan   Func  Tilt     Select one or more cells under    Func   Pan    or    Func  Tilt    and press the Encoder  Now  select    Invert    and  press the Encoder one more time  If a function is inverted  this will be indicated by a    Invert  in in the  respective cell    DM X Pan   DM X Tilt   Here you can invert the DM X   signals for Pan and Tilt functions   the signals are only inverted in the DM X   Out    put  not for the visualizer  this means  that movements in the visualizer and on stange will differ    Select one or more cells under    DM X   Pan    or    DM X  Tilt    and press the Encoder  Now  select    Invert  and press   the Encoder one more time  If a function is inverted  this will be indicated by a    Invert  in in the respective cel   Changing from PAN to TILT and vice versa   Select one or more cells under    Swap    and press the Encoder  Now  select    Yes    and press the Encoder one more   time  If PAN and TILT are changed  this will be indicated by a    Yes    in in the respe
49.  Fixture with  Show Fil the self  created Presets in other Shows or on other consoles  too  you have to save this Fixture in the USER   Library on disk or floppy  See Updating the Fixture Library  USER Library     e r By pressing the    Create Dimmer Presets    button  you can creatPresets in differently adjustable levels for each  Presets E  Dimmer channel  The Presets can bei adjusted in 4 levels  5  10  20  or 25   by pressing the button on the right     Auto Create Presets       For Selected Types    AutoCreate Presets  New   AutoCreate Presets  Merge    Delete Presets        Select Fixture Types  Select    Qty  Name  MAC 500 M4    19 B       Presets_    E   E    Eos     Sow       DIM8  STAGE LIGHT 300               Select exactly 1 Fixture as reference    Create Preset Reference    All Presets which contain the selected  fixture will be stored inside the fixtures type  and can later be used for AutoCreating Presets          2 11 2 Creating groups automatically       f the Groups button is pressed  green background   you are in the Auto Create Groups menu    In the upper table  all Scanner and Dimmers are displayed that are used in the current Show    In the lower table  all    Fixture Layer    are displayed that are used in the current Show    On the right of each Scanner and Dimmer  you ll find the Select column  By choosing a cell and pressing the  Encoder on the right of the Display  these are selected and the display switches to Yes  When creating groups   groups wil
50.  Invert  Invert  Invert          Create  Multipatch      select the    S       rotate each single lamp by turning the encoder    Rotation G roup       select multiple fixtures     select the Circle icon     select the    G        rotate the fixtures    in traverse    around their virtual traverse using the Encoder      Press    X    to leave the menu      Press    Save    to save the settings      Press    Don t Save  to discard the settings     Press    Cancel    to stay in this menu     The    ALIGN    function will be of great help and save you quite some time     2 2 4 Adjusting the Fixture Layer      Fixture Layer must be active  By shortly clicking on the title bar  it will be displayed in dark blue     Select group of Fixtures  Layer       Add Line  A new group can be inserted in front of the selected group  Proceed like indicated 3 pages earlier   Creating groups with Scanners Dimmers      Delete Line  The selected group is deleted  All fixtures with all settings in this group are deleted       Moves Lines  The selected group can be moved to another position in the table  If the    M oves Lines    button was   used  this will be displayed in red  By selecting a new position in the table  the group will be moved      MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn         Fixture Layer    Name   Qty   ID Cha   ID Fix    frontOd  10 q1  1  backOl  dimmerO1        IMMmemneu    Fixtures and Channels in Layer         Hame Type ID Furvc_Tall  Sus  
51.  MA Network Connections    sessions Stations in session    grandMA    i    Ho  Hame   IP    Version No  Name   Status   IP Vers       Master 192 168 0 111 3 940    Slave  132 168 0 145 3 340    Slave  192 168 0 1  0 3 940      O Unconnected 1 gtandMA      RU iE 3940   2 iot  3 RPU    ASsconnect    Stations          15 3 Creating a Session      Before you start a Session  make sure that the appriate settings from chapter 14 2 have been made      Connections always have to be made when starting a Session      Only now canthe different units  3D  Offline  grandMAs      be integrated in this Session  After all settings are made  press the Start New Session button and confirm with OK  The name of the unit will  automatically be accepted as Session name   Or   If you want to assign a name to the Session  click into the empty cell on the side of    Session Name     enter a name  and confirm  Then press the Start New Session button and confirm with OK     In the left table  the created Session will be displayed with its name and on a light green background  This unit will  now be the only Master in this Session  Now  you must integrate another unit into this Session     15 3 1 Expanding the Session   Before units can cooperate with each other  you have to integrate the second one  or further units  theoretically up  to 10 units  into this Session      The Show of the second unit  and of all others  must be saved before  as these   even on the 3D   will  always be overwritten by the f
52.  NON  TRACKING mode  only Dimmer channels of the first copied Cue are taken account of  For  the following Cues  the Dimmer values are    0    and will have to be reprogrammed manually     4 2 Programming Sequences   Sequence is the generic term for multiple of cues  with the option of various Fade and Delay times per channel   and cue  Sequences can be stored either on an EXECUTOR fader or an EXECUTOR button      Store the first Cue  first step of a sequence  either on an EXECUTOR fader or an EXECUTOR button  See   Creating Cues     Create the second Cue  next step of the sequence  as before  When storing the second Cue  use the same  EXECUTOR fader or EXECUTOR button  Now  the STORE window will appear      In order to create a Sequence  more than one Cue   press the CREATE SECOND CUE key  The Cue will now be  stored in this Sequence as the second step  Cue 2     In the ASSIGN menu  you can define whether this Sequence should be executed in TRACKING or NON  TRACKING   mode  TRACKING and NON TRACKING  See EXECUTOR SETTINGS     Create the next Cue for any other step and use the same EXECUTOR fader or button when storing     4 2 1Copying Sequences   Once a Sequence has been created  it can be copied completely with all component Cues  Fade and Delay times     Press the COPY key once  LED is on       Press the SEQUENCE key once  LED is on     Using the numeric keypad  enter the number of the Sequence to be copied  All sequences and their numbers will  be displayed in the Assign 
53.  Numbers Big ie amet  Fader Sheet Keyboard  English    Numbers  Sheet Keyboard  Readout Dot Zero              Preset  Colours j gt                    Basic Fade Basic Outfade  8s Infade    Remotes Trackball    a a i ms  E       Snap Delay  Os       46 MA    LIGHTING         DEFAULTS  By pressing this key  you will enter the DEFAULTS menu  All general presets can be set in this    menu  See Settings in the DEFAULTS menu      By pressing this key you will enter the DATE and TIM E menu  See DATE and TIME    I     By pressing this key you can change the display language    Change dimensions M eter   Decimeter   Millimeter   Feet   Inch   Switch On   OFF the OOPS   function     To switch the screen saver off an on  By pressing the key briefly  a window will appear where you can select the  ime after which the screen saver will activate      By pressing this key  you will reach the UPDATE SOFTWARE menu  The operating system  the operating software  as well as the console software and the fixtures can be updated from this menu  See Software Update     Close menu with X     2 12 1 OOPS Function Options     If the OOPS function is activated  the will be able undo commands or values that you set  This function requires a  large amount of system resources  This requires a lot of processor power  what could slow down the console  performance  This could interfere the execution of programs  that is why you can switch it of completely or for in   dividual functions  See OOPS function   Gen
54.  Open STAGE and choose SETUP mode      Select fixtures  using the mouse or the touch screen  or enter the ID number area      Inthe WIZZARD  choose the desired function       ARRANGE IN MATRIX      Select those fixtures to be embedded into the matrix  the number should be the sum from horizontal and  vertical lines as otherwise no complete square will result      Enter the number of horizontal ROWS and vertical COLUM NS      Enter the horizontal and vertical distances of the fixtures  the resulting total value may  however  may not  exceed the stage size      Confirm using the OK button    Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand ITA 85      use POSITION   b  single      ARRANGE IN CIRCLE      Select fixtures     Set starting and end angles  between 0 and 360 or more     Set the starting and finishing radius  if the two radi are unequal  a spiral will be the result  see graphics on  the left       use POSITION   iL  single      STRETCH POSITION      Select fixtures     Use Total Factor to change the magnitude of the complete figure without changing its proportion     the value Total Factor   0 will place all fixtures in one point      Use Factor X  Y and Zto change the figure s proportion on the chosen axis  See graphics on the left  the circle  has been modified to an oval      the value 0 will yield a straight line on the respective axis       use POSITION   Va 4 single      CALCULATE FOLLOW  
55.  PAGE P  THRU  Q   Executor X to Y of page P to Q    Executor number X Y must be in the range of   1    60   where    1  20  is adressing the motorized fader executors and    21    60  is addressing the button executors      Page numbers P Q must be in the range of  1    64       as starting keyword   EXEC ENTER  EXEC  range list  ENTER  Select devices included in objects to given executors   EXEC  range list  AT     See AT   Apply values to devices included in objects assigned to given executors    the command line to an executor   XECUTING COM MANDS can be assigned with the command line to an  executor   s button  For fader executors  the keyword EXEC specifys the middle    EXEC becomes the DEFAULT KEYWORD     key    COPY Copy one executor to another   DELETE Delete an executor  This does not destroy the object that  is assigned to the executor    EDIT Edit the object that is assigned to the executor     MIA    LIGHTING    IF Deselect devices which are not part of executor   s  object s selection      FOUTPUT Select devices which have stage output from this  executor   INVERT Invert current selection by the selection of executors  object    LABEL Change name of executor   s object    MOVE M ove executor to another position   PREVIEW Preview executors object  If the object is a Sequence   and the executor is running  the next cue will be  previewed     as target for ALL executing commands   Please look at 9 3 1 Executing Keywords for a summary or look at those  keywords for 
56.  Physical Values  in P T degrees can be displayed  Layer     Display Color Mix  CMY can be displayed    Display Wheels  Gobos can be displayed    Show Cue Colors   ON  Colors of tracked   blocked values are shown  OFF  Colors of tracked   blocked values are not shown  Numbers are shown in yellow and fader bars in grey         Programmer only  The Fixture sheet will only show those fixtures and their features  whose values were     Display changed  to change values not displayed  press on the magenta PROGRAM MER ONLY button in the Layer  Filter Control bar so that the button turns grey  to display the complete Fixture sheet     Fixture Sheet Options          Sorting a  Readout        Display Wheels    Display Color Mix Color Mix    Settings          Fixture Sheet Options    Display  Filter  Mone    Programmer Re  Oni     Parked Settings    Crna    Selected Display     egue nce Filter    Filter        haulti Control          Display Filter      None  Filter is inactive  all fixtures are shown     Programmer only  Only those fixtures are shown that are in the programmer     Parked Only  Only the parked fixtures are shown     Selected Sequence  Only the Selected Sequence fixtures are shown      Selected Sequence No Default Values  Only the Selected Sequence fixtures are shown  but without default  values           Delete    S ete es                                  Z     SL300 2   60 i  3   S3003   0    aan TA 0 I      7 M ulti Control   B     SL300 6  6l te  B e   1 When On  the
57.  SETUP using UPDATE SOFTWARE and UPDATE CONSOLE     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    Tools Menu    Current User is    edi    Network    MIDI     Show Control    Remote Control    Network  gt     Setup User  amp  Profiles             DMX In   amp  Output   DMX  amp  NSP   Configuration  NDF     Configuration   VIDEO   _ Configuration    User Administration            Change current User     Current User Profile                   Load User Profile    from Show p    Save to Global  User Profile        Restore from  User Profile       Network Dimmer Processor Configuration    NDPs found in Network    ee a es   ee eS  192 168 0 113  00 02 b3 31 09f2 DATA_OPEN  192 168 0 77 _ 00 e0 4b 06 be 35 dimMA DATA_OPEN       _ Session ID Bick No                 My NDP Network Settings    Session ID               Confirm   Show  Errors   Errors                   Dimmer 1  DHX  0007    Rack 1  Crate 1  Module 3           Vier 2 Uiar DIDIEN          I _Nessage  Dimmer 001 0131  Unknown    Circuit Breaker has tripped                      Dimmer 001 01 3 1  Unknown    Circuit Breaker was switched on again    Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49  5251 688865  30    17 1 NDP Configuration     NDP Configuration    You can use this menu to configure an MA Dimmer cabinet  Fault messages and status reports are shown in the  NETWORK DIMMER menu  Please read the NDP manual if you wish to configure the dimmers  it can be  downloaded from our ho
58.  SL300 1 SL300    SL300 2 SL300   SL300 3  SL300 See PIGET 20o    SL3JOO0 4 SL300 otrobe Dimmer   oe SL300  Dimmer bit   SL300 6 SLa00   SL300 7 SL200 COLOUR FADER DIME   SL300 3 SL300 From Library   SL300 9 SL300 Sar RE 3   SL300 10 SL200 Multipatch Dummy    Hew                        Name  front01    back01 10    dimmer01 a   blinder 5 A   G     dimmetneu z T  NA Delete   N         ad Amount Multi Patch Fixtures _ Lines  Input Range   1 to 3974   Move   Lines             Name  SL300 1  SL300 2   L300  SL300 3  L300  SL300 4 SL300  SL300 5 SL300  SL300 6 S L300  SL300 7 SL300  SL300 8 SL300  SL300 9 SL300  SL300 10 SL300  New    Create  Multipatch    Patch  Sheets j      Attribute  Setup j                  Fixture    Fixtures and Channels in Layer          Name   Type ID Ch  ID Fix  Patch     Dim 1 Dim 1    ALT  Dim 1 a    Multip     Dim 2 Bm 2      AfA  2              Fixtures and Channels in Layer    Name Type  ID Ch ID Fix  Patch    Dim 5 Dim 1 fA        Dim 1 _ Multip  em 114  101 4    Dim  Dim 2 Aj           2 2 5 Adjusting individual fixture groups   Select a group in the    Fixture Layer     this will now be displayed below    Adding identical fixtures     Select    New     dark blue  and shortly press the Encoder  right to the Display   The    Create New Fixtures or  Channels    window will open  In this window  all types of fixtures are displayed that are already present in this  show      Select the type of fixture by turning the Encoder  Proceed like indicated  3 
59.  Set the mode onto ENABLED     Enter an ID number  the same number has to be set in the WYSIWYG configuration      The button has to be on Enabled if Standalone  green  in the DMX via Ethernet  in TOOLS   DMX   Configuration  menu  otherwise no DMX signal is issued outside a session    There is an extra manual available for more information on installation of the grandMA   WYSIWYG drivers    and the connection grandMA   WYSIWYG     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    E E Strand Shownet    A cia anata Mapu To output a show via STRAND   DM X  converter you need a network and the converter must have a relevant IP   adress                                      Mode  Strand Shownet Output Enabled J DMX Output ji  Priority  C DMX Input   Open TOOLS   Menueand DM X  Configuration  Goan  zs r   Press button DM X  Output via Strand Shownet to open the configuration menue  Universe        Set Mode to ENABLED  Debug Output WYSIWYG  at TextScreen Contig al      Priority  0   3  set priority  Delay after   ree   First universe set the first universe  DM X  universe has to be within the range first  last for output   oe via Strand   Last universe set the last universe  DM X  universe has to be within the range first  last for output   pee DMX via Ethernet           DMX Output  Off   Delay after 3 Packets  active with dark background  set a short break after 3 packtes  necessary for some  aaa older components to    take a breath       Send unchanged p
60.  Sorting  By the SORTING column  you define according to which aspects the fixtures and channels shall be sorted when  setting up new windows  You can switch to the next option by clicking on the respective keys   Sheet Fontsize  With the FONTSIZES column  you can define the type size of new windows   Sheet Readout  Preset for the output of numbers in the OUTPUT  CHANNEL and PATCH windows   M isc    Function of BLACKOUT key   PUSH  serves as push key  key   TOGGLE  will remain active when pressed  DISABLED  switches the blackout function off    Function of the GRANDM ASTER FADER   ENABLED  Grandmaster Fader active DISABLED  Grandmaster Fader inactive    Highlight is Solo  The button HIGHLIGHT has Solo  function  see page  75   Highlight Normal  The button    Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand  TA 4     60   168   488   iK ak 6K   L2K  lee  el a Ud A 0 er eae          Triggermonitor    I Ta   a  a a    l Se  ad a      l paw           BPM  OFF       48 MA    LIGHTING       WARNING    AUT   GAIN  is functional on GrandhA from serial nunber H5S onwards    HIGHLIGHT has HIGHLIGHT  function     KEYBOARD GERM AN ENGLISH  Switch option for country  specific keyboards     KEYBOARD Dot  Zero  Switching the key sequence on the numeric keyboard to Zero  Dot  The key caps   can be exchanged without any problems     With the Preset Color key  three different presets for the color scheme of displaying pr
61.  The Channel Value button can be used Tor all selected fixtures         Red square  he Feature or Attribute has been activated and the values have been entered in the    Fixture or Fader Sheet             Colors used for the SEQUENCE POOL  Yellow key symbol      Sequenceislockedandcannotbeedited  6  4 Ff s    lt C    lt 2U2 32U2SG   h           3      i lt CS    merme ZS SCC  gt  gt     sequence 1 is assigned to 3 executor fader or executor buttons   T When the letter Tis displayed   these sequence is in Tracking  Mode    238 PY OoitisTswTw Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr 16   D 97297 Waldbiittelbrunn    LIGHTING    Col d for th display in the Executer Fad  COLOR CODE Colors used for the screen display in the Executer Fader _ _       white triangle shows the priority when overwriting in LTP mode    title bar  no triangle   medium priority   light green this sequence is the master sequence  SELECT   Executor No   All store    title bar  commands will always affect this sequence  on the grandM A  only the yellow   only 1 master sequenz possible keys that are available in a sequence will have an effect on this sequence   dark green these sequences are Default sequences  The yellow buttons or the command    title bar  combination  e g  GO   GO    Pause  etc   and ENTER will affect all light and   possible for multiple Executors dark green Executors at the same time  The setting is temporary and will not be  adopted when saving   orange  cues this sequence is fixed and  e
62.  The function of the lower button below the Fader is displayed in the lower cell     5 3 EXECUTOR Sheet   In the EXECUTOR sheet  you can see the sequence assigned to a FADER or BUTTON while allowing you to perform  modications to cues and cue data  See Creating a window   Touch the left corner of the title bar you can open the EXECUTOR SHEET OPTIONS window    In this options window  you can select which Sequence is assigned to the executor by clicking on it  With the  FONT SIZE key  you can toggle the font size used in the EXECUTOR sheet between Huge  Big and Small  With the  DELETE WINDOW key  you can delete the Executor sheet or close the Options window using the CLOSE key    In the EXECUTOR sheet  you can watch the progress of the sequence  the currently playing back Cue will be  displayed by a yellow background     Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand HALLS    Executor 1 1  sequ  3    seq J      Action Master  F Speed  F  Fade  F  Made       Cuelist View Mode Options    f   af    Save as  Default    116 MA    LIGHTING       You can modify the M ASTER fader using the left Encoder or by pressing the button above it   Using the    RATE FACTOR    Encoder  you can temporarily adjust all FADE and DELAY times  If the Sequence is    switched off  the RATE FACTOR will automatically be reset to 1     You can set the time to be used when switching off  OFF key  using the right Encoder or by pressin
63.  Top  Resets the Sequence to the first cue     Empty  Button has no function     Flash  Sets the Dimmer channels in the current cue to 100  of their programmed value  Starts the sequence   if not already activated     Out  Sets the Dimmer channels in the current cue to 0  of their programmed value  Starts the sequence  if not  already activated      Toggle  To switch on and off the Sequence or Chaser     Fix  Will fix Sequence or chaser on this executor  even when switching PAGES here  this will be displayed by an  orange background in the small EXECUTOR window      Load  Pressing the button on the right TFT display will open a chart for this sequence where you can select and  directly load the next cue to be played back in the sequence  LOAD CUE   Start the cue using the GO button     Select  M akes this executor the Selected Sequence     Swop  As long as the button is pushed all other dimmer channels are faded out  except with executors  where    oWoOp Protected    has been activated     Kill  Has the same function as GO  but will switch off all running Executors     With the Size of Executor buttons 1   5  you can define how many faders and buttons are available for  controlling your sequence on EXECUTOR FADERs  and whether one to five buttons could be used for EXECUTOR  BUTTONS    The respective titles will be displayed on the TFT display above the EXECUTOR FADERS  When the LIST function is  active  the function of the EXECUTOR buttons will be displayed above these button
64.  ae bs eLA e ee E  change the setup of the current show   Add Unmatched Devices  Harmless    ADD UNMATCHED DEVICES   Harmless  here  only those parts of the imported show will be transferred that   Use Oid Devices  Dangerous  do not overlap with the current setup   i e  the current setup will not be changed  but only extended  No risk of  ruining the current show      USE OLD DEVICES   Dangerous  here  the complete setup of the imported show will overwrite the setup of  the current show  Only those parts that do not overlap will be kept           Partial Show Read Data Menu x lt   CE f    confirm with OK  NEXT   Matrix   confirm PLEASE CONFIRM with OK     confirm WARNING    Worlds           Copy                       1  oben Has Changed   Layout  Macro  Form   H Eff  Bitmap Effect  H Seq    Merge            After opening the files  the BACKUP menu will open again        woa DS    j     press MERGE CONTENTS                         ETARE User Data l    EB andre ay   select the desired show elements   will receive a dark green background      Bea  see   move the blinking frame using the Encoder  Using the Encoder  open or close the sub folders  marked with a     E View Buttons Remove or   sign   or select individual elements    4  Unchanged      ut            5  Chat Settings Rome    the text note    has changed  It is older    in red  This element is older than that having the same name in the    6  User Settings Has Changed  i    1 1    21 Encoder Definition Remove current sho
65.  any objects through the slots of the unit  as these could    get in contact with live parts or could cause short circuits  This may  cause a fire and an electric shock       Do not place the unit on unstable surfaces  It may fall and get damaged   10     The unit is provided with a safety plug  This plug can only be used  with safety sockets  These precautions should by all means be followed   If the plug should not fit into a given socket  e g  the case with old  sockets   the socket should be replaced by an electrician     Do not ignore the safety purpose of the grounding type plug  A  grounding type plug has two blades and a third grounding prong  The  third prong is provided for your safety  If the provided plug does not fit  into your outlet  consult an electrician for replacement of the obsole   te outlet     Do not place any objects on the power cord  Protect it from being  walked on or pinched particularly at plugs and the point where they  exit from the apparatus     If using an extension cord  make sure the rated output of all units  connected in aggregate does not exceed the maximum rated output  of the extension cord  The rated output of the units plugged into the  socket should in aggregate not exceed 10 amperes     MIA    LIGHTING    14  If the power cord or the mains plug is damaged  let a qualified technician replace it immediately   15  Only use power cords which are marked as safety  proof     16  Refer all servicing to qualified service personnel  Servicin
66.  are not exposed to mechanic stress     Transportation Case Housing    During transport  take care that the touchscreens are not exposed to mechanical   Do not block or cover the ventilation  If there is a high ambient temperature  the  stress  Flightcases not provided by MA Lighting have to be designed in a way that display pannel  grandM A only  should be at least 5 cm open to ensure sufficient        ventilation   under no circumstances pressure can be exerted on the TFT displays    Do not place any drinks on the unit       Do not use excessive force when adjusting the viewing angle of the display panel  Panel  grandMA only   grandM A only    If the mechanical parts of the display panel have not been moved for a period of time   more than 24 hours typically   you may feel a stronger resistance when adjusting the  angle  This is normal and related to the mechanics of the pannel     Battery  not on the ultra light and micro   pico     In case of power failure  the console offers  with fully charged battery  an emergency  backup of at least 12 minutes  In case of a power failure  the console will automatically  switch off after approximately another 3 minutes or another 12 minutes when  CONTINUE is pressed  If this occurs  the console will automatically save all  data     When switching off the unit via built in power switch  all current show data is  saved automatically     In case of an automatic shut  down after a power failure  described above   the unit  must be running 
67.  attributes will be changed         select a modulator  in order to do so  press on the right arrow and select it using the Encoder  confirm by pressing  on the Encoder  or select the menu by pressing on the text button       select MODULATOR PROPERTIES using the left Encoder below the Screen  chose an effect or a setting and confirm  by pressing on he Encoder on the side of the Screen        Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand HAAS    134    Ries lie Spa  Fage Hange     lu te   Suu      Mim f aodritass  MEL       MIA    LIGHTING    NONE no effect selected   PWM Impulse Width Modulation   RANDOM Random fade  ins of individual channels of the selected function   TABLE here  specific effects have a special background  identical to TABLE in EDIT EFFECT     FORM here  forms that were previously defined and arein the FORM pool memory have a special  background      MODULATOR SIZE  here  you can enter the size of the effect  in the graphics  100  are entered     open the Calculator using the Encoder below the Screen  enter the value und confirm with ENTER    MODULATOR SPEED  here  you can enter the effect speed in BeatsPerM inute     open the Calculator using the Encoder below the Screen  enter the value und confirm with ENTER    MODULATOR PHASE  here  you can enter the angle for shifting the modulator     open the Calculator using the Encoder below the Screen  enter the value und confirm with EN
68.  by MA Lighting   D Link DI  614   3 COM WLAN Access point 2000  D  Link DWL 900APP  Wireless Access Point  D  Link DWL  800AP   E POX EWL A11 Accesspoint  US ROBOTICS USR 5450  LANCOM L 54 g Wireless  recommended by MA Lighting   APPLE AirPort Extreme 802 11n Wi  Fi  If in the network there is a device having a transmission rate of more than 10M bit  the whole network will be    reduced to that transmission rate  As at the time being  all Access Points work with this rate  using a PDA  id be  e Power save mode must be can potentially affect the network  i i       Installation    Install the Wireless Access Point according the the manufacturer s instructions    On the PocketPC  select the installed adapter under SETTINGS   CONNECTIONS   NETWORK ADAPTER and enter the  IP address plus subnet mask number 255 255 255 0 under PROPERTIES  see Preparing the Network settings    Download the  REM OTE X X    software from our website and connect the PocketPC via COM or USB interface with  a PC  The program ACTIVE SYNC must be installed  Start the SETUP EXE file   the software for remote controlling    Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand HAOI      fA         af    GMA Remote    Y gt  q   10 38 ok    Sort By   _ am  Readout f F    Name    Pan    SL300 1 88  300 3    m   Bi      d i  a    C  a   a    i  B   B    208 MA    LIGHTING       the grandM A console will be installed on the PocketPC  The softwar
69.  can be done up to 8 times   Modification will be displayed above the left Encoder   This key will bring you to the ASSIGN menu  See ASSIGN menu  The Edit  CUE button allows you the modify values of individual Cues  LED in Edit key will flash   See Changing       24  Page 1  agl   4           Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand HAAOL       UPDATE    102 MA    LIGHTING    values of individual Chaser steps  Above the encoders on the right screen  playback soft keys and the name of the chase are displayed  The  functions of these soft keys are     EDIT  Open edit menu for the chase  LEFT ARROW  GO   Run backwards   SQUARE  OFF  Stop     DOUBLE LINE  PAUSE  Has toggle function   RIGHT ARROW  GO  Run forward   PAGE X  Toggle between encoder functions  The important functions are on page 1     As usual  a pushed and then turned encoder works with a different resolution  depending on the settings  in the setup menu   An encoder click   push and release without turning  brings up a huge fader on screen     Encoder functions of page 1    SPEED SCALE  Divides or multiplies the speed with a factor    SPEED  The speed of the chase  The accessible range depends on the speed scale  If the chase belongs to a speed   group  changing the chases speed will affect the speed group   also the other way around      FADE  Step by step INFADE time  Defines the smoothness of the running chase    M ASTER FADE  Contr
70.  can be found in the context menu of the timecode pool  This can  be accessed by right clicking on the headline of the Timecode pool    The names for pre roll and after roll have a historical significance  At the beginning of the timecode era   the  huge tapes in the machines which contained timecode and audio signals where really visibly rolling     NOTE  Set After Roll to minimum 0 37 seconds  Shorter time can cause failure of the time code show     Manually Changing the Current Time   If the show is playing back or recording with external sync  it is not possible to change the time manually   There are many different ways to change the current time of your show when using the internal time base   Graphically with the mouse      left mouse click somewhere into the timeline   With the encoder      Turn the time encoder  leftmost  to change the current time  Each click on the encoder means one frame     If you p ress and turn this encoder simultaneously  each click means one second      If you press the encoder without turning  you can enter an absolute time    With the    jump to breakpoint    commands      You will find them as the outer playback symbols in the timecode control bar and as command line functions   lt  lt  lt  and  gt  gt  gt       Time will jump to the next available breakpoint in the given direction    With the event encoder  second  in the bar      Whenever you select a new event   time will jump to the exact time of that event     Technischer Service  tec
71.  can filter the command  e g  With IFACTIVE SEQ X  you can select all Fixtures and Channels of  this Sequence having active values  or IFACTIVE GROUP 1 will select all Fixtures in Group 1 having active values     9 3 Agenda Menu  In this window you can set the time of day and date for the automatic execution of M acros  It is also possible to set  relative trigger points using sunrise  sunset  dawn and dusk as a reference   SaaS ee Sse   You can select a different Edit Date by using the encoders or the keys on the display   IEE 023000 20000  vest Ee 420 ag rab 2s anos Jan  ad   Pressing this key  you can toggle between day  week  month or year in this display     If DAY is chosen  the ADD  DEL and EDIT keys will be displayed   Pressing the ADD key will include a new column in the sheet  where you can set the programming for automatic  control   If a column is selected  you can delete it by pressing the DEL key   If a cell is selected  you can change the function   time by pressing the EDIT key   All created events will be displayed in this sheet   Selecting a cell within a column and pressing the encoder will open a window where you can enter the following     February 2008               Start  Absolute  The Macro will be started at the set time      Dawn  The Macro will be triggered at the calculated time for dawn      Sunrise  The Macro will be triggered at the calculated time for sunrise     Sunset  The Macro will be triggered at the calculated time for sunset     Dusk  Th
72.  chasers using this speed master   executor assigned to a speed master   SUBM ASTER Unpark all channels involved in this group   CHANNEL  FIXTURE  GROUP Unpark devices   PRESET X  Preset Type  Unpark all channels of current  selection of that preset type  GO     As starting keyword  every object that follows after the GO will try to go  backwards one step    GO   target object list   FADE X   DELAY Y   ENTER    If fade or delay are given  they overwrite the default GO  times    The default GO  times can be changed in the SETUP   DEFAULTS menu   Target type Operation   EXEC Go backwards one step    172 MA    LIGHTING    EFFECT Start running backwards  PAGE GO  on all its executors   SPEEDM ASTER GO  on all programs using this speed master executor    assigned to a speed master     GOTO  As starting keyword  every executor that follows after the GOTO will try to go  directly to a given step   GOTO  CUE   W   EXEC X   FADE Y   DELAY Z   ENTER   Using the keyword CUE is optional   If W  cue number  is not given  you will be prompted for it   If executor is not given  default executor will be used   If fade or delay are given  they overwrite the default GOTO times   The default GOTO times can be changed in the SETUP   DEFAULTS menu   In an assign command  this function can be put directly on to an executor  button  see ASSIGN    In actual fact you will end up with an LOAD assigned to the executor button as it  has to ask for the cue number     GROUP  As starting keyword   GROUP EN
73.  cleard  e g  2x Clear  Fixture  Preset amp aVal background  Theatrical   Aion Mba  Value lightbluewithred selected  value froma preset  S    Pan Tit   Dimmedeah background  Default    Pan Tilt Dim NE          n ee value light blue with dark red not selected  value from a preset      background  Default   value white with green not selected  not active  value from a preset  background  Default     bk L value red with dark re selected  value from a preset         _       background   light blue bar  Theatrical   Ma  cI 400 g   i value red with very dark re not selected  value from a preset        SL300 9   er        background   light blue bar  Theatrical   10     SL300 10     F      value red with dark blue not selected  not active  value from a preset   SL300 1 no     background   light blue bar  Theatrical   Theatrical Colours value yellow value from a sequence  value light blue value from the selected sequence  value green value from the selected sequence and has beenreduce  value magenta value from the selected sequence and is   tracked      with different  background colour  depending onorigin  white square  only TIx position of a moving head fixture  3 settings possible       Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand Mf 233    violet bar these attributes has modulator  values            Closec ue bar the channels are    parked     On the output  no changes  R i k m us   will be output  the 
74.  commands  In the macro  shown left  a channel is set to 100  with the f irst command  The second command  is to park this channel with the 100  output  With the setting NOT TIMED both commands would be executed  simultanously and the channel would be parked without an output  no time to set the output   WORKAROUND  set  a short delay  for example 0 2 seconds   then both commands can be executed completely     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn               Edit Macro 5    Macro 5   COMMAND    ws   9 1 3 Editing Macros      Press the EDIT key once  Select a Macro from the MACRO Pool              z  Z  m    Fader 1 7 At 100             See Dette     Press the EDIT key once  Press the MACRO key once  enter the Macro number and confirm with ENTER  The  4 Fader 1 10 At 100 Line s  EDIT M ACRO window will open   ft     lt    Inthe LINE column  the individual commands are numbered   4 A Ramga   Ue AE 2an A   In the COM M AND column  all stored commands are displayed one by one       For each command the time between steps where the macro was recorded is displayed in the DELAY column   This times can be edited or ignored for playback purposes   Note  if a GO command is assigned to line in the DELAY column  see example left   the macro  in    Timed M acro      mode  will have a break and can only continued with a GO  command   see previous page     Pressing the ADD LINE key will insert a step in front of the chosen position  Now you can enter o
75.  corner of the title bar    Or    With a right click using the mouse on the title bar  you can open the Agenda Options window    The table will show all created events  By clicking with the mouse or the encoder you can select and edit specific  events    Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand  A51       10 Command line    10 1 Introduction   The following chapter describes the functionality of the grandMA family of consoles that can  be achieved using the command line       Command line operation    means using physical keys or the keyboard as opposed to using  the mouse or touchscreen s     10 1 2 Quikeys   On some grandMA consoles  particularly the grandM A replay unit  you may not find all of the  described hard Keys  In spite of this small disadvantage  you can create a QUIKEY pool  window on the screen and arrange the missing functions there  Then simply use these    soft  keys    instead of the hard keys    10 1 3 Double functions of hard keys   Some keys have more than one function due to space considerations  Some hard keys have  an alternative function at the second or even the third push  These keys are    Hard key First press Second press Third press  ASSIGN ASSIGN LABEL   CHANNEL CHANNEL DM X   EXEC EXEC FADER   GOTO GOTO LOAD   IF  FOUTPUT IF   MOVE MOVE INSERT   PRESET PRESET FEATURE   TIME FADE DELAY VALUE  VIEW VIEW VIEW KEY   EFFECT EFFECT Call up an effect view   GROUP GROUP 
76.  create a profile      Touching the screen will create a reticule ADD POINT creates a new point in the center of the reticule  DELETE   POINT delets the point      With the encoder POINT you can jump to the next point  the encoders In X and Out Y adjusts the reticule      Move a point with a touch on the screen or with    grabbing    with the left button of the mouse    When a red point is in the center of the reticule  the button TOGGLE CURVE tranfer the straight line into a curve   between 2 points  The point changes from red to yellow      some predefined profiles are stoed inthe menu PREDEFINED      the MIRROR   function inverts input and output     With leaving the EDIT menuthe profile is stored automatically     DELETE PROFILE will delete a profile from the overview   You can t delete a Fade Path and you can not create a new Fade Path  If all Fade pathes are used  you must   change the profile in this path  ATTENTION  all cues  which uses this path will get the new profile too     4 3 4 Moving Cues     Press the M OVE Key once  LED is on       Press the SEQUENCE Key once  LED is on       Using the keypad  enter the number of the Sequence in which Cues are to be moved     Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand ITA 97      Press the CUE key once  LED is on      Using the keypad  enter the number of the first Cue to be moved  If only one Cue is to be moved  continue with the  AT key       P
77.  defective this may cause a loss of show data as only DM X channels 1 to 2048 are processed  on    smaller    2048 channel systems  Therefore please make sure that the channel upgrade is being implemented  on the slave    16 3 3 Using a PC as master or slave console   Though the grandMA Offline Editor software cannot be used to actively control DM X  channels as the DM X   Ethernet protocol is permanently disabled it still can be used in a master slave connection with    real    grandMA  consoles    Because of the limitations of the PC hardware in combination with Windows  operation systems the grandM A Off   line Editor must be seen as    weakest    part of the EtherNet chain therefore it may only be operated as slave  console    You may use this setup with a PC as slave to easily transfer show file data to other grandM A consoles  whatever  type they are   especially when they are used on a distributed network        200 ME   ooo Wt Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr 16 D 97297 Waldbittelbrunn    LIGHTING                                                           16 4 Connecting consoles for a Network Backup system   Any True Tracking Backup configuration with grandMA components may only be connected via a EtherNet  communications network  The grandMA consoles currently support two different hardware types of transmission  media     16 4 1 10 Base 2 EtherNet  not for grandMA ultra light    EtherNet with 10 Base  2 connection media  also Known as    Cheapnet     has los
78.  down and click on the desired Executors  no effects or Bitmap effects   the first  EN ea He Executor becomes the Selected sequence  light green  and the following Executors become Default sequences  no  irgu oe  dark green   This selection is temporary and cannot be saved in the Show file        HY  1      A further selection  holt the SELECT button and click on Exec  will delete the previous selection     GOTO 4 2 4 LOAD CUE   You can use LOAD CUE In order to directly call up a certain cue with either one or several executors      Press the GOTO key twice  LED is blinks       Select an executor by shortly pressing a key    A window with a chart appears  All cues of this sequence are listed in this chart    If you select one of these cues  it will be loaded  This cue will be displayed as next  red blinking background  in    MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    T  re  oe fr ea        E   An AN        Fikaid         LIGHTING      the small executor window above the executor   t 3   Start this cue with the GO button        huw Cues within the Mastersequence can be directly loaded        Press GOTO key twice  LED is on    Load   Enter Cue number using the keypad and confirm with ENTER   F The Cue will be loaded and displayed as next  red blinking background  in the small executor window       Prais   ue with the GO button    2 2Playing back sequences or chasers    31 Using the EXECUTOR button  you can playback the stored Sequences directly
79.  each fifth fixture of the whole selection and move this  Subselection    Next Prev must be    Off    Switch it off by shortly pressing into the center of    Next Prev    to     lt  2nd  gt     The display  will switch to    Off      Then  press      gt     under    Settings    next to    Interleave     until a 5 appears  Now  you have selected only the first   sixth  eleventh       fixture    By shortly pressing     lt or  gt     next to    Interleave Next Prev   you can move the selection by one position up or  down    If you want to move several fixtures simultaneously  you can define this under    Groups     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn       STORE    Circular Copy    J  a Filter  al        MA    Tricks iik    Setu  F     Fixture Sheet Values  amp  Presets 51    Pan  Tilt  Pan Tilt  RS nee  2     VLI000AS 1 50 00     Closed  Open 50    3   VLI000AS 1 50 00   Closed  Open 50    A  VLIO00A5 1 50 00 gt    Closed  Open 50    Cr RS ee  6  pa       Id       Hame     VLIOO0AS 1  50 0 0   Closed  Open 50    f    YL1000A5S 1  50 0 0   Closed  Open 50       amp      LI000AS 1 50 0 0    Closed  Open 50    3      f Y  L1I000A5 1 50 0 0    Closed  Open 50    10    Y  L1000A5 1 50 00   _  Closed  Open 50    20      L 100075 1 50 0 0 _   Closed   Open 50      Additionally    Wings  Allows you to split and mirror the whole selection    E g   When you have a setting of 2  the complete selection of fixtures will be split in the middle  The set s
80.  filters LAYER CONTROL and PRESET CONTROL bars are replaced by a line with 3 pull down menus    EO containing all buttons  This saves space on the screen   Hone Parked Selected  i Only Seguente  esels Wodulator aay  ea m   Eadie  i    ma G   i oi   PRESET CONTROLON  selectable in the Display Layer     68 MA     SMa Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr 16   D 97297 Waldbittelbrunn    LIGHTING      Fixtures  Values   Sot   Auto    Auto  e oo sorted by Numbers        Cos   Rows   Filter   S  R aa ka l oy Ch Frost teeus J When On  the display filter is shown as buttons in the fixture sheet  Use these buttons to switch over the display  t  S3001 Gi it Sma e 0 without calling up the Options menu                 Programmer  Only       LAYER CONTROLON  selectable in the Display Layer           hodulator Modulator Modulator                G1 Mat           ly   Guu ca    Wales Inside  unctionel WEES Tanen l    T EAEn E  Bahn hred hed 1          Wales Inside Fune onal Slee ae  Name i eens                                           17 Tpen   s    Gobal  f   code a I  A  Gubuse gt     37  ay   5    E r  ipn  s sa o Eey Ea T 2   5mp  Liay Pak pitti log _   BB Clay Pak pS M61 Flan                                Man  Input AeA r 1 In Ah   x    Gna     7 5   z  pais  is I          ari zi  FEI        Cier 3    Thi So              3 4 10 SM ART  Window  The SM ART window offers you an overview of all features and attributes of the selected fixtures  as well as very  fast way to change  save 
81.  for moving light control or theatre applications                  When working with a tracking cuelist it only makes sense to store values that have changed  On playback  the  grandMA will hold a parameters value until it is given a new value by subsequent cues    NON TRACKING CUELIST   With anon tracking cuelist  all values to be playback have to be stored in each respective cue  as all values not  stored within a cue  will be switched off     O    or default      Playback buttons and faders     The motor faders allow to work on different pages simultaneously  With OFF  playback of cues loaded onto  executors can be stopped      With the ASSIGN   EXECUTOR buttons  you can define  which sequences with which functions are to be  playbacked on executors      The 12 function keys can be used for any Playback  OFF   EXECUTOR1      To call up a cue with a fader  it has to be activated via GO   TOP or ON   Watch out for the GRANDM ASTER   or simply switch it off in the Setup menu     Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand ITA 17    Fixture Schedule       Change Structure  OF Show  Create or  Delete Fixtures ete     Change Patch and  Fixture Settings  Live On Stage    Automatic    ation  of Presets  Groups  and Effects      Version    3 843       DMX Count      4056        Fixture Schedule    Full  Access       Live    Touchscreen Calibration     Left Middle   Right       Touchscreen Options     Lef
82.  for special cases     All for Selected Devices  Will store all values of the selected Scanners and Dimmers  the Scanners or  Dimmers are indicated by yellow names    If not empty     Merge  When expanding Cues  all settings already stored will be kept  The newly set values will be stored to the                                                    E mm Cue as additions  already existing ones will be overwritten    No  Name eae   Di E   Overwrite  Cue will be overwritten completely     z aa      m JEL LL   Remove  When removing  only those parts of the Cue will be cut  deleted  out of the existing Cue that are active  11 Cue Upen Rae E   E E   mmm   Realease    e 2 Cue oat ml   Ope nm This option  no matter which settings are done  will store no values for the selected channles  RELEASE   3 op  Cue Meleaj outputs no values and enables other playbacks to use this channel  this means  even though the sequence is  A 4 Cue running  this channel can be used by another sequence  chaser  etc  till this channel gets an value in a  En te following cue  In the left shown example the dimmer no  2 during cue 3 and 6 can be used by another   oe i T Cue playback  of course also in cue 1   If no other playback is running  using this channel  there is no output for  6   6B Cue this channel during this cue          select a channel and set an dummy  value    Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand A  89    AL  Pl 
83.  im Remote  PDA  211    Show  deleting from  harddisk 180   Show Import 44   Show  loading from harddisk  180   Show  saving on floppy disk  180    Show  saving the current on  harddisk 179   Shuffle select order 82   Shuffle value 82   SIN 124   Single 64   SINGLE DIGIT VALUE ENTRY  46  215   Size 126   Size of EXECUTOR buttons  108   SMART 55   SMART Window 69   SMPTE 141   SNAP 94  100   SNAP DELAY 17  88   SOFT 95  101   SOFT Keyboard 7  14   SOFTNESS 128   Software Crash 6   Software Update 185  187   Software  version 55   SOLO function 75   SOUND 48  101   Sound Signal 96   Sound Signal  Setting of a  48   Special functions 225   Special M asters  assigning  113   SPEED  95  101  107  128  129   Speed Group 113  129    SPEED INDV  101   SPEED SCALE 129   STAGE 26  30  32  55   Stage Flip 87   Stage size 20   Stage window 84   START LINE 99   Start New Session 195   Start Speed 129   Statuscopy 98   STORE 16  156  177   STORE encoder window 90   STORE ENCODER WINDOW   90   STORE LED 57   Store Options 89   Store Realease 89   Store Source  89   Strand Shownet 41   STRETCH POSITION 86   SUB NET addresses 38   SubNet 39   Subnet mas 207   Summer Time 49   SWAP 107   SWOP 108  177   SWOP_OFF 177   Sync Start 129    T    Table 125   TEMP 108  177  Temp 107   Temporary Views 56  TEST OUT 20   Throw Out Station 196  THRU 177  TILTNORMAL 66   TILT OFFSET 31   TIME 17  64  72  92    Time  automatically  according to set 96  Time Scaling Chaser 103  Time Scaling Sequence 96  Tim
84.  in the    Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865  30    Examples      EDIT PRESET 1 ENTER  Starts edit update for first non empty PAN TILT preset   EDIT NEXT goes on to the next non  empty PAN TILT preset      EDIT SEQUENCE 1 ENTER  Starts edit update for first cue    EDIT NEXT goes on to second cue    Together with the HIGHLIGHT function  EDIT NEXT is a very powerful tool to for  checking your stage presets    Opening an edit screen    Some objects can not be edited in the programmer  They have edit screens to  manipulate them  Only one edit menu for only object can be open at one time   If you open an edit menu for an object  all other edit menus will close  Edit  menus can be closed with the ESC key     EDIT EFFECT X ENTER or EDIT  hit key in effect pool   EDIT EXEC X Y ENTER or EDIT  hit executor    EDITFORM X ENTER or EDIT  hit key in form pool   EDIT MACRO X ENTER or EDIT  hit key in macro pool   EDIT TIMECODE X ENTER or EDIT  hit key in timecode pool     EFFECT    As starting keyword    EFFECT ENTER   EFFECT becomes the DEFAULT KEYWORD    EFFECT  range list  ENTER   Start effects in range list    Effect numbers in the range list must be in the interval   1     999    Effects are numbered in a certain way     Range Meaning   1    upwards User created effects   899    downwards Automatic created effects used by cuelists   900     upwards Temporary effects  created from preset effects  These  effects are not visible in pools    As target for t
85.  in the MATricks menu or using the Quikeys     SHUFFLE VALUE examples      Select the first 11 fixtures in the FaderSheet  from left to right      Press ALIGN once and increase the dimmer value   As dimmers were selected in ascending order  the values between the first selected fixtures  n   1  and the last  selected fixtures  n   11  will also be aligned in ascending order  ALIGN function    see graphics above  NOTE   Important for an alignment using the ALIGN function is always the order in which the selection takes place and  not the channel number      Press Select Value once  either using the Button or the Quikey    The values will be kept  but randomly assigned to the dimmers  graphics in the middle      Press Select Value once  the values will receive a new assignment  bottom graphics    This procedure can be repeated at will     SHUFFLE SELECT ORDER examples      Select the first 15 fixtures in the FaderSheet  from left to right      in the MATricks menu  set the groups of five     Use NEXT to select the groups of five  for a better visualization  the groups have received different dimmer  values         MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    As the dimmers were selected in ascending order  the groups will be formed in this order  too  1  group  n   1   5   e Fader Sheet Values sorted by Numbers    2 group   n   6   10  3  group  n   11   15   Using the SHUFFLE SELECT ORDER  you can change the selection order  i e  that will also 
86.  into a cell  indicated by the Focus   colored frame and or blue background  and press on the Encoder on the right  side of the display    In this window  you can enter values or times and recalculate them    Presets can be called up for the selected Fixtures or Channels    If in the Executor Sheet or in the EDIT menu  a trigger call or time is selected  you can open this window by pressing  the Encoder on the right side of the Display    If Fixtures or Channels are selected  this window can be opened by pressing the respective keys for this function above  the Encoder    The title bar of this window will display the selected function  In the upper cell  the current value will be displayed    Using the touch screen  the number pad or turning the encoder on the right of the display you can enter a different  value or time  and accept it by pressing the OK Key    Left of the numbers  the following keys are displayed  H  for hours   M  for minutes   S  for seconds  and F  for frames    With these keys  you can directly enter times  if necessary    Or    If a function is selected  keys for Clear  Deactivate and the individual presets are displayed in the lower part  If you    Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand  TA 13    oops Press CLEAR  the values of the selected Fixtures or Channels will be deleted  If you press DEACTIVATE  the active  values of the selected Fixtures or Channels will be dele
87.  is one from the MA Library  If a self  created fixture is used  you ll   find the date off creation here      Type  Toggle between mirror or moving head Fixture  When using moving head Fixtures  the FIXTURE SHEET  will show a square left of the PAN value  indicating the current head position       MIB Delay  To set a DELAY time for the M OVE IN BLACK function for this fixture  If Default is displayed  the set  value from the DEFAULT menu is used  See Settings in the DEFAULTS menu     MIB Fade  To set a FADE time for the M OVE IN BLACK function for this fixture  If Default is displayed  the set   value from the DEFAULT menu is used  See Settings in the DEFAULTS menu     BeamAngle  M ax  Beamwidth in degree  Zoom and Iris  function corresponds to this value       Power  For the 3D view  see 3D instructions      Lumen  For the 3D view  see 3D instructions       Weight  For the 3D view  see 3D instructions    If you select a fixture  the individual functions of this fixture will be displayed in the lower part of the Displays      No  Listing of the individual DM X channels  If a number is displayed in red and with an asterisk  this channel   has been modified      Break  If one cell contains a    Yes   you can assign a different DM X address from the next channel onwards  To  change the setting  select a cell and press the Encoder  Now  select    Yes    and press the Encoder one more time      Attribut  Listing of the individual functions  Press Encoder and choose function      
88.  keyboard    a   press Update Software from Floppy      when asked to  insert the floppy and confirm with OK           Update Libraries from Floppy Version    Info       Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand HAAB    ATTENTION PLEASE  Deactivate  Anti  Virus or Firewalls  Those  can affect proper operation     186 MA    LIGHTING    Before changing disks  make sure that the green LED on the floppy drive is off     The update can last up to 10 minutes  After updating   it is possible to do a reset    By pressing the soft key    VERSION INFO    you can read about new functionality and fixed bugs of the latest  update  To renew the Fixtures Library  insert the optional available FIXTURE UPDATE floppy and press the    Update  Fixture Library from Floppy    button  This may last a few minutes  After processing the note    Fixture Library Up   date done    appears  Additionally here is a possiblity to import older fixtures made with version 3 2  3 3     Update via network   for that  the new software has to be loaded onto the console    grandM A  grandM A  Light  grandMA Ultra  Light   grandM A MICRO  NSP  OFFLINE Editor and grandM A Replay  Unit   connected via a network  can be updated among themselves    Proceed very carefully  This operation may be carried out by qualified grandMA users only  Futhermore  this  Operation requires an impeccable network not overloaded at this moment  IN NO CASE MAY 
89.  locked to that position when switching the Executor pages and will only be released when it is switched    Size of Executor    lt  lt a 7 off  If an Executor is stored at that position on another page  this Executor will appear and can be used again only       after switching the locked Executor off    If the    Swop Protected    key is pressed  the Dimmers of this Sequence will not be switched off  when another  Sequence is called up using Swop      If the TRACKING key is pressed  dark background   the Sequence will be executed in Tracking mode  If the key is  default i not pressed  the Sequence will be executed in Non Tracking mode    The TRACKING mode is normally used for theatre applications    Values that were played back in a Cue  remain unchanged for each susequent Cue  until they are modified or  overwritten by a later Cue  LTP principle   Therefore  you do not have to program values which do not change into  later cues    Example  At the beginning of a Sequence  Dimmer channels are set to 80   Let   s assume that the setting isto be  used for several cues  As long as the channels are not modified  they will remain at 80   When working with this  Sequence  you may recognize  however  that the channel setting should only be at 70   Now  you only have to  change this channel setting once  all subsequent Cues will automatically be    modified    to 70     Example  Cue 10 is made up of the changes programed in cue 10 as well all the changes in cues1 thru 9 with the  late
90.  lt    gt  gt  gt   ON and OFF    Combining the two methods      COMMAND  as described above  and then touch a key in the timecode pool    Description of playback commands     Status Command Line Description   STOP OFF Show is stopped  no output is generated    PAUSE PAUSE Show is stopped  output is generated for current time   PLAY GO  Show is running    RECORD STORE Show is recording    JUMP BACK  lt  lt  lt  Show jumps to the next breakpoint before current time   JUM P FORWARD  gt  gt  gt  Show jumps to the next breakpoint after the current time     If a show is generating output  the corresponding key in the timecode pool will show the current time  In case of  recording  this key is also blinking red with the note    REC     AUTOSELECT ON   light background  the selected track is green highlighted and is permanent shown  OFF   dark background  the actuell track of the running show is green highlighted  External   Internal Sync  PLAY and RECORD on the sync setting in the options menu for their behaviour   If sync is set to internal  time runs continuously  based on the internal time base   If sync is set to    SM PTE     the current time of the timecode show depends on the SM PTE input signal  If M IDI is set  M TC   M idi Timecode  will be used   In the headline of the timecode pool you will find a SM PTE input indicator  Regardless of the shows using SM PTE  it will  always display the current SM PTE input signal together with the SM PTE frame format   If a show is usin
91.  object pool  window  ENTER is not needed   Examples   IFOUTPUT EXEC 1 ENTER All devices which have stage output  from executor 1 will be selected   IFOUTPUT PRESET 1 1 ENTER All devices which have the preset 1 1  active on stage will become selected   Very nice for selecting all fixtures that  have a    blue star    currently on stage   All devices of the given selection that  have a stage output at the moment  become selected   IFOUTPUT CUE SEQUENCE EFFECT works accordingly   IFOUTPUT ENTER All devices having a dimmer value of  more than 0 will be selected  All devices having an output between  the entered values will be selected  If  no value had been entered for X  the  value 0 will be taken     IFOUTPUT  selection  ENTER    IFOUTPUT  X  THRU  Y  ENTER    lf no value had been entered for X   the value FULL will be taken     If only one value had been entered   this value will be selected     Basically  only   values will be looked  for   entries above 100 will yield no  result     INSERT    INSERT  source objects  AT  destination     ENTER     Example  INSERT GROUP 10 THRU 15  20 AT 1 ENTER   Insert is working ONLY with SORTABLE objects  Sortable objects are    PRESET  GROUP M ACRO VIEW EFFECT FORM    TIM ECODE SEQUENCE   Insert will try to make sufficient free space at the given destination by moving    non empty objects     INVERT    INVERT  selection   ENTER    NVERT is inverting the selected status of devices   Example1    Fixtures 1 through 5 are already selected   I
92.  or deselect it  respectively     72 MA    LIGHTING    MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    3 5 5 Link Fader Function in the CHANNEL window  If the Link Fader function is activated  paging through in CHANNEL M ode will keep the current fader range in the  Channel   Fader sheet  3 5 6 AUTO  SORT  Function in the CHANNEL window  If the AUTO  SORT  function is activated  key has a black background   the selected channels in the CHANNEL  window will automatically be moved to the left and upwards   Using AUTO  SORT in conjunction with Link  Fader allows channel selections to be transferred to the faders when  in channel mode   CHANNEL mode    3 5 7 Options within the CHANNEL or Fader window  Touch the touch screen on the left corner of the title bar  yellow dot    Or   With a right mouse click on top line the CHANNEL SHEET OPTIONS window will open   Display The Channel or Fader Sheet Options window will open   The Display button must be pressed  displayed with green font      Layer Display  only Values and Outputs in the FADER CHANNEL window possible     By pressing the respective keys  the following basic values will be displayed      Values only  Values are displayed      Fades  FADE times will be displayed      Delays  DELAY times will be displayed      Output  The DM X output values are displayed      Executor ID  The Executor   s number and page are displayed  only valid for Executor Keys       Cue ID  The Sequence   s number and respec
93.  over the numeric block  have to be done in the conventional   way  entry 2_0 will yield a value of 20    SINGLE DIGIT VALUE ENTRY  Entries performed over the numeric block will be done in factors of ten  entry 2 will  yield 20 0 5 will become 5  and 1_5 will yield 15  without switching to DUAL     Default AT  Here  enter the percentage value that the selected fixtures or dimmers are to take when the 2x AT  command is used     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn                                                                                 Playback Timing   The duration set for the OFF Time will be used when switching off Executors  OFF key     GOTO  amp  GO   If a specific time is set when calling up a Cue using the GOTO or GO  function  the Cue will be  called up with this duration  If Cue Timing was set  the Cue will be called up with the duration programmed in this  Cue  You can overwrite the Goto Default duration at any time  See Default Sequence  M aster Sequence    Here you can enter a Default time for MIB DELAY and FADE  See Move in Black Option   Executor Defaults   Default is Sequence Chaser  With this key  you can define  whether a newly programmed sequence will be  created as a Chaser  one look after another running automatically  or as a Sequence  press go for cue 1 and then  press go for ce 2 etc    default setting     Chase Fade  Here  you can define the preset for Chase Fade    Chase Speed  Here  you can define the defaul
94.  respective Cue in the LINK column  For the selected command  you can now enter a delay time in  the LI  DEL column  The command will only be executed after this time has ended  e g  if you enter    5    in the LI   DEL colu mn  the command will be executed after a delay of five seconds     4 3 9 Automatic change of Pages   An automatic switch to another page can be assigned in the column    Link        select a cue and press button LOOPS  amp  LINK     typeinthe requested page  page x y   4 3 10 Copying cues between sequences    You can also copy Cues from one sequence into another  To do so  use the following syntax on the command line     copy seq X cue XX_at_seq Y cue YY ENTER   If the target Cue is empty  select the status of the copy  STATUS COPY or CUE ONLY   if the Cue has a contents  choose  between the OVERWRITE or MERGE option  You can cancel the copying process using CANCEL     4 3 11 Copying individual values of a cue into another cue or sequence   Values of individual parameters can be copied from one cue into another or into another sequence  Use the  following syntax in the Command line    From the current cue into another cue of the same sequence or another sequence        yo   Select the fixture or the channel in the current cue  if necessary activate the parameter  double  click    headline   the column has a red background    STORE OPTION should be set with Active values       STORE seq X cue Y and confirm with MERGE or OVERWRITE    4 4  Editing Chasers   
95.  set this value  See ALIGN function   The values set for the respective Effects will be displayed in the WIDTH column  Press and hold the  Encoder and turn to the right so that the focus  blue cell frame with red background  will be moved to the  right  When moving the focus beyond the right border  further columns will be displayed  WIDTH  BASE        RANDOM  Random fade ins of individual channels of the selected function  The number of channels to be    faded in can be set     SIN  Sinus function    COS  Co  sinus function      LIN   Saw tooth ascending    LIN    Saw tooth descending      TRIANGLE  Triangle function     PHASE1 PHASE2 PHASE3  Normally used to create rainbow color effects on fixtures with color mixing  Each  of the phases is exactly out of phase with the other  This allows for an even and offset application across 3  parameters    By pressing the USER DEFINED key  turns dark gray   user  created two  dimensional forms can be selected for   the PAN TILT parameters  If a form is to be created or modified  press the NEW or EDIT key to open the EDIT   FORMS menu  See Creating and storing virtual forms   Pressing the SELECT key will adopt the function  the window will close discarding any modifications when   pressing CANCEL       Dir  direction   In this column  an arrow indicates in which direction the Effect will be executed  To reverse the    direction  select the cell and press the Encoder to the right of the display once       Size  In this column  each Effe
96.  settings  Encoder and Trackball sensitivity and Wheel function  See Settings in  the Setup menu Furthermore Cue Timing  Executor Defaults  Sheet Sorting  Sheet Fontsize  Sheet Readout  M isc    Preset Colours  Attribute Grouping and Store Options  See Settings in the DEFAULTS menu       Each show contains a full set of local user profiles  These local user profiles can be stored as default in the global  parts and they can be loaded from there      When saving a show on floppy disk  all users registered to this console will also be saved with all default settings   When loading a show from floppy disk to another console  all users including all default settings will automatically  be transferred to the new console  Individual users can use these profiles for a particular show or for other shows  in which this console is used     Tools Menu _  Current User is    Administrator       2 16 3 Creating a new User  TENES LESI F To create a new user  you need to have administrator privilege level   a     Goto Tools menu and User   Setup      ann ga   Press the New in User List and type name and password  Select and confirm Rigths and Profile by turning and  pressing the encoder     Change the rights  privilege level  for the new user     By default  the new user utilizes the DEFAULT user profile  If the user utilizes a different or an independent user  profile  it will change his user profile  If you create a new user profile in this way  it is initialised with the default    User P
97.  speaker be switched on or off  not available on older grandM As     To set the sensitivity of trackball and the encoders to coarse  fine or extra fine  16bit resolution     With the PUSH key  you can set the Encoder   s sensitivity when holding it down and turning    Switching between the M otorfader functions  Executor Fader  Channel Fader   not available on the MICRO    AUTO      Executor Faders  When switching between the Pages  the M otorfaders will automatically pick up the values   stored last      Channel Faders  Faders adjust to the called  up values of the allocated channels    MANUAL      Executor Faders  When switching between the Pages  the stored values will be called up  but the Faders will  not follow  To change a stored value  you have to use the Fader to manually set it to a higher or lower  value      Channel Faders  Faders do not adjust automatically to the called  up values of the assigned channels  To  change a stored value  you have to use the Fader to manually set it to a higher or lower value      DISABLED    Faders without function     Executor Faders  When switching between the Pages  the stored values will be called up  but the Faders will  not follow      Channel Faders  Faders do not adjust automatically to the called  up values of the assigned channels    After switching from MANUAL to AUTO  you have to change the PageNo once so that the motor fader   work again     The wheel   s functions for the dimmers      Additiv  All dimmer values will be 
98.  the Group Keys in the GROUP window  By selecting several groups one after the other  that set of  groups can be copied together     Press the AT key once  LED is on       Click on the position for the copied group in the GROUP window    Confirm with ENTER     The functions M ove  Copy or Delete can also be used for Executors  Pages  Sequences or Effects        Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand A  59        Fixtures  Values   B    sorted by Numbers   ID FAC Name Pan Tilt Dimme    P  Tilt    Dim    tL       SL300 7     SL300 8    60       L   G HT dIN G       3 4 Accessing Fixtures directly  in the FIXTURE SHEET     Individual fixture functions can always be accessed directly and multiple fixtures can be controlled at the same  time  The selection will determine which fixtures react to Direct Access procedures  selected fixtures will be  marked in yellow writing in the FIXTURE window     Within the FIXTURE window  you can locate  select and execute all functions for all fixtures    Select the fixtures  where you wish to modify a value  the selected fixtures will be displayed in yellow characters    Selection      Call up a fixture group  See Creating and calling up Fixtures and Dimmer GROUPS   Or      Select fixtures using the touchscreen    Or      Select fixtures by using the Fixture key and the numeric keypad  See Creating and calling up Fixtures and Dim   mer GROUPS   Or      A left mo
99.  the Next   Prev    buttons are working     press button  in MATricksPool      press NEXT  PREV  to select lamps and set values    In the Matrix pool  press the    SETUP    button    The    M Atricks Settings    menu will open    Next Prev  Move individual or several selected fixtures within the whole selection    E g  select fixtures  When pressing the    Next Prev  lt     or      gt     key for the first time  the first last fixture remains  selected  When pressing the key once more  the next will be selected  and so forth  This function can also be  operated by using the NEXT PREV keys    Groups  Here  you can define the number of fixtures that are to be moved simultaneously within the selection   E g  Press the    Groups  gt      key  until a    3    appears  Now  each time you press the    Next key  the next 3 fixtures of  the whole selection will always be selected    Interleave  To divide the whole selection into groups    e g   If you select a 3 under    Interleave     the next 6 fixtures  3 groups of 3 fixtures each  will be skipped  when  pressing the    Next  key    To select the skipped fixtures  you can choose individual groups  If you had entered a value under    Interleave   1st  will be displayed for the first group on the right of    Interleave Next Prev    Using the      lt     or      gt     keys  you can  Switch over to the next group  When moving the selection  the other fixtures will now be selected    Or    Interleave Next Prev  E g   You want to select
100.  the set Fade Time when the Effect Group is called up  make one right mouse click into the  cells behind the value in column F  Fade   The column will show a Y for YES  Press UPDATE to confirm the  modifications and save them in the Cue    You can modify the cells Name  Intens  Speed  F  Soft and Fade directly by a right mouse click     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    trior      window    Edit Form 8  Form 8        Put in form  PAN      sinld  sx  tcos  od   Put in form  TILT      cos  x              Confirm    Predefines    gt   EDIT  be  CLOSE             6 6 View ALL RUNNING EFFECTS menu    In this menu  all currently playing back Effect Groups will be displayed      Press the EFFECT key twice   On older consoles  this key is not labeled and is positioned between the VIEW  and GOTO keys  An appropriate label can be ordered from MA or from your local dealer    Or      When choosing an Effect Group from the Effect Pool the respective key will be displayed above the Encoders    Press the LIST key on the touch screen      By pressing the ALL OFF key  you can switch off all Effect Groups simultaneously      You can leave the menu with the CLOSE key      In the left part of the menu  all manually called  up Effect Groups will be displayed  Pressing the OFF key on the  right side of MANUAL  all these Effect Groups will be switched off      The middle part of the menu shows all Effect Groups that areplaying back via EXECUTOR faders  Pre
101.  tracks simultaneously  These functions are  also available as direct    R     Reset all tracks to unselected  and    S     Set all tracks to selected  keys    At the moment  selecting tracks does not affect the playback functionality  it is only a display and edit function   For future versions  however  we plan to have that as a special playback mode  to enable playback output for  selected tracks     Sorting Tracks   Perhaps you have a large number of tracks in your show  but currently you are only interested in some of them   Select these tracks and press the SORT key  The selected tracks will be sorted and displayed at the very top of the  track display    If you have selected all  or no  tracks and press SORT  they are sorted into their natural order  e g  the order in  which they appear on the console    The sorting of tracks is part of the show and is stored with the show  It is only a display function and not affect  playback functionality    Adding Events   Graphically with the mouse      Choose the ADD mouse tool  The cursor will show an arrow with a large              Click anywhere in a track  At the position you clicked with the mouse a new event will appear      To edit this new event right click on it    With encoders and keys      Set the current time with the time encoder  first one  to where you want to add the event      Use the track encoder  second one  to select the track on which you want to add the event      Press the ADD HERE  key      At the given 
102.  using the two Encoders in the middle      AutoGen  By choosing a cell and pressing the Encoder    No    will be indicated  this means  that the presets will  be not automatically generated      Visualize  Here  you can define what else is to be displayed in the Fixture  Stage  Sheet or grandMA 3D  You can  visualise either graphics  for Gobos  and colors or data plus units  e g   degrees for PAN TILT or RPM for Gobo  rotation       Range  Visu    These values will be displayed to indicate units  e g   with PAN TILT degrees   e g  Gobo rotation    for a value of 1   20 1 RPM  20 RPM will be displayed  Discrete values    For the functions PAN and TILT the maximal deflection is here setted  important for Flip functions and  grandMA 3D views  E g   Pan  90   270 corresponds a maximal deflection of 360 degrees whereas the middle is  at 0 degrees  asymetric deflection   For Zoom and Iris the value  range between 0 and 1      Extra  With this  you can define  what Gobos or colors will be displayed      Mode  Here  you can set an additional condition for displaying the name    With    Always     you do not set a condition  and the name will always be displayed   If  however  a function  Attribute  is selected and a Range set  this name will only be displayed  if the value  of  the Range  of this function has been set  condition       Range  Mode   Value for the indicated function  mode      Functions of the individual buttons    By pressing the button     Add Line  you can insert a 
103. 0         66 MA    LIGHTING       3 4 6 FIXTURE OPTION    In the Fixture Sheet  you can adapt different basic settings for each individual Fixture      press EDIT     touch ona Fixture and the FIXTURE OPTION window will open    The Fixture can be renamed using the keyboard    Next to Type the type of Fixture is displayed  next to ID  the corresponding number  and next to Patch the start   address for this Fixture      Pressing the PAN NORMAL key  display changes to PAN INVERSE  will invert the output of the PAN parameter      Pressing the TILT NORMAL key  display changes to TILT INVERSE  will invert the output of the TILT parameter      Pressing the NO SWAP key  display changes to SWAPPED  will swap the output of the PAN and TILT parameters  so that the Pan parameter on the console controls the tilt of the fixture and vice versa      Pressing the WITH MASTER key  display changes to NO MASTER will be indicated by a dark blue background    the Dimmer value will be output without regard to the level of the GRANDM ASTER    If a Fixture was modified in this window  the Fixture   s name will be displayed on a blue background in the Fixture   Sheet  These changes can also be set while patching Fixtures  See Selecting DM X addresses for Fixtures     With the  lt  lt  lt  key  you can switch to the previous Fixture  With the  gt  gt  gt  key  you can switch to the next Fixt    ure     With the X key  you can close the window       3 4 7 AUTO SORT Function in the FIXTURE Window   Press
104. 0 g9 AS   Invert      SL300 10 SL300 10 AJ Invert Attribute  Setup          dimmer01    Enter Channel ID  Input Range   1 00 to 3999 00      Name Type ID Ch  ID Fi  SL300 1 SL300 11  SL300 2 SL300 12  SL300 3 SL300 13  SL300 4 SL300    14    SL300 10 SL300 20    Fixtures and Channels in Layer  tt  Type      ID Ch  ID Fix  Patch   Mas  Func_Pan Func  Til   Swap  DHX  Pan De  Tilt  SL300 11 A101 No     Invert    L300 12 ATI Invert   Invert    SL300 13 A121 Invert   Invert Invert  SL300 14 A131        Yes Invert    SL300 15 A141     Anvert  SL300 16 AIM   l   Invert  SL300  17 A161     Invert  SL300 18 A7 i   Invert  SL300 13   A181    Invert    24 MA    LIGHTING        Inserting  deleting or moving fixtures     Select Fixture Layer      Select a fixture  Pressing one of the buttons will have the following effects      Add Line  Inserts a new fixture in front of the selected fixture    Delete Line  Deletes the selected fixture  And all settings for this fixtures are deleted  too     M oves Lines  M oves the selected fixtures to another position in the table  If using the    M oves Lines    key   this key will be displayed in red  By selecting a new position in the table  the fixture will be  moved to that new position      Assigning fixture names    Click on the fixture   s name  enter a name directly  and confirm with Enter     If a space and a number is added an automaticly enumerate of the names is made     Adjusting ID Cha and Fix     Select one or more cells under ID Cha or
105. 1  confirm with ENTER     the report for Preset 1  PAN TILT will appear on the right display  the columns will display the names of the involved  fixtures and the respective percentage value of PAN and TILT  Use the Encoder to scroll down  if not all rows are visible  on the display     To create the report WORLD 3  containing the names of all fixtures in World 3      enter the following on the CommandLine  report_world_3  confirm with ENTER     the report for sequence 1 will appear on the right display  the Cue values are arranged in columns  the parameters  of Individual fixtures in rows  Use the Encoder to scroll down  if not all rows are visible on the display      49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand HALOS       Crec LET Group 1    dimmer       Choose fror Esi W  F P   I       a  ee ee       Setings             apial Aai    Effect         Rirlacagy Flies st     i       106 MA    LIGHTING    5 Executing Cues  Sequences and Chasers  5 1 ASSIGN menu  Assignment to EXECUTOR     Cues  Sequences or Effect Groups can be assigned to any EXECUTOR fader or button    One way to enter the ASSIGN menu is by a mouse click or using the touch screen on the title bar of the  EXECUTOR FADER window    Or    Press the ASSIGN key once  LED is on     Select a Sequence in the Sequence Pool  or an Effect Group in the Effect Pool    Press the EXECUTOR FADER or EXECUTOR button  to which you want to assign a Sequence or Chaser   Or    Press the ASSIGN key once  LE
106. 1 Saving and loading a SHOW 179 NOTE    3 9 MAtricks 80  11 1 Saving the Current Show on harddisk 179   3 10 BLIND   Modus 83 i ae a aes ie the harddisk ne All text marked with    does not  4 Cues and Sequences 87 9 Loading a empty snow   4 1 Creating a memories  gg 11 4 Deleting the current show     180 apply to the micro   Agee   4 2 Programming Sequences 901 1 5 Deleting a Show from harddisk 180 All buttons marked with   Are  4 3 Editing Sequences 94 n a etal a on wee ae located in the micro   s   4 4 Editing Chasers 100    Loading a SNOW trom Floppy als   45 iadatings Cues 103 11 8 Loading a Demo Show 181 COMMAND WINDOW only     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    L   G HT dIN G8    1 Introduction    General Information  Combining an approved concept of operation  an outstanding product design and first   class quality with a host of new ideas and the latest technology  this new console offer  ulitmate control on larger shows  The grangMA range combines the best in mechanical  design with a flexible and powerful software platform   MA users will feel very familiar with grandM A from the very beginning  The basic operation  modes  well known from the Scancommander have been well proven in the field as powerful  tools for the control of intelligent fixtures and many are now the standard of the industry   Of course  there have been quite a few improvements as controlling hundreds of channels  requires intelligent solutions to time con
107. 1_5 will yield 15  without switching to DUAL      Default AT  Here  enter the percentage value that the selected fixtures or dimmers are to take when  the 2x AT command is used    HIGHLIGHT NORMAL  IS SOLO  The function of the button in COMMAND 1 will be set to the  respective function    IS SOLO  has the SOLO function  i e  all fixtures not selected will be set to the dimmer value 0   except they were set to NO MASTER in SETUP   NORMAL  The HIGHLIGHT button has the normal Highlight function        tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 gad MA 219    GMA Remote x 10 42 O     Channel  mal STS  Rij    Seq 1  Effects     Masher    a Name Trig TE Executer   Run    1 Cue GO  100  2 Cue GO       Cue GO M short    6 Cue GO Changes the function of the three right buttons  if CHANGE FUNCTION lights green press one  of the buttons and select a new function  After the second press on CHANGE FUNCTION the  chosen functions will be executed   Buttons with functions differing from the default setting  have a blue background  The  modified setting can be saved with AS A DEFAULT FOR ALL as new default setting     short the chosen functions will be  executed    set master with fader or cursor    3    7 E Er M acros can only be started or stopped  Creating or modifying macros has to be performed  a on the console    7 A g ual Ti  Macro 8  Macro 9               e I   Use the cursor to scroll in the Sheet  if only some of multiple macros ar
108. 6   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    GMA Remote qx 10 21 G    Fiare ort ae    Values i a  I   Readout   Presets   Clear   i          Using more than one remotes can cause bad screen display  parts  of the menue are missing   Press REFRESH SCREEN to actuate  the screen      Besides the label  the buttons have  depending on their operational task  different symbols  to  make orientation easier     w  black    gt   black     pressing shortly or long will bring up a menu  reference to the next menu  you could open    The following terms are used to explain the keys to refer to different effects     short    short press on the key  to get to the function   long    long press  time can be set in the PocketPC  the function  will be started after this time  acoustic signal    each time you press the Key  the next function is selected   press on the cursor in the middle    toggle   press center     To set values by the Cursor  you can define three setting speeds  coarse   fine   finest    The setting can be performed either   e using this key  and with each press you will  Switch from one setting speed to the next  one     or    e pressing the Cursor Scroll key long and  selecting the setting speed in the menu    or    e using toggle in the taskbar  and with each  press the setting speed will be switch to the    next one      AN l IN    finest   fine A   Coarse  IN  IN    Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 gra
109. 6   Oops Settings 5   Out 108   Outdelay 94   OUTFADE 94   OUTFADE TIME 88   Output Window  DMX 42   Overview  Command 159    p    PAGE 110  119  175  PAGE Administration 119    PAGE  copying a 120   PAGE  deleting a 79  120   PAGE  moving a 120   PAGE Name 120   Pages  change within a cue  100   PAN NORMAL 66   PAN to TILT changing 24   Pan Tilt Swap 27   Panel  mechanical parts of  the 5   Param  Parameter  125   PARK   PAUSE function 63   Part  Partly  128   Patch Sheets 34   PAUSE 107  128  175   PAUSE   PARK Function 63   Phase 127   PHASE1 PHASE2 PHASE3  124   Pitch  assigning the 152   Playback Buttons  assigning  150  152   Playback keys  assigning  150    PLAYBACK Master 114  Playback Timing 47  Plug In Card 37  PocketPC 207  Position X  Y Z 21  POSITIVE ENABLE 112  POSITIVE ENABLE   groupmaster  112  Power 30  Power Failure 5  Pre Roll 143  PREDEFINES 131  PRESET 175  PRESET  calling up a  75  76    Preset Control 67  Preset Control Bar 60  Preset  creating a 75  Preset  creating a    automatically 42  Preset  deleting a 79  Preset group 28  Preset Options 90  PRESETS 32  33  Presets automatically 42  Presets  embedded 78  Presets  move 76  Presets Selective 75  Presets Universal 75  Presets  Update 77  104  PREV 9  59  PREVIEW 93  PREVIOUS 156  176  Priority  STRAND  41  PRIORITY OPTIONS 111  Products 207  Profile 30  34  Profiles deleting 34  Prop   45  pulldown menu 12  PULSE WIDTH 126  PUSH 45  PWM 124    Q    Quick Reference 15   QUIKEY 55  153  156   QUIKEY  a
110. 65 99 Version 6 0 gad HAAS      MOUSE FRAME  if the button is activated  text turns green   you can draw a blue frame on the grid  This frame  forms the target for the commands CLEAN  REM OVE  and FILL  If the button is not active  text is grey   you can fill the  grid using the FILL command  or you can deliberately position individual fixtures on a free cell       TAKE SELECTION  the selected fixtures will be transferred into the layout and you can position them using the  Selection WIZZARD command     Sept   ADD SELECTION  when there are already fixtures positioned in the layout  the selected fixtures will be added     CLEAN FRAME  fixtures within the blue frame  drawn with the active MOUSE FRAM E  will be taken out of the layout           Selection Frame       Rows             Remove  Frame       Column             Wizard and    bunkered    as red squares adjacent to the grid   Cot ee   REMOVE FRAME  fixtures within the blue frame  drawn with the active MOUSE FRAM E  will be deleted from the  Top  gt  Bottom  Fil layout  but can reintegrated again into the layout using the ADD SELECTION command        Positioning fixtures within the layout   The order in which fixtures are arranged  will influence how the effect will appear later     The default setting is Left  Right  Top  Bottom  and Wrap Off   with this setting  the stage output will correspond to  what is displayed in the Preview window  Changes applied to this setting will not appear in the Preview window of the  Bitm
111. 8 1 6 Special Procedures   Recording Crossfades   Crossfades for executors are recorded as a combination of commands and fader movements    These commands are    XGoUp Crossfade will start upwards   XGoDn Crossfade will start downwards   Xend Crossfade has ended   XGoUp and XGoDn have a cue number as parameter  just like a GOTO command  therefore a crossfade may  start on any cue  not only on the next one    Try to record a crossfade and have a look at the outcome  You will see  that the global crossfade setting  CROSSFADE PERM ANENT  RELOAD affects the recording    In the first case  a pattern of XGoUp  XgoDn  XGoUp    Xend is recorded  while in the second case only XGoUps are  recorded    Nevertheless you can change the global crossfade mode afterwards without affecting the playback of your  recorded timecode show    If you edit a crossfade manually  be aware that the crossfade fader movement alone does not do  anything  Although faders are moving  no crossfade is started  You have to place the crossfade commands on the  command track to make the crossfade work    Accordingly  if you want to move a crossfade in time  you have to move both  the fader events on the fader track  and the crossfade commands on the command track    At first glance  this procedure of recording a crossfade may seem to be complicated  but it has a lot of advantages     The crossfade commands are displayed in text mode  making crossfades more readable     Crossfades relate to absolute cue numbers  li
112. 8 onwards    grandMA MICRO with all devices    Consoles with lower serial numbers must be upgraded with 256 MB RAM and a 100M Bit network adapter   Start a session      press TOOLS     press MA NETWORK CONFIGURATION     press CONSOLES     enter SESSION ID  1 31     all stations within this session must have the same ID  number     press START SESSION and enter name and password  if required      press NSP to open the NSP configuration menu   Register a NSP on the console   the NSPs should be switched on  connected to the network and have unique IP  addresses   you can change their names and IP addresses in SETUP under UPDATE SOFTWARE  and a session must  be started      press ADD NSP     if needed  enter a name     select the IP address of the desired NSP and click on it using the Encoder   This will transfer the NSP into the overview     assign the DM X lines to the NSP outputs  lines 1   8 equal A   H  lines 9   64 will only receive numbers      repeat the operation for each NSP   Delete a NSP on the console      click ona NSP in the overview     press REMOVE NSP   EXPANSION MODE  You can choose between 4 096 channels  whether the DM X channelss are output from the  console  Expansion Mode inaktiv  or via network  Expansion Mode activated   For shows with more than 4 096  channels  the Expansion M ode will switch on automatically     SOFTWARE UPDATE   For updating purposes  the NSPs must not be set to ARTNET   set them to M Anet     Update the NSP like the other consoles in
113. 99 Version 6 0 grand A  9    1 7 2 Layout and Controls micro          CAC    mne  MP     TE OP   eelo    r o UMM  CCC     E SS   lt  lt  lt  LEARN  gt  gt  gt   eloo   SS               oO  Of Gor  ToTo lo          i T  on        CHANNEL EXECUTOR  FADER FADER BUTTON  zit      PAGE       An additional external keyboard  a  mouse and an Trackerballhowever   can be connected on the rear of the  unit     NOTE   always have to connect an external  keyboard  too     When using a mouse  you    10 MA    LIGHTING                    18 14 16   ot    on   _           18 18 20    EXECUTOR BUTTONS       QUA OO Nm    Power switch    Blackout key for Dimmer  channels    Grand Master for Dimmer  channels    TFT Display touch screen  View Macro keys    Encoder for moving   scrolling the  respective window contents    Background key   If on the TFT  display  Views are being overlayed  by a menu  ASSIGN  EDIT         you  can use this key to bring up or hide  the menu     Keyboard key to bring up the  Soft Keyboard on the TFT display     MA key   without function    COM MAND key to bring up the  Command menu    Manual Time Setting for  Presets    13    14    17    20  21    Encoders   To set the attribute  values such as Gobo  Pan Tilt  times  etc     Keys   To directly process Go    Go  etc  for any Executor  or to  lock Executors   Page change over   For  Channel faders  Executor faders  and Executor keys    Playback buttons   Can be  defined as Got  Go    Pause  Flash  etc     Executor faders
114. ASE3  Normally used to create rainbow color effects on fixtures with color mixing  Each of    the phases is exactly out of phase with the other  This allows for an even and offset application across 3    parameters     By pressing the USER DEFINED key  turns dark gray   user  created two  dimensional forms can be selected for the    PAN TILT function  If a form is to be created or modified  press the NEW or EDIT Key to open the EDIT FORMS  menu  See Creating and storing virtual forms    MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    In order to assign further Effects to the selected Fixtures Dimmers in this group  press the Add Line key again  A  new line will be displayed and the Select Parameter window will open  Choose a function now and assign an Effect     Up to 16 individual Effects can be combined within a Group uss Edit key  LED on  and a key in the Effect Pool  The  EDIT EFFECT menu will appear in the right TFT display    Edit Effect 61    EFF 6T       DIMMER SIN    CHANNEL   FADERS    6 2 Editing Effect Groups   When choosing an Effect Group from the Effect Pool  respective keys will be displayed above the Encoders   Pressing the EDIT key for this Effect Group will open the EDIT EFFECT menu    Or    Push Edit key  LED on  and a key in the Effect Pool  The EDIT EFFECT menu will appear in the right TFT display     6 2 1 Editing Effects   In the title bar  the Effect Group to be modified will be displayed with its number and name  In the s
115. ASK    With the MASK function  you can choose parameters to be displayed in the CompFixture Sheet  One touch on the  parameter in the INCLUDE column will transfer this parameter to the EXCLUDED column and it will not be displayed  in the Sheet any longer  Vice versa  you can beam a parameter from the EXCLUDED column to the INCLUDED  column    ATTRIBUTE SORT    With the SORT function  you can change the position of the parameters      select Parameter  blue line     change position with UP or DOWN    3 4 1 The ALIGN Function   The ALIGN function allows you to apply ratios to ranges of parameters  Four different modes are available    ALIGN key pressed once  LED is on  The values will be distributed between the first and last selected fixture  i e  not  the ID numbers  but the selection order will determine  what the    box    will look like  Example  if you select the  fixtures in the order 1 through 10  pressing ALIGN once will have the result displayed in the graphics on the left   The order 10 through 1 will result in a mirrored version  An irregular selection will yield an irregular graphics       ALIGN key pressed once  LED is on      When changing the activated values  the value of the first selected Channel Fixture will be taken as the starting  value  will not be changed   while the value of the last selected Channel Fixture value will be the one modified  most  and all values in between will be distributed evenly       ALIGN key pressed twice  LED is on      When chan
116. ATE  them  save to disk or floppy    See Updating the Scanner Library  USER  Library     Delete self created fixtures  Inthe Tools  menu you can delete  permanent  self created or varied fixtures from the library  You can not delete  fixtures from factory desk library       Inthe menu Tools press the button M anage Fixture Library     Select the fixture and press Delete Entry     With the filters you can display fixtures of the desired manufacturer or names    With Harddisk Floppy choose store medium  mostly its Harddisk     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    Preset Types  o Name Sheet N Note x  PAN TILT    an Ti Unmoveable  DIMMER Di    nmoveable  GOBO EE Unmoveable Add  COLOR r Unmoveable Line  BEAM Bea Unmoveable    FOCUS ocus Unmoveable Delete  CONTROL T Unmoveable Lines       o Name S N Note Encoder  GOBO1 G1 Grouping      GOBO1 POS  GOBO1 ROT G1 Rot  GOBO1 MODE G1 Mode       Note  1   Preset Types Can Not Be Edited  2   Red Fields Are Protected And Can Not Be Changed      MAC 2000 WASH 21CH  Function Sets of Channel DIM  Nol Name   Range Visualize Range Extra   Mode   Range  E Closed 0  0 Dimmer Always  2 Open 255 255 Dimmer   a  Always g    Hew               Range Esta   Mode  0255 Pan  270 00   27000 Always     MINISCAN HPE  Function Sets of Channel COLOR T           No Name Range Visualize   Range     Exa   Mode   Range  1 Open 0  0 Color Color Always  0  2  Red  amp  24 Color Always D  3  Yelow 2 41 Colo P Color Alay    4  V
117. AULTS menu below the Executor Defaults Crossfade    With the PREVIEW function  Cues can be displayed in the FIXTURE SHEET or CHANNEL SHEET without being   output to stage  Press the PREVIEW key once and playback the desired Cue using the EXECUTOR button           SET MANUAL  FADE       4 2 6 Saving a sequence  To protect a sequence or Cues of a sequence against unintended modifications  you can lock them  Playback is  possible  the Edit mode cannot be activated  how ever     On the CommandLine  enter  lock seq  number or area of the sequences    lock_seq_ number of the sequence  cue  number or area of the Cue   In the sequence pool  the locked sequences are identifiable by their yellow key symbol  in the Assign menu  all  values are displayed in red  If only some part  individual Cues  of the sequence are saved  this will not be  displayed in the sequence pool   If you want to re  edit the sequence     On the CommandLine  enter  unlock seq  number of the sequence    unlock_seq_ number of the sequence  cue  number or area of the Cue   or    Insert the functions LOCK   UNLOCK as Quikeys    Press LOCK or UNLOCK and choose the sequence in the sequence pool    Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand ITA 93    EDIT                 Paudetnlay Snap Fade  Tda     Tis    Ti      94 MES    LIGHTING    4 3 Editing Sequences   During editing procedures  you can change all values of cues  add values or delet
118. BE Coarse Yes 33 1  2 DIM Coarse 0 255  3 COLORHI e 0 0  4 COLORMI  Coarse 0 0  5 COLORMI  Coarse 0 0 Eet  6 COLOR1   Coarse Yes 0  7 GOBO1 Coarse Yes 0 0  GOBO1 e Yes 0 Import  9 GOBO1 R  Fine  10 GOBO2 Yes 0 0  11 GOBO2 R  Coarse Yes 0  12 PRISHMA2 Coarse 0 0  13 IRIS Coarse 0 0  14 MACROS Coarse Y 0 0  15 FOCUS 0 Function  16 ZOOM Coarse 127    17 Coarse 0 i  gt   Default Highlite Stage MIB Fade  as Se       this Feature    Some Attributes cannot be moved  e g   Color M ix1   This is indicated by the word    Unmoveable    in the table on the  right of the respective Attribute     The changes will take effect and will be saved only after leaving the Full or Live Access menu and pressing the  SAVE button     2 4 2 Encoder  Activation  Grouping  All settings within this menu will affect the storing of Cues  Presets and creating of Presets  Create Preset menu      Attention  This menu is important and can influence all of your programming       Call up this menu by pressing the    Encoder  Attribute  Grouping    key in the Preset and Feature Assignment   The Attributes combined in a group will be activated and stored when they are changed  e g  Pan and Tilt      In the Attribute Setup menu  see 2 pages earlier   open this menu by pressing the Encoder Grouping button   By selecting a group  the appropriate Attributes will be displayed in the table on the lower left side       Pressing the    Add Group    key will create a new group    In order to delete a group  this group has 
119. Boxes Beep On  one Screen       5 623          Executor Mode oarse   Coarse    1    Encoder  amp  Fader Movement      Parameters Wide Trackball  Encoders  Push is    Fast d       2048    Faders Wheel    Auto 2 Add       itive  r       and Time                         Fixture Schedule Adjustments             NEW SHOVY Touchscreen Calibration     Change Structure  Calibrate    Delete Fixtures etc     CESS          Touchscreen Options   Change Patch and    Fixture Settings On    va on Sade eee          Click  amp  Beep   of Presets  Groups Beep Off    and Effects       Backlight   Bright      Defaults   gt              Encoder  amp  Fader Movement 3  Trackball  Coarse       Encoders   Push is  Cc a s       Wheel          and Time      Display  Language p    Date                      Values          Setup   Menu MICRO         Defaults           Executor  Defaults    Playback  Timing       Programming    Reset to  Defaults       x       Sheet                      Default is    Basic Fade  8s Sequence 3    On Off Time  Os             Basic Outfade       GOTO  amp  GO     Chase Speed  Cue Timing 1s00             Snap Delay MIB Delay Chase Fade  Os 0 33 100                 Trigger MIB Fade Readout  GO Is SEC                                                                 Crossfade  Permanent _       Single Dic  Value Entry          Done At             Sorting Fontsize      Fixture Sheet Screens intern Blackout  Push  Numbers Big    Master  Channel Sheet    Screens extern _ Enabled   
120. CTS OFF 121   Elimination  Dropout 143   Embedded Presets 78   Emergency Backup 5   Emergency Switch 45   Empty 107  108   ENCODER 8  75   Encoder  Attribute     Grouping 29  Encoder Grouping 29  Encoder labels 64  ENCODER SPEED 156  ENTER 156  EQUALIZE DOTS 132  Equalizer 48  ESC 170  ESCAPE 16  156  Ethernet 37  38  EVEN 43  156  170  EVERYTHING OFF 121  EXEC 170  Exec Sync 197  EXECUTOR 17  54  100  EXECUTOR  Assignment to   106  EXECUTOR BUTTON   87  108  Executor button  assign   107  EXECUTOR Button Page   119  EXECUTOR  copying an 114  EXECUTOR Defaults 47  EXECUTOR  deleting an   79  114  EXECUTOR FADER   45  94  108  119  Executor Fader 151  EXECUTOR FADER Window   115  EXECUTOR  moving an 114  EXECUTOR pages 110  Executor sheet 115  EXECUTOR Window 115  Export Effects 44  Export Show  ASCII  44  Extra 33  Extra fine 45    F    F  Fade  95  101  F9 45  FADE  17   amp    WO W  5 10  Fade Time  individual 64  FADE times in Profiles 96  FADE times in the CHANNEL  window 72  FADE times in the FIXTURE  window 64  FADE Basic  88  FADE SNAP 30  FADER 54  171  Fader button assignment  108  Fader  changing a 107  Fader Page 119  Fader Pages 55  FADER window  colors used  for the screen display  233  236  239  FADERS OFF 121  FAQ 220  Feature 28  Figures  red 60  71  Filter 125  First universe  STRAND  41  FIX 117  171  FIXTURE 54  171  FIXTURE  accessing directly  60  FIXTURE  calling up a  58  112  FIXTURE  creating a  18  58  112  FIXTURE  editinga 18  Fixture Layer 19  22 
121. Call up a submaster view   PAGE PAGE Call up a total page view    158 MA    LIGHTING    10 1 4 M essages   Sometimes the command line asks you a question upon the execution of a  command  It can also inform you about something that went wrong with your  command    If such a message or a question window appears on the display  use the NEXT and  PREVIOUS hard keys to select the appropriate answer  the key with the thick blue  border  and then hit ENTER  Also ESC can be used for simple messages or  warnings  If there is a more complex question and you hit ESC  the action is  considered to be CANCELED    Every command line action that succeeds will appear in the history of all  command line windows    10 1 5 Command line window   Of course you want to be able to see the commands that you give to your  console  Open a command line window on the screen  There you can see what  you enter and what you have entered previously    10 1 6 Using the PC keyboard   Some users may find it convenient to use the PC keyboard for command line  input  Open a command line window on the screen  Whenever this window has  the input focus  title is shown in deep blue   all keystrokes of the PC keyboard go  into the command line  If the input focus goes somewhere else  the PC keyboard  will no longer work with the command line  Touching the title or the bottom line  of the command line window will give the input focus back to it    To permanently lock the the PC keyboard to command line input  press th
122. Controls  items 9 and 10   If the AUTO SCROLL key is pressed  the Sheet will be automatically moved upwards downwards when working  with larger Sequences   Using the left mouse key  you can select values or times durations  also by using the    lasso function      Values  and times durations can be modified using the middle mouse key  If you click and drag with the left mouse key  and then click with the middle button on the selected values  a window will open where you can enter values  directly   To modify presets  must make a middle mouse click on the preset  A window will open where you can enter  values or load other presets direclty   This is one of the few menus where using the mouse is the only method that makes sense     Delete    Clear    Clear Aon       The following window will open if you make a right mouse click on a selected value   Use this window in the following manor  1  Select one or more cells in the Tracking Sheet  2  Choose the DELETE  CUE ONLY  UNBLOCK or BLOCK  command  3  Execute the command by choosing the source  Selection   All Channels of Selected Cues  Complete or Selected Channels for All Cues      Modulators         DELETE  Will remove all values      CUE ONLY  Will copy the values of the previous step into the following step  that step must be empty       BLOCK  With BLOCK  tracking values  magenta  can be converted into    stored values     Theses values  will be displayed in red      UNBLOCK  Converts blocked   stored values to tracking val
123. D NOT  FIND ATA  blue scree     Will boot up to the message    screen will remain black  will not become  blue   no system found       Features are not assigned correctly  e g  the  wheel changes the PAN setting   or the fixture cannot be triggered     MA Lighting Technology GmbH    Answer    The other console   s priority is higher than that  of the    founder    console   see chapter 14 1    When working with the 3D Visualizer  you  have to activate TOOLS   MA NETWORK  MULTIUSER on the console     IP addresses do not correspond  The first three  groups of the IP have to be identical  e g   192 168 177 xxx  the figures of the forth  group  here xxx  have to differ for each device  connected     The 3D version is not compatible to the  console software  the first three figures of the  version number have to correspond 4 36X    Some anti virus programs like e g  NORTON  ANTIVIRUS  can disturb the interplay with the  3D   deactive these programs     Hard disk failure or not present or cable  disconnected  Repairs should be performed by  a service technician  see hotline contact on  the bottom margin     Flash corrupt  not present or bad contact   Repairs should be performed by a service  technician  see hotline contact on the bottom  margin     The patch number used for patching has to  correspond to the fixture address   if e g  fora  moving head  the figures do not correspond or      Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    Moving Heads or Scanners are hanging in 90    
124. D is on     Press the EXECUTOR FADER or EXECUTOR button  for which a Sequence or Chaser is to be created  The ASSIGN  menu will appear in the middle TFT display    Another way to enter the ASSIGN menu is via the EDIT menu    The title bar will display the selected EXECUTOR FADER or BUTTON    5 1 1 Assigning Sequences or Effect Groups    The    Function    key must be activated  dark background      By pressing the CHASER  SEQUENCE or EFFECT key  all created Sequences will be listed in the Sheet  Select the  Sequence or Effect Group to be assigned  Assigned Sequences or Effect Groups are displayed in red    The CUES column shows the number of Cues in the individual Sequences    By pressing the key    Edit  you can customize the assigned Sequence or Effect Group in the EDIT menu    See Editing Cues  Sequences or Chasers and Editing Effect Groups    5 1 2 Changing Sequence Names     By pushing the key    Name    the a sequence can be renamed using the keyboard   Or      Push ASSIGN key 2x  LED is on       Push the executor button  where the name of the sequence should be changed     A window appears  where you can now enter the new name     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    Exec 1 11 Seq 1    Seq 1 x 5 1 3 Changing Button and Fader Functions  Button and Fader Assignment    Auto Swop    Function  Fix Protect    Kill  Protect                       press ASSIGN    press small executor window or executor button    press FUNCTION            
125. DM X address   Remote DM X button   Edit  lt destination gt    Effect   Escape   close dialogs   Even selection  with ALL ODD   Executor   Enter fade mode or give fade time  Fader  access executor faders  Middle button of executor section  Lower button of executor section  Upper button of executor section  Single feature like PAN   Fixing executors   Fixture   Downflash executor   End of Downflash   Upflash executor   End of Upflash    Version 6 0 grand HAAS    FORM FO CONSOLE Form  used by effects   FULL FU FULL Full  equals 100    GO GO GO Go forward   GO  GO  GO  Go backwards   GOTO GOT GOTO Goto  lt cue gt    GROUP G GROUP Grou   IF IF 2x IF If  logical AND for selections     FOUTPUT IFO IF If Output  create selection from output  INFO INF Exe  key Info   Window   INSERT   2 x MOVE Insert  lt source gt  at  lt destination gt    INVERT INV QUIKEY Invert  lt destination gt    inverting selection  LABEL LA 2 x ASSIGN Label  lt destination gt     Name    give a name  LEARN L LEARN Learn  change speed of running programs  LOAD LO 2 x GOTO Load  lt Cue gt    M ACRO M M ACRO Macro   MIDI_BTN MI CONSOLE Remote M idi Button   MOVE MO MOVE Move  lt source gt  at  lt destination gt    NEXT N NEXT Next device of current selection   ODD OD QUIKEY ODD selection  with ALL EVEN    OFF OF OFF Off  switch something off   ON ON ON On  switch something on   OOPS O OOPS Oops    made a mistake    gt  Undo   PAGE PA PAGE Page   PAUSE PAU PAUSE Pause something   PRESET PR PRESET Preset type or P
126. Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    LIGHTING       petol    rot   blau   off   Orange      j Eo ouuu  rf Hr 3 4  5 E   Heavy Open Heavy   Gobo2 lt  gt    Gobo3 lt  gt       a a A s e              Pictures of the gobos a rdigplaved only if they are  stored in library     Keep  Activation    T       STORE   PRESET OPTIONS  Button KEEP   CLEAR ACTIVATION button    Will keep or delete the Fixture activation after saving Presets     F    1  Pan Tilt       Technischer Service         3 6 SOLO function    The SOLO function Is  so to say  the counterpart of the Highlight function  SOLO will bring all dimmers not  selected to a viaue of 0  l e  sequences  effects etc  will still run  but are no longer visible  This does not apply to  Fixtures that had activated the NO MASTER function in SETUP   FIXTURE PATCH  and whose dimmer values will  not be modified  The SOLO function can be activated as Quikey  see 9 2  or by using the HIGHLIGHT hardkey    In SETUP   DEFAULTS  set the Button to HIGHLIGHT IS SOLO    The Hardkey will then have the SOLO function  LED is on  or no function at all  LED is off   The HIGHLIGHT Quikey  will then also behave like the HIGHLIGHT hardkey    If the Button is on HIGHLIGHT NORMAL  the Highlight Hardkey will execute its normal function  and the SOLO  function can only be activated using the Quikey    3 7 Creating and calling up Presets   There are certain values for the functions of fixtures  which will be needed again and again  for example the   va
127. Dim  Dim3 3314 Dim5 DimG Dim  Dim  Dim Dim10 Di1 SL22 SL23 SL24 SLB     Dim Dim Dim Dim Dim Dim Dim Dim Dim Dim Dim Dim Dim Dim Din       5 4 TRACKING Sheet   In the Tracking sheet  all values and times durations of a Sequence can be displayed and modified   Create a Tracking Sheet  See Creating windows     Touch the left corner of the title bar  you can open the TRACKING SHEET OPTIONS window    Display Layer    Choose the values  which will be displayed in th eTracking sheet   identical with Display Layer in Fixtuer and  Channel Sheet    Sorting  amp  Reading    Choose the type of value  identical with Display Layer in Fixtuer and Channel Sheet      With the FONT SIZE key  you can switch the font size used in this window between LARGE and SM ALL      By pressing the   key  DEC or HEX  you can switch the display of values between percent  decimal or  hexadecimal values      The button LAYER CONTROL ON opens the control bar at the bottom of the tracking sheett  Pressing the  requested button switches the display to these values     Attribute M ask    All attributes in the EXCLUDED column will be not shown in the TRACKING SHEET when the button MASK is  activated      A Click on the attribute moves it to the other column  Excluded to Included and vice versa     For example  Click on PAN  in EXCLUDED  moves the attribut in the INCLUDED column  the attribut will be shown in  CONTENT SHEET when MASK is activated     Select Sequence   Slelect the sequence by clicking on the requeste
128. E Cope    Random Functions  gt                   Functions    heal k   Duluri    Rosul 4    rsa  amp  FW  gt  Ee   Fil lur d    chu fih    Yalu    a n  67  67  67  Bb   67 1598 198 194       LIGHTING    Setting Filters  to just copy move individual Functions     Example  You have set different positions for 10 Scanners  Now  you want to just copy move the    PAN    value  from one fixture to the others      Pressing the    Filter    button will open    AT Filter Option    menu  In this menu  you ll find all functions available   The functions are all displayed with a green background  Pressing on a function will deactivate it  will be displayed  in black then        f you just want to copy move the    PAN    value  deactivate    TILT    and leave the menu by pressing the    X  key   Now  only the    PAN    value will be changed  when you copy move     3 9 5 Shuffle select order and shuffle value    Using these two functions  you can randomly change the selection sequence  SHUFFLE SELECT ORDER  and the  assignment of the values in respect to the selected fixtures  SHUFFLE VALUE   Using SELECT ORDER will only  change the selection sequence  i e  the change will only be visible  if you have selected a function in which a  certain sequence is important  Using SELECT VALUE  the selection sequence is not important  only the values  within the selected fixtures will be    shuffled    NOTE  The functions can only be undone using OOPS  Both  functions can be executed using the buttons
129. ER   Individual delays for the feature shown in the preset bar will be set to X X seconds   If no selection is given  the current selection is used    Please note that the given delay may be a range  In this case  delays will be aligned  over the given selection    The given delays can be signed  which will result in relative changes of individual  delays    Giving individual delays can be combined with giving individual fades and values  into one AT command    Clearing individual delays     SELECTION  AT DELAY ENTER   Works very much like b   but no value for the delay is given    Setting default snap delay     No selection present  DELAY X X ENTER   The next cue will be stored with X X seconds snap delay default for all   Snap channels    As snap delay when storing a cue    STORE  List of Cues  DELAY X Y ENTER    MIA    LIGHTING    The given cues will be stored with a snap delay default of X Y seconds  for all snap channels    Switching to delay display mode    DELAY ENTER   All sheets wich are set to AUTO display mode  will display delays  instead of values  This effect is only temporary  All sheets will switch  back to value mode upon ending of the next command line operation     DELETE    EDIT    DELETE  object list  ENTER   Some forms of delete will need no ENTER in the end    DELETE  hit key in a pool    DELETE  CUE  X  hit executor button    DELETE  hit viewkey    All objects in the list must be of the same type  You can not delete a preset anda  cue at the same time 
130. ES  Server  192 168 177 114 LI FTF  Benutzername  boot LJ gobos  Cios      C  MET TYP2  keine car  LO NET TYPS  Klicken Sie hier  um weitere Cd MEW ha  Informationen zum Browsen won  new show  f      psr  Spor Ca psr_cony  Ca Report  C  sHows_o4 2  et A g g D E F Gm  H  1  No    1 3 4 5  2  Name 1 Cue 2 Cue 3 Cue 4 Cue 5 Cue 6 Cue  3  MIB s  4  Trig 3s 3s 3s 3s 3s 3s  5  Fade 3s 3s 3s 3s 3s 3s  6  Outfade  7  Delay Os Os Os Os Os Os  6  Outdelay Os Os Os Os Os Os  9  Snap Os Os Os Os Os Os  10     Fade  11  I Delay  12  Loop  13  Lo Del  14  Li Del  15  Link  16  Info  17  SL300 1 x 42 19  77 34  77 34   18  SL300 1    16 80  16 60  16 60   19  SL300 1 Z 6 25  6 25  67 19   20  SL300 1 Dim 100 00  100 00   21  SL300 1 Pan 72 66  08 67   96 10     22 SL3001 Tit    26 SL3002 Dim    27  SL3002 Pan  28 5L3002 Tit       42 19   16 80   6 25   100 00     77 34   16 60   6 25     77 34   16 60   67 19     30 08  30 08  30 08     100 00   72 66   30 08     96 10   30 08     58 67   30 08     Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com     Setting up a FTP  File Transport Protocol  access    Via this access  you can transfer data from the console to a PC  This way  you can take over the report on your PC  and open it as an Excel table  The easiest way to save and print out reports is also via the PC  In order to do so  PC  and console have to be connected to the same network  i e  the first 3 number groups or the IP number have to be  identical  e g  192 168 177 xxx   and the la
131. ET device will be used  For further information on Assignments   see 2 9 3 ARTNET DM X  ETHERNET CONFIGURATION  on the next page    PORTALL  Not yet available in this software version    PATH PORT  The assigned DM X IN of a PATH PORT device will be used  For further information on Assignments  see  PATH PORT DM X  ETHERNET CONFIGURATION  on the next page s     STRAND    Pressing on the button below Configuration will open the respective menu    If the button is on    Enabled if Standalone     the DM X output via Ethernet is activated  as long as the device is not  being used in a session  idle     In a Master Slave configuration Full  Tracking or M ulti  User session  the Slave will automatically switch to     Disable     off  If a M aster fails  the Slave having the higher priority will automatically switch to    Enable     on    Consequently  the DM X will only be generated by the former Slave  now M aster     If you switch two devices to Enable  the data may possibly superimpose  This has to be avoided by all means   Pressing the button will switch it to    disabled    with the consequence that DM X output via Ethernet is generally  blocked      Use SAVE to save the setting    DMX OUTPUT via Ethernet   In this menu  you can output the DM X ports via the Ethernet output using various protocols    Press the button for the required output  A   D  and select a protocol  The configuration procedure is identical to  that of the DM X IN menu     DM X CONFIGURATION on the Micro   
132. ETUP  SETUP key   TOOLS  TOOLS key   PREVIOUS  PREV  key   NEXT  NEXT key   TRACKBALL SPEED    ENCODER SPEED     Toggles the TRACKBALL between coarse and fine    Toggles the ENCODER between coarse and fine  further toggling   is achieved by pressing on the ENCODER    REPORT  Creates a report   INFO  Opens the INFO  window of the required sequence   LOCK  Locks sequences  or a single cue in a sequence   executors  effects  forms   groups  presets  worlds and macros  editing i snot possible    UNLOCK  Unlocks the above items   editing is possible   HIGHLIGHT  HIGHLIGHT  button has Highlight   function   SOLO  HIGHLIGHT  button has SOLO  function   TRACKBALL TILT ONLY  Trackball will only change the Tilt value  as long as the Quikey is   active  pressed down     TRACKBAL PAN ONLY  Trackball will only change the Pan value  as long as the Quikey is   active  pressed down      SHUFFLE VALUE  Will exchange the values at random between the selected fixtures  SHUFFLE SELECT ORDER  Will mix up the selection order at random   BLOCK   UNBLOCK Quikeys have the same function as Buttons in the Tracking sheet   Quikeys  however  offer far more options  With Quikeys  you can block individual Fixtures or  Dimmers  not only Sequencies and Cues  When using the AT filter  you can block individual    parameters  too     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    IFACTIVE With IFACTIVE ENTER  you can select all Fixtures having active values    Instead of ENTER  you
133. Effects    Select the Effect to be deleted     Press the DELETE LINE key     6 3 Executing an Effect Group   If an Effect has started  this will be indicated for the appropriate Scanner and Dimmer channels by a violett bar in   the Fixture  Channel or Fader Sheets  If you want to visualize the changes made to the values  the appropriate   Sheet has be set to    Output   Options   See Options of Fixture  Channel and Fader Sheets     Select the Effect Group from the Effect Pool  The Effect Group will be started automatically    Or      Thenames and playback keys for the Effect Groups will be displayed in the right TFT display above the   Encoders  The name of the currently selected Effect Group will appear above the left Encoder      Pressing the right arrow will start the complete Effect  The selected Fixtures or Dimmers will now form the  Effect      Pressing the PAUSE key will stop or restart the complete Effect  respectively      You can switch off the Effect using the STOP key      By pressing the left arrow  the Effect will run backwards    With the left INTENSITY Encoder  you can globally adjust the size of the whole Effect Group    Pressing the Encoder while turning it will increase or decrease the Encoder   s resolution  depending on the setup    When pressing an Encoder or the key above  this will bring up a Fader above the Encoder in the display  Now  you   can also use it to modify the value    Use the SPEED encoder to set the speed for the whole Effect Group    If 
134. Fixture are to be transmitted with the same  speed  you have to press the EQUALIZE DOTS key once      The form can be modified in its horizontal or vertical size using the Hori  and Vert  sliders  By pressing the dark   grey key below the modified sliders shortly  both values can be set simultaneously  By pressing the     lt   gt     key   both sliders can be coupled  so that the size can be modified simultaneously      Using the ROTATION slider  the form can be turned from 0   to 360        By pressing the MIRROR key  the form can be mirrored      You can leave the EDIT menu with the CLOSE key    With good knowledge in maths  you can also use formulas for PAN and TILT    Syntax to enter a formula manually    The standard display of mathematic formulas will be executed  The following is allowed      M athematic Basic Operators                      Numerical constants  integers  floatingpoint numbers or exponential figures  Example for valid numerical constants  2 71818    1 2e  2  0 4  Other constants  pi corresponds to the circle figure 7  Variables  X  Mathematical functions     sin x  or     sinus x     cos x  Or     cosinus x     abs x  corresponds to the absolute amount    sqrt x  corresponds to the square root    pow x  y  corresponds to the y Power of x    Arguments errors with x   0 und y  lt    0 or with x  lt 0 andy are no integers  Examples  sin 3   x   sqrt abs x     sin x   sin x    cos 3   x    pi 2   cos x    abs x    1    pow x 2    cos 0 5   x    abs x    0 5
135. Fixtures  which are present in the fixture  Sheet  can directly patched in the DM X  Sheet    select fixture in fixture sheet  with mous or touch     press button Assign  LED lits     press empty space in the DM X  sheet  the fixture will be patched  if the fixture needs more channels  as available in this area  the procedure will be stopped  Look for an area with enough empty channelsin a row   Note  when you take action in the DM X  sheet and Full Access is aktive  dont press Save after closing Full  Access   otherwise all changes in the DM X  shet will be rejected   Direct DMX access to non  patched channels   Using the CommandLine  you can also assign values to non  patched channels    DMX x y ATz  eg  DMX 2 35 AT50  channel 2 B  35 will be set to a value of 50   This value will appear as    parked    channel on the DM X sheet      De  parking    values    GO DMX x y    The non  patched values will disappear from the DM X sheet     2 11 Auto Create   Creating presets  effects and group keys    automatically   For most of the Fixtures in the library  there are ready  made presets that can be created in this window  Further   more  ready  made effects and group keys for each Fixture and Dimmer can be also be created      open AUTO CREATE in SETUP  Menu    2 11 1 Creating Presets automatically      Call up AUTO CREATE in the SETUP menu    In the table  all Scanner and Dimmer types are displayed that are used in the current Show  On the right of each  Scanner and Dimmer  you 
136. Global User Profile  save current settings  independently from the actual show  in your User Default Pro   file  Restore from Global User Profile  load your User Default Profile  independently from the actual show     Loading user porfiles or part of profiles with the Micro      press TOOLS     press Load User Profile List      select user an items in the Load to current User Profile menu     confirm with Load selected Items    World Filter    You can assign a World for any User profile  see  chapter Worlds   By this  you cannot only assign Rights to a User   but also grant him access to  only  certain areas of the Show  By this  e g  the Dimmer operator has full access to    the Dimmers  but cannot access the Fixtures by chance  If these are saved to another World      nthe User Profile List menu  click on the respective cell under World Filter and enter the name of the  saved World     2 16 8 Forced Login at Desk Start     Forced Login is enabled only if at least one user appears in the user list  TOOLS menu   User Configuration     To change the Forced Login setting  you need to have administrator privilege level      Go to Tools menu      Go to User   Setup      Press the FORCE LOGIN AT DESKSTART key    If you switch on FORCED LOGIN  upon every desk start or loading of a show  the desk will automatically bring up   the login screen    If FORCED LOGIN is switched off  upon desk start the desk will automatically login the user who was last logged 53    Technischer Service  
137. Groups in Cues 130 15 7 Worlds  Welten  197  2 5 FIXTURE TYPES 31 6 6 View ALLRUNNING EFFECTS menu 131 15 8 Remote Network Monitor 198  2 7 Function Sets 33 6 7 Virtual Forms  EDIT FORM S  131 16 Full Tracking Backup 199  2 8 Profiles 34 6 8  Modulators 133 16 1 Why using a backup system  199  2 9 DM X Output and Ethernet Configuration 37 7 BITMAP Effects 135 16 2 grandMA with show backup 199  2 10 DM X Output Window 42 7 1 Creating a Layout for a BITM Ap Effect 135 163 Setting up a Network System 200  2 11 Auto Create 42 1 2 Creating   Changing BitM ap effects 138 16 4 Network Backup system 201  2 12 Setup menu 44 7 3 Starting the Effect 140 17 Channel expansion with NSP 204  2 13 Settings in the DEFAULTS M enu 46 8 Remote Control 141 17 1 NDP Configuration 205  2 14 Setting Sound Signals 48 8 1 Timecode   141 17 2 2  Port Configuration 206  2 15 TIM E  amp  DATE M enu 49 8 2 Remote Control via Touchboard 150 18 PDA Remote Control 207  3 Creating a Show 54 i ae vis QUIKEYS oe FAQ 220  3 1 CREATING A WINDOW 54 i aoe eee Service   Timetable 224  3 2 Storing VIEWS 57 9 2 Assigning and Activating QUIKEYS 156 Special functions 225  3 3 Fixtures and Dimmer GROUPS 58 9 3 Agenda Menu 137 Compatibility mode 226  3 4 FIXTURE SHEET 60 10 Command line 158 Color Code 233  3 5 CHANNEL SHEET 70 10 1 Introduction 158 Index 241  3 6 SOLO function 75 10 2 Command Overview 159   3 7 Creating and calling up Presets 75 10 3 Command Reference 161   3 8 Deleting Groups  Sequences  Views etc   79 1
138. K FUNCTIONS key or make a right click with the mouse in the track display of the timecode show  editor  on the left side  below the sort key       Select ADD NEW TRACK      Choose an executor from the list  or simply press a physical executor button  You can even enter EXEC 17  ENTER in the command line  An executor track for this executor will be added to your timecode show if it did not  exist already    Changing the Executor   Changing the executor of an already existing track is very similar to adding a new track      Choose the track that you want to change  with the track encoder or by touching it      Press the TRACK FUNCTIONS key      Select CHANGE EXECUTOR from the list  The rest is similar to adding a new track    Adding Subtracks   When recording SUBTRACKS are added automatically  Of course you can also add subtracks manually  Subtracks  can only be added to already existing tracks      Choose a track  with the track encoder in the bar or by touching it       Press the TRACK FUNCTIONS key or right click with the mouse on the TRACK      Select ADD NEW SUBTRACK      Choose the type of the new subtrack from the list    Deleting Tracks or Subtracks     Choose a track  with the track encoder in the bar or by touching it       Press the TRACK FUNCTIONS key or right click with the mouse the TRACK       Select DELETE TRACK      If the track contains events  you will be asked for a confirmation  otherwise the track will be deleted  immediately      If you delete the first s
139. L FADER keys this will toggle your executor faders so that they are  FADER now channel faders     The assignment of Channels and Faders can be changed via the CHANNEL FADER keys  for example  1 20  21 40   etc     The assignment of a channel number to a Fader is listed on the TFT displays above the faders     By pressing the indiviual CLEAR keys above each fader on the touch screen individual channels  which have been  modified manually  can be deselected and deactivated     The respective channel can be selected using the physical key above the Fader      In the TFT displays above the Faders  the assignment of channel numbers and Faders will be displayed along with  any names that have been given to individual channels      In CHANNEL mode  the individual channel values can be set with the Faders      The respective channel can be hidden using the physical key under the Fader      CLEAR    In order to modify the selection or the active values of dimmer channels     Press the CLEAR key   When pressing the CLEAR key the first time  the selection of dimmer channels will be deselected from the OUT   CLEAR PUT window  yellow characters turn grey    The modified  active  values will be kept and displayed with red background     Press the CLEAR key again   TI When pressing the CLEAR key the second time  the activation of modified values will be canceled  they will no         Tonger have a red background    CLEAR   Press the CLEAR key one more time     When pressing the CLEAR key th
140. LETE mouse tool  The cursor will show an arrow with a large    Drag a frame or click on an event  Events that you click on or that are inside the frame will be deleted    With the DELETE SELECTION key      Make a selection or select the current event      Then press DELETE SELECTION  If more than one event is going to be deleted  you will be asked to confirm that   Attention  mouse users    Please be aware that if you have chosen the DELETE mouse tool  this tool stays active  So wherever you click with  the mouse   it will be deleted  If you switch on    always reset mouse tool    in the options menu  the risk of    U U  z LI    Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand HAAAT    accidentally deleting something is reduced    Moving Events   Graphically with the mouse      Choose the MOVE mouse tool  The cursor will show a hand with a little arrow  The corner of the arrow is the    hot  spot    of the cursor      Left click INSIDE the selection or on an event and keep mouse Key pressed      Drag the mouse horizontally  The selection current event will follow    With encoder within the bar      Make a selection or select the current event      Turn the MOVE encoder  furthest to the right   For every click of the encoder  you will move the selection   current event by one frame      If you press and turn the encoder for every click you will move one second      If you press it without turning  you ca
141. M A s flexibility  you will never lose direct access and control  View  Macro keys allow to visualise current information at anytime  User profiles allow for differing  window configurations to be recalled from previous shows to talyor the console for the  particular type of show  Live Event  theater  Synchronised playback  nightclub  industrial   etc    Hardware and Interfaces  The built in Hard Disk Drive offers virtually unlimited storage capacity  The built  in flashdisk   not on the ultra light  on which the software is on the HDD  contains the board s software  and makes the grandMA independent from any external PC     General Comments    This manual describes the possibilities that the grandMA has in store for you  Step by step  you  will be guided through the logical aspects of working with this console    You will soon find out  that operating the grandM A is simple and straight forward in view of the  vast variety of features and options available  Once you are familiar with the basics  you will  realise that you can easily try out new fuctions  as all procedures and operational modes are  clearly structured     Consequently  this manual starts with a general introduction  followed by basic settings within  the Setup menu  such as selecting fixtures and dimmer channels with DM X address  modifications   etc     Chapter 3 is dedicated to the practical aspects of setting up a Show  while Chapter 4 will show  you how to create and edit Cues and Sequences  M oving on to
142. N MANUAL mode  if moving around frequently  e g  when travelling on a ship   it is    advisable to determine your current position by a GPS receiver and let the values be inserted automatically     Button display  Location M anual  fix entry of values    Set position for the automatic control of   see Agenda M enu  sunrise and sunset calculation  Clicking on the  respective keys will open a window  where the position can be set    Information regarding the respective position can be looked up in a software program that can be downloaded  from the internet at  www djuga net winglobe html    Or    Button display  Location Auto  values are automatically used by a connected GPS receiver    Pressing the button will open the GPS  Info menu  In this menu  you can modify the settings fora NMEA GPS  receiver connected to the serial port  This receiver will then determine the position of the grandMA  This can be  especially useful e g  on ships cruising on the oceans  For best satellite reception  check for an unhindered view  to the sky when setting up your equipment    GPS recommended by MA Lighting     HAICOM HI 203E with seriell 9  Pol Sub D with PS 2 connector  power supply     If the key is set to Enabled the clock will automatically switch between summer and winter time  Pressing the  key deactivates this function  Disabled   Pressing the respective key in the Begin End field will open a window  where you can set the beginning and the end of the summer time    Pressing this key 
143. NVERT FIXTURE 1 THRU 10 ENTER   Fixtures 6 through 10 are selected    Example2    All even fixtures of GROUP X are already selected   INVERT GROUP X ENTER   All odd fixtures of GROUP X are selected    Special case    INVERT ENTER   The selected status of all devices that have ACTIVE channels in the  programmer is inverted     LABEL    LABEL  object list      NEW NAME     ENTER   All objects in the object list will be renamed to    NEW NAME       Directly entering the new name is only possible with the PC keyboard    If the name is not given directly within the command  you will be prompted for  it    If more than one object is to be labeled  the given name will be enumerated for  every object    LABEL PRESET 4 1 THRU    COLOUR1    ENTER   Preset 4 1 is named    COLOUR1      Preset 4 2 is named    COLOUR2    and so on    Please note that executors do not have a name of their own  Instead they show  the name of the object assigned to it  In this way  labeling of an executor does  not change the name of the executor  but of its object  Relabeling of executors  can be very quicky done    LABEL hit executor  enter new name    Of course you can not change the name of an empty executor     LEARN    As starting keyword  every executor that follows after LEARN will use repeated  learn comands to define a new speed    LEARN  executor list  ENTER   In an assign command  this function can be put on an executor button  see  ASSIGN     The LEARN function works with CHASERS   a sequence ass
144. P  NOTE  USB memory stick must be formatted FAT 32    Insert the USB stick  there must no floppy inserted       Press LOAD SHOW  save the current show   182   select the show and confirm with ENTER     MIA MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    LIGHTING                  11 14 PARTIAL SHOW READ  loading parts of a Show    As of version 5 0  you can import parts of another show in to an existing show  Besides the Setup  you can also take  over show elements like Groups  Presets  Sequences or individual Cues  Worlds  Forms  Effects  Layouts  Bitmap  Effects  M acros and Matrices  Take care that all connected elements are being taken over  i e  when a sequence refers  e g  to Presets  you have to import the Sequence plus the Presets     The PARTIAL SHOW READ function is carried out in 2 phases     SETUP transfer   here you have to decide  which fixtures of the imported show you want to transfer  If these fixtures  do not correspond to the current fixtures  you can add them  If overlapping occurs  only the current or the imported  fixture can be transferred  If both fixtures are to be used in the current show  the only way is to change the ID and  Patch numbers of these fixtures in the respective show   it is not possible to do that in the PARTIAL SHOW READ  function     Data transfer   here  you can select elements of the imported show  Elements having the same name  will be  overwritten or merged  depending on the command used     TIP  Save 
145. P  TOGGLE  TOP    Go forward    Go backwards   Goto cue   Learn speed   Prepare next step of executor  wait for GO   Switch off something    Switch on something    Pause   Select default executor    Temporary up flash for executor and downflash for all others   Temporarily run an executor    Toggle executor on and off    Goto first cue     Object Keywords    Object keywords are used as targets by basic operational keywords and by executing keywords  They represent  data  that can be manipulated     Keyword    ALL CHASES  ALL SEQUENCES  CHANNEL   CUE   DMX   DMX BTN  EFFECT   EXEC   FADER  FADERBUTION1  FADERBUTION2  FADERBUTION3  FIXTURE  FEATURE   FORM   GROUP  MACRO   MDI BTN   PAGE   PRESET   SEQU  TIMECODE    TOUCH BTN  VIEW  VIEWBTN    Meaning    All executors assigned as chasers    All executors assigned as sequence    A conventional light    One step or memory of a cuelist    A DM X channel    A Remote triggered by incoming DM X signals    An freely editable effect generator    An executor is the physical front end for executing sequences etc   A executor fader    The middle button of an executor column    The lower button of an executor column    The upper button of an executor column    A complex light that has more than just a dimmer channel   A feature inside a fixture  like PAN or IRIS    A 1 or 2 dimensional path  used by effects    A collection of fixtures and channels    Can do complex command line operations    A Remote triggered by incoming MIDI signals    A 
146. R     This way  you can relieve the memory space and the processor  In case the users on the floppy are identical   Backup Menu EA with those already stored on the console  the request will be skipped   Demo Shows     er Warning  You can only load shows that were created with versions 3 2 or later  If you have to convert shows created    with an earlier version  please contact the hotline  see below              Display  Show Info          11 8 Loading a Demo Show    press BACKUP      e F 3 ryoer    Initialise    Merge Content J ppend Conter Eh   press Demo Show                 press LOAD Show     select the desired show using the Encoder  and load it by pressing on the Encoder        Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand HAABI    11 9 Saving the Current Show to an external Hard Disk   In anetwork envionment  you can save shows to an external hard disk and load them from that location  In order to  do so  you have to define the path to this hard disk from the BACKUP menu      press BACKUP     press File Server     setting up the File Server      press SERVER SETUP     enter IP address  FOLDER path  USER  LOGIN and Server Type     Press SAVE to save the settings      Saving a show      Archive Media     SAVE Show As  Enter a name for the show and confirm with ENTER  The show will be saved under the new  name       11 10 Loading a Show from an external Hard Disk    press BACKUP    press File Se
147. SET    Set AT filtering  Keep AT pressed  After half a second the AT filter menu will   appear  Change the filtering while you keep AT pressed    If the source objects are CHANNEL  FIXTURE or GROUP  the operation will bea    FILTERED COPY INSIDE THE PROGRAMMER All values except default  values will be copied if they pass the filter    Examples   FIXTURE 2 THRU 10 AT  select CMY colour mixing  FIXTURE 1 ENTER  This command will copy the CMY colour of fixture 1 to fixtures 2 THRU 10   You can copy patterns  Set fixture 1 to BLUE and fixture 2 to GREEN   FIXTURE 3 THRU 10 AT  select colour  FIXTURE 1 THRU 2 ENTER  Fixture 3 will be BLUE  4 is GREEN  5 is BLUE  6 is GREEN      Source and destination devices can overlap   FIXTURE 1 THRU 10 AT  select all features  FIXTURE 2 THRU 10   1 ENTER  This will perform a circular copy  shifting the values from device to device   If the source objects are SEQU CUE or PRESET  the operation will bea  FILTERED EXTRACTION TO THE PROGRAM MER   All values that exist in the source for the destination devices will be copied If  they pass the filter    Examples   FIXTURE THRU AT  select PAN TILT  CUE 1 ENTER   This will bring all PAN TILT information contained in CUE 1 of the default  executor  active into the programmer   CUE 5 AT  select GOBO  CUE 4 ENTER   Devices of cue 5 get the gobos of cue 4  of course only if the gobos were  programmed into  cue 4    CUE 5 AT  select GOBO  CUE THRU 4 ENTER  Devices of cue 5 get the gobos of the STATUS of cue
148. Start Id     Here  you can set the first ID for the Scanners  These are then displayed in the Fixture Sheet   Dimmer channels can also be used in the Fixture Sheet  In order to do so  you would have to assign    Fixture IDs   for the Dimmer channels first     Both ID numbers are displayed in the    ID    column in the fixture sheet  separated by a colon   Example    3 The lamp has the Channel ID 3  4   The lamp has the FIXTURE ID 4  6 8 Thelamp has the FIXTURE ID 6 AND the Channel ID 8  Qty  Quantity      Finally  you have to set the number of selected fixtures under    Quantity     numeric keypad or keyboard    Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand A  19       fe   ARENEMINE    PNOWNO       MA  AZ  A2  A5  A  Al    Al   Al  Al  A2  A2             ehh koh   hk   ak  BRWNSEOOONAUMMWN ROO ONTO WN a p       NNNNN           Stage Dimensions    x Min Baral x Max SAPAN       x  20 MA    LIGHTING    Autopatch      displays the next available DM X channel  in position ON this channel will be used after presing CREATE  in  position OFF  default  any other available channel can be used      Pressing    Create      will accept the settings for generating fixtures later on     2 2 2 Patching Scanners Dimmers    In The lower part of the window shows the Scanners Dimmers of the selected    Select a fixture in the    Patch    column  blue background      If all fixtures of these    Fixture Layers    are to 
149. TART   AUTOSTOP functions of the Sequences     Creating and saving a Playback Master     Click on an empty Executor Fader cell      Press the Function button  and in this menu the Special M aster button    Click ona Playback M aster  1 8     Assigning a Sequence to a Playback M aster     Open the Assign menu of the Sequence    Press the MASTER button   default is NONE       Click ona Playback M aster  Pb 1   Pb 8     Toggle  When engaged  it will switch over from Full to Out and vice versa   Full  Will switch the M aster to 100    Out  Will switch the M aster to 0    Using the Fader  you can apply a infinitely variable fading between 0 and 100    The Button and Fader functions cannot be modified    MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    small key symbol    this sequence is  locked and cannot    be edited dark green background      A   high priority  temporyry    Selected Sequence    big key symbol    this executor is    locked and canno  light green backgroufd    T  Tracking Mode    be edited or Selected Sequence  nee  deleted 1 q IS activ       5 2 Small EXECUTOR Window  grandMA   These windows are located above every EXECUTOR FADER or  after pressing the LIST key twice  in the right TFT  display for the EXECUTOR buttons   grandMA light  ultra light and Micro   After pressing the LIST FADERS key  these windows will be displayed above each of the EXECUTOR FADERS   After pressing the LIST KEYS key twice  they will be displayed on the TFT d
150. TER    All entries are executed immediately and can be controlled from the STAGE view or  even better  from the 3D  VISUALIZER      delete the settings by pressing 3x CLEAR  all effects will be deleted from the Programmer immediately    or   Save setting as Cue      press STORE      press on an empty cell in the small Executor window or an empty Executor button    The effect will be saved as a Cue  in the Sheets  the white text on a violet background will change to yellow on a dark  background  If PROGRAM MER ONLY had been activated  all features will disappear from the Sheet  This Cue can now  be executed or edited like a normal sequence     Applying EFFECTS to the Modulators     By transferring effects to modulators  you are enabled to execute changes very rapidly  As the effect will be  permanent  you can delete a temporary change after its execution or save it as a Cue       start the Effect button in the Effect pool    press TOP    press the Effect button of the currently running effect in the Effect pool    The effect stops  disappears from the ALL RUNNING PROGRAMS menu  and its settings can now be seen in the  modulators  All fixtures involved are marked by a red bar  all settings taken from the effect  have a dark violet  background in the modulators  all changed modulators have a violet background      MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn             Arrange in Matrix  Arange in Circle  Stretch Positions  Calibrate Follow       Co
151. TER GROUP becomes the DEFAULT KEYWORD   GROUP  range list  ENTER Select groups in range list   GROUP  range list  AT     see AT  Apply values to groups in range list   Group numbers in the range list must be in the interval   1    999    As target for the following executing commands     ON activate devices contained in group   OFF deactivate and deselect devices contained in group   PAUSE PARK all devices of group   GO UNPARK all devices of group   HIGHLIGHT  Pressing HIGHLIGHT once will change the selected fixtures to the value set in  SETUP     When holding the HIGHLIGHT button down  the selected fixtures will pulse   for  a better identification     IF is performing a logical command within selections  It never enlarges the  current selection  It leaves only those devices selected which are included in  both selections    Assuming that we have two groups  we will use real names to make it clearer    PAR64 includes ALL PAR64 lamps   FRONT TRUSS includes ALL lamps on the front truss     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    PAR64 IF FRONT TRUSS ENTER will therefore select all PAR64 which are on  the front truss     General Syntax       selection1    IF  selection2  ENTER   If selectionl is not given  the current selection will be used  FOUTPUT    IFOUTPUT is selecting devices depending on the current stage output   General syntax   IFOUTPUT  object list   ENTER   If the object list is a hit on an executor   s button  or a click into an
152. THE CONSOLES  HAVE THE SAME IP NUMBERS   THIS WOULD DESTROY THE OPERATING SYSTEM    Updating the software is only possible  if the first three number groups of the grandM As    IP addresses are  identical  e g  192 168 177 X       press SETUP     press UPDATE SOFTWARE     select a console from the table  If a console is not being displayed  it has a software version that cannot be  updated via network  you have to do that individually using a floppy      press UPDATE CONSOLE  or cancel the operation with CANCEL     WARNING  As of version 5 0  the selected console will receive the software version of the very console   the update was started from  i e  it is not possible  to    get    a software update       confirm the successful operation on PLEASE CONFIRM    After the successful update  the console should disappear from the overview  Repeat this operation for all  consoles      Using CHANGE NAME and IP  you can change the name and the IP address of a NSP directly on the console   The button will only be active  if a NSP exists in the overview      using SHOW SAME VERSION  you can call up all consoles of the session already having the same software  version     Updating without floppy disks    Using the OFFLINE   EDITOR  you can very quickly update consoles in a network connected with one another  and having internet access      onthe internet site www malighting de  go to SUPPORT   SERVICE and download the grandMA OffLine  Editor program to your PC      start the grandMA Of
153. TN oo A Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr 16 D 97297 Waldbittelbrunn    LIGHTING    8 Remote Control    8 1 Timecode   All sequences  chases and cues on the grandMA can be synchronized by using Linear Timecode  LTC  or MIDI  Timecode  MTC     Timecode synchronization can be used to trigger one or more controllers to synchronize with an audio or video  recording  SMPTE 24   25  and 30 Drop and Non  Drop Frames are encoded time information  e g  recorded on a  separate track of a multitrack tape  frequency range of 1 2 kHz   Normally  this Timecode is already added when  compiling the music  e g  for presentations  but it can also be recorded afterwards in a regular recording studio  If  the music is recorded in stereo  a third track is needed for the Timecode    All sequences programmed into the grandM A can be synchronized by Timecode    During the playback of the tape  the Timecode information is transmitted to the connected controllers  Each  controller has an internal memory that triggers the activation of a specific program at a given point of time  On  the grandM A  the EXTERNAL LTC Timecode can be connected via a jack socket and the MTC via Midi IN on the rear  of the unit     8 1 1 Introduction to the Timecode System    Here the major advantages of the new Timecode System     Timecode shows are organised in a pool  The basic handling of timecode shows like edit  copy  delete  etc  is  totally compliant with the rest of the console   s syntax     Timecode shows a
154. Type     Coarse    stands for a coarse channel  and    Fine    for a fine channel       Snap  FADE SNAP function for the respective channel  2 3 DM X List   Single Channel  specific Adjustments for  the Current Show     Inv  In this column  you can invert the respective channel      Default  This value is called up  if the Fixture or Channel is not controlled by CUE  Sequence  Preset or a direct  access  Can be changed with the left Encoder n      Highlight  This value is called up  if these fixtures are selected and the HIGHLIGHT key is pressed  Can be  changed with the second Encoder      Stage   No function assigned yet       MIB Fade  Allows you to set a FADE time for the MOVE IN BLACK function for this Fixture  Can be changed   with the right Encoder       Profile  In this column  you can assign a profile to the channel  See Creating  assigning and deleting Profiles     Time  For the 3D view  see 3D instructions      React to Dimmer  depending to a virtual dimmer can be set    Functions of the individual buttons     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn       re Type  Highlight Stage MIB Fade Profile 11       lefault    D       ase 2 Oe es ed Pee ere    a m A BA m BE m A n GA m AA m AE  ell  tal   fm     Fixture Types  Shortname Manufacturer  Comment   Date   Type   MIB Delay MIB    NONAME 01 01  Mirror Default Defa      Select Attribute    n TIL PAN TILT PAN TILT  nn Break   Attribute   Typ PAN TILT PAN TILT  ew    Default        Veci
155. UIKEY window  See Creating a Window     Press the EDIT key and click or touch on a Key in the QUIKEY pool   or      Makea right click with the mouse on a key  The QUIKEY OPTIONS pool will  open      Clicking on one of the functions will assign it to the key  Using this method it  is possible to customise the console allowing quick and easy access to commonly  used functions    List of functions     ALIGN OFF  Switches off the ALIGN function    ALIGN LEFT  ALIGN key pressed once   ALIGN RIGHT  ALIGN key pressed twice   ALIGN BOTH  ALIGN key pressed three times   ALIGN SYM  ALIGN key pressed four times   CLEAR SELECTION  CLEAR key pressed once   CLEAR ACTIVE  CLEAR key pressed twice   CLEAR RELEASE  CLEAR key pressed three times   VALUES M ODE  Switches the FIXTURE and CHANNEL SHEET to  the VALUES mode   FADE M ODE  Switches the FIXTURE and CHANNEL SHEET to    the FADE time mode    DELAY M ODE  Switches the FIXTURE and CHANNEL SHEET to  the DELAY time mode   ASSIGN  ASSIGN key   EM PTY  Creates an empty key   FLIP       Moving Head Fixtures  this function is used to control the manner in which  a Moving head fixture moves between two positions      Pressing 1x  The head will be turned so that it is pointing to the same  position but with different values for Pan  amp  Tilt  All lights that have 360  degrees or more of Pan and 270 degrees of tilt can point at the same  position using two  or more  sets of Pan  amp  Tilt values     Pressing 2x  For fixtures with more than 360 deg
156. URE  or Creating Scanners  EDIT FIXT   URE   Here  you can assign a profile to all fixtures of one type simultaneously    Or    Open the Patch Sheets menu  DMX List   Single Channel  specific Adjustments for the Current Show  Here  you can  assign a profile to each individual DM X channel     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    Gelect Profile x lt  In the Profile column  elect the cell for the fixture or DM X channel  and press the Encoder  The Select Profile  menu will open   Profile The table shows all created profiles   By selecting a profile  it will be activated and the menu be closed  The name of the selected profile will now be  i displayed in the cell     Edit   Un  assigning a Profile          Ho  Hame   Qty  newnew  speciali    W        g Select the name of the assigned profile and press the None button  This will revoke the assignment   ee  No 2 8 1EDIT PROFILES   Creating or modifying profiles  ial lide If you want to create a new profile  press the NEW button  The EDIT PROFILES menu will open  Additionally  a  window will open  where you can enter a name for the profile and have to confirm it with Enter   To change a profile  select it using the Encoder and press the Edit button  The EDIT PROFILES menu will open  with the selected profile   Qty  Numbers of cordinations are displayed  100  Number of fixtures  this profile is coordinated  At first  when creating a new profile  a lineary profile is displayed that can then be 
157. Version 6 0 grand ITA 39    Lr    ia    Cc  U  ss        bi    J   O   Z   N    m  Y        Lle    56 MA    LIGHTING    There are 3 ways to enlarge or reduce a window  M ove the cursor carefully to the lower or right border or corner   until you will siehe a small double  arrow next to the cursor  Now click and drag holding the left mouse key  By  moving the mouse  the window can now be resized according to your requirements    One of the most effective ways to work with the grandMA is by using the touchscreen and the encoder which is  located next to each display      3122 Deleting a window       Press the DELETE key once  Right click on the title bar of the window   Or     Click into the left corner  yellow dot  of the title bar  In the next window  confirm with YES or DELETE   Or     When pressing the top and bottom VIEW keys simultaneously  all windows on this TFT display  will be deleted     3 1 3 Scrolling with the UP and DOWN hard keys       Pushing the UP and DOWN hard keys will scroll a whole page up or down inside the menu or pool window  that has the input focus  dark blue title     Pushing down the UP or DOWN hard key while holding down its opponent will scroll to the beginning or to the  end    If there is an active popup dialog on screen  the UP and DOWN hard keys work as UP and DOWN cursor keys for  navigation inside the dialog      3 1 4 Temporary Opening of Windows   Important windows can be opened temporarily and quickly on the right Display   This function 
158. You can open this menu by pressing a button in the CONFIGURATION column  it contains a summary of all Tool  menus of the    big    grandM As    The    Ethernet Configuration Setup    menu allows you to change the IP and name of the console and to start a  session  This is the only way to make a connection to the grandMA 3D    NSPs and other grandMAs cannot be connected to the Micro     ARTNET DM X  ETHERNET  CONFIGURATION   You can call up this menu by pressing a button in the CONFIGURATION column  if the PathPort protocol has been  selected    It is possible to connect up to 16 Ethernet DM X Converter  On the DM X converters  unique SUB NET addresses  have to be designated accordingly  The address switches of the individual DM X sockets have to be set to four dif   ferent addresses  The settings modified on the DM X converter  can be overwritten by software  Artnet   Note    MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldb  ttelbrunn    ARTNET   Node Configuration SAVE x    Shortname  Fronttruss  Longname  Fronttruss scanns and pars    Manufacturer  Unknown Manufacture  IP  2 10 37  Yersion  100       Reset to    Local Control       SubSwitch  2    Output  Channel    OUTPUT  B     Status           0006  0007  Short Name Stored    PathPort DMX Ethernet Configuration SAVE    Scan for  Nodes    Output Slot Available Nodes    ID Node Dev  Slot Name Slot Name  2 Q000035E BACKTF2 1 A Scans 1 2 D Pars 2             Parameters for Ethernet DMX Output      xDMX Slot  1
159. You have to confirm the delete process by pressing    o    VERY  IMPORTANT   this is the letter    o    not the number    0     After    deletion is completed  the display will show DELETE DONE next to STATUS  You can start  the console by pressing the    ESC    key twice     Press 4  Delete current show   If you press   4    on the keyboard  the current show  this show will be automatically loaded  upon power  up of the console  will be deleted  You have to confirm the delete process by  pressing    o    VERY IMPORTANT   this is the letter    o    not the number     0   After the deletion is completed  the display will show DELETE DONE next to STATUS   You can start the console by pressing the    ESC    key twice     Press 5  Update firmware with display   If you press    5    on the keyboard  you can renew the Firmware for the second built  in  Computer  Motorola   In order to update the software  insert the current update disk  labeled    LAST DISK  You have to confirm the update process by pressing    o    VERY  IMPORTANT   this is the letter    o    not the number    0     As soon as the  update is completed  the display will show UPDATE DONE next to STATUS  You can start  the console by pressing the    ESC    key twice     Press 6  Update grandMA   In order to update the software  insert the current update disk labeled    LAST DISK    You  have to confirm the update process by pressing    o     Shortly after  you will be asked for     DISK 1    Now insert this disk and 
160. _  trigger      dimmer    Protect    Move in Black Options  Cuelist      MIB    MIB  always never    Auto  PrePos    Restart with Track  first cue   From Last           Function    ame                            Normal  vr          Priority Options    Arrest Private  2 Effects       Default Options    Load from  default              114       LIGHTING    5 1 8 Assigning BITM AP EFFECTS     press ASSIGN     press on the small Executor window     press FUNCTION     press BITMAP EFFECTS     use the Encoder to select the effect and confirm by pressing on the Encoder    if needed  set the button and fader functions    Moving  copying or deleting Executors     Press the MOVE key once to move Executors  LED is on     Or      Press the COPY key once to copy Executors  LED is on  Press the DELETE key once to delete Executors  LED is  on       To move or copy an Executor button or a window above the Executor  press or click on it once      Pressing another Executor button or window above the Executor will set the new position      Press an Executor button or on a window above the Executor once     If there are programmed Macros or Timecode Shows  in which the moved or deleted Executors were to be  used  these assignments may no longer work       5 1 9 PLAYBACK Master    As the Groupmaster affects the assigned Groups  the Playback M aster will have an effect on all assigned and active  Playbacks  The displayed   value refers to the output Playback values   This does not affect the AUTOS
161. a speed master     ALL is clearing any sub  selection made with ODD EVEN NEXT and PREVOIUS     ALL_CHASES    ALL CHASES is an alias for the expression ALL EXECUTORS THAT ARE ASSIGNED AS  CHASES  It can be used wherever EXEC could be used  Example   PAUSE ALL_CHASES ENTER    ALL_SEQUENCES    ALL SEQUENCES is an alias for the expression ALL EXECUTORS THAT ARE ASSIGNED  AS SEQUENCE  It can be used wherever EXEC could be used  Example   OFF ALL SEQUENCES ENTER    ASSIGN    ASSIGN  source objects   destination objects    ENTER     Source objects   a list of objects which are of the same type   Destination objects  a list of objects which are of the same type  Source object type Possible destination object type  Executing keyword EXEC FADERBUTTON1 2 3   SEQUENCE EXEC FADERBUTTON 1 2 3   GROUP EXEC FADERBUTTON 1 2 3    Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand HALOS    VIEW VIEWBTN  MACRO VIEW BTN  Executor buttons and view buttons as hard keys automatically perform the ENTER   Fix Ne DM X_N   to patch or repatch fixtures  clear DM X 1   absolute DM X number   Besign Fixture 2 DMN 5 2 DMX 1 2   Universum number     DMX number E       ASSIGN TIME    AT    ASSIGN  Time   value   target    ENTER   to set times in Cues  ASSIGN FADE  press TIM E button once   OUTFADE  press TIM E button 2x   DELAY  press TIM E button 3x   OUTDELAY  press TIM E button 4x   SNAPDELAY  press TIM E button 5x   Cue  N    forthe D
162. achdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    Active Network Sessions       Session N Showfile       Name  Password    Style    Change IP    My Station    IP Address   Be    Name    Invitation Enabled ite seven BEFORE    Local Station          15 Potentialities of Network connections    In the grandMA family  there are multiple networking possibilities  In the following description  we will use the  abbreviation grandMA or    unit  for any grandMA  grandMA light  grandMA ultra light  grandMA RPU  grandM A   Offline  and grandMA 3D  as they are all equipped with the same software options and only differ in their hardware   Offline and 3D  however  cannot create any DM X   The PDA remote control is not a unit in the above sense  and will  not be explained  The micro can only enter into a network connection with the 3D  grandM Avideo and WYSIWYG     NOTE  Connect to a network only with minimum 50  free memory     If in the network there is a device having a transmission rate of more than 10M bit  the whole network will be reduced  to that transmission rate     grandMA plus grandMA 3D  PC   For visualization purposes on a PC   2 grandMAs connected  Backup system or Single user   grandMAs connected  Multi User system   grandMA 3D  PC  with one or two NSPs as a complete console with DM X output  grandMA Micro with grandMA 3D  PC     15 1 Preparing the network settings     pres TOOLS    Pressing the MA Network Configuration button in the TOOLS menu will open this menu     Save Show 
163. achdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    LIGHTING    Di Fixture  Preset amp Values 3 12 Stage Flip      sorted by Numbers    The Flip   Set in the stage values can avoid an unintentional flip of the fixture  This is only possible within a certain  FC  Name Pan Tit   Clage range  depending on the technology of the fixture   some multiple rotations without changing the Tilt   position    Pan Tit     Y Z Flip are normally impossible   3 50 ERS eee    1   SL300 1    Fix a flip   position      Selekt fixture     activate the STAGE   values and set Flip  value with the encoder  With Flip          no specific flip position is  forced  With flip position 1 2 or 3  depends on type of fixture  the specific flip position will retained  if this is  physically possible      set position in FOLLOW   mode     store cue as normal       4 Cues and Sequences    A Cue is an individual stage setting  which can be assigned and stored directly to EXECUTOR button or EXECUTOR  Fader    Several cues in line are called a sequence  Sequences of cues can also be assigned and stored on an EXECUTOR  button or EXECUTOR Fader    If cues are created using Presets  a modication of this Preset will automatically update all cues which use this  Preset    Thus  time consuming checking and correction of individual Cues becomes unnecessary     We recommend to use the Preset functions as often as possible     EXECUTOR buttons or Faders can have multiple assignments for created sequences    EXECUTOR Faders and 
164. ackets  active with dark background  send all packets  even if no changes in the packets            Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand  TA 41    DMX Sheet             2 B   97         amma         42 MA    LIGHTING       2 10 DMX Output Window    Create a DM X Output Window  DM X  using a TFT Display  See Creating windows     Open Options Menu   In this window  each patched channel can be displayed showing the value it is currently outputing    By briefly pressing the respective keys  A   H   dark background   all DM X ports    DM X channels will be displayed  in this window  if needed  scroll through the window using the Encoder next to the Display     The first DM X channel of this row is displayed here       If you position the mouse pointer on a cell  the DM X channel  possibly already patched channels with their    fixture types and functions  will be displayed in the lower part of the window   In the DM X  sheet you can also change the DM X  Patch     Change patch   Press button Move  LED lights  and click on a channel with left mouse button  hold left mouse button down and  move the fixture to an empty space  You can only move the complete fixture  therefore you need enough space   in a continuous row  at the new address     Unpatch   Press button Delete  LED lights  and select a channel  with mouse or touch   All channels of the fixture will be  deleted     New Patch of Fixtures   
165. ackground     NOTE  with activated short cuts the PAN TILT  values are not adjustable by the hardware buttons  Deactivate the  short cuts  dark background  and adjust values as usual      49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 gad MA 211    GMA Remote  x 10 18 GD        Hours  Minutes  Seconds    NJ    MIA    LIGHTING    Command Time    To set the Fade   Delay times  after having selected Fixture and Feature  enter in the following  sequence      Fade   Delay     numeric value     time dimension  must have a red background      ENTER    Backspace to delete the last entry in the CommandLine    Escape to delete the CommandLine    blue background   short    toggle    hours minutes seconds   long    marked dimension will get a red background and remains set as it is    After confirming with ENTER  the COM MAND 2 menu will be called up  automatically    short  choose the  Feature   long  Pull down menu  of the Features    MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    O Fixture   toggle  Fixture   Channel   Fader  oa Sheet _       toggle  Sort Dir   Sort By   Readout    Switching to Values and Presets   fades   Delays   Values Only   DMX   Executor ID      Cue ID    toggle  Presets   Sheet  In the Channel Fader sheet  activate the Cursor scroll    in the Fixture sheet  toggle  Cursor scroll   Cursor value    fe   E  G  iz     8  E     i  Ez       a5        short  Select the parameter  if more than one   long  Calculator   whe
166. ackground  the master has a subordinate  priority     World assigned correctly     Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 gad Mf 221    Question Answer    The configuration of my console  Tracker ball  Screen If the DELETE SHOW button was pressed while loading a  Off  etc   has suddenly changed   settings and IP numbers show  alle configuration settings were reset to their  have changed  defaults  All settings must then be entered anew  Sorry     The consoles have different version numbers and will   In the NETWARE CONNECTIONS menu    cannot see some therefore  not be recognized by the network  Update    consoles  although they are in the network  the consoles to the current software version   All fixtures of a Cue can be selected using the EDIT  Can   select active fixture  e g  an active Cue  function lt  in this setting  you can save a group using  automatically to form a group  STORE  that is a SELECT ALL ACTIVES function  so to  speak   Can   exchange fixtures that are part of a seqency  e g  If you delete or exchange fixtures in the SETUP  all values  dimmers of another manufacturer  or fixtures having of the matching sequence that are not necessary  will  more features  also be deleted  cannot be restored   l e  if a new fixture    does not have e g  a color wheel  the color wheel values  for this ID will be deleted   and cannot be triggered   even if you install the old fixture again afterwa
167. add new contents       Only original contents  Upon updating the preset  only the changes on fixtures channels which have already  been used in this preset will be stored      Add new contents  Upon updating the preset  all changes will be stored regardless at to whether those  fixtures channels have already been used in this preset    Pressing the    Update Preset    key will update that preset being displayed with a blue background  You can select  another preset using the encoder    Pressing the    Update All Presets    key will update all presets listed in the chart    Pressing the Save as default key will store all  pre   settings as default  e g   Only original contents oder Add new  contents   These settings will be ready the next time you open the Update menu     Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand  TA 1    3 7 6 Embedded Presets    0  Ta   With this function  you can    embed    preset values into other presets  so you can quickly change multiple presets   Ti As the embedded value is nothing but a link to the original preset  all changes of the original preset will be     j  preses   contained in all those presets containing this link  All Embedded Presets  as well as all presets having a link to  i another preset  can be distinguished by a black frame in the Preset Sheet     Creating an Embedded Preset      call up a preset     adjust additional values or positions     use STORE t
168. ake  Undo   OOPS progressively performs     If the command line is not empty  a backspace in the command line     If the undo stack is not empty  an undo operation   Undos are created for programming actions such as storing a cue   You can not do an undo for playback actions such as starting an executor   The undo stack contains the last 10 programming operations  therefore you can    go back 10 undos  Nevertheless a command like DELETE SEQU 1 THRU 10   deletes 10 sequences  will create only one undo on the stack    Working with undos can give you security during your programming  but for  performance reasons on very large shows it can be switched off   see SETUP    UNDO menu      As staring keyword  the given page will become the current page   PAGE T X ENTER  T Type of page in range  1  3   Type 1 means Dimmer pages  Type 2 means Fader executor pages  Type 3 means Button executor pages  X For dimmer pages in range   1   amount dimmers divided by 20    For executor pages in range  1  64   PAGE X ENTER Will select fader and button executor page together  As target for the following operational commands     COPY Copy one page to another  DELETE Delete a page  MOVE Move a page to a different location    As target for all execution commands   The page will redirect the given commands to all its executors     PAUSE    As starting keyword  every object that follows after the PAUSE will be paused   PAUSE  target object list   ENTER     Target type Operation   EXEC Pause an executor
169. ake effect and be saved after leaving the Full  Access menu and after pressing the SAVE button     2 6 FIXTURES TYPES  create new     In the Full Access menu  open this menu by pressing the Fixture Types button    All fixtures that are currently used in the Show will be displayed in the upper part of the Displays    Description of all functions See FIXTURE TYPES    In the New column  click on the Name cell and enter a name for the new fixture and confirm with Enter  A new  fixture is created and the basic settings are set to    Default    These settings still have to be adjusted     Please make sure that the chosen name does not already exist  because otherwise two with the same name can  later only be recognised by their manufacturer or the date       Now  you can enter a name for Shortname  M anufacturer and  if needed  a comment      Type stands on Mirror and can be switched to Head by selecting the cell using the Encoders  to the right of the  Display   Type     Adjust the values for MIB Delay and M IB Fade  if needed      The settings for BeamAngle  Power  Lumen and Weight will only be needed for the visualization in the Stage   window or on the grandMA 3D and can be adjusted  if need be    In the New column  click on the Attribute cell and open the Select Attribute window by pressing on the Encoder    right to the Display     Now  select the function for the first channel and accept it by pressing the Encoder one more time  Automatically    the next line will be selecte
170. all values of the selected Fixtures and channels can be stored as Cues     4 1 1 Creating new Cues   Create the look on stage by direct access or presets  See Accessing Dimmer Channels directly or Calling up   Presets   This look shall now be stored as CUE in the following way      Press the STORE key and hold it  The following options and encoder names will appear on the right TFT   display      Press one of the following keys  selected key will receive dark  grey background colour       Active Values  Store only the active values  all values in the FIXTURE CHANNEL window which are shown   with a red background colour       All  Store all settings  all fixture and channel values       All for Selected Devices  All values of the selected fixtures and channels will be stored  the   fixture channel numbers will be marked in yellow       Release the STORE key  LED stays on       For this CUE  set the following parameters via the encoders      Trigger  Call of the CUE by GO  SOUND or FOLLOW  i e  after previous cue in the sequence has completed  or  automatically after an amount of time      Fade  CUE will be played back with the set time  this is only possible with    FADE    functions  See Single  Channel  specific Adjustments for the Current Show  point 10  and EDITING FIXTURES  modify   point 9      Delay  CUE will be called up delayed by the time set  only possible for the    FADE    functions      Snap  Delay  The Snap values of the CUE will be played back after the set per
171. alue or value that has been changed in this cue        Dimmervaluegreen   value has been reduced    value magenta  Default      Tracked value  is defined by the previous cyan  colored value      and is not saved  i e  if you change the cyan  colored value in a cue  above  all magenta  colored values following will also change     value magenta  Theatrical   racked value  see above     Note  The tracked values will only be executed within the sequence  if the Tracking option had been selected in the  Assign menu lt  otherwise  the values will not be executed  although they appear in the Sheet  If only some of the  fixtures are to be tracked  you have to block those values not to be tracked and have to set them to 0     value red  Default ocked value  the value that was defined by the previous cyan   colored value  will be saved  Changes on the  previous cyan  colored value will no longer affect  the value   the first  upper  tracked value will turn from red to  cyan    value white  Theatrica ocked value  see above    times  Fade  Delay   Defaults    yellow individual value  magenta tracked value from a cue  grey value from a cue    times  Fade  Delay   Theatrical     bright value individual value  Index  i  individual tracked value  dark value value from a cue    backgroung blue green  Default  value is from a preset  lateral blue green bar  Theatrical  value is from a preset    background red    this fixture   s selected     Fixture name yellow  header bar  this fixture is se
172. ame directly using the    Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand ITA 29                  Select Attribute i iy  No    Break   Attribute   Type   Si         COLORI Coarse   i     GOBO1 Ri Coarse Attribute   Featue   Pr Specials   kal GORDI _ Coarne _ j    gt       DIM Coarse   PANG  5 i k  a  f          TLT Coarse   tit    FROST Coarse  TT ort     oare    TE Exp 4              FOCUS      Coarse 1 enpa  pne    1d   TILT Fine   BO      Import 4           iate fatures at  R al WW Lomashare ne         Fixture Typuy           Ho   Oty  Moree Chah ama   Maralacture  Coment   Dats Typa Scale IHID Dala    Ee SW A Li SAAR __ bean Heads TMU Metal   E 7 Pau HRH AF Fai Hi mih apai Tas  EET Tha   Hew   Ike       igmess ul Fist Type        He    Dank    EEEN   Tns     San   iy  enfe h ML a ape   Lall Fadi  Mois     ma i ual   i iag ji      H i iual i if a i f   Baa i2 Maat     EST Lo Hrs     e mig iu IHY limi  peee Fe       j tt   fi Conrse     Oo   2 ARAN Eear  ee ea  e   5 AN  eel erlar     To o IPA OAFEE  Wer   r   et ie eet S     oe   7 IMET   Cones  i  0 kupil   U    IFULUS  gaat PES He  Se   er stan    OEhie  neon fia  thd ok  ee h l   Function   natn ine      30 MA    LIGHTING        keyboard      Shortname  Here  you can enter an abbreviation or short name      Manufacturer  Manufacturer s name from the Library      Comment  Enter a comment here      Date  If you see    Original    here  this fixture
173. ammer    gt  CLEAR ALL CUEX EERE T  CLEAR ACTIVE a i  ea   X of oe  Te    vation j i i ame as above    Clears the activation in the programmer without destroying stage output  CUE EXECZ a a eE  CLEAR ALL In case of STORE New cue at the end in executor Z  Clears the selection  CUE X EXEC Z Cue X of executor Z  Clears the activation  X Cue number in format A B with intervals   0   3999   0   999    B is optional   Clears the programmer totally  all values returned to default or to playback    CUE 0    is invalid  but    CUE 0 5    is valid   control  Y Sequence number in interval   1    999    ODD EVEN Sub  selection is reset to ALL  Z Executor number in format PAGE INDEX with intervals   1    64   1   60    or in format INDEX with interval  1   60  using current page   CLEAR SELECTION Either X or Y Z can be range lists  Range lists with X and Y Z are not allowed   Clears the selection  No device is selected  Therefore  Ea  ODD EVEN Sub  selection is reset to ALL  CUE 1 THRU 10 SEQU 1 is valid  SER E S S CUE 1 TRUE 10 SEQU 1 THRU 5 is invalid  COPY As starting keyword   COPY  source objects  AT  destination objects    ENTER   CUE ENTER CUE becomes the DEFAULT KEYWORD   Source objects   a range list of objects which are all of type X  CUE  range list  ENTER Select devices included in cue s    Destination objects  a range list of objects which are all of type Y CUE  range list  AT     See AT  Apply values to devices included in cue s    Object types X and Y must be equal or compa
174. and    all possible Executors        Only last called Executor  The   Cue Destinations    chart only shows the last played back cue      All possible Executors  The    Cue Destinations    chart shows all currently playing back cues on all executors         Tracking    or    Cue Only    Update  A    tracking  update may affect    cues in the future    while a    cue only    update  does not affect them       Pressing the    Update Cue    key will update that cue being displayed with a red background  You can select  another cue using the encoder       Pressing the    Update All Cues  key will update all cues listed in the chart       Pressing the Save as default button will save the  pre  sets as default settings  e g   Only original contents or Add  new contents   The next time you open the Update menu  these settings will be available     Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand HAA03    4 6 INFO   window    An information window can be added to every executor  Type here information for sequences  chasers or effects   Additional you can type infomation for every cue in a sequence  a chaser or an effect     Create Info Window      with CREATE A WINDOW and INFO an empty Info Window opens     press Select      Select Something    appears     press button or little Executor window of the relevant sequence  chaser or effect     type info text     close Info Window    Eseg  1 12 Seq 3 Seq  gt     Cre
175. and accept by pressing the  Encoder one more time  A YES in the respective cell will indicate that SNAP has been chosen for this channel    The default for all DM X channels is to follow cue timing      FADE  A value can be changed slowly  channel can fade            Will show the ID for Channel and Fixture  The IDs can be changed without affecting the show  e g  for a better  DMX Id Ch id Fix siue atuibute I Default Highlight  Stage Snap x f p  ne i SL300 1 GOBOI Ri display on the Fixture Sheet   A3 1 SL300 1 GOBO1         Aag  as i sao  PAN   The name of fixtures and dimmer channels assigned to the individual DM X channels   AG 1 SL300 1 TILT        a  As 1 sL300 1 FOCUS     The functions of the individual DM X channels   All 2 SL300 2 COLOR1 ixture   i     F          A12 2  1300 2 G0801 R Patch   In this column  a profile can be assigned to this channel  See Creating  Assigning and Deleting Profiles  AIS 213002 PAN Channel   Within this column  the respective DM X channel can be inverted  A click into the cell will activate this  A17 2 SL300 2 FROST     4 ll       AGT  awe 2 81300 2 FOCUS E function  Press the Encoder  right to the Display   Select Yes for    Inverted     No for    not inverted    or Original  A23 3   3   3   3   3   3   4   4   4   4                 Fixture Patch   DMX Id Fixld Ch Fixture Type Name NoMaster Pan Tilt Sw  X  Al Test ic   3 i i WW i f   i  arh ie a NNE This is only a pre  setting for each individual channel and can easily be changed during p
176. and delete Channel Values  Using the EDIT command and the respective feature  you  can instantly jump into the FUNCTIONS SETS menu and  after exiting this menu  back into the SM ART window  In  the context of the M A  VIDEO software  the SMART window holds some especially interesting features   NOTE  Although the SM ART function  on first sight  might seem to be equivalent to the PRESET function  you  should use SM ART only for those hardware settings that remain unchanged most of the time  For show   depending settings that have to be adjusted quickly  you should use the PRESET function     Use CREATE WINDOW to open the SM ART window  As long as no fixture has been selected  the window is  empty  the fixture   s features will only be displayed after having been selected  If different fixtures were selected  at the same time     green buttons  show features for all selected fixtures    yellow buttons  show features for some of the selected fixtures    1 grey button  Indicates an empty button to accept new settings to be saved    Press the yellow button  upper left corner  and open the SMART WINDOW OPTIONS menu    Set the desired views     Headline  here  features and attributes will be displayed as pull  down menus      Direct Select  here  features and attributes will be displayed in a structured overview    Select a fixture  The SMART window will display all features and attributes belonging to this fixture  If  e g  for Gobos  graphics are  used as backgrounds  these are d
177. and open the WIZZARD   ARRANGE IN MATRIX      Select those fixtures to be embedded into the matrix  the number should be the sum from horizontal and  vertical lines as otherwise no complete square will result      Enter the number of horizontal ROWS and vertical COLUM NS      Enter the horizontal and vertical distances of the fixtures  the resulting total value may  however  may not  exceed the stage size      Confirm using the OK button       with POSITION   b  Single    Create a layout   Here  you can create layouts that can later be assigned to a Bitmap effect     you can move the layout  without changing the m            open the LAYOUT VIEW menu using CREATE A WINDOW      press CHOOSE LAYOUT and use the Encoder to select   confirm a free layout number in the overview      open the OPTIONS  press the yellow button in the upper left corner       press SETUP to open the MANIPULATE   SETUP LAYOUT menu      click on the LABEL line and enter a name for the layout  confirm with ENTER      select the fixtures to be used in the layout  on the STAGE  FIXTURE or CHANNEL Sheet       enter the values for ROWS and COLUMNS  number of rows and columns making the grid   pressing on the  digit cell will open the Calculator  after entering the values  confirm with ENTER  The menu will now show the    selected grid where you can place your fixtures     Transferring fixtures into the layout    Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 6888
178. ap Editor  so that it is advisable to check them in the STAG view       LEFT  RIGHT  RIGHT   LEFT  places the ID number starting point to the left   right margin     BOTTOM   TOP  TOP   BOTTOM  places the ID number starting point to the bottom   top margin    Horizontal first  arranges the fixtures horizontally in an ascending order of their ID numbers      Vertical first  arranges the fixtures vertically in an ascending order of their ID numbers     If a Bitmap effect runs on the same fixture matrix  but with differently filled layout  this will produce mirrored  representations   see example on the left     Using the default setting will take the stage output as displayed in the Preview window  if LEFT and RIGHT are    exchanged  the stage output will be displayed mirrored  You can save both layouts under different names and allocate  pas them to the effect      FILL  all fixtures taken over into the layout will be placed in it using the selected settings  as far as there is enough  Space available   fixtures in excess will be    spared    in a red square adjacent to the grid    or     position each fixture individually  in order to do so  click  mouse or finger  on the red square and draw it on a free     cell inthe grid      Press  X    to leave the SETUP menu       leave the LAYOUT VIEW menu using OPTIONS and DELETE WINDOW     Use DRAW to switch over to the drawing mode     In this menu  you can create a graphics in a selected layout by hand or mouse  or you can modify a
179. are of the grandMA family is in a process of constant expansion and improvement  Due  to the control via menus and display softkeys it is possible to realise the feedback of our  customers and technical advances in our software updates  The hardware is only the basis and  offers sufficient capacity to guarantee that its owner will always participate in the fascinating  technical developments     14 3 4 Peripherals  Peripheral units  such as a wireless remote control  are still in the development process  A 3D  visualisation software is available     14 3 5 Capacity      grandMA replay unit controls 2048 parameter  4096 parameteras option via ethernet   dimmers and attributes of 8 or 16 bit  with softpatch to 4096 DM X addresses Up to 16384  parameter with NSPs      A freely configurable monitor offers flexible operation and precise adaptation to any individual  working mode      Playback works on the basis of dipless crossfade either in Tracking or Non  Tracking mode      The internal harddisk allows for virtually unlimited storage capacity of presets  memories  cues  and effects     14 3 6 Front Panel Layout      5 Faders as Executor    Effect or Group  Faders  each with 3 directly assigned buttons     5 Executor Buttons for direct retrieval of Sequences  Chases and other functions     when programming the show on the grandMA but    running    the show  afterwards on the Replay Unit     14 3 Specification and Technical Data   14 3 1 Integrated Harddisk and Diskdrive   The ha
180. at all steps as described with the first cue and store with STORE      Copying Cues     Moving Cues     Deleting and renumbering Cues     Inserting LOOPs    MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    UPDATE    UPRAT  marga cad fields int Aati tin      rege Ues lintel Pye Besta    Wo    T   Hama Ji REM T    Te r a E Tu od  Tia  l  il  peel  Cth T      rockmng   prta t    Preset Fille  OH    Suva  be dataut         Inserting Command Line Commands    Changing times for one or more Cues     The Time Scaling function  described in chap  4 3 3  can also be used for Chasers     4 5 Updatings Cues    When executing sequences  Cues can be modified and stored directly    Playback the Cue to be modified  M odify the Cue by either direct access or via presets  UPDATE key LED is on     See Direct Access to Fixtures  in the FIXTURE SHEET    Direct Access to Dimmer Channels and Creating and calling  up Presets     Press the Update key once    The UPDATE window will open      By pressing this key  you can toggle between    only original contents    and    add new contents         Only original contents  Upon updating the cue  only the changes on fixtures channels which have already been  used in this cue will be stored       Add new contents  Upon updating the cue  all changes will be stored regardless at to whether those fixtures   channels have already been used In this cue       By pressing this key  you can toggle between    only last called Executor    
181. at were activated wi e  preset  ue numeral over the preset name ows the number of the lamps that were activated wi e preset  when  lamps are selected at the same time that were not activated with this  preset       ite black points on bottom edge Ihe preset contains    toreign    values  e g  dimmer values In a  preset   The white points signal active    foreign    values in the relevant  parameters  1 field PAN  2nd field TILT  3rd field DIM etc   see Chapter  PRESETS     Colors used for the screen display in the Group Sheet               olor or symbo  ep 42 18 greyarea   i     lt     rW w        QroupwithseveralTixtures        htpOlMt1E grey area wit group with severa  R blue frame fixtures are selected  a ue area group consists of one fixture       Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 gad HASI    COLOR CODE    Manual OFF Colors used for the screen display in EFFECT POOL  r   Color or symbol   Pinkbutton   Effectgroupwithassignedscanners  dimmers SSS  Redbutton   Efectgroupwithoutassigned scanners  dimmers SSS  Green DUT   ue button  in the menu  Temporary Effect group  will be deleted after switcn  orf    if not saved before   Circulating whitedot     SH eFECT STUNNING SSS  flashing greendot o     EDN  menusi  a          Colors used for the screen display in SMART Window   Color or symbol   Button yellow The Channel Value button can only be used for some of the selected fixtures    Buttongreen
182. ate Info for cue      press EDIT     choose a sequence  chaser or effect  not Bitmap Effekt     press Button INFO     type Infotext    4 7 REPORT window    The REPORT function allows you to create a printed overview of sequences  An Excel file will contain all fixtures  involved with their respective values sorted in amp by Cues  You can also create reports for GROUP  WORLD and  PRESET  In these cases  the matching fixtures and saved values will also be displayed in tables     Open the report from the Command Line       enter report_seq  number or area of the sequence       enter report_seq_ number of sequence _ number or area of Cues       enter report_group_  number or area of Groups       enter report_ world_ number or area of Worlds       enter report_preset_  number or area of Preset    Only    Report    will create reports of all Cues  sequences  Groups  Worlds   CAUTION  will produce large files   The right display will show the view form of the report  If there are more columns available than can be shown on the  display  proceed by using the arrow  buttons  If there are more lines available  scroll on using the Encoder next to the  display     With each    REPORT    command  the previously active contents of the REPORT index will be deleted to be replaced  by the chosen files        MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn       LIGHTING             y Ji t e ee          L CI BACKUP    C  colors  192 168 177 114 _ pocde  a TT LL FIRTUR
183. ated       Attribute Sort  only in COM PACT CONTENT SHEET   Sort the vertical order of the attrubutes     Select the attribut e  has dark blue background  and move with UP or DOWN       Select Sequence   A view with all stored sequences is shown      Select the required sequence by turning the encoder and press the encoder to open the sequence   or     Select the required sequence by touching the sequence on the display   In the CONTENT SHEET now the required sequence appears     Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand HAAR                     Tatie  Dr Sze   Base   Os  04    PAN SN  PO         hot Fler       Edit Effect 9 EFF 9         ra w             TATO PWM  lt  00    B waue w                                                                 Fuar CALOUR AME 2 1100 IRA Inn Ta l          Ue I ale      20 Odd COLOURTRAMP  gt  SO  m IF l          124 MA    LIGHTING    6 Effects  6 1 Effect Pool    In the Effect Pool  you can create up to 900 different Effect groups  In the individual Effects groups  different   Effects and functions can be combined and matched to each other    For PAN TILT values  self  created two  dimensional forms can be played back and adjusted  See Creating and   storing virtual forms   The individual Effect Groups can be subdivided into four different types      Effect Group with assigned Fixtures or Dimmers  key of the Effect Group is displayed in pink    a specific effec
184. ating and editing of fixtures and  dimmers  Stage Setup  Edit Show       press SETUP    FIXTURE SCHEDULE   Full Access   In the Full Access menu  you can define the number of Scanner and Dimmer channels and assign DM X  addresses  Furthermore  the stage can be adapted and Scanners and Dimmers be positioned accordingly    Only in the Full Access menu can you modify the complete Show  If using the console in the Multi User mode   you can access this menu only from a console  See All Access   When adapting a Show  a copy will be used  the modifications will only be available when they are saved     Accessing this menu will take a few seconds  as all Fixtures  approx  300  will be loaded from the hard disk     Live Access   There are certain limitations when it comes to modifying a Show  These modifications will be executed  immediately  In the Multi User mode  the Show data can be adapted by multiple users simultaneously  In the  Live Access menu  you can e g  assign DM X addresses  Furthermore  the stage can be adapted and Scanners and  Dimmers be positioned accordingly  Additionally  adaptations can be made in the Attribute Setup    It is not possible  to sign on or delete new lamps in the Show    The PDA remote control does have the status of Live Access only     AUTO CREATE    In this menu  you can e g  have presets automatically created for all your fixtures and dimmers  as long as those  presets are already contained in the internal library  Premade Effects and Groups for 
185. be patched one after the other  you can select all of them together by  clicking on the column title  in this case PATCH   Now  all fixtures are displayed on a blue background     Pressing the Encoder will open this menu    Below    Direct Patch   the first free DM X channel is displayed      First  you have to set the DM X output  e g   A  B        then the  first  DM X channel      Finally  press the    Patch     key  That   s all    Or    All free channels are displayed in the right column  By turning the Encoder  all invisible channels can be displayed  and selected  Pressing the Encoder will accept the channel    If the TEST OUTPUT button is pressed  green background   the selected DM X output channel is set to 100   This  accelerates the localizing of a patched channel in the stage setup    This function will only affect fixtures  whose DM X signal is directly output by the console  Consoles in Slave operation  or fixtures  whose signals are output over the MA  Net  cannot execute this function    Now  the selected and patched fixtures can bei positioned in a 3D stage display      Leave menu with X      press Save to save the modified settings     Don t Save will discard the modifications     with Cancel you stay in this menu     2 2 3 Position of fixtures    In the upper right part of the window  you ll find a simplified representation of the stage that can be used to  position the fixtures  Settings will also be taken over onto the grandMA 3D    If this part of the wi
186. before changing the IP adress      The change it  just click on the IP address  this will open a window containing the current IP address that can be  changed directly  This IP address cannot be used on different consoles within the network  Simply alter the individual  IP address of each unit to unique numbers within your network  M ake sure that the first three number blocks  in this  case  192  168  and 0  are identical for all units      By pressing the Save and Reboot button  the new address will be saved and the console be restarted       Define console name   This is where the name of the console is displayed  This name will be displayed on each unit in the network and will  facilitate the assignment of individual units in larger networks  To change  just click on the name  overwrite it in the  window that will open  and confirm      Define the station name     Define the station priority     Set Invitation to     Enable  Its possible to invite this console to a session      Disabled  Its unposssible to invite this console     Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand HAAI3       Password         Style A  Mutusen         pi Statio Full   Tracking    ras MA Network   Consoles    Active Network Sessions    ID  Session Name   Showfile  Unconnected _      T          IP   ddress  Name eduart 6e35f6a4 Name    Prioritiy f Norma Password    Invitation Enablec Style    194 MA    LIGHTING         de
187. bsite www malighting com     17 4 REMOTE    This menu can be used to see the connected remote handheld PCs   NOTE  Disable Remote when a show is running    MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    18 PDA Remote Control    Introduction   The PocketPC is the ideal complement to our grandMA console  It combines the functionality of a console with the  mobility of a compact organiser  It serves to remotely control the major operations and must be used together with  the console  It is not intended to and cannot replace the programming at the console  as for reasons of visibility  only  the most important menus will be displayed  Working with these menus is explained in the appropriate chapters of  the grandMa User   s Instructions  alternative operation and special key layout will be explained on the following  pages     The following devices are suitable    So far  the following products have proved successful   as of 02 2009   COMPAQ iPaq Serie 36 38xx with extensionPack PCMCIA  TOSHIBA e740 e750 version WiFi  recommended by MA Lighting   TOSHIBA e800  recommended by MA Lighting   DELL Axim X5 with Linksys CF Wireless Adapter  HP iPaq Pocket PC H5400 family with ROM  update  from 17 03 2003   Fujitsu  Siemens Pocket Loox 710 N560 and LOOX N520  recommended by MA Lighting   HP iPaq H4155   HP iPaq H 5550 BT  APPLE iPod and iPhone  Note  Phonecall interrupts Remote function   as access points   as of 02 2009   ASUS SpaceLink WL 300  recommended
188. button  above the right Encoder  will switch this button to Out  Now  you can modify  this time with the Encoder Out  Fade    If no FADE or DELAY times are indicated  none are stored in this CUE     Changing all times of one or more Cues   CUE TIME SCALING  Changing all times of one or more Cues     CUE TIME SCALING     With this function  you can scale or compress all Fade  Delay  and Trigger times      select one ore more Cues  red cell       click on the Cue   s number using the right mouse button or the Encoder on the side of the monitor     Inthe EDIT CUE NUMBER menu  select a percentage or absolute change     Scale Timing      All times of the marked Cue will be changed to the entered value When entering  100   all values remain unchanged      Scale Timing  sec   The total time of the marked Cues will be changed to the entered time   all times  will change proportionally  For the example on the left  For the 4 marked Cues  6 seconds were entered   DELAY and FADE were Increased to 6 seconds in total  the trigger time increases according to the  proportional changes of the individual times       Use the Calculator to make the changes  and confirm with ENTER   WARNING  If you compress all times to 0  you will no longer be able to enter longer times  You would then have  to enter all times anew  or you could restore them  if the OOPS function was activated  not on the MICRO      FADE times in Profiles    Besides lineary FADE times  you can also use to vary FADE procedures u
189. buttons are organised in PAGES  You can work on all PAGES simultaneously  Changing pages  only effects what you currently have physical access to NOT what is currently playing back  When using motor  faders  those motor faders will move reflect the status of the current PAGE    With the EXECUTOR buttons it is possible to call up the Cues  Sequences and Chasers  See Buttons and Faders     For dimmer channels  the respective MASTER FADER  Group fader and the Grandmaster have to be pushed  up     EXECUTOR buttons do not have a Master and are therefore are activated immediately  When dimmer values are  playback via Cues or Sequences assigned to EXECUTOR buttons priority issues may arrise then trying to  control these same dimmer values from other EXECUTOR button and faders without first switching off the relevent  EXECUTOR buttons  In practical terms this means that to work with Dimmers as on a convenetional console  HTP    dimmer channels have to be assigned to the Executor Faders     Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand  TA 87    Store Options    Save as default  JR    Store Source  Filter     il  Define  If not empty           88 MIA    LIGHTING    4 1 Creating Cues  separate memories    The actual stage setting can be stored as a Cue and be called up via the EXECUTOR buttons or faders     All changed  active  values  recommended setting       all momentary settings  complete Output       or 
190. can now edit the duration or the loop counter value in the LOOPDELAY column by  clicking on or entering the respective value    Example  When you enter    5    in the TIMED cell  the loop will be executed for 5 seconds  When you enter   5    in  the COUNT cell  the loop will be repeated five times  before the Sequence will be continued normally d     4 3 8 Inserting Command Line Commands    Within a Sequence  a Command Line Command can be triggered by a Cue  As soon as this Cue is reached  this  command will be executed  By setting a time frame  the command can be played back with its own individual  delay time  See Command Line    Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand A  99    Executor 1 16 Loops  segu  2  Seg 2 Lint    HIE Trig Loop Lo Del Li Def Link  1Cue GO Page 1 2                                                       Exec 1 11 Seq 1    Seq 1  UEA Loops   Effects pe x the  No  Name MIB   Trig Fade _  Outfade   Delay Outde  Start  I Di pales  gt    NN 1 Cue GO    Os cen   meen   cree       3  3 Cue Os    0s Os   rr 2 Speed J  4 4 Cue  Os  Os  Os    5 5 Cue GO  0s Os aag er  gt   6 6 Cue GO  Os Os  7 7 Cue GO  0s  0s Sound bounce    Speed        8 8 Cue GO  s  s oan  lt   gt  2     9 9 Cue GO  Os E  10 10 Cue G0 z random    5Peed  11 11 Cue GO Os 3    Auto Speed  Loop   4                   Double                            Speed Scale Master Fade    100 MA    LIGHTING       A click on the
191. cates  at what position this Group will be in relation to the other overwritten Effect Groups  If the other  Effect Group that had overwritten this Group is switched off  this Effect Group will again affect the Fixtures   Dimmers  This function is active by default when creating a new Effect Group      Sync Start  If this key is pressed  dark background   and another Effect Group had already been started  this  Group will automatically be started at the same speed and position      One Shot  If this key is pressed  dark background   the Effect Group will only be executed for one complete run  and will be deactivated     Speed Scale Start Speed Sync  tl Hi G          Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 gad HALLS                                                Ta See              No    MB   EE TEE   1   BR 1 OFF   E38 GO 7 Ef 40 GO  2 blinder GO   3 0   EE 1 G0 i Eff 38 OFF 7 blinder OFF         a    blinder OFF          Chwa BiP          m a    Cot   ch he       130 MA    LIGHTING    6 5 Effect groups in Cues   During normal SAVE processes  you can also save Effect Groups in Cues  In the Cues  the settings for Call  GO  GO    Pause and OFF   Intensity  SPEED  SOFTNESS and IN OUT FADE TIME are saved  In the Cues  no further  settings from the Effect Group will be saved  function as with presets     Or    It is also possible to create Cues  to which an own Effect Group can be assigned  If temporary E
192. ce  Assigning and Activating QUIKEYS   so that they can be  operated via the mouse  Values within the fixture or channel sheets can be  modified with the middle mouse key  A Command Field will appear on the  monitor when clicking on those fields above the  non  existing  encoders  You  can operate this Command Field with the mouse also     14 2 3 Working in Stand Alone Mode  Playback    This means working with the Replay Unit without the use of external mouse   keyboard and monitor  In this mode you can only activate Playback via the  existing elements on the front of the unit  Please note  that you will only have  5 Executor Faders and 5 Executor Buttons available  These Executors  correspond with the first 5 Executors on the grandMA and grandMA light  There  is no access to any of the other Executors  This becomes particularly important    14 3 2 Ethernet and other Options   In addition to the 4 DM X output ports the hardware of the grandMA replay unit is designed to  transmit larger numbers of channels via Ethernet  ESTA is currently working on a standard  protocol for this form of transmission  which will guarantee a compatibility between units of dif   ferent manufacturers  similar to the DM X norm  In addition to DM X input  Sound  SM PTE  timecode  it offers a printer port and a RS232 interface  only for GPS  receiver  and a USP  Port   not active  for faster communication with any kinds of peripheral units     14 3 3 System Maintenance and Software Updates   The softw
193. change the group  assignment     Press SHUFFLE SEL ORDER once  Now  the first group will consist of the n  s 1  2  3 12  and 15  With each  NEXT command  you can call up the next group and the new assignment of the respective group will be kept  only  when using the SHUFFLE SELORDER command the next time will the assignment be changed     You can also combine the SHUFFLE SELLORDER with SHUFFLE VALUE     Press SHUFFLE VALUE once  This will exchange the values  n  s 1  2  3  12  and 15  randomly within the group        3 10 Blind Modus   The Blind mode will separate the stage output from the programmer  i e  when changing values being in the Blind  mode  the values of the stage output will remain as they are  You can program shows without changing the  current stage lighting  by simply switching over using the BLIND key you gain a quick access to the stage lights       Hold the BLIND key  until you hear the beep and the key LED starts to blink   The title bar of all Sheets affected by the Blind mode will change from blue to red     The Blind mode differs as follows from the stage output      all other Sheets are available      changes in presets can be saved in Blind mode and when switching to stage output  the old value will still be visible     changes in SETUP will also be visible in the stage output      sequences  effects  groups  etc  that you delete while in Blind mode  will also be deleted in the stage output      PDA will show the respective mode without indication whe
194. changed simultaneously  If they reach    0    or    FF     they will be aligned      Incremental  All dimmer values will be changed simultaneously  If they reach    O  or    FF     the respective  intervals will be maintained      Prop    All dimmer values will be changed in percentages and will reach    O    simultaneously      Prop    All dimmer values will be changed in percentages and will reach    FF simultaneously    Please note  that with PROP  a change of the value    0    is not considered a change    Please note  that with PROP  a change of the value    FF    is not considered a change      Switch between    Light    and    Dark    display background illumination      The desk lamp can be switched either on or off with the ON OFF key  The brightness of the desk lamp can be  changed using a left mouse click on the blue bar or using the touchscreen  On the ULTRALIGHT and MICRO  you  can only switch the brightness of the console lamp from FULL to HALF and vice versa     Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand  TA 45             Fixture Schedule Adjustments  BITMAP01 Touchscreen Calibration     Left Middle    Backlight   Right Bright       Touchscreen Options   Live Left Middle  On On       Right  On       External YGA Options           ul ic Creation  of Presets  Groups Auto Left System  and Effects Create  gt  Auto _ of    Right  Auto 3       Click  amp  Beep     i Version   Me Message 
195. concise overview      Remove unchanged Items  Will delete all elements in the overview that were not changed  i e  these  elements will not exist in the current show      Remove already imported Items  Will delete all elements in the overview that were already imported using  the COPY or MERGE command     x   leave the menu by pressing on the    X       12 Update Software    System Sottware Update WA x You can only download the update from our HOM EPAGE  www malighting de  using an IBM compatible PC   After the download execute the file  It is a self extracting archive  You will be asked to insert some empty floppy  disks into drive A    press OK and your update disks will be created        Network Update  Yersion   Univ    Stream MAC       19216817727 4840 0 840 20 00 04 4b 28 1d  192168 17728 4840 GO 4840 60 00 02 4b8a d0  192168177126 4840 2 4840 6f 00 04 4b47 16  o 4 e0 00 02 4b 21 e4  0 e0  00 02 4b 02 e4    192 168 1773  4840  192 168 177 29 4 840    Do not update the grandMA right before running a show  Updating the software is a serious thing  MA  A AE A GE Lighting can not always guarantee that your old show will play back correctly after an update      Update Change Show Same Update by floppy disk   Console Name and IP Version    press SETUP    Hk Rineassar toa   UPDATE SOFTWARE If is should not be possible  to enter this menu  e g  because a previous update had not  Update Software from Floppy   alls been completed properly   you can open it using the F4 key on the
196. confirm by pressing    o     VERY IMPORTANT   this  is the letter    o    not the number    0     The disk will be read  might take a little  while   Following that  you will be asked for    DISK 2    Insert disk 2 and confirm again with     o    VERY IMPORTANT   this is the letter    o    not the number    0     this  will take a little longer now   As soon as the update process is completed  the display  shows UPDATE DONE  PLEASE REBOOT next to STATUS  Now please reboot the console by  using the combination CTRL  ALT  DEL or the RESET key on the rear of the console     PLEASE OBSERVE   This devices may only be operated with the software equal or  higher  Down dating to a lower version is not possible     grandMA S N 1228 and higher Version 5 81 and higher  grandMA Light S N 947 and higher Version 5 81 and higher  grandMA UltraLight S N 682 and higher Version 5 81 and higher  ReplayUnit S N 121 and higher Version 5 81 and higher  Micro S N 438 and higher Version 5 751 and higher  Pico S N 1 and higher Version 5 751 and higher  NSP S N 1000 and higher Version 5 751 and higher    Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 gad AABI          188    MIA    LIGHTING    EXECUTOR FADERS      Piri  ST             14 Layout and Controls grandMA replay unit   14 1 Introduction   The grandMA Replay Unit is a small rack mount controller unit that performs nearly all of the functions of the  Award winning grandMA co
197. create automatic controls by time date or sunrise sunset  See Agenda  menu      DESK STATUS  Displays the current software versions   VXWORKS  Operating system with date  GrandM A  Main program with date  If this line is displayed in green  the unit    supports 4096 DM X channels     1O SUBSYSTEM  Program for the second built in computer  M otorola  Internas  system load  etc      Chat  For communication  Chat  with other grandMA users in the network      Stage  To display a simplified stage model with all fixtures  In this window  the beam of light will only be  displayed as a line  For Scanners having a color mixing unit or Dimmer channels  to which a color has been  assigned  this beam of light represents the chosen color and its position  Additionally  fixtures can be selected  directly by clicking on them  See Position of Fixtures and Adjusting individual Fixture Groups  Assigning Colors   for Dimmer channels    SMART  This window is used to call up  change and store presets   NETWORK DIMMER  Use this window to configure and operate MA dimmer modules and the NETWORK DIMMER   PROCESSOR       Clear Screen  Will delete all windows on this display monitor  but not the saved views     Will close this window discarding all changes     Select the window to be created with a left mouse click   If you wish to move the newly created window  click and drag the window border     Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 
198. ct is displayed with a separate value  The set value increases or decreases the size    of the selected parameter  The maximum limit for size modifications that can be set is from   200 to  200    Before modifying the value of a size  select the Effect first  Press the SIZE key once  green background   Now   you Can Set a different size using the Encoder below  Clicking the Encoder once will automatically set the size  to 100  Clicking the Encoder a second time will increase the value to 200 and at the third time will reset it    O      You can also use the ALIGN function to set this value  See ALIGN function      Modulator  In this column  you can assign an individual M odulator to each individual Size effect  Using a Mo     dulator  the effect size can automatically be altered  Think of it as and effect on the aplication of an effect toa  parameter    To assign a Modulator for this effect  select this cell and press the Encoder on the right side of the Display  The  SELECT MODULATOR window will open  where you can now go to NEW MODULITOR by turning the Encoder and  clicking it to select this option  A new modulator will now be generated in the lower part of the sheet      Modulator  In this column  the different modulators can be discerned by their numbers      Table  The assigned effect for the modulator will be displayed by its name      From  The starting point for the automatic modification in terms of percentage      To  The end point for the automatic modification in 
199. ct will be  mirrored  Possible settings range between  8 and  8   Example  With a setting of 2  the assigned Fixtures Dimmers will be divided in the middle  The set effect will  now be executed in the first half forwards up to the middle  and in the second half  the Effect will be executed  in reverse from the middle onto the last Fixture Dimmer   With a setting of  2  the assigned Fixtures Dimmers will be divided in the middle  The set effect will now be  executed in the first half forwards up to the middle  and in the second half  the Effect will be executed in  reverse and phase  shifted by 180   from the middle onto the last Fixture Dimmer   Before modifying the wing value  select the Effect first  Press the WINGS key once  green background   Now  the  number of Effect wings can be set using the Encoder below  Clicking the Encoder once will delete the set value     000 THRU EuN 0p    au   E  act    Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand HAt2I    im N E  100    pe    Sel  Filter  Param   Table  Dr  Size  Modulator Base   Ofset    Rate  Gip Wine   AS  Part  W    00     Din sf E a Ji Sa a a D ill ia  a pn      5 as weit 1 ie le    Pan Tit Random  gt               Act   Filter  Param   Table     PAN TIL 8   20      TILT SIN   20 Odd COLOUR  RAMP  20 Even COLOUR RAMP  20   COLOUR COS  20       TILT LIN              Speed Sc  t1    Speed Gr  Individu    INTENSITY    100 0 7    L IG HT IHIN 8    
200. ctivating a  156  190   QUIKEY  assigning a  156  190    R  RANDOM 124    RANDOMLY 101   Range  Name  33   Rate 107  127   RATE FACTOR 116   READOUT 67   Realease Store 89   Reference  Command 161   REMOTE 206   Remote Control 141   Remote Control by DM X IN  151   Remote Control by M IDI  152   Remote Control vial  Touchboard 150   Remote Network 198   Remotes as stored   use  commandline 47   renumbering Cues 99   Report store and print 105   RESET 15   REVERS 101   Roll  after 143   Roll  pre 143   ROTATION 132   Rotation X    Y    Z   21   RPM 34   RUN 101   RUNNING EFFECTS 131    S    Safety Instructions 6  SAVE Show 179   SAVE Show As 179  Scanner  DM X  adresses 54  SEC 47   SELECT 8  176   Selected sequence 8  Selected Sequence 92  Selected sequence 116    Selecting 16   Selection 125   Selective Copying 81   Send unchanged packets  41   Separate Memories 88   SEQU 176   SEQUENCE 54  115   Sequence  assigning a 106   Sequence  calling a   Playback  93   Sequence  copying a 91   Sequence  deleting a 79   Sequence  editing a 94   Sequence  executing a 106   Sequence Names  changing  106   Sequence  programming a  91    Sequence  triggering a 48   SEQUENCES 87   SEQUENCES OFF 121   SERVICE   TIMETABLE 224   Service Work 6   Session 194   SESSION collision 196   SET 59   Setting speed 209   Settings  current 108  111   Settings in the Setup M enu  44   SETUP 18  156   Setup Menu  Settings in the  44   SETUP  M ode  Stage  window  84   Sheet 47   Short cuts 159   Shortcuts
201. ctive cell    This is where the useful  PAN TILT trackball orientation    can be set    This can only be done in the Live Access menu Check it out  Select a fixture  press HIGHLIGHT and let the Track    ball    run    Modifications will only be available after they have been saved  In cases like these  the HIGHLIGHT key    among others  is very useful  if you keep the key pressed  selected lamps flashes for better identification     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelorunn    F  Assigning colors for Dimmer channels   Siana Sulu In the STAGE window or for the grandM A 3D  this is where colors can be assigned for the individual Dimmer  channels  color filter foils    eed   Select one or more cells under    Color    and press the Encoder   The Change Color menu will open   In this menu  you can choose between different color tables  Lee  Rosco  etc    Above each color  the currently  selected color table is displayed  here    Standard       By shortly pressing the key  you can switch to another color table  Pressing the arrow will open a menu  in   which all tables are displayed and can be selected directly   Having decided for an individual table  you can choose a color using the Encoder and accept it by pressing the  Encoder once  If a color has been assigned  this will be displayed in the respective cell        Close menu with X         Fixture Types       _Qty Name ShortName   Manufacturer    a    ee ee RGB Lamps and LED Beamer without dimmer
202. cy Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 gad HA 201    16 4 2 10 Base T EtherNet   The most common EtherNet connection is the    twisted pair    link using 10 Base  T EtherNet  Hereby a peer  to  peer  connection is established by minimum 4  wire cable connection at a maximum length of 100 metres  The cable is  always equipped with 8  pole RJ  45 crimp  connectors        Twisted pair    cable to be used for 10 Base  T with RJ  45 connectors    Fs ner fre OSAN  OaE Soa   1  wns nnacsron         Oxevnnts  ME ac     EA             Pin numbers on RJ  45 connector and 10 Base T standard signal assignment    As 10 Base  T EtherNet always requires an EtherNet hub to distribute the signal  connections from console to  console go via a hub  a useful application will be any network where more than two consoles or consoles with ad   ditional equipment  such as ArtNet DM X  Nodes  are proposed    For a simple peer  to  peer connection between two consoles a    crossed    4  wire cable M UST be used       Crossed    cable to be used for 10 Base T peer  to  peer connections       D  wn   e  m     O   e   5  wn     m  m  5  Qa     Ping Pin 1    white  green     Data transmit    ee ener   se N e  o pe E p    pe    e    202 ME ooo i Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldb  ttelbrunn    LIGHTING    Slave Console End   Console End  Colour of Wire 10BASE T ice Colour of Wire 10BASE T tote e       Using a    crossed    10 Base T cable will allow a direct console to  console co
203. d            Copying an Embedded Preset       press COPY    press on the Preset      press on a free button  to which the Preset is to be copied  Link zu cs Link zu value 2 Example   value 1 value 1   COPY     press on Preset 2      press on a free button and rename the new preset to Preset 3   Important  The link to Preset 1 will be kept in Preset 3  even if you delete Preset 2 after the copying   78 eae se ess es es  MIA MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    LIGHTING          ASSIGN HELP ALIGN PREVIEW    OOPS DELETE COPY MOVE    Command Line       _ J SE le    Working with Command Line      press DELETE     pres button Preset   Page   Group   View   Executor or  select Sequenz     type in number on the numeric block  e g  1 16  for Executor 16 on Page 1      confirm with ENTER   writings in red are not possible  if no page number Is typed   the elements of the current page will be deleted    3 8 Deleting Groups  Sequences  Views etc     For all following Deletions  the DELETE key has to be pressed in advance  LED is on     Deleting Groups    Select the respective Group by touch or left mouse click    Or    Press the GROUP key  Enter a Group number using the numeric keypad and confirm with ENTER    Deleting Presets    Select Preset in the respective window by touch or left mouse click    Or    Press the PRESET key  Enter a Preset Function number  e g   3 for Gobo  followed by         and the Preset number    confirm with ENTER    Deleti
204. d    The DUM MY Function is meant for fixed channels  The output value for this channel has to be set in the DEFAULT   column  This channel can not be modified in the FIXTURE  SHEET     Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand ITA 31    32    MIA    LIGHTING    If you finished selecting all Scanner functions  you can proceed with the presets    Presets are      Type     Snap     Inv     Default  can be adjusted with the left Encoder      Highlight  can be adjusted with the second Encoder      Stage  presently without any function      MIB FADE  can be adjusted with the right Encoder      Profil     Speed   See Listing of the individual functions in the EDIT FIXTURE menu   The values are displayed as percentages and can be switched to decimal or hexadecimal by pressing the Percent  button    For the individual functions  e g  GOBO   so  called Channel Values can be created  These will then be displayed in  the Fixture Sheet  You can switch to the menu by using the Function Sets button  See Function Sets      You can leave this menu by using the X button  You could now use the created fixture in this Show     The settings will only take effect and be saved after leaving the Full Access menu and pressing the SAVE button   Momentarily  the created fixture can only be used for this Show     If you want to have this fixture available in the general Library  on harddisk or floppy   too  you have to UPD
205. d    Up to 64 DM X outputs can be triggered via the PathPort nodes  The IP address has to be adapted to the PathPorts  Ethernet  DM X converter  something you can also do via the grandMA  PATHPORT   Node Configuration  next page  If PathPort Ethernet  DM X converter s are connected  they will be looked for when you call up this menu  and they  are displayed in the table  only  if the first 3 digits of the IP address of grandMA and PathPort Ethernet  DM X  converter are identical  e g   192 168 0 x      Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand  TA 39    PATHPORT   Node Configuration    SAVE        Name  BACKTRUSS LEFT  Desk Config  Additional Info   IP  192 168 177  77 192 168 177 111 ID  00 00035E  Subnet  255 255 255 0 255 255 255 0 Serial  431  Software  03000038  A Hardware  0 0 0  Gateway  19216802 Backlight    On 5 MAC  00 04 a 1 00 01 af          Output       ID Name Patch xDMX Slot  00 00035E  Scans 1 Default    unidir  virt  female sink  00 00035F Pars 2 Source 01 2 i    unidir  virt  female sink    Patch xDMX Slot    DMX Configuration    Ethernet Output Menu    Universe Protocol Configuration      PATH outA    PORT    xDMX Slot 1  Offset 0    DMX Output  l P             ARTNET   Port F   F DMX Input     PORTALL PROTOCOL NOT CONFIGURED   via Ethernet  WYSIWYG  EE z  NONE   DMX Output  via Strand  Shownet  gt              EE       Wysiwyg Ethernet Output  amp  Autofocus  Mode  Wysiwyg Out
206. d  all previous steps will be taken into account        Deleting by mistake can be undone by OOPS     Renumbering Cues   Select the Cue to be renumbered  Enter the new number on the right side of    New Number     By pressing the REN   UM BER key  the Cue will be renumbered  If you want to renumber not only one but several Cues  select the  respective Cues  Enter the new number for the first Cue on the right side of    New Number   By pressing the REN   UM BER key  the Cues will be renumbered     4 3 7 Inserting LOOPs   Program flow inside a cuelist can be controlled by LOOPS    Loops have a destination  If a Cue is executed that contains a loop  program flow will continue with the given  destination instead of the next cue    Loops can be timed  A timed loop will stay inside the loop until a given time elapses    Otherwise loops are counting  A counting loop will stay inside the loop until the loop counter reaches zero   Loops can be endless  An endless loop will stay forever inside the loop once it was activated    Make a right mouse click on the respective Cue in the LOOP column  The SELECT LOOP  TARGET window will open   Select the Cue to which the jump is to be performed  The Cue will be listed in the top line    Select the jump function by pressing the respective Key      With the LOOP  TIMED  Key  a timed loop will be created      With the LOOP  COUNT  Key  a counting loop will be created      With the DELETE Key  you can delete the loop    For the indicated loop  you 
207. d Activating have different meanings and are important terms and concepts when working with the  grandM A    Selected fixtures or channels are what you are currently working with  you can tell what is selected by their  names in fixture   channel sheet being yellow  Active values determine which channels and parameters are to  be stored in the next cue and will be controlled by this cue later on  Values with a dark red backround will be  stored in the next cue  values with a bright red background are currently under your control and will also be  stored in the next cue  Channels not active when the cue is stored will not be affected by the playingback of this  cue  Selected fixtures or channels are automatically deselected if a setting was altered and new fixtures selected   a single press of the CLEAR key will do the same      Changing the selection      Any channel or function  being controlled in Direct Access mode  is automatically marked as selected      Pressing the CLEAR key several times  deletes the whole selection    1  CLEAR  deselects   2  CLEAR  deactivates  3  CLEAR  deletes all values set by direct access and returns the  values to their defaults or to being controlled by playback     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelorunn      X   Selecting a channel  fixture or function multiple times can be used to modify an activation  4 1  selects   2    activates all parameters   3  deactivates all parameters   By holding the STORE key a
208. d by a qualified technician  CAUTION   disconnect the mains power first     There are some limitations for the MICRO and grandMA UltraLight  DMX OUTPUT    DMX outputs A to D  on the backside of the console     In this menu  the DM X ports are assigned to the output sockets on the grandM A       Press the button for the required output  A   D  and select an Universe for this output   only Universes having a   green background can be assigned to an output    green cells  in these Universes  channels are patched and can be put out by the console    red cells  there are more DM X channels patched than the console can output    XLR  A   D   these Universes will be put out by the 4 sockets A   D  on UltraLight and Micro Pico only A and B    if the cell has a green background    NSP  this Universe will be put out by a NSP   black cell  in this Universe  no channels are patched     Use SAVE to save the setting    DMX MERGE   You can use DM X IN to mix the signals of a second console with those of the grandMA  MERGE  and route them   on the same line to the stage  When triggering channels of the grandMA as well as of a second console  the higher   value will be forwarded  HTP     Furthermore  you can use the DM X IN as remote control input      Select the Universe  on which you want the incoming DM X signals to be output  in the graphics on the left    Universe 2 B  has been selected      Press the EDIT button  then on the Universe to be merged with the incoming signal  the Universe w
209. d sequence name    In this window  you can watch the progress of the sequence  the currently playing back Cue will be displayed by a  yellow background    Colour codes used in the tracksheet    Text CYAN  New values or values that have changed in this cue     Text MAGENTA  Tracked values  these will not change in the next Cue and are not stored  Text GREEN  Downfading dimmer values  Text RED     Blocked    values       Button TIME   FADE   DELAY times will be displayed  If the FIX key is pressed  dark background   all selected Fixture parameters will be displayed first in the Sheet   If the key is not pressed  indicated by a CHA   the Sheet will display all functions regardless of their    Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 gad MALT    selections  When selecting presets  the Fixtures Dimmers will be sorted accordingly in the Tracking Sheet   aa If the M ASK key is pressed  the INCLUDED EXCLUDED functions will be activated in the OPTIONS menu    Tracking Sheet Options d If the SORT key is pressed  dark appearance   the Fixtures Dimmers will be sorted by selection and parameter   When selecting groups or presets  the Fixtures Dimmers will be sorted accordingly in the Tracking Sheet   If the LINK DEFAULT key of the title bar is pressed  the default sequence will automatically be transferred to the  EXECUTOR window when changing the default sequence   Assigning the Default sequence  See Layout and  
210. d to the executor can be changed by using the  keyboard     Or    Push the ASSIGN key 2x  LED is on     Push the executor button  where the name of the group should be changed   A window appears  where you can now enter the new name    Or    in Group Pool  See Creating and calling up Fixtures and Dimmer GROUPS    Submaster Options     The    Settings    key must be pressed  dark background      If the POSITIVE ENABLE key is pressed  this Group M aster is the M aster Fader for all dimmer channels of this group     If a Group Master is set as INHIBIT Master  NEGATIVE INHIBIT key is pressed  for a group that includes Fixt   ures or dimmer channels from other groups  this INHIBIT Master must also be pushed up  to be able to use  the overlapping channels  The INHIBIT Master has priority over other group masters and can also be used as  Master Fader for all other Group Masters     Group Overview      Pressing the GROUP key twice will open an overview in the right display showing all assigned Group M asters   In this overview  every Group M aster is displayed with a separate small window      The top key contains the group name  Clicking on this key will open the Page on which it is stored  The display  above the Fader shows    HERE        With the FULL key  you can set the Master to 100   With the OUT key  you can set the Master to    0    The yellow  status indicator next to the keys will give you the currently set value for the respective Fader      Pressing the ALL FULL key in t
211. d when  scrolling    with PAGE   or Page      Select Page  Input Range   1 to 64      Page No 1   128  The Faders or Buttons of the set page will be displayed and will not change when    scrolling     with PAGE   or PAGE          The Display units can have individual settings  so that one may be fixed and another may show the Faders or  Buttons of a selected page        Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand HALOS       soe eer tee X 5 1 4 Playback Options     Playback Options   The    Settings    key must be pressed  dark background    E a   Auto   Swop    Function If you press the    Auto start    key  background dark gray   the Sequence or Chaser will be automatically started    id   ai when pushing the Master Fader upwards  item 6     Normal Kill If the    Auto stop    key is pressed  dark gray background   the sequence or Chaser will automatically be switched off  fl ll   Sal when pushing the master fader downwards to the lower stop   If    Auto start    is active  dark background  and    Auto Stop    is not active  the fader gets the function    Auto On    this means that when the fader is moved up wards from 0  position  simultanously the function    On    is activated  and the sequence is reactivated   If the    Auto Fix  key is pressed  dark background  and the Sequence or Chaser is started  this Executor will be               Auto  PrePos                                  Soh ees a  e
212. de    Preset  and Executorfader    Set Time   Man Fade       226 MA    LIGHTING    MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    Executor Buttons    The lower bank of buttons  from 101  and the buttons below the small monitor  X1   X20  are useable as executor buttons  Allocation differs between the consoles     Full  size     Buttons 101   105    Buttons 106   110          Buttons 116   120    Buttons 121   125       Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand 4 221    Buttons X1   X5  Buttons X6   X10    Buttons X11   X 15  Buttons X16   X20       228 MA          MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    LIGHTING    Light and Ultra  light  SETUP   NORM AL EXECUTOR M ODE is recommended    Buttons 101   105    Buttons 106   110  Buttons X1   X5    Buttons X6   X10       Picture shows ultra light  at the light console  the buttons X11   X20 are not active    Preset  and Executor fader    Set Time   Man Fade      Full  size  Fader 29 and 30   adjustable with the subjacent buttons  Display at the center screen  Function is identical with grandM A1   Light  Fader 14 and 15  adjustable with the subjacent buttons  Display at the left screen  Function is identical with grandM A1   Ultra light  Fader 14 and 15   adjustable with the subjacent buttons  Display at the right screen  Function is identical with grandM A1     displays function    P
213. details     With executing keywords and executors    Executing keyword   Executor List  FADE X X ENTER   The execution command is performed on all listed executors with a fade  overwrite of X X seconds  Does not work with PAUSE or flashing commands   Giving individual fade times to fixtures or channels     Selection  AT FADE X X  TRHU Y Y  ENTER   Individual fades for the feature shown In the presetbar will be set to X X seconds   If no selection is given  the current selection is used    Please note that the given fade may be a range  In this case  fades will be  aligned over the given selection    The given fades can be signed  which will result in relative changes of in  dividual fades    Giving individual fades can be combined with giving individual delays and  values into one AT command    Clearing individual fades     SELECTION  AT FADE ENTER   Works very much like b   but no value for the fade Is given    Setting default in  amp  outfade     No selection present  FADE X X ENTER   The next cue will be stored with X X seconds basic fade and outfade for all  non snap channels    as target for the following operational commands    ASSIGN SEQUENCE GROUP and EFFECT objects can be assigned with   As in  amp  outfade when storing a cue    STORE  List of Cues  FADE X Y ENTER   The given cues will be stored with a basic fade and outfade of X Y seconds  for all non  snap channels    Switching to fade display mode     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldb
214. dline  If the last cue is  already shown  the display jumps to the first cue again      Last Cue  only in mode AUTO SCROLL    If the button Is activated  dark background   the previous cue is displayed  This means that If cue 2 of  the sequence Is active  cue 1 is displayed and the cue number appears in the headline  If the first cue  is already shown  the display jumps to the last cue again     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelorunn    Not    Guisi       S BLS om   Tracking  Sort   Linked    fma  Manual  showing    Cue     Dimmer       ld Name     Dim   lt 1   Dimi   Open   2   Dm2   Open  3   Dm3  Open  4   Dm4   Open          xX    Content Sheet Options           __included Excluded     Display  Name   Name Layer  Pan m    Readout          Settings          Atiribute  Mask    Content Sheet Options x         Show  Trackin    Sort Included DAplay    Name Layer  Up    Down                 Sorting A  Reado        Settings    Attribute  Mask   Attribute  Sort       Display  Layer       Sorting  amp   Readout    Type   No  Page Name TYE  Fader  11  1  Fader 14 l  Fader 16 1           Li  Seq 2  Seq 1    Seqence        MAN SCROLL  Is activated when the backgroung is dark  The buttons NEXT and LAST CUE disappear  Select the  required sequence with the encoder      Click on the title bar  gets a light grey background when activated      Select the cue with the encoder  The title bar showst  MANUAL showing    x Cue      For scrolling within the she
215. e  SCROLL LOCK key  You will hear a beep and the SCROLL LOCK lamp will be on   indicating that the PC keyboard is now locked to command line operation    If the PC keyboard is locked  you can not use it for other operations like naming  presets etc  But another push of the SCROLL LOCK key will unlock it    If you are using the PC keyboard as command line input  you can only enter valid  commands and values  If you try to enter FIQQQ the command line will audiably  warn you upon the entry of the First Q  This is because the only two commands  that the command line recognises that start FI are FIXTURE or FIX    In most cases it is not necessary to enter the full name of a keyword  the letter F  is totally sufficient for FIXTURE  You can find all keywords and their shortest form  in section 9 2 command overview    10 1 7 Using the command line history   It is possible to recall previous commands from the history into the current  command line    There they can be re  executed or edited and executed    a    Left click with the mouse in the history of a command line window     Or scroll with the XY encoder if the command line window has the focus     Or use the UP and DOWN cursor keys on the PC keyboard if the command line  window has the focus  or the PC keyboard is locked to the command line    b  Edit the command line if you want   c  Press ENTER  The command line will be executed     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    10 2 Command Over
216. e  summer 49  TIMECODE 55  141  177  Timecode  Midi 142  Timecode  new 141  TIMECODE Show 114  TOGGLE 108  177  Toggle Curve 35  Toolbar im PDA 210  TOOLS 156  TOP 108  177  TOUCH BIN 178  Touchboard  Remote  Control vial 150  Touchscreen 5  44  94  TRACKBALL 60  Trackball 9  48  TRACKBALL  Sensitivity of  the 45  TRACKING 17  54  92  TRACKING mode 110  TRACKING Window 117  TRACKINGSHEET OPTIONS  117  TRIANGLE 124  TRIGGER 88  95  TRIGGER  changing the 96  Triggermonitor 48  TROUBLE SHOOTING 220  True  Tracking Playback  193  Type 30    U    Unblock 118  Unmoveable 29  UNPRESS 178    UPDATE  102  130  156  178  UPDATE Cue 77  UPDATE Presets 77  Update processor 225  UPDATE Software  185  187  Updating the Fixtures  Library 31  USB 8  USB Port 8  USER DEFINED 124  126  USER Library 43  User Management 50  User profile list 53  User profiles 51  53    V    VALUE 178   VALUES 12  156   Variable functions 34   Ventilation 5   Vibrations 46   VIEW 178   View ALLRUNNING EFFECTS  menu 131   VIEW  assigning a 57   VIEW button 8  57   VIEW  deleting a 79   View Macro Button 3   View Pool 57   VIEW  saving a 57   VIEWBTN 178   VIEWS 55   Violett bar 128   Virtual Form  creating a  131   Virtual Form  modifying a  132   Virtual Form  self  created    two dimensional 126  Virtual Form  two  dimensi   onal 131  Visualize 33  VISUALIZE FORMS 126    W    Weight 30   Weights and Dimensions 4  Wheel 45  60  75  Window  deletinga w 56  Window  enlargea 56  Wing 127   WIZZARD Stage  Setup 85  W
217. e Macro will be triggered at the calculated time for dusk   See Menu TIME  amp  DATE    Time  If ABSOLUTE is selected in this line under    Start     a time can be set for the M acro to start    If DAWN  SUNRISE  SUNSET or DUSK is selected in the start column  you can enter between   1 to  1 hour    Consequently  the M acro will be started either 1 hour earlier or later than the calculated time    Duration  If the unit is powered up later than the trigger time a setting in this column specifies the amount of time   up to 8 hours   after the original trigger time  that the macro should still be triggered    Repeat  NONE will execute the event only once    Daily  weekly  monthly  yearly  daily each month  weekly each month  daily each year  weekly each year  mothly   February 2008   each year will execute the event repeataly according to the set frequency    F Link  Here you can specify which M acro is to be triggered by the event    You can enter a comment  using the keyboard    First  If an event is displayed with black background in the sheet  this Event will be repeated on the current day   This cell shows the date  on which the Event was first executed    Last  Here  you can enter that last date that the Event will be executed  If an event is displayed with black  background in the sheet  this event will be repeated on the current day  This cell shows the date  on which the  event was last executed    Agenda Options       Agenda Options   Touch the touch screen on the left
218. e called back on the original screens     TIM ECODE    As starting keyword    TIM ECODE ENTER   TIMECODE becomes the DEFAULT KEYWORD    TIM ECODE  range list  ENTER   Does nothing    Timecode numbers in the range list must be in the interval   1    200    As target for the following operational keywords     COPY Copy one timecode show to another   DELETE Delete a timecode show   EDIT Open edit menu for timecode show   INSERT M OVE Change visible number of timecode show   LABEL Change name of timecode show   As target for the following executing commands    GO Start playback   PAUSE Pause playback  keep output   OFF Switch off  release output    gt  gt  J ump forward to next breakpoint in show    lt  lt  Jump backwards to last breakpoint in show  TOGGLE    TOP    As starting keyword  every executor that follows after TOGGLE performs a GO  if it wasn t running or an OFF if it was running   TOGGLE  executor list   ENTER     As starting keyword  every executor that follows after TOP is performing a  GOTO FIRST STEP   TOP  executor list   ENTER     Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 gad MALT    TOUCH BTN  A TOUCH_BIN  touch button  is a remote function triggert by incoming 0  10V  signals   The TOUCH BTN simulates an executor keypress  therefore it is working only in  combination with an assigned executor  TOUCH BITNs can be seen under TOOLS    REMOTE TOUCH menu   Calling a TOUCH BTN manually   TOUCH
219. e depending on the sync  setting  in the options menu  you will record with internal or external synchronisation   Automatic Recording can also be started from the command line in a similar way to recording a macro  STORE   TIM ECODE X ENTER or STORE and press a key in the timecode pool      Manual recording is started by pressing the MANUAL RECORD key in the timecode editor    Stop recording      Recording is stopped when you PAUSE or STOP the timecode show      Automatic recording with internal sync will also be interrupted if you enter a new time      Recording is NOT stopped when you close the timecode editor  So be aware of what is being recorded  otherwise  you will discover a huge timecode show at some later point    After recording  particularly if you have recorded fader movements  it is a good idea to use the DO FADER  DATA REDUCTION  in the options menu   This keeps your show slim and easier to edit  The fader data reduction  process guarantees  that the compressed signal will not differ more than 1 frame in time and 1  in value from the  original  Usually recorded fader events will be reduced to 20  or less of the original amount    The Length of the Show   During recording  the length of the show is automatically extended if needed  This also happens if you manually  add events after the current length  see manual editing     The length of a show becomes very important if you plan to use Internal sync and repeat  In combination with the     when reaching the end 
220. e displayed                 216 ME   A Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr 16   D 97297 Waldbiittelbrunn    LIGHTING    rr   et     GMA Remote qx 10 44 GD    Name   Qty ID ChJID Fix                    T       New Device LHB  T  g i   Mame  Type  ID Ch  ID Fix  Patch   Mi    GS HF GS HF 1 Al      GS HF GS HF      GS HF GS HF   GS HF GS HF     GS HE GS HF          lm AG  oS EB    GMA Remote x 1 54 GD    Groupmasters All Fu          Patch    Note  on the console  FULL ACCESS may NOT be opened in the SETUP   Only LIVE ACCES is available with the PDA    switch with Touch  active part has a heading with a dark blue background      scrolling in the Sheet    for the marked cell    press center  to change the contents of the cell or make entries   depending on the cell   s contents    same function as the  Encoder of the console    Groupmaster    short   All Full sets all groupmaster to full    Full master is set to full  Out master is set to zero  scroll the master to the desired value    scroll  display can show max 12 masters  if more masters are created  scroll to the next page with  also 12 masters    Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 gad HAU    Groups    GMA Remote qxi0 49 O       ou a aana enscan p Immer Diuma    Bbi i Groups    Groups   Presets    toggle   Fixture   Groups       t jump to the next  Group button       4 gt  jump to the next  Group area      press  OPTIONS will be displayed  
221. e for the    FADE    functions    Outdelay  Outfade will called up delayed by the time set     Snap  Duration of the DELAY       Fade  Duration of the individual FADE time  min and max        Delay  Duration of the individual DELAY time  min and max    If the LOOPS key on the title bar of the edit key is pressed      LOOP  Will initiate a jump after the cue that includes the loop statement has finished     LOOPDELAY  The length of time or the number of occurences of a LOOP will be displayed    LINK  The Command Line Order to be triggered will be displayed     LI  DEL  The delay value for the execution of the Command Line Order will be displayed  If the EFFECTS key on the title bar is pressed      EFFECTS  Display of the effects calls   A second sheet will appear in the lower part of the display      NO   Number of the Effect     NAME  Name of the Effect     ACTION  Type of Effect call  play forwards  play backwards  pause  stop      INTENS  Display of the defined size of the Effect    MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    F  Fade   If Y  YES  is displayed  the size will be faded in with the set fade time    SPEED  Display of the defined speed of the Effect  F  Fade   If Y  YES  is displayed  the speed will be faded in with the set fade time    SOFT  Display of the set softness  softer fade in  of the effect  F  Fade   If Y  YES  is displayed  the softness will be faded in with the set fade time          gs oe i v If AUTO SCROLL key is pr
222. e group and must confirm this action    Now  the    Create New Fixtures or Channels    window will open  When opened for the first time  only    From Library     will be displayed here and is already selected  indicated by its blue background       When selecting    From Library     the library window will open      By turning the Encoder  you can only choose a lamp type  blue bar       Pressing the Encoder will accept the chosen lamp type and close the window      To load a lamp type from floppy  press the    Floppy    button  Now  the Scanners present on the floppy will be  displayed and can be selected and loaded     For conveniently localizing scanners  fixtures   the list can be sorted by name  manufacturer or date  Example  Sort  alphabetically  Make a right mouse click on NAME  Clicking once will sort the list A  Z  on the second click Z A     Or     You can use a search filter  Select the manufacturer column on the side of    Filter     and enter the first character of  a manufacturer  Now  only the models produced by this manufacturer will be displayed t     On www ma share net   you will find a forum to setup and download self  created or altered Fixtures     Channel Start Id     Here  you can set the first ID number of the Dimmers  These are then displayed in the Channel and Fader  Sheet  The Dimmer channel of Scanners could also be used in the Channel and Fader Sheet  In order to do so  you  would have to assign    Channel  IDs    for the Scanners first   Fixture 
223. e ow ae    Funch   Tabla    Wia   SIN   SIN   TIM   GIM    EN    tipeged Leale  E1    Bama Eid 4   i F Ea    Create Text Githiop       138 MA    LIGHTING    Ttect 4    Brimap Etrect L          7 2 Creating   Changing BitMap effects    press EDIT and an empty button in the BITMAP EFFECTS window       using CHOOSE LAYOUT  select a previously created layout from the overview  the current layout is indicated by  its name and number and with the number of rows and lines below the CHOOSE LAYOUT button       open the BITMAP WIZARD to load  create or adapt a bitmap     Creating a graphics    CREATE TEXT  to create and save a text bitmap     press CREATE TEXT  enter text and text size  and name the file       with TAKE  transfer it to the Wizard  with TAKE SAVE save it and simultaneously transfer it  or just save  it with SAVE       SAVE BITMAP  to save a bitmap on the console   s hard disk      LOAD BITMAP  to load a bitmap from the console   s hard disk      DELETE BITMAP  to delete a bitmap      IMPORT BITMAP  to import a bitmap from floppy disk      press  X    to return to the EDIT menu     choose a background color     TILES  tiling function  sets the graphics as multiple tiles one after the other       using BACKGROUND  choose the background color  Choose color and brightness in the Select menu and press the  button for the desired color       COLOR CORRECTION   GREY SCALE CORRECTION     set the offset values using   or   or the Calculator  pressing on the black number cell    
224. e them  The X  FADE and DELAY  times can be altered and the trigger of cues via GO key  X  FADER  SOUND or TIME can be defined    Apart from what is indicated in this chapter  there are three other ways of editing    See Overwriting  expanding  removing Cues  Update Cues or Presets and EXECUTOR window      Press the EDIT key  LED is on   The sequence may not be saved  see 4 2 6     Select the sequence with the respective EXECUTOR button    Or    Left click with the mouse into the small window above the EXECUTOR Fader or use the touchscreen    The EDIT menu appears on the right TFT display  showing a listing of the individual cues contained in the selected  sequence       You will find the addressed EXECUTOR fader or button in the headline  giving the number of the PAGE and the    sequence name    The second line will give you the functions of the columns      No   Number of Cue     NAME  Name of Cue     MIB  Activate MIB  Move In Black function  individually for each cue  Activate it by selecting a cell and shortly  pressing on the encoder on the right side of the display  Activation is confirmed by YES     MIB can only be used in cells where a     X     is displayed       Trig  The trigger for the Cue  GO button  SOUND  TIME or FOLLOW    If the TIMES key on the title bar of the edit window Is pressed      Fade  FADE time     Outfade  Duration of the fade time on Dimmer channels which are reducing in value     Delay  CUE will be called up delayed by the time set  only possibl
225. e third time  all modified values will be reset  default or to their original setting  prior to the activation         After pressing the CLEAR key for the first time  the yellow LED in this key will flash  This means that only    the selection was deleted  When you select other fixtures or dimmer channels now  the yellow LED will no  longer flash        Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand A  n    3 5 4 FADE and DELAY times in the CHANNEL window  In addition to the standard  basic  FADE times  individual durations can also be set for the individual  functions in the CHANNEL window  not in the FADER CHANNEL window    These settings are needed when creating Cues  so that you can work with different FADE or DELAY times for indi   vidual channels     Open CHANNEL Window    Press Values  so that the button displays Fades or Delays   TIME Or   i When pressing the TIM E key once  this will switch the channel sheet to the FADE time mode  The second time     aN ae  EEEE      balsa     pg et au ap sa aie     VM   i  MADAN E E  Dim             G    this will switch the channel sheet to the DELAY time mode    If in the Window options Automatic was not selected  the display will not switch over  The currently selected  function of the FADE or DELAY Command Line will be displayed only for the Encoder labels  See Options within  the CHANNEL window   Now you can modify the IND  FADE or IND  DELAY time for 
226. e to another position    Fe as target for the following executing commands   SELECT S ON    Knock in    all devices contained in sequence   As starting keyword  it is used to select the DEFAULT EXECUTOR  OFF    Knock out    all devices contained insequence     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    176 MA    LIGHTING    PAUSE PARK all devices contained in sequence   GO UNPARK all devices contained in sequence     STORE    STORE  object list   ENTER    All objects in the object list must be of the same type    If no object is given  a new cue is stored into the default executor    If the destination of the store command is not empty  you will be asked for  confirmation    In case of storing over existing cues  you will furthermore be asked about the  desired store mode  e g  merge  overwrite or remove    If you start storing by pressing the STORE hard key  a temporary window  will appear    The settings in this window affect the way   the store command is handled   Defaults for these store options can be found in SETUP   DEFAULTS menu     SW OP    As starting keyword  every executor that follows after SWOP increases the  intensity of all programmed dimmer channels to 100  while reducing all other  executors to 0   as long they are not protected against swop     SW OP  executor list   ENTER    As starting keyword combined with UNPRESS  every executor that follows  after SWOP reduces the intensity of all programmed dimmer channels to 0   whi
227. e use GO  or GO    ae om os peer to Load from   __ On  Reasserts the priority of the Executor making it the latest action thus overriding other executors which were    default default all Exec  default    Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 gad HAAI    108                Size of Executor         Default Button and Fader Assignment         Load from Save as Apply to 1  default default all Exec           Micro   Assignment M enu  only one button  and the fader  1 5   depends on size of  executor  can assigned here       Button and Fader Assignment               Size of Executor    errr    Default Button and Fader Assignment                   Load from    Save as Apply to  default default all Exec     Assignment M enu of a fader button   only the button  1 5   depends on size of  executor  can assigned here     MIA    LIGHTING    previously overriding it  LTP      Off  Switches the Executor off so that it no longer outputting cue data to stage     Rate 1  Puts the RATE FADER to 50  position  RATE Fader      Learn  Direct entering of the Chaser speed  When pressing this button at least three times  the Chaser speed is  set      lt  lt  lt   Playback of the previous cue without FADE or SNAP times      gt  gt  gt   Playback of the next cue without FADE or SNAP times     Temp  A Cue or chaser plays back as long as the button is pressed  Upon releasing the button  previous  condition will be restored    
228. e will recognize the operating systems Pocket  pc  Windows M obile pocketpc 2002  Windows M obile pocketpc 2003  Windows M obile pocketpc 2003 SE   Second Edition   Windows Mobile 5 0  Windows Mobile 6 0 Classic and will automatically install the respective  modules    Installation APPLE iPod  see instructions of manufacturer     When all software and hardware requirements are met  the PocketPC is operational   Switch on the console  Switch on the PocketPC  Call up the GM A  REM OTE program  Select the desired console  Log in with a user name and password  has to be registered in the console it is not  possible to log in as an administrator On the grandM A  MICRO  without user management    the login will be skipped and the user be logged in with administrator rights     You can connect up to 6 remote controls  ATTENTION  selected fixtures apply for all  connected units and for the console     will always and at once switch to Select View    will always and at once switch to Command 1   Command  2 and toggles between the both menues  with long press     Depending on the menu  the cursor can have different functions  but will always have the purpose of  moving  scrolling  or entering values  value   pressing on the outer edges  or confirm or switching over   pressing in the middle     The key layout is identical for most PocketPCs  even if the symbols on the keys differ  have other symbols  or the keys are arranged differently     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  1
229. e you can select a filter for this Effect   appa rae   Param  Parameter   Display of the assigned parameter for which the Effect has an influence over  To change  ie EH Gobo which parameter  select the cell and press the Encoder to the right of the display once  The SELECT ATTRIBUTE    Color window will open  where you can select a different parameter for this Effect   i HH Beam   Table  Here  the assigned Effect is indicated with its name   Focus To re  assign an Effect  select the cell  Press the Encoder right of the display once  The SELECT TABLE window will                              d Scale EH Control open  where you can select a different Effect for this function  The left part of the window displays the selected  i Shapers Effect  If the Effect Group has been started  the Fixtures and Dimmers will be displayed on the Form mimic at the  d Group H Video bottom left of the display       PWM  Pulse width modulation  The pulse width can be defined as follows  Press the EFFECT SETUP key once    Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand HAA2S    126    MIA    LIGHTING     key has a dark background   press the PULSE WIDTH key once  key has a green background   Now  the pulse  width can be modified using the Encoder below  The pulse width can be set to between 0 and 100   Pressing  the Encoder once shortly will automatically set the width to 25  50  or 75   You can also use the ALIGN  function to
230. each Fixture or Dimmer  channel can also be created  See Creating presets  effects and groups automatically    MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    Fixtures and Channels in Layer    Move  Lines          Type   MINISCAN HF  MINISCAN HF MINISCAN HF  MINISCAN HF MINISCAN HF  MINISCAN HF MINISCAN HF  MINISCAN HF MINISCAN HF  MINISCAN HF MINISCAN HF  MINISCAN HF MINISCAN HF  MINISCAN HF MINISCAN HF  MINISCAN HF MINISCAN HF  MINISCAN HF MINISCAN HF    Load from Fixture Library  Harddisc       CO Fixture     MAC 500 M4 Ww 1 9  DIM     ONDA UN         ID Ch  ID Fix  Patch Master Inv_Par  Inv Tilt  Swap   Color  Al      Manufacturer    Date    Original  Original    8 5    Multipatch    Patch  Sheets    Attribute  Setup p      Fixture    Stage    Setup p      Yersion  Floppy    Original  and User         Channel start Id        Putur SESE d          Auto Patch   None    Create            Full  Access    2 2 Menu Full Access oder Live Access      press Fixture Layer   Here  you can create Scanner and Dimmer groups    These groups can be modified later without any problems  e g   increase number  change the lamp type etc   Additionally  you have an overview over the number of all signed  on lamps and their ID numbers for Channel and  Fixture e     2 2 1 Creating groups with Scanners Dimmers  Fixture Layer       Press the    Add Line    key  Fixture Layer must be active  i e  header dark blue     A window will open  where you can enter a name for th
231. econd line  the   column functions are listed      Sel  Selection   Displays the numbers of Fixtures or Dimmers assigned to this Effect  If the Fixtures    or Dimmers     assignments are to be modified for an Effect  it has to be selected  this will be indicated by a red background     Hihun   prx_out   ness ae          Pressing the SHOW SELECTION key once will select the assigned Fixtures and Dimmers  displayed in yellow         Edit Eff 1    Eff 1        Param i Tahle   Did Ge  lMaoduatari Base   Nifzet J Bate   Grp       Bir ek R mae  select Attribut x lt                   Select those Fixtures and or Dimmers  will be displayed in yellow  that are to be assigned to this Effect  Now   ress the TAKE SELECTION key once  The new number of Fixtures and Dimmers will now be inserted and adopted  If        an generic Effect Group is to be created  thats one without any selection which can then be used with any    Possible Effect Attributes selection   do not select any Fixtures or Dimmers  but press the TAKE SELECTION key once  The cell will now  LH Special Attribute Combinations display a    Zero     The key of this Effect Group will be indicated in red in the Effect Pool      Available User Attributes   Filter  Here  a filter can be set that limits the execution of the Effect either to the odd  numbered or to the even     Bee ee numbered Fixtures  To assign a filter  select the cell  Press the Encoder right of the display once  The SELECT FIL   Ct ener TER window will open  wher
232. ed cells    COLOR  a color value will be assigned to the selected cells    The selected cells receive a yellow frame and will disappear  the next time you touch the screen  Only if the selected  cells have an assigned dimmer value  these cells will be kept  grey scale according to dimmer value  and you can  select the next cells  Each selected cell will immediately loose its dimmer value   this way  you can delete individual  cells from the graphics  And this is also  how to create a graphics with different dimmer values       COPY      SELECTION  only the selected cells  yellow frame  will be copied     TOTAL  all active cells will be copied     MOVE  using the arrow keys  you can move the graphics in the desired direction    MIRROR  using the arrow keys  you can mirror the graphics     saving or deleting settings      using SAVE  you can save the graphics as sequence to a free Encoder or    using BITMAP WIZARD  to switch to the WIZARD menu    using SAVE BITMAP  you can save the created bitmap      or the other way round  load a bitmap graphics in the Wizard  return to the Draw mode  and go on processing the  graphics there    or delete all selections and setting pressing CLEAR 3 times     Press    X    to leave the SETUP menu       leave the LAYOUT VIEW menu using OPTIONS and DELETE WINDOW     Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 gad HAASI    Edt Etmap E  PaF nFLE    i mmo  imag g    abusi    am
233. ed profile will appear in the PATH column    For some of the pre  defined profiles  the curve position may partly lie outside of the coordinate system  A fixture can  follow this negative amplitude only  if it is not already positioned at it   s ultimate    stop    For self  created profiles   you Cannot place the curve outside of the coordinate system      assigning a self  created profile to a FADE path     touch the field DIM PATH or MOVE PATH and press the right encoder   Menu SELECT FADE PATH opens     Turn the encoder and choose an empty path  User 1   User 16      NO PTAH if you don t want to assign a profile      LOAD PROFILE if you want to assign a profile to a path      Click to a profile in the overview  profile gets a blue background      Press button CHOOSE PROFILE  now the profile is assigned to a pathand the menu SELECT FADE M OVE PATH  opens       Press button SELECT PATH   the path with the assigned profile is assigned to the cue      Press SELECT PATH and the profile is assigned to a cue in th epath column    or create or change a profile      touch the field DIM PATH or MOVE PATH and press the right encoder   menu SELECT FADE PATH opens     Turn the encoder and choose an empty path  User 1   User 16      Press LOAD PROFILE to load a new profile or change an existing profile     Select an existing profile with SELECT PROFILE and press EDIT to change it   oder     Click NEW in SELECT PROFILE   press rigth encoder  type in a name and confirm with OK   Change  
234. ed the Administrator privilege level first  To restrict rights    the following privilege levels can be issued      Call up Tools      Setup User  amp  Profiles     Select the desired RIGHTS field with the encoder  Pressing the encoder opens the selection menu of the   available rights      DESIGNER    Ths user cannot execute any changes  solely the views can be switched over  Since no playback functions can be  executed either  Fader  Go button etc  are disabled   the show must be started first by a user with higher rights   If the user logs in with DESIGNER privilege  he or she takes over the desk with these settings      PLAYBACK    The user can use all playback functions and load shows    He or she can change playback parameters  but has no access to ther functions that change the show    Even if playback settings were changed  these are not permanently saved      EDIT PRESETS    The user can create additional presets  otherwise no other programming tasks are possible      EDIT GENERAL    The user has access to all functions  with the exception of User Management and software update functions  and     Worlds        EDIT WORLDS    The user can create and change    Worlds        EDIT SETUPS    The user has in addition the right to execute changes in the SETUP mode  e g  in the library      ADMINISTRATOR      Along with all other functions  User Management and Update of Desk Software are enabled    Some grandM A operators may find it helpful to create an user with playback r
235. ed with the current Show data   and furthermore  all Playback commands can be executed  so that it could take over the Show at any time  if the  Master console fails or the connection is interrupted manually  Both the connected consoles will always run the  Same Show    16 2 2 Tracking the Console Status   As soon as the grandMA Full  Tracking Backup has been set up and is operational  all important operating  elements of the M aster are simultaneously transmitted to the Slave system for parallel execution  If not set up  this way  the Slave system will only follow the commands of the M aster  main system   if the latter is operational   If the connection to the M aster system is interrupted  or the M aster itself crashes due to a hardware or software  failure  the Slave system would not accept this invalid condition    All these features as a whole let the grandMA provide a complete    Full Backup    without any compromise  offering  maximum safety in any Show    16 2 3 Using the True  Tracking Backup live   The grandMA Full  Tracking Backup system has been developed mainly  to ensure and cover any kind of live  situation and critical Show conditions  Show recordings and final rehearsals will  however  be even better  protected  by saving Show data at regular intervals  in between  by activating the  Autosave  or double clicking  on the BACKUP button   One major advantage of a synchronisation via EtherNet is the possible combination with  the DM X  EtherNet distribution  in 
236. edi of  desk with IP 192 168 177 113  will be re  established  only when session master is available    SESSION Collision    If between abort and reconnection to a session  the session was changed  this collision warning will pop up after   reconnection  Choose an action to connect the desk to this or another session    Join other session    The desk connect s to another session   Take over other session    Other desks  whenInvitaion is enable  will be invited to this session   Change my ID    The ID of this session will be changed    MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    scan    ae     World 1       links  r  Isolated     Scan           PanDimt              F          12  orld  1           15 7 Worlds   In the World pool  you can create  call up or manage so  called    Worlds      Worlds can be created individually  Worlds can be used e g  to split up complete Scanners  all Attributes  or indivi   dual Attributes of Scanners or just Dimmer channels or all Scanners and Dimmers for programming purposes    and  what is even more important  to run Executors     Creating Worlds   e g   In a World  the Scanners 1 10 are saved with the Dimmer and Color function  If you call up this World   only these Scanners will be displayed in the Fixture Sheet  Furthermore  only the Dimmer and Color functions  can be modified  In the Channel or Fader Sheet  the Dimmer channels will no longer be displayed        Selecte Scanner or Dimmer channels        f y
237. efault Executor  Cue  N    Executor  N    for the respective Executor  You can also enter multiple times for several Cues of a sequence at the same  time  e g  ASSIGN FADE 3 DELAY 8 OUTDELAY4 CUE 1 THRU 4 EXEC 2 4    As operational keyword     AT TYPE 1  Inputing dimmer values directly    166       destination objects    AT values   FADE fades    DELAY delays  ENTER  Destination objects  A list of objects that can create selections  Usable keywords   are  CHANNEL FIXTURE GROUP SEQU CUE PRESET EFFECT   If no destination objects are given  the current selection will be used     Values  VALUE X  THRU VALUE _Y  in percent   Fades  FADE X  THRU FADE_Y  in seconds   Delays  DELAY X THRU DELAY Y in seconds   Values  fades and delays are decimal numbers with dots   e g  FADE 1 5     Examples     CHANNEL 1 THRU 10 AT 20 FADE 2 5 DELAY 0 THRU 5 ENTER   Will put channels 1 through 10 at 20  and give them all a fade time of 2 5  seconds  It will also stagger a delay time across all 20 channels  with channel 1  having the longest delay time and channel twenty having no delay time at all   CUE 1 AT FULL ENTER   This will set the dimmer of all devices contained in CUE 1 of the default executor  to 100      MIA    LIGHTING    AT TYPE 2  Copying values with filtering        destination objects    AT  set AT filtering   source objects  ENTER   Destination objects  Same as above    Source objects  A list of objects that can supply values  Usable keywords are   CHANNEL FIXTURE GROUP SEQU CUE PRE
238. election  will now be executed in the first half from the first fixture to the middle  and in the second half from the last  fixture backwards to the middle     3 9 2 Mirroring when Entering Pan Tilt values   Mirror Wingstyle  When entereing values for PAN TILT  these can be mirrored individually or together    E g   Take 10 Scanners  mounted In a row from left to right  and select them 1 10    Now  set    Wings    on 2 digits and    Mirror Wingstyle    on Pan    Now  when you modify the    Pan    value  the first 5 Scanners move in one direction and the others into the other  one     3 9 3 Storing settings   The modified settings can be stored individually or together    In the MAtricks Setup  you ll find a    Store    button next to each function  If a function has been changed  this   buttons will automatically be activated  dark green background   By shortly pressing the button  you can switch   on  activated  or off  deactivated  the storing function  When storing  only the activated functions will be stored      To store  press the STORE key  LED in on       Now  choose the desired button in the M Atricks pool  Directly after storing  you can assign a name for the  stored setting      By cklicking on the button  you can call up the stored setting  and the button will be displayed with a dark  green background  You can combine multiple stored settings by calling them up in sequence      By pressing the    Reset    button  all settings in the M Atricks Setup will be switc
239. enu using the REM OTE key      Press the STORE key once  LED is on       Select a key in the MIDI REM OTE CONFIGURATION menu      Press the Playback button that you want to assign  The selected button will now be assigned    The assigned Playback buttons will be displayed on the individual keys of the MIDI REM OTE CONFIGURATION  menu  EXECUTOR buttons and faders can be assigned to the respective MIDI note     8 4 3 Selecting the MIDI Channel  Pressing the Channel key will open a menu in which you can select one of the 16 Midi channels by a mouse  click     8 4 4 Assigning the Pitch  By pressing the KEY OFFSET key  you can transpose the incoming notes by one octave downwards  This can be set  for up to three octaves     8 4 5 Deleting Assignments    To delete an assigned Playback button  press the DELETE key once  LED is on   Press the Key once     8 4 6 Using the MIDI Input   In the TOOLS menu  you can switch the MIDI input function on or off using the ON   OFF Key    If the MIDI input is active  you can call up the assigned keys by pressing the respective note keys on the MIDI  keyboard  For optical convenience  the key in the MIDI REMOTE CONFIGURATION menu will have a red    MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelorunn       Executor 1 11  Segu     Seq 1   Effects     GO    MCh 12 11     G0 MProog 23 oO ooo  G   MiNote 13 122  MiNote 14 123  STORE        TIMED          background when pressing a note key     8 4 7 MIDIOUT   Use the following syn
240. eral Enabled  If this key is set to Enabled  all OOPS functions are available   except for VIEWS commands  and entries in the PROGRAM M ER   both of which can be switched off separately  for further information see  below    General Disabled  Pressing the Enabled key next to General will toggle it over to Disabled and all OOPS functions  will be switched off   Oops for Views   If the key is set to Enabled  OOPS functions can be used for VIEWS calls and creating or  deleting VIEWS keys  Pressing the Enabled key will toggle it to Disabled and the OOPS function can no longer be  used for VIEWS commands    Oops for Programmer   If the key is set to Enabled  OOPS functions are available for all entries in the  PROGRAM MER  selecting deselecting or activating deactivating Fixture or Dimmer channels   Pressing the  Enabled key will toggle it to Disabled and the OOPS function can no longer be used for entries in the   PROGRAM M ER    In strong bass enviroments  vibrations   please switch off all OOPS settings and    Autosave     disabled     See Saving and Loading a Show  Autosave      Close menu with X  Changes will be saved     2 13 Settings in the DEFAULTS Menu  Pressing the DEFAULT key in the SETUP menu will bring you to the DEFAULTS menu     Programming   This column will display the default times and settings that will be used when storing Cues and Sequences    Using the Encoders  you can adjust the individual times and trigger calls    DUAL DIGIT VALUE ENTRY  Entries performed
241. eric keypad plus standard keyboard and mouse  only with grandM A      Trackball  ultra light and micro pico only extern     General user functions      Constant access to single units or groups     Fixture library with updates supplied via the Internet     Selective programming for free combination of memories and effects     Free switching between stage orientated movements and DMX control in  combination with 3 D     Hardware     Hard Disk Drive   resp  CF  and 3 5    Floppy Drive     12 MB flash memory for self  contained operating system  not on the ultra light  and micro   pico      Protection against radio interference  CE  Norm      Inputs  MIDI  Sound  Remote Go  SM PTE  Analogue   10 V   DMX 512     Output  4 Times DM X 512  2 on the ultra light and micro   pico   MIDI  Printer   Ethernet     Full tracking backup and sync mode with second unit    Dimensions and Weight  grandMA full  size       Width 48     height 6     depth 26     1200 x 150 x 670 mm     Weight 104 Ib   47 kg  without flightcase    grandMA light     MIA    LIGHTING    1 4    MA Lighting Technology GmbH      Width 29     height 5     depth 20     730 x 120 x 510 mm     Weight 46 Ib   21 kg  without flightcase    grandMA ultra light       Width 29     Height 5     Depth 20     635 x 157 x 490mm     Weight 28 Ib   12 8 kg  without flightcase    grandMA replay unit see 14 Layout and Controls grandMA replay unit  grandMA micro   pico       Width 482mm  height 146mm  depth 438mm    Weight 9 0 kg without f
242. es X  Y  and Y  STAGE  in the PARAM ETER column     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn              Arrange in Matrix  Arrange in Circle  Stretch Positions  Calibrate Follow         SETUP mode    In this mode  you can position fixtures using mouse  Encoders or touch screen  Changes will automatically be  saved to the SETUP menu      The SETUP menu may not be opened      Open STAGE and choose SETUP mode      Select fixtures  usingthe mouse or the touch screen       adjust the 3 axes using the Encoder die 3 Achsen verstellen    or     modify the X and Y axes usingthe left mouse button  if you hold the left and right mouse button  only the Z axis  will be modified      X  Y  and Z axes can be modified individually or groupwise  see also 2 2 3      after switching from POSITION to ROTATION  you can rotated fixtures individually or groupwise on the X  Y  or Z  axis   NOTE  Perform changes preferably using the Encoders  as with the mouse  you run the risk of changing the stage  setting just like that  Undo unwanted changes using OOPS  except with MICRO      WIZZARD in the SETUP mode    Here  you can arrange fixtures in geometrical figures  e g  square  circle  arc   You can  however  position each and  every fixture manually  see above   but this function saves you a lot of precious time  A special highlight is the  Calibration mode that you can use to transfer the actual fixture position to the console    The SETUP menu may not be opened     
243. es or Dimmers  for which you want to call up a preset  Fixtures Dimmers have to be displayed  in yellow   Now  the individual presets can be called up for the selected Fixtures  The called  up presets and their  names will be displayed in the FIXTURE windows    If you select a preset directly  without having selected Fixtures or Dimmer channels  all Fixtures and Dimmers  for  which presets had been created  will be selected  The preset can now be called up by pressing the respective Key   Using the Fader next to the right display  you can either define Preset Fade times or fade over presets manually   Press the key above the Fader once  red LED is on   Select the desired Fade time using the Fader  The selected Fade  time will be used when presets are being called up    Press the key above the Fader once more  green LED is on   Select your Presets  With the Fader  you can now fade  over towards the selected Preset  Default setting for the Fader to fade just upwards or in both directions See Set   tings in the DEFAULTS menu below the Executor Defaults Crossfade     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    FREEZE    Lrockmng  Jpatstr        EDIT    UPDATE    UPDATE    3 7 4 FREEZE Function    By activating the FREEZE function  called  up Presets can be locked  As long as the FREEZE Function is switched   on  the called  up preset can not be overwritten by any Cues  Sequences or Chasers      Press the FREEZE key once  LED is on       Select a P
244. eset keys   can be called up     Functions of the Trackball  not for grandM A light and Ultra  light    Pan Tilt    Trackball button on  LED is on    Trackball controls Pan and Tilt  OFF   Trackball button off  LED is off    Trackball has no function  Pan Tilt    Trackball button on  LED is on    Trackball controls Pan and Tilt  Mouse   Trackball button off  LED is off    Trackball controls the mouse  using the Prev   SET and Next keys    you can operate the appropriate mouse buttons   Pan Tilt     Trackball button on  LED is on    Trackball controls Pan and Tilt  M ouse OFF   Trackball button  LED blinking    Trackball controls the mouse  using the Prev   SET and Next keys   you can operate the appropriate mouse buttons     Trackball button off  LED off    Trackball has no function   RESET DEFAULTS key  Will reset all changes back to factory settings   Encoder labelling for figures within the Cue Timing column   Use SAVE TO GLOBAL USER PROFILE in the logged in user   s profile to save changed DEFAULT settings in the  TOOLS menu  You can reload these individual DEFAULT settings with RESTORE FROM GLOBAL USER PROFILE     2 14 Setting Sound Signals    The sound signal is used for triggering Chasers and Sequences  In other words  this is an electronic  graphic  equalizer  In order to slowly balance any fluctuations of the audio signal  a specific compressor function has been  integrated    You will find an integrated adjustable HOLD  OFF function  This function will prevent any d
245. esk  Status    Fixture  Compact  Sequence   j   Content MAtricks   __Compact _  Sequence Pages   Content Channel    Macros 5  Beam               6  Focus Info         Layout  View       Z  Control    Options     Press the yellow Button in the upper left corner to open the Options     To change a TYPE or PAGE  select the cell by a finger touch or using the Encoder  and press the Encoder to open  the Options menu  Depending on the monitor  2 or 6 units  each with 6 Faders or 20 Buttons  can be displayed                Sequence  Executor       Pages    Fader 8  Shapers                Sequence Pages  Tracking Button          9  Video          Quikey       Playback 1 TYPE              ETT TT NET eee fae ee A EETA ETN Faders 1 5 Will display the Executor Faders 1 to 5  Faders 6 10 Will display the Executor Faders 6 to 10  Faders 11 15 Will display the Executor Faders 11 to 15  On a grandM A Light and Ultra Light  switch on the WIDE EXECUTOR mode in the SETUP  Faders 16 20 Will display the Executor Fadersi 16 to 20  On a grandM A Light and Ultra Light  switch on the WIDE EXECUTOR mode in the SETUP  Buttons left On a grandM A Light and Ultra Light the Executor Buttons will be displayed  On a grandM A  the left Buttons block will be displayed  Buttons right identical to Buttons left  except     On a grandM A Light and Ultra Light  switch on the WIDE EXECUTOR mode in the SETUP    PAGE  Auto  Will display the Faders or Buttons of the current page  i e  will update what is being displaye
246. essed  the chart will automatically move to top bottom when handling larger sequences   In Delay The chart will show you all cues of a sequence including the various TRIGGER functions     Snap Delay  ee The EDIT CUE key will enable you to change values of individual cues  below      Description of each encoder           Trigger  GO          BLIND 4 3 1Changing values for individual cues in the sequence     Select the Cue that you want to change  red cell  in the Name column      Press the Edit Cue key  LED in the EDIT key starts flashing       All values of the Cue will now be played back on stage and displayed  active  red  in the   Channel  amp  Fixture sheets      The cue can now be changed by either direct access or presets  See Accessing Fixtures directly  in the FIXTURE   SHEET    Accessing Dimmer Channels directly  in the CHANNEL SHEET  and Creating and calling up Presets   If this Cue has been changed  the LED in the Update button will be on       f the Cue is not to be seen on stage  activate the Blind function by pressing the BLIND key  integrated LED is  on        Press the Update key once  Choose OK in the window that has just opened  The changed Cue is now stored     Press the CLEAR key twice if necessary  Cue values will be deleted in the FIXTURE or CHANNEL window      For modifying further Cues  select the respective Cue one by one  will be displayed on a green background      Repeat all steps as described with first cue        Technischer Service  tech support
247. essing the respective button  you can select the next function  in this case Gobo1   Pressing on the arrow will  open a menu in which all functions are displayed and can be selected directly      Pressing on    Align Off  allows you to select the individual Align functions  Pressing on the arrow will open a menu  in which the respective function can be selected directly      Default setting is    Values     by pressing the button shortly  you can switch to    Fades    and  pressing the button  again  to    Delays    Pressing on the arrow will open a menu in which the respective function can be selected  directly     randMA Hardware keyboard or grandMA light  ultra light and Micro Soft   TOUCH  Keyboard    Views  Groups  Presets  Sequences  Effect groups  Forms or Macros can directly be named within the respective  pool     Cue names can be adjusted in the EDIT menu  in the Tracking or EXECUTOR Sheet     If the    Scroll Lock  function is activated  all entries on the keyboard will be entered directly to the comandline  Scroll  Lock LED on keyboard is lit   By pushing    Scroll Lock  briefly  you can toggle this function ON or OFF     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelorunn    GOBOT  Input range   0 00 to 100 00            O         ae          aa  OB  oo      Cear   Deactivate  Open   Sabot  ee ee                grandMA Mouse or grandMA light and ultra light and micro pico  Trackball  When using a mouse on the micro pico  you always have to c
248. et   if not all rows and columns are visible  click on the sheet  the title bar has now dark  backgroung again   Turn the pressed encoder for horizontal movement and turn the encoder for vertical movement   The colored frame shows the actuell position     SHOW   SKIP TRACKING    SHOW TRACKING  shows tracked values    SKIP TRACKING  doesn   t show tracked values    Mask  only in COM PACT CONTENT   When MASK ts activated  button has dark blue background   all attributes in the Excluded column  in Options  Attribute M ask  will disappear from the display     CONTENT SHEET OPTIONS  Configurating the layout in the display     The Content Sheet can personalized and stored in Users profile      Press EDIT and the yellow bar in the Content   Window    or     Press the yellow dot inthe CONTENT SHEET  on the left side of the title bar    The OPTION   Menu opens      Display Layer  identical with OPTIONS in Fixture Fader Channel Sheet      Sorting  amp  Readout  identical with OPTIONS in Fixture Fader Channel Sheet     Setting  identical with OPTIONS in Fixture Fader Channel Sheet       Attribute M ask  only in COM PACT CONTENT SHEET    All attributes in the EXCLUDED column will be not shown in the CONTENT SHEET when the button MASK is activated     A Click on the attribute moves it to the other column  Excluded to Included and vice versa     For example  Click on PAN  in EXCLUDED  moves the attribut in the INCLUDED column  the attribut will be shown in  CONTENT SHEET when MASK is activ
249. eted as a selection      CHANNEL FIXTURE GROUP SEQU CUE EXEC PRESET EFFECT   In object lists it is excluding objects        OBJECT 1 THRU 10   OBJECT 2      In front of values it is changing the value to a negative relative value   CHANNEL1 AT 10 ENTER will decrease the dimmer value by 10     As a starting keyword  and repeated    is decreasing the dimmer values of  the current selection by 10  every time you press        lt  lt  lt   Go backwards with no time     As starting keyword  every object that follows after the  lt  lt  lt  will try to go   back one step with zero fade time     lt  lt  lt   target object list   ENTER    Target type Operation   EXEC Go backwards one step with no fade time   EFFECT Start running backwards without fading in   TIM ECODE Jump to the previous breakpoint   PAGE Does a  lt  lt  lt  on all executors on that page    SPEEDM ASTER Does a  lt  lt  lt  on all chases using that speed master   executor assigned to a speed master      gt  gt  gt   Go forward with no time     ALL    As starting keyword  every object that follows after the  gt  gt  gt  will try to go forward   one step with zero fade time     gt  gt  gt   target object list   ENTER    Target type Operation   EXEC Go forward one step with no fade time   EFFECT Start running forward without fading in   TIM ECODE Jump to the next breakpoint   PAGE Does a  gt  gt  gt  on executors on that page    SPEEDM ASTER Does a  gt  gt  gt  on all chases using that speed master   executor assigned to 
250. ey one more time    When pressing the CLEAR key the third time  all modified values will be reset  default or to their original setting  prior to the activation     After pressing the CLEAR key for the first time  the yellow LED in this key will flash  This means that only the  selection was deleted  When you select other fixtures or dimmer channels now  the yellow LED will no longer flash     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    The selektion of single fixtures can be deleted     Press OFF key 1x  LED is on      Click on the Fixture key in the Group Window or on the Fixture Name in the Fixture Sheet   You can also deactivate parameter values of individual fixtures  Output will be set to Default or to an outputing  cue value      Press OFF key 1x  LED is on      Click on the activated value in the Fixture Sheet   y i   l     id TEA Pan Tilt You can also delete activated values of entire function groups of selected fixtures  Output will be set to Default  Pan Tilt of activated cue value      5  S00 144 E   Press OFF key 1x  LED is on     S5L300 2 144    3 141   Press a key for the respective function on the Preset Control Bar or click on that function within the Fixture  132 a      5 Eee 192  Id Name 6 ESE 192  Fi EEEF 192 Special feature in Multi User mode    1   s3001  8    5L300 8 BER l cs T   L300 2  3   192 If multiple users  having different user profiles  on different consoles or PDAs are connected wihin one session     EE 3 the p
251. f this square is yellow  the Sequence or Chaser is active                          i        Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 gad HALLS    120    MIA    LIGHTING    5 5 4 Edit PAGE Name     Press the EDIT key once      Select the PAGE key on the display      The EDIT NAME window will open  Enter a name using the keyboard and confirm with ENTER     5 5 5 Copying  moving and deleting Pages   Copy or move a Page containing the Executor faders or buttons  Press the COPY key once to copy Pages  LED is on     Or    Press the M OVE key once to move Pages  LED is on     Press the PAGE key once  LED is on        2  for Executor fader or    3    for Executor buttons  enter via numeric keypad     Press the        dot  key and then enter the page number    Press the AT key  LED is on   enter the number of the target Page and confirm with ENTER   Copy or move complete Pages with Executor Faders and buttons  Press the COPY key once to copy Pages  LED is on     Or    Press the M OVE key once to move Pages  LED is on     Press the PAGE key once  LED is on     Enter the page number    Press the AT key  LED is on   enter the number of the target Page and confirm with ENTER   Delete Pages with Executor faders or buttons   Press the DELETE key once to delete Pages  LED is on     Press the PAGE key once  LED is on        2    for Executor fader or    3    for Executor buttons  enter via numeric keypad     Press the
252. fLine Editor on your PC     inthe grandMA OffLine Editor  press the SETUP button     with UPDATE CONSOLE  update the consoles and NSPs  see above     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    13 Utility Menu    You will need this menu  if the main program or the actual show is damaged due  to a crash or some other error  For the grandM A light and ultra light you MUST  have an external keyboard    In the Utility M enu  you can load or delete an old grandMA operating system   You can also delete shows here  You can delete the current show  this show is  automatically loaded upon power  up of the console   You can renew the Firm   ware for the second built in Computer  Motorola  and you can also renew the  grandM A operating system via floppy disk    During the Boot up process you will see all loaded program segments  blue  background  on the right TFT display  In order to access the Utility Menu you  have to push any key as soon as the message         TO ENTER UTILITY MENU PRESS ANY KEY     is displayed with  red background during the boot  up process  The menu will open after approx   10 20 seconds     Press 1  Restore grandMA operating system   If you press the    1    key on the keyboard  you will see a list with all systems existing  on the harddisk  By pressing one of the displayed keys  a  b  c     the respective  system will be installed  You have to confirm installation by pressing    o  VERY  IMPORTANT   this is the letter    o     n
253. fect and wiil be saved only after leaving the Full or Live Access menu and pressing the  SAVE button     Moving Attributes to another Feature or Preset group     Click on an Attribute  e g   Shutter      Press the Moves Lines button  will be displayed in red      Select a Preset group  to which the Attribute is to be moved  e g   Control     Then  select a Feature  to which the Attribute is to be moved  e g   Control       Select the position in the Attributes table by clicking on it  In this Preset group  the Attribute will now be moved into    MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    All Encoder Groups  No  Name QTY x   laa iy Le aaa     2 PAN TILT 4   3 COLOR 4 Add   4 SHAPERS 8 Group  Delete  Group       Attributes in Selected Group Ungrouped Attributes    Attribute Feature Preset Attribute Feature Preset    PAN TILT PAN TI PT MODE PAN TILT PAN TI   TILT PAN TILT PAN TI PAN lt  gt  PT ROT PAN T   TILT lt  gt  PT ROT PAN T    TILT lt  PT ROT PAN TI   TILT gt  PT ROT PAN TI                                                                   lt  lt  lt     gt  gt  gt   No Qty Name S e Manufacturer Dat Type M el x lt   1   10 MINISCAN I CLAYPAKY Origini Mirror Default Defa  2 120 DIM8 E Origin  Mirror Default Def Add  3 10 Ea MARTIN Origin  Head Default Def  Li  New ine  Delete  Lines  Channels of Fixture Type go              gt  gt  gt  Decimal  No   Break Attribute   Type Snap  Inv    Default Highlite  Stage MIB Fadi Profile   8 bit  1 STRO
254. fect on Chaser   If the LOOPS key on the title bar is pressed      LOOP  Will initiate a jump after the cue that includes the loop statement has finished     LOOPDELAY  The length of time or the number of occurences of a LOOP will be displayed    LINK  The Command Line Command to be triggered will be displayed     LI  DEL  The delay value for the execution of the command will be displayed   If the EFFECTS key on the title bar is pressed      EFFECTS  Display of the Effect calls   A second sheet will appear in the lower part of the display      No   Number of the Effect Group     NAME  Name of the Effect Group     ACTION  Type of Effect call     INTENS  Display of the defined size of the Effect Group                                                        Pool eock Mesh T    Lops Erect soot   OK z F  Fade   If Y  YES  is displayed  the size will be faded in with the set fade time  al ce   co a nce a a Hf   SPEED  Display of the defined speed of the Effect Group  33 Cue 00s CEN   F  Fade   If Y  YES  is displayed  the speed will be faded in with the set fade time  5 5 Cw cds Tii ssia   SOFT  Display of the set softness  softer fade in  of the effects  7 Toe     0 W n a  _See    F  Fade   If Y  YES  is displayed  the softness will be faded in with the set fade time  se g ts d ce     Seem   The chart shows all Cues in the Chaser  Sequence      Saber a_i ae rv ml With the help of these keys you can define the various functions for the Chaser   13 Cue AN   RUN  Chaser runs with the 
255. ffect Groups are  used when creating the Cues  a copy of the Cue will also be saved  i e  it will not be depending on the  original Effect Group anymore       Start an Effect Group in the Effect Pool by selecting it     Press the STORE button once       Press the EXECUTOR button to which the call is to be saved  The Effect Group call will be saved in the Cue with  all settings mentioned above  If this Cue is called up  the Effect Group will be started     When calling up Effect Groups  its size  soeed and softness can be faded in or out  If in the Effect Group a FADE  TIME is set  the intensity and speed or softness of the Effect Group will automatically be faded in or out when this  Group is started     In the Executor Sheet or in Edit Sequence  press the EFFECT button  will be displayed dark grey   The window will be  divided into two halves  The upper part will display the Cue  the lower part the calls of the individual Effect Groups  for the selected Cue  including the respective parameters    Select a Cue in which calls or parameters of Effect Groups are to be modified  selected Cue will be displayed with a  blue frame and a magenta background      The lower chart displays all calls of Effect Groups from this Cue     Select an individual call to be modified  will be displayed with a blue frame   In the right display  the setting will be  adopted and displayed above the Encoders and can be customized at will  If intensity  soeed or softness are to be  faded in or out with
256. fic about which cue you want to Store   4 2 Programming Sequences      Merging a Cue   When merging cues  all existing and stored settings will be maintained  The newly set values will be stored and  added to the cue  while already existing values will be overwritten    If you wish to merge a cue  simply use the same EXECUTOR Fader or EXECUTOR button once again  The SAVE   STORE  window will appear  as above   In order to merge this cue  press the MERGE key  If the executor contains  more than one cue you will have to be specific about which cue you want to store   4 2 Programming  Sequences      Removing a Cue   In the removing operation  the active values  red  will be subtracted from the already existing cue    If you wish to remove from a cue  simply use the same EXECUTOR Fader or EXECUTOR button once again  The  STORE window will appear  as above   In order to remove from this cue  press the REM OVE key  If the executor  contains more than one cue you will have to be specific about which cue you want to Store   4 2 Programming  Sequences      MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    SEQUENCE    STORE SEQUENCE    ot          You can also remove specific parts of a complete sequence by entering   STORE   SEQUENCE   Sequence  number   CUE   1   THRU   number of last Cue   ENTER   A window will open in which you confirm your  operation by pressing the REMOVE key   This syntax also applies for    OVERWRITE    and    M ERGE       Caution  In
257. fine the session ID number  Ervery member of a session must connect the session with this ID number      define the session name     to set the Session Password  option   If another user wants to log into this session  he has to do so using this  password       to set the Session Style       Full Tracking  Preset for Backup System or Single User  Will automatically switch to Multi User  if a session  with multiple consoles is opened      Multi User  Preset for Multi User systems     NOTE  In Multi User mode  you should use special network switches  e g  PROCURVE SWITCH 2524  managable  Switch   Our hotline will gladly advise you on setting up your network accordingly     My State  display  MASTER SLAVE    15 2 Preparing a Session  also neeeded to run NSPs     The left table will show all sessions stating its names and the    Unconnected    group  all not connected  consoles   If a session is displayed with a red background  you can only log into this session using a password   join  above item 3  Forced Login  When clicking on a session  blue background   the units of this selected  session will be displayed in the right table     The right table will only show the units of the selected session  also grandM A  Offline and grandMA 3D     If a unit is displayed with a red background  it is not enabled for network connections  above  item  Allow  Invitations    The Master priority will only interest you  when you want to create sessions with more than 3 units  By clicking  into 
258. for at least 10 minutes  in order to guarantee a proper SAVE  procedure the next time the unit is switched off  By ignoring this advice the  harddisk may be be damaged     The battery needs approximately 4  8 hours for a full recharge  Only then the battery  is able again to bridge another power failure of up to 12 minutes     According to manufacturer provisions  the battery has to be changed after 5 years    Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand  TA 5    1 6 ener  Safety Instructions    A    12     13       Read all the instructions in the user   s manual  especially the safety    requirements see Safety requirements      Follow all instructions  Keep the user   s manual for later use     Follow all cautions and warnings indicated on the unit     Disconnect the mains plug before cleaning the unit  don   t use any    liquid or spray cleanser  Clean with a dry cloth       Do not use the unit near water  Do not expose it to a humid    environment  Do not spill any liquid over the unit       Unplug this apparatus during lightning storms or when unused for    long periods of time       Do not block or cover any ventilation slots in the housing   they    guarantee the reliable functioning of the unit and protect it against  overheating  Do not install the unit into a frame unless sufficient  ventilation is guaranteed  Install in accordance with the  manufacturer s instructions       Do not insert
259. g SM PTE  external synchronisation   the local time within the show can differ from the external SM PTE    MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    time  By using the timecode offset in the options menu  you can set up a time offset  which is subtracted from  the external SM PTE time    Shows which are using internal sync can have a user definable repeat  These settings are also found in the  options menu    Pre Roll  amp  After Roll  Dropout Elimination   Due to the fact that SM PTE is an analogue signal  fluctuations can occur  Very often there are temporary errors in  the recorded SM PTE signal which are called dropouts    As such misleading small errors should of course not affect the board  it filters out these errors automatically   Therefore the desk is filtering out these errors    This filter is controlled by two values  PRE ROLL and AFTER ROLL    PRE ROLL defines the time that a signal must be error free before it is accepted by the console    A small pre roll means that your console reacts faster to Incoming SMPTE signals    AFTER ROLL defines the time that a signal must be continuously in error or missing before it is assumed to be  off  During the after roll time  the console continues the show  using its internal time base    A small after roll means that your console stops faster after the SM PTE signal has stopped  but that it is also  reacting faster to errors in the SM PTE signal    The settings for pre roll and after roll
260. g is required when the apparatus  has been damaged in any way  such as power  supply cord or plug is damaged  liquid has been  spilled or objects have fallen into the apparatus  the apparatus has been exposed to rain or  moisture  does not operate normally  or has been dropped  Besides others  you run the risk of  suffering an electric shock     17 All service work should be exclusively performed by qualified service technicians   18 Do not use any high  power walkie  talkies or cellular phones near the unit     19 If one of the following conditions occurs  please disconnect the mains plug and   call your dealer or technical support      Power cord or mains plug is damaged or worn      Liquid penetrated the unit      The unit was exposed to rain or high ambient humidity      The unit does not function properly  even when following all the instructions in the manual   Only manipulate the controls as stated in the manual  wrong settings on the controls may  damage the unit       The unit fell and the housing was damaged   20  WARNING  TO REDUCE THE RISK OF FIRE OR ELECTRIC SHOCK  DO NOT EXPOSE THIS APPARATUS  TO RAIN OR MOISTURE     Please note that this console is based on complex software and as you probably know from  tes your own computer experience  software crashes can occur on occasion  But be assured    that we will do our best to keep them rare exceptions    Electric shock warning on the rear of the grandMA   The unit should be serviced by qualified personnel only  as 
261. g the button  above it  If Default is displayed  the default time will be used  See Default M enu   Using the    Arrow right    or    Arrow left  buttons  you can call up the next or previous Cue  With the double arrow   you can call up the previous or next Cue without any FADE or Delay times  With the STOP button  you can switch  off this sequence    By pressing the Edit Window button  you open the assigned sequence in the Edit menu  See Editing Sequences   If the LOOPS key Is pressed  the programmed jumps and commands will be displayed in the Sheet  If the EFFECTS  key is pressed  the calls of the Effect Groups are displayed  See Editing Sequences   If the LINK DEFAULT key of the title bar is pressed  the selected sequence will automatically be transferred to the  EXECUTOR window when changing the selected sequence   Assigning the selected sequence  See Layout and  Controls  items 9 and 10     If you press the AUTO SCROLL key  the Sheet will be automatically moved upwards downwards when working with    larger Sequences    Without prior changing the buttons shows  INFO  EFFECTS  LOOPS amp LINKS  TIMES  ALL and AUTO SCROLL at the   upper bar  All buttons   except AUTO SCROLL  can be renamed and the view can be edited      AUTO SCROLL  If AUTO SCROLL Key is pressed  the chart will automatically move to top bottom when handling  larger sequences     Editing the displays     AUTO SCROLL can not be edited      Select a sequence in the Executor  Sheet or press the small executor w
262. ging the activated values  the value of the last selected Channel Fixture will be taken as the starting  value  will not be changed   while the value of the first selected Channel Fixture will be the one modified most   and all values in between will be distributed evenly     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn                               eo Fader Sheet Output sorted  sian ie      e g 4x    lign t Dimm gi    l  S LE   2   ap   2a         Fixture  Preset amp aVa  sorted by Numbers    PanfTilt    __ Pan Tilt      ID F C            Name       Channel  Preset amp   sorted by Numbe       oO         ALIGN key pressed 3 times  LED is on      When changing the activated values  the value of the selected Channel Fixture s     in the middle    will be taken  as the starting value  will not be changed   The value of the first and last selected Channel Fixture will be the ones  modified most  and all values in between will be distributed evenly       ALIGN key pressed 4 times  LED is on      When changing the activated values  the middle value will be the one modified most  the values of the first and  last will not change  and the values in between will be distributed evenly     3 4 2PAUSE Function    With the Pause Function you can temporarily freeze  park  entire fixtures or just individual parameters of fixtures   After the activation of the Pause Function  no further changes will be output by the console  But you can still  change and store fi
263. gy GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    Exec 1 11 Seq 1    Seq 1               E          Normal       tigger      HIE  always    HIE  never              Restart Options    Restart with  first cue                Mee      Default Button and Fader Assignment   Default Options                    Load from  default    Apply to  all Exec     Save az  default    Load from  default                PRIVATE EFFECTS    running effect   other sequence    GLOBAL EFFECTS    running effect    other sequence    7 im  TFN ia  T Ji Tak  a f oat   at   7 ai  Po AN crud a Tiger ht T      a ie i  LB ie  F       Button and Fader Assignment     Playback Options        Move in Black Options    PrePos    Track  From Last      Priority Options    Normal Private  i Effects          Save ag  default                   unchanged   Kill Protect  If Kill Protect is activated  the button has a dark background   the sequence is not switched off by  the Kill command of another sequence     Move in Black Options   MIB Always key pressed  Cues in which fixture intensity changes from zero and also change other parameters    for example  a different position  color or gobo  etc   will have these values    preset    so that live changes will not  be seen on stage  You can also set a FADE or DELAY time for these channels   See Settings in the Defaults M enu    Playback Timing     MIB Never key pressed  Cues which have separatly activated cues MIB fuctions are completely switched off    Edit Sequence
264. h support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand HAt43    144    MIA    LIGHTING    8 1 4 Recording a Timecode Show   Recording is enabled only if the timecode show is not write  protected  options menu     Recording will always be    live on stage    and can be done in three ways    a  Fully automatic recording with external synchronisation  The current time is given by the SMPTE  signal and every executor command or fader movement will be added to the timecode show until you stop or pau   se the show  Your actions and pre  recorded items already in the show will be live on stage  You can repeat the  recording process step by step to add more and more details to your show    b  Fully automatic recording with internal synchronisation  Basically the same as with external  sync  time is running continuously  but you where to start and where to stop    c  Semi automatic manual recording  In this mode time is not running  although your show is in  recording mode  Between each executor command that you want to be recorded  you can set the recording time  manually with an encoder or by direct absolute input  simply press the first encoder   This is probably the best way  of editing for the experienced user  who already has a time table in front of him  Even fader commands can be  recorded this way    Starting to record      Automatic recording is started by pressing the record symbol in the timecode control bar  the red symbol    Th
265. haser  calling a  Playback   93  Chaser  editing a 100  Chaser  executing a 106  CHASER SPEED 47  CHASER  triggering a 48  CHASER FADE 102  CHASES OFF 121  Chat 55    Circular Copy 81   CLEAR  9  16  60  71  156  167   Clear Activation 75   CLEAR LED 60  71   CLOCK 55   CLONE 43   CLOSE 112   Colours 33   Colours used for the screen  display 233   Colums 74   COMMAND 1 211   Command Line Commands  99   Command Line Order 94   Command Overview 159   Command Reference 161   Command Time 212   COMMAND WINDOW 11   COMMANDLINE 55   Comment 30   Comp Fixture Sheet Options  61   COM PACT CONTENT 54   Compact Fixture Sheet 61   Compatibility mode 226   Complete Loss of Data 5   CONFIRM 132   CONTENT 54   CONTENT SHEET OPTIONS  123   COPY 59  98  156  167   Copy cue in another  seugence 100   Copy cues between  sequences 100   COS 124   Crash file 222   Create 20    CREATE GROUPS 43   CREATE MATRIX LAYOUT 85   Create Preset Preference  43   CREATE PRESETS 43   CREATE SINGLE GROUPS 43   Crossfade 47   CUE 87  167   Cue  copying a 98   Cue  deleting a 79  99   Cue Destinations 103   Cue  executing a 106   Cue  including a 91   Cue load 92   Cue  moving a 97   Cue Only 98  118   Cue Options 90   Cue  renumbering a 99   Cue  Update 77  104   Cue  updating a 103   CURRENT PAGE OFF 121   Current Settings 108  111    D    Date 30   Deactivate 65   DEF GO 168   DEFAULT 26  46  60  71   DEFAULTS M enu  Settings in  the 46   Defined 64   Defining DM X Addresses for  Fixtures 54   DELAY 17  156 
266. he Ethernet  DM X converter and be displayed    Aside from the name  a deliberate name for this node can be chosen    IP  here  you can set the IP address  When pressing the Save button  you have to start the Ethernet  DM X  converter transmission by pressing OK in the opened window  The converter will reboot and set the new IP address   Under Desk Config  the IP address and the Subnet of the console will be displayed    If the SubNet is not identical  this has to be adjusted  For further information  please contact you network  administrator    Gateway  For further information  please contact you network administrator    With the Backlight button  you can switch the background lighting on and off    In the Output table  all available DM X outputs of the DM X converter are displayed    In the Input table  all available DM X inputs of the DM X converter are displayed  DM X input four pages earlier    In the tables  you can adjust the name  patch for every DM X output or input    In the xDM X column  you can assign a number for every DM X output or input  Each DM X output or input will be  assigned by this number    If you press the Save button  the changes are transferred to the converter    By pressing the X button  you close the menu    2 9 5 WYSIWYG    To visualize the show  every desk  also onPC and offline  can connect with WYSIWYG visualization      Open the DMX  amp  NSP Configuration in the TOOLS menu     Open the Configuration menu with the WYSIWYG Config button      
267. he Executor Buttons or the  appearing menu on the monitor  you can switch off active executors  You can switch off the executor by  simultaneously pressing the    Off Key    and the respective    Executor Button     5 6 OFF menu    Executor Fader   There are 5 Executor Faders available  These five faders correspond to the faders no  1 to 5 on the grandM A  Faders  no  6 to 20  Faders 6 to 10 on the grandMA light  are not available  This becomes especially important when  programming the show on thegrandMA and    running    the show afterwards with the Replay Unit  These faders are  not motorized  so that the actual values have to be    grabbed    after switching pages  If the faders are not located at  the actual value  the respective LEDs within the buttons will flash  until the value has been reached by moving the  fader  Channel faders are not available     Executor Fader Button   Three Executor Buttons are available for each Executor Fader  as on the grandM A   These 15 Executor Fader But   tons correspond with the Fader Buttons no  1 to 5 on the grandM A  Fader Button no  6 to 20  Fader Button no  6 to  10 on the grandMA light  are not available  This becomes particularly important when programming the show on  the grandMA and    running    the show afterwards on the Replay Unit     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    EXECUTOR FADERS                                       Mode Key   Has no function yet  This key is being reserved f
268. he Gobo should completely be visible   depends on the fixture type    guni  o ex     Visualize   using the Encoder  choose the Visulize Effect fro the menu  in this case  Gobo 1 or Gobo 2    oie Ate   Eh   position the frame in the EXTRA column using the Encoder   the CHANGE GOBO menu will appear        use the arrow to open the folder overview   pia Sine ee   Sa    use the Encoder to choose and open the folder in which you want to save the bitmap   Eekelen     SELFCREATE 4   copy the bitmap into the folder by using IM PORT IM AGE FROM DISK    Pirn line       Ries  Ie Or   idilo Hake Folder    SFI TGREATT on Disk   create anew folder using M AKE FOLDER ON DISK  enter a name and confirm  Poe  gt  copy the bitmap into the folder by using IM PORT IM AGE FROM DISK  from Floppy       i rh ine  eer rai Urara Ebon    m    _    a    inserting    an already saved Gobo in a fixture  When Gobos were exchanged within a fixture  you have to do the same for the    equipment    in the library so that    the 3D Visualizer can give a real representation of the Show   Se    pae mo      open the FUNCTION SETS menu of the respective fixture type  Gobo 1 or Gobo 2    see above   Yarine  Almays Aaa   use the Encoder to go to the EXTRA cell and open the CHANGE GOBO menu  ae ENEE De   use the arrow to open the menus of different manufacturers     lt a   choose a manufacturer and a Gobo  and confirm using the Encoder   the chosen Gobo will be    inserted    into  Make Folder  on Disk                 
269. he PAGE Keys in the display  By clicking on  the respective PAGE Keys you can call up the PAGE     5 5 2 Executor Fader Page  When pressing both PAGE keys for the Executor Faders simultaneously the display will show a summary of the Executor Fader    If in EXECUTOR FADER M ode  you can call up the summary for all EXECUTOR FADER Pages by pressing the PAGE Keys in the  display  By clicking on a PAGE Key you can call up the respective PAGE    The individual Faders are indicated by symbols in the respective PAGE Keys  The yellow bar graph will give you the currently set  value for the respective Fader  If there is a green square above the Fader symbol  a Sequence  a Group or a Special M aster is  allocated to this Executor Fader  If this square is yellow  the Sequence or Chaser is active        5 5 3 Executor Button Page   When pressing both PAGE keys for the Executor Buttons simultaneously the display will show a summary of the EXECUTOR BUT   TON Pages    Or    After pressing the LIST key once  the TFT display will show a listing of the Sequences assigned to the Buttons  and in the middle a  PAGE Key with the currently called  up EXECUTOR Page    You can call up the summary for all EXECUTOR BUTTON Pages by pressing the PAGE keys in the display  By clicking on a PAGE key  you can call up the respective PAGE    The keys are indicated by symbols in the respective PAGE Keys  If there is a green square  a Sequence  a Group or a Special M aster  is allocated to this Executor Button  I
270. he STAGE window  The values set will be displayed in  the back part of the table  Press and simultaneously turn the Encoder  right of the Display   to change the table    view  Turn it  until the columns for Position X  Y  Zand Rotation X    Y    Z   are displayed   or    highlight a value directly    press on the right Encoder    enter the value using the Calculator    confirm with ENTER       Shift linear  S Gs have no importance      select one or more fixtures     select the Linear icon     select the space axis icon     shift the fixtures along the space axes using the Encoder       Shift linear tilted  S Gs have no importance   Only for rotated fixtures  if the fixtures were not rotated before  this function is equal to the one described above      select one or more fixtures     select the Linear icon     select the Axis icon     shift the fixtures along the fixtures    axes using the Encoder       Rotation S ingle      select one or more fixtures    select the Circle icon    Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand  TA 21                         Name  front0    dimmer  blinder  dimmerneu  New       Name  SL300 1  SL300 2  SL300 3  SL300 4  SL300 5    22    Fixture Layer  Qty   ID Cha   ID Fix  10 1  10    SL300  SL300  SL300  SL300  SL300    11  20    Alll  Al21  Ali  Aldi    LIGHTING    Type ID _Ch ID Fix  Patch Mas   Func Pan Func  Til Swap DHX Pan   DMX Tilt  1 Alli    Invert  Invert 
271. he external monitor to enter the external monitor to enter the external monitor    Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand A231    Keyboard    Press butons MA   List  Keyboard opens for labeling names  values       Debug  Monitor  Press button V10 to open the debug  monitor  small screen   Information of this screen arenot relevant to normal programming     Only ultra  light       List   buttons opens overview of executor buttons    user2   button opens overview of executor fader    232 MIA MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbittelbrunn    LIGHTING    COLOR CODE    Colors in the FIXTURE  CHANNEL and FADER window    Color or symbol                               Fixture  Preset amp Val value grey with darkblue        s default value  ___ sorted by Numbers  background  gee fae   ID F C and name yellow fixture is selected and has default value  EE   EK oo value white with re Ixture Is selected with manual activation or tader Encoder movement  background  Default   value red with dark re Ixture Is selected with manual activation or fader Encoder movement  background  Theatrical   value white with dark re selection is cleard  e g  1x Clear  background  Default   value red with very dark selection is cleard  e g  1x Clear   red background  Theatrical   value white with dark blue activation is cleard  e g  2x Clear  background  Default   value red with dark blue activation Is
272. he following operational keywords    ASSIGN Assign an effect to an executor   COPY Copy one effect to another   DELETE Delete an effect   EDIT Open edit menu for effect   IF Deselect devices that are not included in effect   FOUTPUT Select devices that have stage output from the effect  INSERT M OVE Change visible number of effect   LABEL Change name of effect   As target for the following executing commands    GO Run forward  start with fade in    Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand A169    ESC    EVEN    EXEC    170    GO  Run backwards  start with fade In   gt  gt  gt  Run forward  no fade in    lt  lt  lt  Run backwards  no fade in  PAUSE Pause  stand stil   OFF Switch off  fading out    ESC  Escape  will progressively perform the following actions   a  Isthere something in the command line   Yes    gt  clear commandline    b  Is edit update procedure running   Yes    gt  cancel edit update  c  Is there an open window or a message box   Yes   gt  close it    d  Isthere an edit menu open   Yes    gt  close it    EVEN creates a sub  selection from the current selection   If you have selected 10 fixtures and then select EVEN  only the 2   4  6  8   and 10  fixture in this selection stays selected  The others have become     temporarily deselected     waiting to be fully selected again by the ALL  command     Format Meaning  EXEC X  THRU  Y   Executors X to Y of current page  EXEC P X  THRU  Q Y   Executors X of page P to exec Y of page Q    EXEC X  THRU  Y  
273. he next time you say NEXT  only the 2  fixture within the current selection is     really selected    and so on  The   ALL command will clear this subselection    Continue EDIT   UPDATE procedure with NEXT object    See EDIT    Cursor Right in open dialog windows    In all temporary dialog windows and message boxes  you can use the NEXT key  to move the input focus in that window to the right  Together with PREVIOUS  and ENTER you can  for example  choose the appropriate answer in a message  box     If no device is selected  NEXT will bring the fixture having the lowest ID into the  selection  on the next NEXT  the fixture with the next ID in order will be selected   With PREVIOUS  the selecting direction will be reversed  Proceeding from the  fixture with the highest ID  on the next NEXT  the selection will jump to the  dimmer with the lowest ID     ODD is creating a sub  selection from the current selection    If you have selected 10 fixtures and the say ODD  only the 1    3tt 5  7    and  9th fixture in this selection stays Selected  The others become    Temporarily  deselected     waiting to be fully selected again by the ALL command     As starting keyword  every object that follows after the OFF will be switched    MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    ON    OOPS    OFF    OFF  target object list   FADE X   DELAY Y   ENTER    If fade or delay are given  they overwrite the default OFF time    The default OFF times can be changed in 
274. he title bar will set all group masters to 100       Pressing the CLOSE key will close this window     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    5 1 6Assigning Special Masters     Press the ASSIGN key once  LED is on       Press an EXECUTOR FADER button  to which a Special M aster is to be assigned to     Press FUNCTION      f the SPECIAL M ASTER key is pressed  all CHASER SPEED M asters will be displayed     Select which SPEED is to be assigned    The following window will appear above the assigned Executor fader    The name of the Speed Group     The speed     Speed 1 ee With the top button  you can enter a speed directly  By pressing the button at least twice  you can set the speed   With the button below the fader  you can double the speed   S555 ES With the bottom button  you can halve the speed   The speed of the Speed Group can be adjusted by using the Fader   LEARN VW If SOUND   BPM is selected  you can adjust the given BPM value in the Sound menu using the fader   See      Sound Signal Settings   The Sound M enu will open by touching the lower part of this window  not the headline    Or   If SOUND   HOLD is selected  you can adjust the given HOLD value in the Sound menu using the fader   See  Sound Signal Settings   The Sound Menu will open by touching the lower part of this window  not the headline    The name of the fader function   The speed   With the top button  you can enter a speed directly  By pressing the button at least tw
275. he values are the same as in the Tracking Sheet  see COLOR CODE in the appendix of this  manual     The COM PRESSED CONTENT menu offers the same contents  but is structured more compactly  up to 19  columns  and gives the practiced user a more extensive overview     Open the sheet     Click a blank screen    Select CONTENT or COMPRESSED CONTENT in the overview    Sequence selection      Link Last Go   This displays the sequence that was last started  with GO or ON   The sequence name is shown in the  top bar of the CONTENT Sheet      Link Selected   Always select Selected Sequence here  the small executor window has a light green background       Not Linked   Here you have to select a sequence in the CONTENT SHEET OPTIONS menu  The sequence name is  shown in the top bar of the CONTENT Sheet     AUTO SCROLL  when the button is activ  has dark background   automatically the actuell cue is diplayed   NEXT and LAST CUE not activated  or the next cue is displayed  NEXT CUE is activated  or the previous  cue cue will be shown LAST CUE is activated   The actuell  running  cue number and the shown cue  number is displayed in the title bar  E g  act 2cue  showing 3cue  Cue 2 is running and cue 3 Is displayed  in the Content Sheet  therefore NEXT CUE Is activated       Next Cue  only in mode AUTO SCROLL    If the button is activated  dark background   the next cue is displayed  This means that if cue 2 of the  sequence is active  cue 3 is displayed and the cue number appears in the hea
276. hed off     3 9 4 Selective Copying   With the Circular Copy function  you can copy or move set values of fixtures to other fixtures    Copying values   Example   Select a fixture and set the Dimmer value to 100       Select the fixture and further fixtures      By pressing the      gt     button  the Dimmer of the fixture that was selected as next one  will be set to 100       With each pressing  the value will be copied to the next  selected fixture  When pressing     lt      the value will  be copied to the last selected fixture    Moving values   Example  Select a fixture and set the Dimmer value to 100       Select the fixture and further fixtures  to which you want the Dimmer value to be moved to      By pressing 2x on the column title  here Dimmer   you can activate all Dimmer values fur the selected   fixtures     By pressing the      gt     button  the Dimmer value of the first fixture will be moved to the next  selected fixture     When pressing     lt      the value will be copied to the last selected fixture     Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand  TA 81    Fader Sheet Values sorted by Numbers       Tela TT    e Fader Sheet Values sorted by Numbers       ee   oe        132 155    22  88  177 199  221  Taaa aa ee aa aaa a a aa Laa LaL    e Fader Sheet Values sorted by Numbers       pee a  a2   132 22  177 88 U                 tHe Lg        Interests  Head Pre                    C
277. her Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 gad HAAA    142    MIA    LIGHTING    8 1 2 Creating a Timecode Show   Graphically with the touch screens or mouse      Open a timecode pool window      Touch one of the timecode show keys  you will get the timecode control bar for this show in the display on the right     Enter the name for the timecode show using the PC keyboard      Press the EDIT field in the timecode control bar  and the timecode editor will appear    Using the command line      EDIT TIMECODE X ENTER   Brings up the timecode editor and the timecode control bar for timecode show X  There is  no hardware key for TIMECODE on the grandM A  but you can enter this in the command line or into a macro by using the  text keyboard    Combining the two methods      EDIT and then touch a key in the timecode pool    If the timecode show that you have selected was empty  there will be only the empty editor in front of you and you can  now start recording or manual editing     8 1 3 Playing back a Timecode Show   Graphically with the touch screens or mouse      Brings up a timecode control bar for the desired timecode show when touching a key in the timecode pool      Use the cells with the cd player  like symbols to control the show playback    Using the command line      COMMAND TIMECODE X ENTER  COM MAND is one of the executor commands that you will find above the page keys   You can use GO    PAUSE   lt  lt 
278. ically be taken over   The Channel window can be deleted by pressing the Delete Window key      By pressing the X key  the Option window will be closed    All these settings  excl     LINK   will be stored when storing the VIEWS   Storing VIEWS      3 5 8 DIMMER OPTION   In the Channel Sheet  you can adapt different basic settings for each individual Dimmer channel     Press Edit key and choose the channel on the Touchscreen    The CHANNEL OPTION window will open             r Display  E Filter       Columns 10  Delete  Yw indov    Channel Sheet Values sorted by Numbers          The Dimmer channel can be renamed using the keyboard    Next to    Type    the type of Dimmer is displayed  next to    ID    the corresponding number  and next to    Patch    the DM X  address for this Channel    Pressing the WITH MASTER key  display changes to NO MASTER  will be indicated by a dark blue background   the  Dimmer channel will be output without regard to the GRANDM ASTER    If a Dimmer channel was modified in this window  the Dimmer channel s number or name will be displayed on a  blue background in the Channel Sheet    These modifications can also be defined while patching Dimmer channels  See Selecting DM X addresses for  Dimmers   With the  lt  lt  lt  key  you can switch to the previous Dimmer channel  With the  gt  gt  gt  key  you can switch to the next  Dimmer channel      With the X key  you can close the window        r     With Master             MA Lighting Technology GmbH   
279. ice you can set the speed   HPH Be With the button below the fader you can double the speed   With the bottom button you can halve the speed   ere  i You can adjust the BPM   HOLD value with the fader             i          LEARN   GRANDM ASTER  this will assign the Grandmaster function to this Fader   TOWBCE   MASTER EXEC FADE  this will assign the Executor Fader function to this Fader   HAL   MASTER PRESET FADE  this will assign the Preset Fader function to this Fader   TP  ee Executor Fader having these 3 functions  will always run synchronized to the console faders  The BLACKOUT  SET    TIME  and MANUAL FADE buttons will also affect all Faders having these functions          he     ESP a  et gem    5 1 7Assigning effects    w Su 2   Speed   rotate TES P   press ASSIGN         press on the small Executor window  LS   an   press FUNCTION   uae   press EFFECT    or _ LEARN   use the Encoder to select the effect and confirm by pressing on the Encoder                    it    Er lo h  LEARH        F  oe       DOUBLE DOUBLE      HALF       Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 gad HAAS          Exec 1 1 Seq 1    Seg 1            Button and Fader Assignment          Size of Executor     il ill all ll    Default Button and Fader Assignment                Apply to    Load from Save as  all Exec     default default                   Playback Options    Auto Swop   Fix Protect  A B Normal HTP Kill  Xfade 
280. ights only  for their own personal   use  After they have finished programming  they log in as this playback user  so they can be sure that they will   not change anything in their newly completed show data   of course they should save their show before they log   in as playback user     It is not necessary to save the whole desk after you have changed something in the User M anager  All data of the   User M anager is immediately saved when you leave the User M anager menu     2 16 6 Login    Login is only enabled if at least one user appears in the user list  TOOLS menu   User Configuration     M anual login      Go to TOOLS menu      Press LOGIN key    Never push Login without knowing the password  Otherwise you can only log in by     ADMIN       All touchscreens will show LOGIN  and you have to enter a valid user name  During LOGIN  the surface of the  desk is locked  LOGIN does not affect playback  All programs that are running continue to do so    After a successful login  the views of the corresponding user profile will appear on the screens  Furthermore  the  user s saved setup and default settings will automatically be loaded  too     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn                                              Chat    Nes Settings    Displays    N Encoder  amp  Attnbute  Ouikeys j  Grouping   General    Settings Everything                          No      Hame   Used    World Filter   DEFAULT NT   fa jdd r E S  iL WORLD 1    U
281. igned to an executor  in chaser mode  and with EFFECTS  regardless if they are assigned to an  executor or not      Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 gad MALTS    Note  It makes no sense to use this function by typing it into the command line     The LEARN function will calculate and average the timing between 2 to 4  LEARN commands and adapt its speed to that     LOAD    As starting keyword  every executor that follows after the LOAD will go to a  given cue upon the next MANUAL GO command    LOAD  CUE   W   EXEC X   ENTER    Giving the keyword CUE Is optional    If W  cue number  is not given  you will be prompted for it    If executor is not given  default executor will be used     MACRO    M IDI    As starting keyword  given macros will be executed    MACRO  range list  ENTER   Macro numbers in the range list must be in the interval   1    999    as target for the following commands     ASSIGN A macro can be assigned to a VIEWBIN  COPY Copy one macro to another   DELETE Delete a macro   EDIT Open edit menu for macro    INSERT MOVEChange visible number of macro   STOREStart to record a macro from live actions  Macro recording is indicated by  a flashing macro key  M acro recording is stopped with the command STORE  MACRO ENTER     Macros can be timed    A timed macro plays back with the same timing as it was recorded    Non timed macros execute completely at once     BIN    A MIDI BTN  midi b
282. ill receive a   light background and Merge Local will appear   in the graphics on the left  the incoming DM X signal is merged   with Universe 2       Use SAVE to save the setting    Important  If in a Master Slave network environment  only the DMX IN of the master console will be  connected to the internal DMX port  The DMX IN of the slave console can then only be use for remote  control purposes                 Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand  TA 3             ikdiNetwork Connection Setup    192 168 0 4      Available grandMA 3D  IP    No  Name   Status Vers            SAVE x    ArtNet DMX Ethernet Configuration    Available Nodes    cae A a Short Name Long Name Status  ike Short Name Long Name  0001  OC Scan for  5S Short Name Long Name  0001  2  Nodes    Edit Nodes    Choose Delayed  Output    If You Use the        DMX Hub     a    Legend        Used by internal  Slot       Parameters for Ethernet DMX Output              SUBNET  1 ID  1  Current  F F          MJA    LIGHTING    By pressing a button in the CONFIGURATION column you can call up the respective menu for this DM X output     DMX INPUT   By pressing a button in the PROTOCOL column you can define a protocol for he respective DM X Port 1 A    8 H    By pressing the button below PROTOCOL  you can define the following    Intern  The DM XIN  on the backside of the console  will be used    ARTNET  The assigned DM X IN of an ARTN
283. indow abov ethe fader     Click the button with the right mouse button   or     press EDIT and pres the requested button   The menu Cuelist Display Options opens   All attributes in the EXCLUDED column will be not shown in the Executor sheet      A Click on the attribute moves it to the other column  Excluded to Included and vice versa       With Info Dialog and Effect Dialog the cue Info and effects overview will be shown in this display     Click on Label for typing an individual name      Save as Default stores the view fro all executors      Confirm using the X  button  options are stored    MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    Tracking Sheet Options    Das plea Layer          Fades  Delays  Moduilntor Table  Modulator Sire  Modulator Speed  Fodulator Phase     Autom tic     Rimes ounly r    Sequence Ib            Layer Control   E Preset Control         Tracking Sheet Options    BOUGRE ESCHGEN  Name Mame    Pan  Tit   X  Stage  Y  wage  2otage  Dim    G1   a Rot      Type    Fader  Fader  Fader  Fader  Fader  Fader  Fader         No   Page Name  1 1 Seq 3  6 1 Seq 6   10 1 Seq f   1 1 Seq 1   12 1 Seq 2   16 1 Seg 4   17 1 seq 5    Select Sequence    seq     Attribute     hKdask  Colec       Sorting    Readout       Attribute      ait Select  Sequence       i Display  Layer    Sorting  amp   Readout    Attribute       Mask    Select  Sequence    Tracking Sheet Options x  Display    E Layer    Sorting  amp        Readout          1 
284. ing displayed    in both Sheets  The difference lies in the arrangement of the fixtures and features as well as the adjustable  number of visible fixtures and features on the screen    Comp Fixture Sheet Options   S     a a a AN R AS opposed to the Fixture Sheet  you can here make the following additional selections under OPTIONS   SET   ZAE TINGS    ORIENTATION        Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand IA  61             Included     Excluded Display    Name Name Layer  Pan g rae  Tilt G1 Rot elie  Dim C1  Frost    Pocus Settings          Attribute  Mask    Display  Layer    ate DG ENS aEs ESE  Name            Pan         sorting  amp   riis Up Readout  Dim  Frost  Focus      Attribute  Mask    Attribute  Sort             LIGHTING          Left   Right the fixtures will be displayed with ascending ID numbers side by side  set the number of columns  using COLUM NS   Top   Bottom The fixtures will be displayed with ascending ID numbers from top to bottom   WRAP AROUND    If    On    has been selected  the size of the Channels will be adjusted automatically  when the number of Channels  changes    NAME FIELD    ON The Fixture names will be displayed   OFF The Fixture names will not be displayed   COLUMNS    Here  you can enter the number of columns on display  1   60    NOTE  If you choose too many columns  it will not be possible to display the values in the cells completely     ATTRIBUTE M
285. ing the    Auto Cols    key  dark background  will move the function column  for which the value is currently  being changed  automatically to the left    Selecting Presets or functions in the Preset Window   Create Presets  will move the respective column in the  Fixture Window to the left     Pressing the    Auto Rows  key  dark background  will move up those fixtures  selected via groups or directly by  fixture key and numeric keypad     3 4 8 SORT Function in the FIXTURE Window  Pressing the SORT key will update the sorting  see below  in the Fixture Window     3 4 9 Options in the FIXTURE Window     Touch the touch screen on the left corner of the title bar  yellow dot    Or      Right click with the mouse on the headline bar    The NEW FIXTURE SHEET OPTIONS window will open    If pressing the Sorting  amp  Readout button  displayed with a green font    Layer Display  By pressing the respective function  the following values will be displayed as basic setting     Preset and Values  The FIXTURE window will show presets or values if no presets are used     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn      Fades  FADE times will be displayed     Delays  DELAY times will be displayed     Fixture Sheet Options              Die   Modulator Table   Size   Speed   Phase  All modulators are shown   i   Values Only  Only values  without presets  will be displayed  but no effects and profiles   Names Downwards Sorting i   Output  The DM X output values 
286. iod of time  only with    SNAP     functions     Pressing the In Fades button will switch it over to Out Fades      Out Fade  Dimmer channels  which reduce their level in the next Cue  will be faded with the set period of   time     Out Delay  delays the outfading    Cues can be stored on EXECUTOR faders or EXECUTOR button    Define the assignment position of the Cue by pressing the EXECUTOR button once  When storing to an EXECUTOR   FADER  press a button above or below the fader once    The CUE is now assigned to this EXECUTOR button or EXECUTOR fader and stored in the Sequence Pool  This way   it is possible  to assign the same Cue more often than once  See ASSIGN menu  Assignment to EXECUTOR    Repeat all steps to create the next Cue      Pressing the CLEAR key  once   will delete the selection  twice   will delete the active values and reset all  values then     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    store Options    Store  Source  Filter     F    Defi ne    for a  Selected   Selected          e  FELEN     4 1 2 Store Options   Functions available when storing  STORE The different settings in this menu have an effect on how Cues  but also Presets are stored  The settings modified  in this menu can be stored as defaults  These  Pre  sets will then be used for storing  but can also be adjusted from  case to case   Press the STORE button and hold it  In the right TFT Display  the following selection will appear   Press the buttons  selec
287. iolet 42 58 Color Always             2 7 Function Sets   Names  Channel Values  and Presets   In this menu  you can create or adjust so  called Channel Values  names  for the individual functions  e g   GOBO   These names will then be displayed in the Fixture Sheet instead of the number value  Furthermore  you  can assign different graphic parameters like e g  colors or Gobos that will then additionally be displayed in the  Fixture Sheet  These data will also be needed for the visualization on the grandMA 3D    These names and values are used when creating Presets in the Auto Create menu   Auto Create   Creating  Presets  Effects and Group buttons automatically     Presets will not be created automatically  if for the Ranges of Names and Visualize values from    X    up to    Y     are Indicated  e g   10 21   Otherwise  always   see column AutoGen       Open this menu by pressing the Function Sets button in the Fixture Types menu  see 2 pages earlier     Listing of the individual columns and their functions     No  Listing of the created names and appropriate values  If a number is displayed in red and with an asterisk   this line has been modified      Name  This name will only be displayed  if the value indicated for Range is reached  There are exceptions that  will be explained on the next page  You can select individual names using the left Encoder      Range  Name   For these values  the names  Channel Values  will be displayed  The Start and End Ranges can  be adjusted
288. irst unit  that had created the Session       All users that are not present on the first unit  that had created the Session  will be deleted  If needed   you would have to set them up again      Master priorities have to be defined  see on the right side     Attaching Units from the Master   In the left table  click on  Unconnected    The table on the right will show all units that are the    free      In the right table  click on the unit  3D  Offline  grandMA       will get a blue background     Press the Invite Stations button and confirm with OK  The data of the    invited    unit will be overwritten   Attaching from another Unit   In the left table  click on the Session  which is to be joined    Press the Join Session button and confirm with OK  The own Show data will be overwritten now    Master Priorities   All units of the same priority  The unit that had created the Session  remains the M aster  If the M asters fails  the  Slave  2nd unit  will automatically become the M aster  When there are more than 2 consoles  coincidence will  decide  so you should assign priorities    If there are more the 2 unit  e g   1st unit grandMA  priority    Normal    2nd unit grandM A light  priority    Nor   mal    3rd unit grandM A RPU  priority    Low      When the Master fails  the 2nd unit  grandM A light  will  automatically become the M aster  die RPU will remain Slave    In the left table  click on    Session      The right table will now show all units of the Session  Under  
289. is especially useful on the grandM A light and ultra light       Hold the List key     By additionally shortly pressing the function keys  the respective window will open and the function be  Switched off again afterwards     Press 1x Press 2x Press 3x  Channel Channel  Sheet Fader  Sheet  Fixture Fixture  Sheet Stage window  Group Group pool World pool  Sequence Sequence pool  Executor Executor Sheet Tracking Sheet  Page Channel Pages Fader  Pages Button Pages  Macro M acro pool  Preset all preset windows will be opened one after the other  View View pool  Effect Effect pool Bitmap Effect Pool Timecode pool    By pressing the ESC key  you can close the temporary windows at any time     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn       MACRO   VIEW    STORE    N       5       i  Views VIEW 2 VIEW 3  FIXI  5      7  GOBO   COLOR   BE FO sun          ia 11 12 is if  MACRO   EXEC   TRACK      Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand ITA 37       3 2 Storing VIEWS    The soft VIEW keys running down the righthand side of the touchscreens and external displays can be assigned  with views    The physical keys located beside the touch screens can be used for direct access to the VIEW soft keys on the  screens    What can a  soft  key be used for      You can store one or more displays on it      You can store all currently created windows on all screens and both external mo
290. isplay for the EXECUTOR buttons   The name of the assigned sequence is displayed in the headline  The shown figure displays the number of the  sequence   Touching the Sheet  not the header  on the touch screen or using the left mouse key will open the EDIT menu   See Editing Sequences or Editing Chasers  Touching the title bar on the touchscreen or using the left mouse key will open the ASSIGN menu  See  ASSIGN menu    The current section from the Cue Sheet will also be displayed   Sequence  The Outfade time of the last Cue will be displayed by a blue bar in the upper cell   The Infade time of the cue will be displayed in the second cell   The next Cue will be displayed in the next cell below   Chaser   The speed will be displayed in the upper cell   The Fade time in percentage will be displayed in the second cell and also as a green bar   Whilst the Chaser is not activated  you will find the type of activation in the bottom line  During execution  the  number of Cues that have completed will be displayed on the left while on the right side you will see the total  number of all Cues  which is also being displayed graphically by a bar   The individual Fader and Button functions are displayed here     On the left side  the function of the fader is displayed  The yellow status indicator will give you the current fa   der level     The function for the button above the fader is displayed at the top     The function of the button below the Fader is displayed in the middle cell    
291. isplayed in the upper part     Editing Channel Values     press EDIT      Press the desired Channel Value button  If different fixtures were selected  you will be refused to edit them  in this case  select only one type of fixture       Perform the change from the Functions Set menu and afterwards  close the menu using the X  upper right  corner      After having returned to the SM ART window  the changes have been stored automatically    Storing new Channel Values      Select a new fixture type     Adjust the setting using the Wheel  Encoder  Calculator or Trackerball     press STORE     Press the grey  empty  button  Only the value of the selected feature will be stored  l e  for dimmers  only the  dimmer values will be stored  not e g  the PAN values that were changed at the same time     Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand A  69      Enter the desired name and confirm with OK  The same name can be used for different fixtures types    therefore  use unique names    Deleting Channel Values      press DELETE     Press the desired Channel Value button   Renaming Channel Values      press ASSIGN twice     Press the desired Channel Value button     Enter the desired name and confirm with OK  The same name can be used for different fixtures types      therefore  use unique names    Activating Channel Values      Select anew fixture type     Select feature and  if needed  attribute  buttons wil
292. ize    The software for the grandM A light and ultra light and the grandMA full  size is  nearly identical     The product will not be delivered with a hardware keyboard and an external 14 Playback buttons can also be defined as e g   mouse  An additional external keyboard and a mouse  however  can be Go  Go   Pause  Flash  etc     connected on the rear of the unit  15 Executor faders can also be defined eg  as  Using the KEYBOARD key on the TFT display  a Soft Keyboard can be brought up M aster  Swap M aster  X  Fader  etc      that can be operated via the touch screen  The Soft Keyboard will only appear  if  entries are possible    If the trackball is switched to mouse function  LED in the PAN   TILT key is off    you Can perform mouse functions using the trackball or the LEFT  MIDDLE  RIGHT  keys  There are some limitations for the micro   pico    List keys   Faders  will bring up small Executor  windows for the EXECUTOR  FADERS    Buttons  will bring up small Executor  windows for the EXECUTOR  BUTTONS     17 Go   Go   Pause button   Will only    18  19  20    21  22  23    24    effect the default sequence  A default  sequence can be assigned by using the  Select key  indicated by the green title  bar in the small EXECUTOR window displayed  above      Executor buttons can also be defined  as e g  Go  Go    Pause  Flash  etc      Manual setting of times for Executor  buttons    Choosing Groups  Executors  etc  in  combination using the numeric keypad    Numeric keypad  In
293. ject  keywords and will still be interpreted as operational keyword     Operational keywords expect object keywords as targets for their operation  Sometimes they also use helping    keywords    Keyword Operation   ASSIGN Assign one object to another  like assigning a sequence to an executor   AT  operational form  Set a value to something    COPY Make a copy of an object    DELETE Delete an object    EDIT Edit an object     FOUTPUT Create a selection depending on an objects stage output   INSERT Insert an object at another location    INVERT Invert the selection    LABEL Change name of an object   MOVE Move an object to another location    PREVIEW Have a look at an object without stage output    STORE Store data into an object    UPDATE Update data of active object  Active objects create stage output     Executing Keywords    Executing keywords may be used as starting keywords  or as source in an assign operation   As starting keywords they expect object keywords as targets for their operations     Keyword Operation    lt  lt  lt  Go back with no time    gt  gt  gt  Go forward with no time   FIX Fix an executor  This executor will ignore page changes     FLASH DOWN  _ OFF Temporary down flash of executor   FLASH_UP  _ OFF Temporary up flash of executor    Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 gad HALOL    162    MIA    LIGHTING    GO  GO   GOTO  LEARN  LOAD  OFF  ON  PAUSE  SELECT  SWOP   OFF  TEM
294. jor Selected  Active Tor Salectad    Oyerarite Cue Create Second Cue    Overwrite    Save    Overwite Cue Create Second Cue    Overwrite E    Save    Overwrite Cue Create Second Cue    90 MA    LIGHTING            press STORE and choose option RELEASE    store cue as usual  tracking sheet shows    release    instead of an value      Ask to Confirm  When storing a second cue on an Executor  the SAVE window will open  Here  you can execute  one of the functions by selecting it    Cue Options      Cue Only On Off  Settings to save  Cue Only On or Off     Reset Times On Off  Preset  whether the set times are to be reset to default when saving CUEs the next time    can be set in SETUP   DEFAULTS   RESET TIM ES ON  or whether they are to be kept  RESET TIMES O   Preset Options  See Creating and calling up Presets   Pressing the Save as default button will save the presets as defaults     STORE ENCODER WINDOW      press STORE   The Encoder window displays the setting of 3 areas of the OPTION menu  The settings can be changed  for the  following STORE process  temporarily from the pull  up menus  On the next STORE  the very setting will reappear that  was defined in the Option menu     Overwriting a Cue   If you wish to overwrite a Cue completely  simply use the same EXECUTOR fader or EXECUTOR button once again   The following window will appear    In order to overwrite this cue completely  press the OVERWRITE key  If the executor contains more than one cue  you will have to be speci
295. k window     Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 gad HAASI       Visualize Forms  lt HEW FORM gt        Set Handle  Left Mousebtn 7 Remove Handle  Mid Mousebtn p    DRANMODE  ARC    A EQUALIZE  DOTS __        Put in form PAN   sinlx    abs x   1 5  Put in form      TILT25  sinlx    x  coslx   1 5    CONFIRM       M ake a left mouse click on the respective fields    now enter the formula via keyboard     The form will be confirmed by pressing CONFIRM     132 MIA    LIGHTING    EDIT FORM         6 7 2Modifying Forms   The EDIT FORM S window will open by pressing the EDIT key    Make a left click with the mouse on at least three positions of the marked form  With each click on the form  a   new red dot will be displayed on that position  In order to delete one of the dots  middle click with the mouse on   this dot    To reshape the form  click and drag with the mouse on one of the red dots  If you click the right mouse key during   the reshaping  while holding the left mouse key   you can define the reshaping each time      By pressing the key  you can program in which way the lines shall be drawn when reshaping the form      ANGLE  straight line     ARC  outer arc     ARROW  inner arc   By reshaping the form  the lines will be expanded and  respectively  the extended positions of the form will   be reported to the Fixture faster       f the extended lines and  consequently  the longer ways for the 
296. ke gotos      Crossfades are not destroyed by running fader data reduction                                     pe   You can jump into the middle of a crossfade  or run backwards into a crossfade  and it will be correctly initialised     iit z rera p p eoan i F  This will happen quite often when using external time code        SS F E A         8   1     Ti me Code im onPC  ars  e ie  CD Player im onPC  ors   saci al se In the onPC you find a CD Player in the OPTIONS menue  click with the right mouse button on the yellow dot    vies  a     E Then click    CD Player visible    and switch on the ecoder bar                    Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand AAAS    Tools Menu  Current User is    Administrator       8 2 Remote Control via Touchboard    On the rear of the grandM A  there is a 25  pin SUB  D socket  DC REM OTE CONTROL  to connect a standard Touchboard  with up to 16 channels        PIN 1    16  Input Channels 1 to 16  PIN 21422   5 Volt  max  100 mA Output   PIN 17 18 und 24425  Earthing  The Touchboard input sockets only function as switches   0 bis  2 Volt  Off   5 to  15 Volt  On  Remote  Touchboard  8 2 1Assigning Playback keys  Remote Touchboard Configuration EX    press TOOLS           press TOUCHBOARD REM OTE    STORE    Empty The menu REM OTE TOUCHBOARD CONFIGURATION displays the commands     Empty    means  that there is no    command assingned to this button    Fader 
297. ked to update the old one first      Programmer is cleared  and the values and selection of the object is loaded  into the programmer      All titles of fixture and channel sheet will show the name of the    edit object       Change values and selection in the programmer as required      UPDATE starts flashing as soon as values are changed      Hit UPDATE  You will be asked for a confirmation and then changed values  and selection is stored back into the object      ESC will quit the EDIT   UPDATE procedure without updating the object at any  time    Objects that can be edited in this way are     Syntax  start with EDIT    Comment   CUE ENTER Edit active cue of default  executor    CUE  X ENTER Edit cue X of default executor   CUE X SEQUENCE Y ENTER   CUE X EXEC Y Z ENTER   CUE X  hit executor     SEQUENCE X ENTER or hit key in Will edit first cue of sequence X  sequence pool window  Although a group has no values   group pool windowthe selection  can be edited    PRESET X ENTER or hit preset type on Will edit first non  empty preset  the preset control bar of fixture sheet  of type X   PRESET X Y ENTER or hit Key in   preset pool window   Continue EDIT   UPDATE procedure with NEXT   PREVIOUS  object    EDIT NEXT  ENTER    EDIT PREVIOUS  ENTER    If you use the NEXT and PREVIOUS hard  keys  ENTER is not necessary    Next and previous will continue edit update with the next previous non  empty  object in the context of the current    edit object        GROUP X ENTER or hit key
298. l   Selective  Preset Filter ON or OFF       Release STORE key  STORE LED comes on   Select the required location in the PAN TILT window on the display by  a simple touch or with left click of the mouse  These Pan  amp  Tilt values are now stored in this location  STORE LED is  off       Enter a name for the preset using the keyboard  confirm with ENTER    If you want to store more presets for the same fixtures and functions  start again with step 3    Update Preset      3 7 1 Moving Preset Keys within the Window     Press MOVE key 1x  LED comes on       Activate the key in the respective window by either using the touchscreen or a left mouse click on the key and  drag  a hand symbol appears  to the required location within this window     You can also insert preset keys      Press MOVE key 2x  LED flashes       Activate the key in the respective preset window using the touchscreen or make a left mouse click and drag   hand symbol appears  to the desired location between two other keys  The following Keys will all be moved by  one position to the right     3 7 2 Presets Options  In the Preset Options menu  you can define how Presets in the Preset Pool will appear       Icons Off No icons will be displayed    Icons small The icons will be displayed next to the name    Icons big Only the icons will be displayed  the Preset name will not appear      Use the right mouse button to click on the blue window and open the Options menu     3 7 3 Selecting Presets      Select the Fixtur
299. l be created only for these Scanners or Dimmers    By pressing the CREATE GROUPS button  one ODD button will be created for each Scanner type  with which you  can select all odd  numbered Scanners simultaneously  One EVEN button to select all even  numbered Scanners   and an ALL button  to select all of the two    By pressing the CREATE SINGLE GROUPS button  you can create a single button for each Scanner type in the  GROUP window     2 11 3 Clone Fixture   Copying Fixture data globally  cloning      Press Clone button  green background  to open the Clone Fixture Data menu    You can clone  copy  all data of one or more fixtures globally  In this  all Preset  Group  Cue and Effect data are  cloned from the first fixture s  From Fixtures     to the target fixture s     To Fixtures   If you select the same  number of fixtures on each side  the data of the first will be transferred to the first  of the second to the second   etc    Select the fixture s that you want to clone  Fixture Sheet   If you want to clone several fixtures  you have to  observe the sequence in which you select them  Pressing the left Take Selection button will display the fixtures  in the left table  From Fixtures         Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand MA  43       Auto Create Groups       be    select Fixture Types       No   Qty Name  Select Create Groups Menu    Bis HAC 500 M4 v 1 3 All Odd Even  2 15 DME only P 
300. l turn dark green              Smart      OF Ledion L e Lad i    Enter Hew Name  Pan  Tilt    ear yellow    4  rple          Dimmer        Pan  Tilt       Colori    3 5 Accessing Dimmer Channels directly  in the CHANNEL  SHEET     The individual dimmer channels can be accessed directly at any time   S __ Select the channels  which you wish to modify  selected channels will be displayed in yellow characters    CIKKJEIKIKIKJE    O  Selection         Select a dimmer group  See Creating and calling up Fixtures and Dimmer GROUPS   ales   Select dimmers via the CHANNEL key and the numeric keypad  See Command Line     With Touchscreenn or a left mouse click on the individual channels      Make a left mouse click on the first channel and drag with the mouse holding the left mouse key down  creates  a Loop   all channels in this loop are selected      Values can be modified     with the encoders  Encoder assignment is displayed on the screen above  or with the wheel    7   By direct entry into the Command Line  AT functions  you can also enter dimmer values  See Command Line  ae  e eee e Pea ee ee   Select channels with a left mouse click and hold middle the mouse key down and drag  the value will be    CLEAR CLEAR a CLEAR CLEAR CLEAR CLEAR CLEAR CLEAR CLEAR    Ea fala oo en    ce i em Yee U oe modified                   0 MA   o a igting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16  D 97297 Waldbittelbrunn    LIGHTING    3 5 1CHANNEL Mode  CHANNEL    Activate the CHANNEL M ode with the CHANNE
301. l up the macro window with CREATE A WINDOW     Press the desired macro button    or      Enter in the COMMAND LINE  Macro XX   ENTER   or      Press ASSIGN  LED lights up  and click a VIEW button  The OPTIONS window appears     Select MACRO  The SELECT M ACRO window appears     Select macro  Now the macro is assigned to the VIEW button and can be requested at any time     Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand HAAS      None   No    Name  iW Macro L Sequence     TO E Settings  5 Macro 5 Chaser  9 Macro 9    Exec 1 60 Macro 1  Macro 1     Choose from list       x  E                   Name    T    Effect       Bitmap Effect       Edit l   gt              Executor Fullsize   Light   Ultralight Micro   Pico         Edit Macro 1    Macro 1     COMMAND               Channel 1 At Ful  Pause Channel    New Entr       LIGHTING    9 1 2 Assign a macro to a executor   M acros may be stored to executor fader or executor button and may be started with this button  3 buttons of the  executor fader  Micro and Pico only 1 button  as well as the executor buttons can be assigned with the commands  ON  GO or OFF  With this function the fader is not active    Note  If a macro is startet from an executor button  it is only effective lokal  with the same user profile   AIl macros  startet with in a cue  linked in a cue  are effective global  as hitherto     Store a macro to a executor button      press ASSIGN and p
302. lack background can be seen    Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 gad HA 239    COLOR CODE Colors used for the screen display in the Worlds Sheet    Color or symbol    red triangle in the upper left corner This world does not contain all attributes  of the World button of the fixtures   Warning sign This World is being used by another   on the World button user    Colors used for the CONTENT   COMPACT CONTENT SHEET    Color or icons Entical WI e IrackiIng onee    Colors used for the COMMAND LINE    Black Command was executed  Red Command was not executed  An entry was missing ora command was   not possible  because e g  a triggered button was empty  Green a Macro wasexecuted oo  ue ime code was execute    Colors used for the VIEW BUTTONS    Yelow here  the screen dumps of several monitors are saved  i e withthis  button  you can also switch other monitors    Orange Ne saved screen dump only refers to thismontor     Brownwithoreentext this View is currently shown on the montor        240    MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    LISHTING       Symbole     lt  lt  lt   108   2  Port Nodes configuration  206   2x GOTO   ENTER 159   3D stage display 20    A    ACTION 94  101   Activating 16   Active 64   Active Values 67  88   Add Point 35   Additiv 45   ADMIN 51   After Roll 143   ALIGN 12  126   ALIGN Function 62   ALIGN OFF 156   ALL 17  88  156  165   All fo
303. last value will be kept   internally  however  they can  Poma        R be changed and saved   CIUSEU hPa    magenta bar these attributes has engine values  e g  from a effect   e   a wm blue background the fixture has been switched to No Master in the  Dimmer Option    or    L OSEC l IE      Fixture Options    menu  these fixtures will not react on the reagieren  a nicht auf den GrandM aster  i e  for GrandM aster on 0  they will react on       Incon MURT i changes made using the wheel    if oe   or  E SOFE ee F the Group master  to which these fixtures belong   grey background the values has been changed by another user within one session  this value    will not be taken into account when saving  and can only be modified after  having selected the fixtures        LIGHTING    COLOR CODE  DMX Sheet       Gia nn Aiea   are       ua ess sei Bae EI                        i 4    MA Default Colours    DMX Sheet           jy   f  I Ir            l I   l Ss Se et a  z     I  d i    E                1 Ig  KERN Nadel ata aa     lt a sea iE    Eg PR BEL  Theatrical Colours    Colors used for displaying the DMX output sheet  Colororsymb a a e a a       values yellow   value of an Executor  changes while sequence is running       Dimmer value light gey           defaultvalueofthefixtures 9  value light blue      value of the selected sequence 0 Oo  value magenta   fracked   value oo  dimmervaluegreen    value has been reduced    value white with red   manual activation or fader Encoder mo
304. ld   The button will be displayed in green    If you see a warning symbol on a button  it means that this World is presently being used by another User  user    With the Exec Sync function  multiple users  units  can start calling Executors simultaneously   synchronously   In order to do so  this function must be switched on on both appropriate units by pressing this    mm button  will be displayed in green      This special function only serves synchronizing two different Worlds  Playback   And this function has to be  Switched on in a Playback session  if the Playback commands are to be transferred     Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand HAAST    x    Remote Network Connections       15 8 Remote Network Monitor  In the menu Tools Remote Network all remotes  e g  PDA   s are displayed   Button Disconnect Remote disconnect the selected remotes   With Show Remote the selected remote Is displayed on th eright touchscreen   al With Send Message you can chat with the selected remotes   Message WithENABLE   DISABLE REMOTES you can reject or enable a remote connection to your desk  Pressing Disable  Remotes does not interrupt the actual connection with a remote   press Disconnect Remote first     ID Location User Rights  1 Local edi Administrator Disconnect  Remote    Sh  Pemote BE ON THE SAFE SIDE  During life  situation switch remote access to DISABLED     Enable  Remotes    fe fete    198 otst
305. le restoring the intensity of   all other executors to 100    SWOP  executor list  UNPRESS  ENTER    In an assign command  this function can NOT be used  You have to use the  Assign menu to define it on an executor   s button    Note  It is nearly impossible to use this command by typing it into the command  line  Use it when it is assigned to a button or as part of a macro     SWOP OFF    Same as SWOP    UNPRESS   Please look at the SWOP command description     As starting keyword  every executor that follows after TEMP performs a GO  if it wasn t already running     TEMP  executor list   EN TER    As starting keyword combined with UNPRESS  every executor that  follows after TEM P is switched OFF    TEMP  executor list  UNPRESS  ENTER     In an assign command  this function can be assigned to an executor s  button    ASSIGN TEMP  executor list  ENTER   Note  It is nearly impossible to use this command by typing it into the command  line  Rather use it when it is assigned to a button or in a Macro  TEMP does not  really exist as a function  It is always translated into a pair of GO OFF  commands  You will see that if you record TEMP in a timecode show     THRU     Views that contain multiple screens will be called back on the original screens       Views that contain single screens from external monitors can not be called  back on the build in system screens   because of higher resolution       Views which are called by the command line   and not by the push of a  VIEWBTN  ar
306. leaving the Full or Live Access menu and pressing the SAVE button        rane  ad AA Danes nn Pal lin Laibar  2a Ail Fety fa Priede And Cun Mal    Be Charl     Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand ITA 2        Lrcoder   GPO Up ree       aie 1   MRA Ayreon Pi iie Taari s  2y Aid Feks Au Prier And Can Mal Be Chore     28 MA    LIGHTING    The new name will now be displayed in the respective Preset window or in the Fixture window    Creating an additional Feature in a Preset group   When creating new scanners or adjusting of present ones  you possibly need additional Features and Attributes    Select a Preset group    Click into the empty cell below the present Features  Enter a name for the new Feature using the keyboard  e g     Gobo 4  and confirm with Enter  The same name is automatically taken over and will be displayed in the Fixture   window on the right side  If you want to use a different name  change It as indicated further above    Now  you still have to create Attributes for this Feature    Click into the first cell below the name  Enter a name using the keyboard  e g   Gobo 4  and confirm with Enter  The   same name is automatically taken over and will be displayed in the Fixture window on the right side  If you want to   use a different name  change it as indicated further above  To create further Attributes  go to the next free cell and  proceed as you did for the first Attribute
307. lected in the Fixture Sheet     2   Sequence name in title bar white Figures in the cells are dimmer values  Display can be adjusted over  an option   Sequence name in title bar green Figures are Fader times  press IME JX     Sequence name in title bar orange Figures are Fader times  press TIM E 2x     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    COLOR CODE Colors used for the screen display in PRESET POOL    Red triangle Ine preset can olny be used for those fixtures  it was  created and saved for       Ext very taln e preset Was deleted In and Cannot be appilea any more       eM  PAN TILT   _ Gobo Oren E  ue frame reset is selecte  U   as  o e pL C4  reen area ese presets can be applied to the selected fixtures   the higher    ae  t    r a  r J a    PANSTILT   PANSTILT  2 3 f         2 3 2 figure shows the number of fixtures  on which the preset is applied to  Gobol 1   Gobot 2 Cto  th small figure is the button number   L I a ellow area ese presets can be applied to the selected fixtures   the higher figure  i i   shows the number of fixtures  on which the preset is applied to  Gobo1 3   Gobo 1 4 pE  the small figure is the button number           e   Closed                  zE   7   E rey area o lamps selected or the preset is not available for the selected lamps        sots ster Violet ack frame e preset also contains values from another preset   an embedded prese  l Il a   urple numeral over preset name ows the number of selected lamps th
308. light  amp  grandMA ultra  light  Ultralight and  Micro     Left click selects a field for keyboard or encoder input  etc     Right click goes to M odify  opens windows with options  sorting columns by clicking on the headline        Pressing and holding the middle mouse key changes output values  Hold and M ove   The displays  select one by a click into empty space   The grandM A offers different windows  M enus with information and control keys  spreadsheets  key groups  dimmer  channel listings and fader symbols    Clicking and dragging using the left mouse key on the headline moves a window  you can alter the size by clicking  and dragging the left and bottom edges     Right clicking with the mouse on the headline of a window opens options menu for that window   Spreadsheets  comparable to those used in Excel or Access      Click and drag with the left mouse key and you can select a range of cells  not on all screens possible     Left click on a column headline will resize or move the column  Y  Right click on a column headline will sort by this column  grandMA y Emergency help  Like any computer  the grandMA may crash  To resolve a crash    he N E y 1  Perform a reset by pressing CTRL  ALT  DEL or the RESET key on the backside of the unit or Power Off on the  a Ultralight and Micro   Only if this doesn   t help   2  During the booting use    Delete ActShow    to delete the current Show  See Utility Menu       As an addition to this manual  a free DVD Is In case of any fu
309. lightcase    Installation  90 230 Volt  40 60 Hz via Euro plug  No switching of voltage necessary     DMX output  Complies with USITT DMX 512  1990  protocol  The output is opto   insulated and exceeding RS 485 or RS 422  The pins in the 5 pin XLR plug are  Pin 1   ground  Pin 2  Data   Pin 3  Data   pins 4 and 5  not used       Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    1 5 Safety Requirements  Important  read carefully   at latest  Please attach a label on the unit  indicating the date of purchase  preferably  update data etc   choose a location  where this information can easily be seen      Touchscreen  Never use any sharp items when operating the touchscreens  Deep scratches will H arddisk   damage the screen  During operation  due to temperature fluctuations  the calibration During operation  do not push or knock the unit   of the touchscreens may change  so an adjustment may be necessary  see Settings a Ea  in the Setup Menu  point 1  The built in notebook harddisk is secured by a rubber  upholstery  however  mechanical  stress can still damage the unit and lead to e g  a complete loss of data   Sockets for keyboard and mouse Please read the appropriate notes and warnings given under    Autosave    and    Oops    Settings     if the unit is to be used in very loud environment  Not necessary for the    These sockets are located on the rear of the unit and are very delicate  especially MICRO  as  a Compact Flash is used    during transport  take care that these parts
310. live parts may be exposed when    CAUTION    RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK  DO NOT OPEN    ATTENTION    RISQUE DE CHOC   LECTRIQUE  NE PAS OUVRIR       opening and or removing coverings  besides others  you run the risk of suffering an electric  shock     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    1 7 1 Layout and Controls grandMA light    grandM A ultra light  Items 7 and 17 do not apply  keys inexistent   Item 22  Wheel  does not apply  can be controlled by Trackball  item 25  and Wheel key  item 24      Power switch   Blackout key for Dimmer channels  Grand Master for Dimmer channels  TFT Display touch screen  View Macro keys    Encoder for moving   scrolling the respective  window contents    A QuhQN      Viewpool key for opening a window on the  TFT display with all the created VIEWS in the  show  These can then be recalled up directly by  selecting the required view       Background key   If on the TFT display  Views  are being overlayed by a menu  ASSIGN  EDIT          You Can use this key to bring up or hide the  menu     9 Keyboard key to bring up the Soft Keyboard  onthe TFT display     10 Manual setting of time for Presets    T T Encoder for setting the attribute values  e g   Gobo  Pan Tilt  times  etc      12 Keysto directly execute functions like Got  Go     etc  for arbitrary executors  locking executors   SELECT key    13   Page flipping for Channel fader  Executor fa   der and Executor buttons       Differences to the grandMA full s
311. ll find the Select column  By choosing a cell and pressing the Encoder on the right of  the Display  you can select them and the display switches to Yes  When creating Presets  these will only be    MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    created for these Scanners or Dimmers    By pressing the Autocreate Prests New button  you can create individual Presets for each Scanner type   The created Presets will now be available in the individual PRESET windows  See also  Function Sets   Names   Channel Values  and Presets   By pressing the Autocreate Presets Merge button  you can create the Presets for all Scanner types  simultaneously  Same names of different Scanners will be displayed on one PRESET button    pm By pressing the Delete Presets button  you can delete the Presets of the selected Scanners and Dimmers    By pressing the button Reset Presets References you can delete all self created preset references and the    aore Ai presets created from the function sets from library   To save self  created Presets of a Reference Scanner  select the appropriate Scanner  in the Fixture Sheet   Press    EE a the    Create Preset Preference    button  The Presets will now be saved to the Fixture in the USER Library in this  MAtrickg   Show  same name  can only be distinguished by its version number   If you sign on further Fixtures of this type  Ber ic  same version   you can load the created Presets with CREATE NEW PRESETS  see item 3   To use this
312. ll only use channels that are not used by other sequences     So  in some cases the effect may not be executed completely as no overlaps are allowed   upper graphics    GLOBAL EFFECTS  Effects saved in this sequence will use all channels  even if they overlap with other sequences    lower graphics    For LTP Executors  you can choose Off On Overwritten additionally  When all functions of this Executor   have been overwritten by other Executors  this one will switch off     Defaults Options  Pressing the SAVE AS DEFAULT key will save the current settings as default settings   Pressing the LOAD FROM DEFAULT key will load the saved default settings and use them for this Executor     Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand MALL       Exec 22 Group 12    lines             None                Chaser    Special Master                                 Effect         Bitmap Effect            Normal  tigger    Eim  En ane    ASSIGN       112       LIGHTING    5 1 5 Assigning Group Masters   Group masters are Faders only assigned to one group previously defined  Group masters do not have an influence  on the effects produced by the GrandM aster      select group in GROUP  Pool      press empty EXECUTOR FADER  button   or  open ASSIGN M enu of the related Executor     press FUNCTION     press GROUP MASTER     select group    Changing Group Names    By pushing the key    Name    the name of the group assigne
313. loaded show  All following chapters marked with         are not available for the Micro     2 16 1 Locking the Desk   Locking the desk is a method to temporarily protect your desk against misuse from inexperienced users  It is not  suitable for permanent protection    Locking the desk does not affect the output  All programs that are running continue to do so  But the surface of  the desk is inaccessible  even moving the grand master fader will be ignored    Activating Desk Lock      Press CTRL  PAUSE on the PC  Keyboard     All touchscreens will show DESK LOCKED      Desk is locked    Deactivating Desk Lock      Press CTRL  PAUSE on the PC  Keyboard again      All touchscreens will restore in the original screens      Desk is unlocked      CAUTION    Due to the fact  that the grand master fader is not motorised  master dimming may jump to an unwanted level  upon deactivation of desk lock  So have a look at it before you deactivate the desk lock  For the grandM A ultra   light this is also valid for all faders     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    2 16 2 Concept of User Profiles     The desk has a list of users      Each user can have his own user profile  but he can also share a profile with other users      A user profile includes views  quikey arrangement and playback settings      Part of each user profile is global and independent of the currently loaded show  This part is used to store and load  default Views  Setup and Default
314. lready created  graphics  Besides changing the layout  you can also change all values of the fixtures involved  Save the drawn  graphics as a bitmap or save the individual layout steps as a Cue  You can delete all changes by pressing CLEAR 3  times                                                           136 ME   A Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr 16  D 97297 Waldbittelbrunn    LIGHTING    Manipulate Setup Layout    h   Move   Selection    Color  Bitmap Wizard    Draw mode  Color     Block       Color for Unused            BitMap Wizard    Original  20 20  Scaled  20 20   Scale  1 1  Scale to  best fit  Scale to  fit width       Layout  wallklein  1   20 2             h    Grey Scale  Correction         Scale to  fit height    Action will  Reset              Green EA pe e Tile    Create Import Save Load Delete  Text Bitmap Bitmap Bitmap Bitmap    Offset Scale  1 of 3    Modulators                        BitMap  Wizard    4    100       open LAYOUT VIEW     picka layout with CHOOSE LAYOUT     pressing DRAW will bring you into the drawing mode     choose DRAW MODE     FREE  allows you freehand drawings using the mouse or your finger    BLOCK  forms a rectangular frame      COLOR  opens the color menu for fixtures with color changers Choose a color and insert the new color by  pressing on the Color button in the Select menu  When using ACT ON CMY  this color will be assigned  to the selected cells       choose ACTON    GREY  a dimmer value will be assigned to the select
315. ls  Rows 1  Width 3 281    Height 3 261  Orientation          Left   gt  Right    Top  gt  Bottom A OK       Horizontal first    e Layout   V   fixtures  1   a eaaaa    hi                   Select Choose    Vertical   paces   Draw       Name       dimmer l  Layout 3  Layout 4  Layout 5       Layout 6       Layout 7 l     Layout 8     Layout 9       Layout 10    Layout 11       Layout 12                   New Device Layer 85  SL300 99     Manipulate Setup Layout       Label   dimmer    Take Mouse  Selection Frame    Add  Selection    Clean  Rows  Frame  Remove  Column  Frame    Wizard    Left   gt  Right    Top   gt  Bottom Fill  Horizontal first                                     7 BITMAP Effects    Besides the effects mentioned in chapter 6  you can use the Bitpmap Effects function to run graphics in a fixture  matrix  You can either create Bitmap graphics on a PC and then import them  or directly create them in the DRAW  mode  With CREATE TEXT  you can also create texts as Bitmap graphics  The    setting    for the effects is a fixture matrix  to be created in SETUP  In the Editor  you can assign effects  e g  rotation  zoom  etc   and a layout to the fixture  layout  Bitmap effects can be assigned to Executors and be controlled very easily  just like normal effects     TAKE CARE THAT THE FIXTURE TYPE USED HAS THE FUNCTIONS TO BE USED IN THE EFFECT     7 1 Creating a Layout for a BITMAP Effect   Arranging the matrix  Open STAGE window  activate SETUP  button on right top  
316. lues for individual colours of the color wheel  These values can be programmed as presets in the respective   PRESET window and then be reselected    If you have presets for the fixtures be created automatically  CREATE PRESETS   these pre  recorded presets will   be available in the respective windows  See Creating Presets automatically     Create a window for all presets you want to use   select them from preset  pools      Inthe GROUP window  select those fixtures  for which you want to create a Preset  by a touch or mouse  click  fixtures have to be displayed in yellow in the FIXTURE window       Select the Preset group for which you want to create a Preset on the display  using the Touchscreen or by a  left mouse click on the title bar  For example  In the Preset window PAN TILT    Values and positions can be changed by      Encoders  all functions and the assignment will be displayed on the right display above the encoders       Trackball  only PAN  TILT   if activated      Level Wheel  only for dimmer values       Middle mouse key  left click on a value in the FIXTURE or CHANNEL window  drag the mouse while holding the   middle mouse key will change the value       Switch on the Trackball by pressing the TRACKBALL ON button  the integrated LED must be on   Now you can   control the selected fixtures via the trackball  PAN TILT    Changed  active  values will be displayed in the OUT    PUT window by a red background colour     There are two types of Presets      Selecti
317. mal  G bit j               XYZ       Remove XY Support from all fixture types  Create XY2 Support for all fixture types              Harddisc       Floppy       ENTRY       Filter  Fixture          Add Line  To insert a new fixture or function above the selected line      Delete Line  To delete the selected fixture or function      Decimal Values  To display the table values as percentages  By pressing the button  you can switch between  decimal and hexadecimal representation     XYZ SUPPORT  Using CREATE  you can insert virtual X Y  and Z axes into all Fixtures  necessary in order to use   some of the STAGE features   Using REM OVE  you can remove the virtual axes   CAUTION  this will also remove all   STAGE information contained in the current Show  sequences or effects containing these information  can then   no longer be executed     Updating the Fixtures Library     Export to Library  The selected fixture will be saved to disk in the Library      Export to Floppy  The selected fixtures will be saved to floppy      Function Sets  Changes into this menu  See Function Sets     Import  You can insert a fixture from the Library or from a floppy      Funcion Sets  Here  you can enter and modify value  depending names and values for the visualization and   representation in the Fixture Sheet  Furthermore  you can define how Presets are automatically created  See   Function Sets   Names  Channel Values  and Presets     With this  you can leave this menu  The settings will only t
318. mber of Sequence via the numeric keypad and  confirm with ENTER   Deleting CUES  Press the SEQUENCE key  Enter the number of Sequence via the numeric keypad  Press the  CUE key and enter the cue number via numeric keypad  confirm with ENTER   If no sequence number is entered  the Cue of the M aster  default  sequence is deleted   Deleting a PAGE  Press the PAGE key next to the numeric keypad  Enter the PAGE number via the numeric  keypad and confirm with ENTER  The complete PAGE with all EXECUTOR faders and buttons  is deleted     Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand A  19    we   Poa 3e                      Bitmap                   6  Focus                                                 interleave    Next Prev    Mirror  Yfingstyle    80 MA    LIGHTING       3 9 MAtricks   3 9 1 Intelligent Selecting   Here  you can create  store and directly call up different Selection groups    Find out  what the different combinations and the resulting options can be used for  by simply trying them out  The  listing of the individual functions will only contain and explain a few of the many options   Proceed as follows    In order to reate groups      open the MAtricks SETUP     choose function and value  STORE button lights green      press STORE  LED lightsred      press empty button in M Atrickspool and insert name   In order to apply groups      select lamps  the order of selection is the same order
319. menu  See ASSIGN M enu     Press the AT key once  LED is on       Using the numeric keypad  enter the number of the new Sequence and confirm with ENTER     4 2 2 Including Cues   Set a Cue see Creating Cues     Press the STORE key once  LED is on       Press the SEQUENCE key once  LED is on       Enter the number of the Sequence using the numeric keypad      Press the CUE key once  LED is on       Enter the number of the new Cue via numeric keypad and confirm with ENTER    Example  A new Cue is to be included between Cue 3 and Cue 4  This new Cue will be named for example Cue no   3 1 numbers between 3 001 and 3 999 are possible   This way  999 Cues can be included between two Cues     Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand ITA 31    SELECT 4  2 3Selected Sequence  Master Sequence   K When creating sequences  Cues can directly be stored on a Selected Sequence     Press the SELECT key once  LED is on      Select the respective EXECUTOR  which shall be the Selected Sequence by pressing the respective EXECUTOR  button once  The headline of the small EXECUTOR window will be green   To create the first Cue of the Selected Sequence  See Creating Cues    Push STORE key 1x  LED flashes      Push ENTER key 1x  the created cue is now stored in the M aster Sequence     LT    If no EXECUTOR button has been selected before storing  and you confirm with ENTER  the stored Cue  will always be added to the cur
320. mepage     Connecting the NETWORK DIMMER PROCESSOR  NDP  with the grandMA     Press TOOLS    Press MA NETWORK CONFIGURATION      Press NDP  The NDP Configurations menu appears    IP  The IP network addresses of the devices   MAC  The MAC addresses of the devices   NAME  This displays the entered name of the device  The name can be entered or changed with EDIT  STATUS      yellow JOINING  the network connection is being constructed  please wait a moment      green DAT OPEN  the network connection Is active    SESSION ID  This displays the ID number  All devices intended to work together in a session have to have the same  SESSION ID number  The ID number can be changed with EDIT and pressing the relevant field    RACK No  This displays the number of the displayed racks   MA NETWORK DIMMER       Click an empty screen and press the button NETWORK DIMMER in the section OTHER    The MA NETWORK DIMMER menu appears  Here you can acknowledge all fault and status reports  and faults     Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand 14 205    MA Network   4 Port Nodes          save Node Configuration    192 168 0 105 MA  SETUP2    Local search for   node  HardDisk   gt           MA Network   2 Fort Nodes    192 168 0 106 Mal  192 168 0 105 Maj Local                      Disconnect en OW  Remote Message Remote                206 MA    LIGHTING          Remotes    17 2 2 Port Configuration     In this menu  you can configure a 2  port node  For further information refer to the man
321. mmediately if liquid has entered  On malfunction  clean slot with a Q tip    Spare parts can be ordered from     MA Lighting GmbH or Lightoower GmbH  Dachdeckerstrake 16 An der Talle 26   D 97097 Waldbuttelbrunn D  33102 Paderborn  info  malighting de info  lightpower de    For your order  please have the serial number of the device at hand     224 MA    LIGHTING    Installation  follow safety instructions     Simple installation by experienced amateur    By electronic specialist having appropriate tools  or MA service    By electronic specialist having appropriate tools  or MA service  By electronic specialist having appropriate tools  or MA service  By electronic specialist having appropriate tools  or MA service    or your local distributor    MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    Elen Reset   CLOS  y       Please Confirm    Thre will smitch the Right Touch Screen  Fi to the Aight External Screen    Attention  NetWork Update will Update the Selected Console             Update Motorola Desk Processor 1 50       Update from Floppy Pree Info                  Update Library eee   CLOSE          Command Window       Please Confirm  2 Do You Want To Switch Off All Touchscreens 2     a r    m    Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 gad Mf 229          Special functions  Some function keys of the external keyboard are reserved for special functions  You will only 
322. modified  If an existing profile   1     Number of channels per fixture  this profile is is selected  this will now be displayed   coordinated t The y axis gives the value set on the grandM A  whereas the x axis gives the DM X value that will be output  By    pressing the PERCENT key  you can switch the scaling from percent to decimal or  when pressing the key once  more  to hexadecimal     Clicking on a desired point in the diagram will bring up cross  wires  Above the diagram  the value of the  current position is displayed  The value after IN is the set value on the grandMA  the one after OUT is the DM X  value that will be put out     Add Point  The profile line will automatically be connected with the new point   This way  you can set as many points as you wish      Delete Point  To delete a point  select one and press the Delete Point button     Toggle Curve  will create a wave form     PREDEFINED  opens a menue with predefined profiles  these profiles can altered and stored with a new name     MIRROR  displays a selection to mirror the profile     Using the mouse  you can move points  Make a left mouse click on the point  draw it to the desired position   and let the button go     The modifications made will be saved to this profile directly    The table will show all existing profiles that can also be accessed and modified directly    To create an additional profile  press the Add Profile button  name it and repeat the steps above    To delete a profile in the table  
323. n e mail with your contact details and subject  information at tech support  malighting com  We service your request within 48h on working  days  This E Mail Service is monitored during MA Lightings regular business hours in Germany  from 8 30 a m  until 5 p m   Monday through Friday  Alternatively you can call our Technical  Support during that time   49 5251 688865  30    For emergency services please contact your local distributor or contact the MA Lighting Service  Hotline  Call   49 5251 688865  99   Please note  this 24 7 hotline is strictly for emergency cases  so  called show stoppers    for  people being in trouble out in the field  Thank you for your understanding     Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand  TA 3    1 3 Specifications    Capacities     2048 control parameters  HTP or LTP  with 8 or 16 bit resolution   optional  also  available with 4096 channels  ultra Light 2048  With NSPs expandable to 16  384 parameters  on the micro   pico only 1024 channels are possible      Virtually unlimited number of presets  memories  cue lists and effects    Ergonomics      full colour TFT touch screens with a wide angle of view and 2 external  one on the  ultra light  monitors  optional      encoders for display setting  5 master encoders for data entry     20  10  motor faders and extra silent GO  and GO  Buttons  10 non  motorized  Faders on the ultra light and micro   5 on pico      Num
324. n enter a new start time for your selection current event  This input can  be a relative movement if you use signs        1 5    will move your selection 1 5 seconds backwards In time     In text mode      Edit the Time column  by right clicking with the mouse or press the XY  encoder       The movement will be relative if you use the signs  otherwise it will be absolute     Editing an Event   You can only edit an already existing event  see Adding Events     Editing an event means to change its data  If you want to change its time  look for MOVING EVENTS   Graphically with the mouse      Right click on an event and the Edit menu appears according to the type of the event    With the event encoder in the bar      Select current event with the track and event encoder      Then press the event encoder  Edit menus will appear    In text mode      Scroll to the event that you are looking for      Edit the appropriate column by right clicking or pressing on the XY encoder  The parameter column is only  editable for GOTO commands and for fader events    Special fast edit for fader events in graphic mode      This method is not exact enough for speeds  but for master fader events it is recommended      Click with the middle mouse key on an event and keep the mouse key pressed      Drag the mouse vertically with middle mouse key pressed  The value of the fader event will now follow     148 MA    LIGHTING    MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    
325. n name marked in the Fixture          Feature   short  Choose the Feature  Gobo         Short  same function as of NEXT key on the console    long  Pull down menu       for Cursor Scroll     scrolling in the Sheet when name is marked  frame around the name blinks     press  OPTIONS will be displayed    for Cursor Values  name must be marked and frame around the Feature blinks        changes the values of the chosen parameter       only with activated    Change Parameter    in the Button menu   gt    with feature PAN TILT change values in PAN and TILT    with other features change values of the right neighboured parameter     press  to the next parameter  e g  Color1  Color 2        Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 gad MA 213             eet F i  Fe  displays the current Sheet  GMA Remote   Gheet   toggle  Fixture Sheet   Fader Sheet   Channel Sheet  PAAGA E     short  Selection  Only      short  toggle between scroll   value  long  cursor mode    Short  The figure indicates  how many channels will be displayed in one  Columns  column  Enter a new number  x   x  and confirm with OK  saaa for Cursor Scroll      scrolling in the Sheet for Cursor Values  e   to change the values of the marked Dimmers           i Show I o  gt Preset      Aan Hoe mE       for marked name  frame around the name blinks         press  OPTIONS of the Dimmers will be displayed       a T eaa  displays the current Sheet  f
326. nd Dimmer groups     SEQUENCE  In this Pool  all the created Sequences are displayed  This way  assignments to Executors can be  made very quickly  Sequences can be renamed  copied and deleted from within this window as well  See   ASSIGN menu     EFFECTS  Displaying and Calling up Effects  See Effects     FORMS  In this POOL  all created forms will be displayed  Here  you can rename  copy or delete forms  See   Creating and Storing Virtual Forms  EDIT FORM S      MACROS  In this Pool  all the created M acros are displayed  It is also possible to store new macros and edit    MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn             Pesk HEP ideo Remote HEP      w 0 0 0    At the bottom of Desk Status Menu the NETWORK MASTER shows all   stations in the network    Numbers show the stations in this session  numbers in    show the   stations in this session prior to a change failure  the buttons are always   red or yellow     Colors    Green   OK  number of stations within the session is displayed    Yellow   anew station has joined the session  After confirming  touch  on this button  this button changes into green color  OK     Red   Failure  After confirming  touch on this button  this button  changes into green color  OK  or this button changes into grey color  and displays    0     no station of this type is in this session  or this  button stays red  the station is still misssing     existing ones from within this window  See M acros and QUIKEY  
327. nd HA 209      fi    i a    GMA Remote    Name    Pan    r   n  i     a        a   E  E  i ii    a     2  j pa  i   f  i oa     a     ri    mr    210 MA    LIGHTING    Y gt  q   10 38 Ok    Panz Tilt       Toolbar    Refresh   Using more than one remotes can cause bad screen display  parts of the menue are missing   Press REFRESH    SCREEN to actuate the screen    Available Desks    toggle  see the available desks or the standard menu    red cross  desk is available  green hook  desk is connected     Chat  Menu   menu to send messages to desks user in the net    close the menu with    HELP  Menu   Information for button  and cursor functions    close the menu with    INFO  Menu   Information about software   version     Close menu with    Buttons    Here you can adjust the hold  down time for some hard  and softkeys   Here you can swith on off the horizontal cursor buttons during the value setting  The cursor left right can adjust  the next parameter e g  if in COLRM IX the parameter CM 1 is set the vertical Cursor adjusts CM 1  the horizontal  Cursor may adjust  this setting  CM 2    Chat    set the acoustic signal on off   Current IPs    shows the actual IP  address of this pocketPC   Shortcuts    Switch on the shortcut options     Disable  without chek mark    shortcuts are disabled    Enable  with check mark   shortcuts can be switched on and off     Close menu with    Shortcuts   If shortcut   option ison ENABLED   activate shortcuts with this button  bright background  
328. nd selecting ALL  the activation will be ignored and the complete console output stored  Function as a cue   Timing   Fade times  FADE  and Delays  DELAY   The grandMA offers two different ways of storing time settings for a cue   1  BASIC X  FADE and SNAP DELAY  With STORE  a basic fade time can be set for all typical fader channels  whereas SNAP DELAY will only work for  channels marked as snap channels in the Patch menu   2  TIME key for individual durations per channel  With TIME  the status windows can be switched to the FADE or DELAY layer  where individual fade and delay times  can be set for each channel  These durations will be stored in the cues and will overrule any basic duration   Create List  When storing a cue to an Executor already containing a cue  the grandMA offers the option to create a second cue  and start a cue list  which may be replayed as a Chaser or sequence later on        Exec 1 11 Seg      Seq T         Button and Fader Assignment     Playback Options      Swop  Protect            Kull  Protect           Normal  trigger        77          Auto  PrePos                  Track  From Last _    Restart with  first cue     P           Normal     zF           Size of Executor       nionty Options  Normal Eievate       Effects             _ gogg                Perault kulon ane Fader Sevres   HBa BRIE N A E d In the ASSIGN menu  you can preset the Cue list as tracking or non tracking  respectively   Ee E gt  pern Eee   None    TRACKING CUELIST  typically
329. ndow Is active  title bar    Stage    is displayed in dark blue   you can modify the stage view by  turning or turning plus simultaneously pressing the Encoder    Setting the stage size   In the geometrical system of the grandM A  Stage window  or in the grandMA 3D  you can position objects in the  three  dimensional space    It is modelled on the geometrical system used in architecture  The X Y level is defined as base area  stage  and the  height as Z axis    To adjust the stage size      press Stage Setup      Click on the values and enter a value in the entry window   the values do always refer to the centre of the stage     By turning or turning and simultaneously pressing the Encoder  you can change the stage views      Close menu with X     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn          Positioning fixtures   You can only set the specific group selected in the Fixture Layer   it is not possible to select fixtures from the small  Stage window  To gain a better control  click on the small STAGE window  title bar turns dark blue  and change the    a ae ee ee stage view using the Encoder right of the Display  turn or turn and press the Encoder        in the FIXTURE LAYER  select the fixture type    inthe FIXTURES AND CHANNELS IN LAYER  select one or more fixtures    set the positions and targets of the fixtures using the 3 Encoders  shift linear on the x  y  and z axis  or    rotation around the x  y  and z axis    check out results in t
330. ne      Enter the number of first fixture or dimmer channel  using the numeric keypad      Now you can select the next fixture or dimmer channel to be selected by using the         key      The THRU key on the numeric keypad will select a range  All fixtures and dimmer channels from    to  including the last number entered      Using the         key  the fixture dimmer channel with the number you input will not be selected      Theselection can be confirmed with ENTER    The selected fixtures or channels will be displayed in the FIXTURE or CHANNEL window in yellow characters     Press the STORE key once  LED within the key is on   Using the touchscreen or left mouse click  select the  desired group key in the GROUP window on the display  The selected fixtures are now stored In this group  STORE  LED is off     You can now name this group using the keyboard  Enter the name or description and confirm with ENTER    Press the CLEAR key once  This deselects the group of fixtures and dimmer channels    For further groups  simply repeat the process     Delete Groups    press DELETE button    press groupbutton of relevant group    2 11 Creating presets  effects and group keys automatically    3 3 2 Calling up groups    Groups can be called up by     A left mouse click    Direct touch on screen    MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn      Pressing the GROUP key once  entering the group number with the keyboard or keypad and confirming with  ENTER  
331. ne or two  commands  separated by a semi  colon   Now  you can enter a command using the text keyboard  If you want to  use a Delay time when performing a command  click in the cell  enter a time using the keyboard  and confirm  with ENTER   7   To delete a command  select one of the lines and press the DELETE LINE S  key     To modify a command  select one and press the EDIT LINE key  Now  you can enter a new command      f you want to modify the Delay time  click into the cell  enter a different time using the keyboard  and  confirm with ENTER     Pressing the EDIT MACRO NAME will open the EDIT NAME window  Now  you can enter a new name using the  keyboard and confirm this with ENTER   If the TIMED  MARCRO  key is switched on  the calls of this M acro will be executed with the set DELAY times                             LINE COMMAND l DELAY Pressing this key once will switch the display to MACRO NOT TIMED  In the Sheet  the DELAY times will be  ies ea displayed on a dark background  and the M acro will be executed without delay times   Ss Off Exec 1 14  Go Exec 115   s   You can leave the menu with the CLOSE key     Second command  possible in one line when separated  by a semi colon    Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand A199    9 2 Assigning and Activating QUIKEYS   You can display and call up various keys  commands and functions using the  QUIKEY pool  Display Softkeys       Create a Q
332. need these functions   when components malfunction lt  you would not use them during normal operation     F1 SCREENSHOT  without figure   To transfer screeshots to a PC using FTP    F2 TASKDISPLAY  Here  important operational data are displayed for service engineers     F3 RIGHT TOUCH SCREEN TO RIGHT EXTERNAL SCREEN  not on the MICRO    To transfer the contents of the right screen to an external monitor  Some menus  e g  SETUP  will only be displayed  on the right screen lt  if this screen fails  you can use F3 to switch to an external monitor  You can then operate the  menus using the mouse     F4 UPDATE  To update the software  if the SETUP menu cannot be accessed  e g  after a cancelled update   Here you can update  the software of the console  the library and the processor   not for MICRO      F7 COMMAND WINDOW  Here you find the most important buttons as softkeys  Will especially be useful  e g  when operating the  ReplayUnit     F9 SWITCH OFF ALL TOUCHSCREENS  To switch off all touch screens  If e g  a screen is blocked by a failure so that you can make no entries After  Switching off  you can only proceed using the mouse     Special functions  grandMA1 Software with grandM A2  Hardware  Compatibility mode     Shows  created on a grandM A1 console  can be played in the compatibility mode on the grandM A2 console  but with some limitation in operating  This mode also allows to run grandM A1  and grandM A2 consoles within the same session     Start up in GM1 mode      swi
333. new name above the selected line      Delete Line  you can delete the selected name  i e  the complete line      Percent Values  you can display the table values as percentages  By pressing the button  you can switch to   decimal or hexadecimal display      to leave this menu  The settings will only take effect and be saved after leaving the Full Access menu and  pressing the SAVE button     Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand MA  33    Select Fade Path    Name  NL Normal Low  NO Normal Over  N Hi    LH Low High  LL Low Low  LO Low Over  ON Over Normal  OH Over High  OL Over Low  00 Over Over                LIGHTING    Entering Names and Values   The Attribute  for which names and values can be entered  is displayed in the title bar or above the right Encoder   below the Display  To select another one  rotate the Encoder  until the desired Attribute is displayed    The first column contains the name  for Color e g   Color1   Click on this name and change it  if needed  e g   Close    Red          In the Range column  0 00    100 00  is displayed  Using the second and third Encoder  you can enter the   starting and end values for this name  Channel Values   By pressing the Percent Values buttons  you can switch to   decimal or hexadecimal display    For further names and values  repeat these two steps  using the next lines  respectively    Examples    Here are some examples for standard func
334. ng VIEW Assignments  Select a VIEW with the VIEW key on the side of the numeric keypad  via the   Touchscreen or a left mouse click    Deleting a VIEW  Press the VIEW key  LED is on   The SELECT VIEW window appears  now select the window to   be deleted  The VIEW Name will be maintained  but without any contents  All assignments to VIEW keys are now   deleted    Deleting a MACRO  Press the MACRO key  LED is on   The SELECT MACRO window appears  now select the   macro to be deleted  The MACRO Name will be maintained  but witout any contents  All assignments to MACRO   keys are now deleted    Deleting an EXECUTOR  Press the desired EXECUTOR key    Or    Deleting the EXECUTOR on the current page      Press the EXECUTOR button next to the numeric keypad  LED is on   Enter the EXECUTOR number via the  numeric keypad and confirm with ENTER    Deleting the EXECUTOR on another page      Press the EXECUTOR button next to the numeric keypad  LED is on   Now  enter the PAGE number    Then  press the full stop key and the number of the EXECUTOR and confirm with ENTER    Example  EXECUTOR 5 on PAGE 3 is to be deleted    Entry   DELETE key   EXECUTOR button   3       5   ENTER    Or       Press the EXECUTOR button next to the numeric keypad  LED is on   Enter the EXECUTOR number via the  numeric keypad     Press the PAGE key next to the numeric keypad  LED is on   Enter the PAGE number via the numeric keypad and  confirm with ENTER   Deleting Sequences  Press the SEQUENCE key  Enter the nu
335. nitors on it    or   You can store a Macro  See Creating M acros     Organize a display or monitor  See CREATING A WINDOW     Press the STORE key once  STORE LED is on       Press a VIEW key or a VIEW soft key once  The SELECT VIEW window will open      Enter a name for the VIEW using the keyboard  The new name will be displayed in the top line      By pressing the keys 1 5  selected key will turn dark  grey   you can select the display to be stored      Pressing the key ALL SCREENS will store ALL displays on one view key      With the OK or ENTER Key you can complete the store and assign process     3 2 1Assigning VIEWS   All created views can by assigned to any view key    Click on the view key with the right mouse key  The window SELECT VIEW will appear  In this window  make a left  click on the VIEW you require       The table shows all created VIEWS      The QTY column shows the number of stored displays and external monitors for the individual VIEWS     Scrolling is possible by dragging the scrollbar on the right side      Selecting a VIEW in the table will assign this view to the chosen key     3 2 2View Pool    In the View Pool  all created Views are displayed and can be called up directly by selection         Fixtures  YWalues Cet Auto    Auto  sorted by Numbers    Cals      Name Pan Tilt Dimmer Gobol Colori Focus  Pan Tilt Dim Gi Rot Cl Frozt Focus  1  S300 1 GD 40 iz 50   2     5L300 2  60 Ji   3    813003   60  a     SL300 4   60       SL300 5                     
336. nnection but no additional  components can be added to this connection type later on           grandM A Master slave configuration with 10 Base T    crossed    cable                            Tan tt tit i i Ss eee   isapan aan The console s  can only work on one transceiver type at a time   when the 10 Base  2 port is in use anything  IAN    connected to the 10 Base T outlet is ignored and vice versa  If you want to connect more consoles at one time   or the use of a ArtNet DM X  Node is required a 10 100 Base  T EtherN et  switch must be installed    Also for security reasons on longer cable runs or branched wiring a 10 100 Base T switch is strongly   recommended  like a DM X  booster on larger DM X  networks     The following example shows a network configuration with two identical consoles and an ArtNet DM X  Node for   DM X changeover and distribution  All components are star  wired from a central EtherNet hub using standard 10    100 Base T cabling                HE sa it TH sess Hast                                 eae grandMA Master slave configuration with 10 100 Base  T Switch and ArtNet DM X  Node    5 E                    2 j 0o00 OOOS  lemmas  D D D e D e e e O  EE                treet tests     ipana Peon                      When deciding for a Switch  please make sure that its Cache is as big as possible     Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand A203    ae MA Network   Console
337. nsole  At 19    x 17    x 5     it requires a very little space  while offering 100   compatibility with the larger consoles    The grandMA Replay Unit is designed to perform as a stand alone show controller on exhibitions  in theme parks or  other venues  In conjunction with one of the grandM A consoles  it also becomes a very powerful backup system  capable of running an entire show in full tracking backup mode despite its reduced hardware     Floppy Key   Quick and easy loading of a show from floppy disk  This key complies with the following steps on the grandM A      Backup  Load Floppy     If monitor and mouse are connected  you can follow the instructions in chapter 11  Saving or loading a SHOW  Without these  you would proceed as follows  Confirm  if you wish to save the actual  show on the internal harddisk in advance by pressing the page keys   key no  1 to 3    Key no  1  Save actual show on harddisk before loading show from floppy    Key no  2  Do not save on harddisk before loading show from floppy    Key no  3  Cancels the actual load task    Without a floppy disk inserted  you will get an error message on the display  Confirm with key no  1    This procedure is also valid for many other    Pop Up menus    of the grandMA     Floppy Drive    The floppy drive will take all 3 5    1 44M B HD disks and will serve to save shows or single fixtures from the library     Off Key   The    Off Key    has the same function as the    Off Key    on the grandMA  Together with t
338. nter values directly into the modulator columns       Modulator Table  here you find the entered functions  e g  SIN  SWING  etc      Modulator Size  here you find the entered size of a function  ranging from   200 to 200    Modulator Speed  here you find the entered function speed     Modulator Phase  here you find the entered angle to shift the effect    The TOP   button in combination with a target  will synchronize the effect modulators     3 4 5 Deactivating values individually  Knock out    Before storing  it is possible to select which parameters of which fixtures are to be stored  Values that are to be  stored are indicated by a red background or by red numbers    By default  parameters within functions are partly activated together  See Encoder  Activation  Grouping   In order to split the activation for a function  press Edit key and touch on the set activation  red background   before storing it       press EDIT    choose function in Fixture Sheet    This will open the input window   The title bar will display the chosen function  Attribute      Pressing the Deactivate button will cancel the activation of this function     tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand ITA 65    D Fixture Sheet Values  amp  Presets sorted by Numb    Pan Tit   Dimmer Gobo Gob  Pan Tilt LOU CRRRS Cs ee G1 Ac G2    Fixture Option    F PAN Normal     l     j Pa    Id  a  Em  A  S   6    B    a        J4    as    T6    q8    q3    2
339. o save the new preset to an empty button in the Preset Pool   mind the preset filter setting  The      black frame around the new preset indicates an Embedded Preset   value 1 Example     activate Preset 1 and save it with an additional value as Preset 2  In the Preset Pool  Preset 2 will be displayed    with a black frame indicating an Embedded Preset  Create Preset 3 in the same way  If you change Preset 1  this  will automatically change Presets 2 and 3     Editing an Embedded Preset    Link zu value 2   press EDIT   value 1   call up a preset   in the Fixture Sheet  all Embedded Presets will now be displayed with a black frame    make your changes            press UPDATE and confirm with OK   If you change the values of all Embedded Presets  they will become a    normal    preset after an update  If an  Embedded Preset or a part of an Embedded Preset  e g  only the PAN channel  is kept  the character of the  Embedded Preset will also be kept     o Preventing changes by previous Presets   e link zu value 3   call up the Embedded Preset  value 1   press STORE  red LED is on       press the button of the Preset and confirm with OVERWRITE  The black frame around the Preset will vanish and the link to the Embedded Preset will be cancelled   Example             Activate and save Preset 3  The link to value 1 will be cancelled  value 1 will be entered in Preset 4  the black    Wale l frame in the Preset Pool will vanish   If you now change Preset 1  Preset 3 will remain unchange
340. obo1 G1    G1 Rot    Colori a       64 MIA       LIGHTING       3 4 3 FADE and DELAY times in the FIXTURE window   Additionally to the standard  Basic  FADE and DELAY times  individual durations can also be set for the indivi   dual parameters in the FIXTURE window    You will need these settings when creating Cues  in order to be able to work with different FADE or DELAY times  for individual parameters      Press the Values Fades Delays key as displayed above in the    Fades    picture    oder      When you press the TIME key once  the fixture sheet will switch to FADE time mode           Thesecond time  the fixture sheet will switch to DELAY time mode       If in the windows options Automatic has not been selected  the display will not switch over  The currently   selected FADE or DELAY function will be displayed only for the Encoder labels  See Options in the Fixture window   Choose a function  where you wish to program a time  other than the Basic time    Now you can modify the IND  FADE time or IND  DELAY time  individual Fade Delay Times  for the selected fixtures   using the encoders  While modifying  you can use different options    Choosing options    Above the left Encoder  a second additional button with the currently chosen option will be displayed    By pressing this button  you can select the respective next option    Or    By pressing the right arrow  a menu will open  in which all options are displayed and can be chosen directly      Single  For Active   The 
341. odifications that can be set is from  360   to  360                                  i Off      Input Panai a to 36P Su   Before modifying the value of a size  select the Effect first  Press the OFFSET key once  green background   Now     you can set a different Offset using the Encoder below  Clicking the Encoder once will automatically set the  value to 0  You can also use the ALIGN function to set this value  See ALIGN function     Rate  Display of the set ratio between the speed for this individual Effect as to that of the whole Effect Group   Possible settings range between 1 16 and 4 1  At a ratio of 1 16  the rate set for the Effect Group will be divided  by 16  If the setting is 4 1  the rate will be multiplied by four   Before modifying the ratio   s value  select the Effect first  Press the RATE FACTOR key once  green background    Now  you can set a different ratio using the Encoder below  Clicking the Encoder once will automatically set the  value to 1 1      Grp  Group   Display of the set number  by which the assigned Fixtures or Dimmers will be divided  In the  subdivided groups  the Effect will then fully be executed   Before modifying the subdivision value  select the Effect first  Press the GROUPS key once  green background    Now  the subdivision of the Effect can be set using the Encoder below  Clicking the Encoder once will automati  cally delete the set value      Wing  The set number will indicate  how often the assigned Fixtures or Dimmers and the Effe
342. ols master in  amp  outfade  It is used when starting or switching off the running chase  With   the encoder the    M aster Fade    can be set to    DEFAULT     In this position the predefined M  Fade from the menu   setup defaults playback timing will be used    Encoder functions of page 2    SPEED GROUP  Link chase to a speed group or let it have individual speed    OUTFADE  Defines step by step OUTFADE time  With the encoder the OUTFADE can be set to always equal  INFADE    SNAPDELAY  Defines the trigger point for snapping channels in the chase     4 4 1Modifying values of separate Chaser steps     Select the Cue to be modified in the Names column  red cell       Press the Edit 7 key  LED in Edit key will blink       All values of the Cue will now be played back on stage and displayed  active  red  in  the Channel  amp  Fixture sheets      This cue can now be modified by either direct access or by presets  See Direct Access to Fixtures  in the FIXT   URE SHEET    Direct Access to Dimmer Channels  in the CHANNEL SHEET  and Creating and calling up Presets   If the Cue is not to be seen on stage  activate the Blind function by pressing the BLIND key  integrated LED is on      Press the UPDATE key once  Choose OK in the window that has just opened  The changed Cue is now stored     Press the CLEAR key twice  Cue values will be deleted in the FIXTURE or CHANNEL window     For modifying further Cues  select the respective Cue  Cue will be displayed on a green background     Repe
343. on  Backlight   Change Structure    cr ee Cae Full Left Middle Right Bright Defaults  Delete Fixtures etc  os  Access Touchscreen Options   4 p Date  Change Patch and Left Middle Right and Time  gt   Fixture Settings Live On On On  Live On Stage 2    Access External YGA Options  Display  Automatic Left System Right Language p  reation Auto Auto A Off   Auto a 7  of Presets  Groups   ops  and Effects os Click  amp  Beep  Settings  gt   Beep On  ry 5 Screensaver   pon MSGBOX mode      Encoder  amp  Fader Movement  bo  1 screen  3 843 Trackball Encoders  Push is  i oarse i st Update  Er Wid z Software p  l ide  pmt Executor Faders   Wheel On  4096 Layout _ Auto Additive _    SETUP  Menu grandMA   Light   UltraLight                With the respective keys  the touch screens can be switched on or off  It is possible that a fault may cause the  mouse to freeze in one position and can no longer be operated  In this case  the touchscreens can be switched  off  For this  use function key F9 on the keyboard    F9 will switch off all three touchscreens  emergency switch   To switch the touchscreens back on use the  mouse    To toggle the mouse function on both external monitors on and off  In AUTO mode  the software will recognize if  a monitor is connected or not and will switch the mouse function for the external monitors on or off  accordingly   OFF will not allow any mouse function  while ON will keep the mouse function activated at all times   With this key  the grandM A s internal
344. onitor  which have to be confirmed  as on the grandM A    NOTE  If these messages are not being respectively confirmed  you might not be able to continue in the process  If  monitor and mouse are connected  you can also confirm the messages with these tools    Power Supply   See Battery    Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 gad HALES    14 2 General Instructions   14 2 1 Differences between Replay Unit and the  grandMA or grandMA light   The Software is identical for all of the units  However tow 1 external monitor  can be connected  The UPS Functions as well as the 2048 4096 channels are  also fully supported as on the grandMA or grandM A light    Connectors for external keyboard  mouse and monitor are located on the rear of  the unit  these are not included as standard     Encoder  Trackerball  Wheel  more than 5 Executor Faders and 5 Executor But   tons as well as quite a few other keys on the grandMA and grandMA light are  not available with this unit  Nevertheless most of the functions  except for the  executors  can be reached and activated using the mouse and tow external  monitor     14 2 2 Working with Mouse  Keyboard and Monitor  With these tools almost all functions of the grandMA can be operated on this  unit  The 3 keys of the mouse will take on the functions of the keys on the  console  All required keys  such as CUE  COPY  NEXT  a s o   have to be set up as     Quikeys    in advan
345. onnect an external keyboard  too    The most effective way of working with the grandMA is to use the touchscreen and the encoders which are located  next to the respective displays  The only means to change the size of windows  work within the Tracking Sheet or edit  forms   though  is the mouse  or the Trackball  if the mouse function Is on     With the left key      Keys can directly be selected      Individual cells in charts can be selected      Several cells in charts can be selected simultaneously by clicking  holding and dragging them      Fixtures or Channels can be selected      Title bars of windows can be activated or options for the individual window can directly be called up    With the middle key      The values of selected Fixtures or Channels can be adjusted    With the right key      The options for this window can be opened by clicking on the title bar      The options can be opened by clicking on an individual Fixture or Channel     OOPS Function    By pressing the OOPS key  you can undo  step back  the last 20 operations    Holding the OOPS key opens a window showing the 10 last entries on the right TFT display  Pressing the UNDO key will  cancel the first entry on top of the list    Note  Please  switch off the Oops function in loud environments  as otherwise  the built in harddisk may not function  properly    Entry window Calculator   Open by pressing on one of the 4 Encoders below the display or clicking on the Buttons above the Encoders    Or    Click
346. ons  e g  horizontal shift or rotation     Enter preset values   if TOGGLE is active   is green  you can combine multiple settings     ROTATE RIGHT will insert    0     360    into the Rotation column     ROTATE LEFT will insert    360      into the Rotation column      SCROLL LEFT will insert   5 0   5 0    into the OFFSET X column    SCROLL RIGHT will insert    5 0    5 0    into the OFFSET X column      ZOOM IN will insert the    100    50     into the SCALE X and SCALE Y columns     ZOOM OUT will insert the    100    200     into the SCALE X and SCALE Y columns  or   Enter individual values       click on the cell in the respective column and open it by pressing on the Encoder  enter values and confirm with  ENTER      TABLE  here  you can select the effect     FROM TO  here  you can enter the starting and end points    PHASE  here  you can enter the angle to shift the effect     RATE stands for the ratio d      set ACT ON  depending on the setting and type of BITM AP  the buttons below are active  bright   values can be  entered  or inactive  dark   no modifications possible   The values allocated to the bitmap are marked by a violet bar  over the respective column in the Fixture or Channel Sheet       GREY  dimmer values are assigned to the graphics element    TRIGGER  presets are assigned to the graphics element    Preset 1   the preset is assigned to the graphics background    Preset 2   the preset Is assigned to the graphics    Background   the preset Is assigned to 
347. opy of the show   with AUTO SAVE  this  happens automatically  In this way several 100 versions  of the show can quickly burden the hard disk    Delete superfluous show versions and set the button to  ENUMERATE OFF  Store backup copies on floppy disc     This may mean that free memory is less than 50    Delete shows or backups to create free memory space   Networking In the UltraLight does not work any more  when more than 50  of memory is already used by the  show    Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 gand Hf 223    SERVICE   TIMETABLE    In order to guarantee the legendary reliability of our products over a long period of time  you should mind the service lives of some hardware components  These parts are heavily stressed  in continuous duty and are subject to normal wear and tear  By replacing these parts in time  you can avoid malfunctions in time critical situations  The replacement intervalls depend on    the stress and environmental conditions lt  the specifications listed below  are based on our experience data     Part Recommended replacement Delivery situation  in Europe   after   Battery 4 years 2 3 workdays    not ULand MICRO    Hard disk 3 5 years 2 3 workdays  should be in stock when using  not MICRO several devices    Touchscreen after mechanical damage 2 3 workdays   Encoder 2 3 years 2 3 workdays   M otor fader depending on env  situation 2 3 workdays    only grandMA and Light i
348. or 180   angles on the traverse   what do   have  to consider when using the PAN   TILT function     When loading a new show  from the hard disk    the console will freeze showing the message  REBOOTING   PLEASE WAIT  After resetting   using the yellow button on the rear side of the  console   the show will load     When starting a sequence  using the Executor  button or the Executor fader   the fixtures will  not light up on the stage  but the Channel  Sheet shows some values  nothing in the  STAGE window      When loading a show from floppy that had  been created on another console  no fixtures  will appear     are placed on moved positions  no or the wrong  channels will be triggered    Choose SETUP   FULL ACCESS   in FIXTURE LAYER  the group to which this fixture belongs  in the  menu below  you can find the starting number  of this fixture   it has to correspond to the  address adjustable on the fixture    e g  on the console B17   onthe fixture 017   If the fixture has 14 channels  the next fixture  must beginn with B31     Adapt the fixtures using the parameters X   Y   and Z in SETUP   FULL ACCESS   if needed  use  INVERT to adjust the sense of rotation of PAN  and TILT     It is highly probable that a software error has  occurred on the hard disk  Repairs should be  performed by a service technician  see hotline  contact on the bottom margin     Master open    Group master open    If in the Channel   Fader and Fixture Sheet the  ID numbers or the names have a blue  b
349. or deactivate    shortcuts  dark background      MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    ga  A d    GMA Remote    ng  INCE    D F      m         a    Jackgrd   Tools   Setup   Backup M   wPoo  BiFa  f ced Fro    cad Fi    ced 12  A    Mormal    Follow etuip    Fo Me 10 38 lok    Sort By   _ anc i  Readout f  Fre   I Name   Pan Tilt   Pan         5L300 188 _     en   3   sT  URAANSA i  i  r p r     LI  Cee A  ind Pa   7  AAT Te a Fi        Tilt             Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com     COMMAND 1   COMMAND 2   Both menues contain the same buttons asthe COM M AND WINDOW on the grandM A console  The limited space  makes necessary to devide the menueto COMMAND 1 and COMMAND 2    Open COMMAND Window     Press  long  Button   Every time you press this button long    the view toggles between COMMAND 1 and  COM M AND2     For some inputs you have to change the views  Press the above button to toggle between the both COM M AND  windows  The command line stays in both windows      Shortcuts   If you use a hardware keyboard with the remote  software on the PDA  you can use shortcuts for better access   The shortcuts corresponds to the shortcuts of the grandM A  onPC  software  picture left displays a part of  grandM A  onPC screen  shortcuts are written in brackets          inthe button menu  tas inthe Toolbar  choose    Shortcuts       choose    Enable    and close menu     Activate Shortcuts in the toolbar  button has light b
350. or possible special functions in the future    Reset Key   This key stands for a    hard    reset  This key is only required in the unlikley event of the console freezing or  crashing  The same key is located once again on the rear panel    Executor Buttons   There are 5 Executor Buttons  no  6 to 10  available  as on the grandM A   These buttons correspond with the  Executor Buttons no  21 to 25 on the grandMA  Buttons no  26 to 40  no  16 to 20 on the grandMA light  are not  available  This becomes particularly important when programming the show on the grandMA and    running    the  show afterwards on the Replay Unit    Executor Fader Page Up   Key no  1   This key has 2 functions    Switching pages for the Executor Faders  Page up    Confirm key no  1  the respective command appears as running text on the display    Executor Fader Page Down   Key no  2   This key has 2 functions    Switching pages for the Executor Faders  Page down    Confirm key no  2  the respective command appears as running text on the display    Executor Key Page Up   Key no  3   This key has 2 functions    Switching pages for the Executor Keys  Page up    Confirm key no  3  the respective command appears as running text on the display    Executor Key Page Down   Key no  4   This key has 2 functions    Switching pages for the Executor Keys  Page down    Confirm key no  4  the respective command appears as running text on the display    Display   Pop up messages will appear on the display of the TFT m
351. orld Filte 53   World pool 197   Worlds 55  197   WRAP 74   Wrap 74    X    X axis 35   XF A B 107  XFADE 107   XYZ SUPPORT 31    Y  Yellow dot 66    
352. ossfade is not active  you can fade out to the next Cue and to the brightening Dimmer channels when   pushing the fader upwards or downwards      Empty  Fader has no function     Choose Button Function   Rate  Using the Fader  you can change all fade and delay times for sequences  If the fader is at 50   all times                  Empty Norr will be executed in the normal way  Using the RATE 1 button  you can automatically set the Fader back to  Eir trig the 50  position   Bla   MFade  This fader controls master in  amp  outfade in a range from 0 to 10 seconds  It is used when starting or  Out hil Switching off the running chase  With the encoder the    master fade    can be set to    DEFAULT    In this  Toggle ney position the predefined M Fade from the menu setup defaults playback timing will be used   Off Fix   Temp  Use the Fader to temporarily fade in the first Cue step   then  the previous status will be restored  similar  Se to the    Temp    key   a Swop   By a touch on the respective KEY symbol  a selection will appear in which any button can be allocated with diffe   pa rent functions   a siiki   Go  The cue will be played back with all programmed FADE and DELAY times   Temp Ki   Go    For sequences  the previous cue is played back and all changes are executed  full tracking  using all  a Top a programmed FADE and DELAY times  For Chasers  the running direction will be reversed   E i       f    Pause  A running cue or a Chaser will be temporarily stopped  To continu
353. ot the number    0    As soon as  the installation is completed  the display will show UPDATE DONE next to STATUS   You can start the console by pressing the    ESC    key twice     Press 2  Delete grandMA operating system   Upon every update  a safety copy of the system will be automatically created on  harddisk  In order to delete an older system from harddisk  press    2    on the keyboard   You will see a list with all systems existing on the harddisk  By pressing one of the  displayed keys  a  b  c     the respective system will be deleted  You have to confirm  the delete process by pressing    o    VERY IMPORTANT   this is the letter     o  not the number    0     After deletion is completed  the display will show  DELETE DONE next to STATUS  You can start the console by pressing the    ESC    key  two times     Press 3 Delete  old  grandMA shows    Upon every update  a new folder for the shows will automatically be created   to cleanup the harddrive on the harddisk  During every update  the console will save  all old shows  converted to suite the new system software  in the youngest folder   From the time of the update  all new created shows will be automatically saved in  this folder  too    In order to delete shows from an older system version from the harddisk  press    3     on the keyboard  You will see a list with all shows in all system versions existing on  this harddisk  By pressing one of the displayed Keys  a  b  c     the respective shows  will be deleted  
354. ou just want to store some Scanner attributes  you can activate these by double clicking on them  these  Attributes will be displayed in red for the selected Scanners     Press the STORE key shortly      By clicking a button in the World pool  the World will be stored and operational  You can also give it a name  directly by using the keyboard    If not all Attributes are stored in a World  this will be indicated by a small red triangle in the left upper  corner of the appropriate button     Working with Worlds   For the programming  creating the Show   Worlds are a great deal of help when it comes to creating Cues  If  you select a World  only the assigned Scanner and Dimmer channels will be displayed  ready to be modified and  stored    NOTE  Starting a console will always reload the last setting  if a World was active when the console was shut down  last time  only this World will be displayed on the next start  In the stage window  only fixtures of this World can be  seen   in the stage window  however  under SETUP  all registered fixtures can be found     If you are in a network session that means that different users  units  can use different or overlapping Worlds   Call up a World by clicking on it  will be displayed in dark green    CONTROL shows  if you have full control over the selected World  green  or just a partial Playback control  yellow     Full World  By pressing the Full button  all existing Scanner and Dimmer channels will be displayed again   complete Wor
355. ouble triggers  for  example  with fast BASSDRUM beats   Beats will be automatically recognized via the incoming sound signal  BPM       Press TOOLS      Press Button Sound Settings to open the menu    To set an equalizer  pull the respective    slider    to the desired position  In the left lower corner  there is a visual  trigger signal  monitor  for your orientation  The small dot on the left side of the HOLD Function will indicate the  remaining HOLD time  The small dot on the left side of the GAIN indicator will show the compression rate of the  audio signal    The right small dot will indicate the state of compression of the audio signal  The sound signal is visualized in the  lower left part of the display  The analysis of the sound signal will be indicated in the smaller right part of the  window  including indication of the recognised BPM  Beats per minute   By moving the BPM slider  the beat can be  set  The next  possible beat will be recognised from the incoming audio signal and will be used to control the BPM   If the BPM key is ON  the currently recognised beat will be used  When switching the BPM to OFF  the last  recognised beat at the time will remain unchanged and will be used  You can adjust the value using the BPM slider   If the Auto Stop key is on ON  the Chase or the effect will be stopped when there is no sound signal  If the Auto  Fader key is also on ON  the Chase or the effect will be faded out when there is no sound signal    When you switch the Au
356. ow  on the right  are displayed     Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 gand HALBS      with MATCH  all overlapping channels are displayed  you must choose  which fixtures to overwrite in the current  Setup  Overwriting objects  even partially  in the current Setup  can affect the whole show   after starting the  Operation with 2x OK  the modification cannot be undone any more  If you do select none  the fixtures of the  current Show are kept  the fixtures in the left half of the menu keep their green background        with NO MATCH  you find all fixtures that do not overlap  i e  that can be taken over without having been    selected   The Imaps on the left side  current setup  also can be selected  they will be deleted from current setup     NEW here lamps are displayed  you are importing from loaded show into the current show  color has changed  from grey to green     IGNORED here lamps are displayed  you will not import into the current setup  lamps in the right part  color  stays grey  or lamps  which are deleted from the current show  lamps in the left part  color has changed from  green to grey     select the fixtures and press on the Encoder next to the screen   the colors of the selected fixtures will  change     or    Choose Wizzard Select in the WIZARD   No New Devices  Default       NO NEW DEVICES   DEFAULT  will always be executed  If no other change was entered  Here  you cannot   i
357. page is one set of visible executors    A memory that can be used Indirectly as a placeholder    A sequence consists of one or more cues    A timecode show consists of many timed playback instructions for executors  Can be  synchronised with incoming SM PTE or MIDI signals    A Remote triggered by hardwired analogue 0 10 V Inputs   Stores a display arrangement    A physical button that can call views and macros     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelorunn    Helping keywords  Helping keywords are context sensitive and thus have different functions depending on where they are used and  what they are used with     Keyword Used         Everywhere         Everywhere       AT  helping form  by COPY M OVE etc    DELAY In executing commands  AT  STORE etc  FADE In executing commands  AT STORE etc  FULL As value 100     IF In selections   THRU In ranges   UNPRESS After executing keywords    Immediate Keywords  These keywords expect no additional parameters     Keyword Operation   ALL Restores selection after ODD EVEN NEXT PREVIOUS   CLEAR Progressively clear the programmer    CLEAR ACTIVE Clear the values in the programmer    CLEAR ALL Totally clear programmer at once    CLEAR SELECTION Clear the current selection    DEF GO Go forward for default executor   DEF GO  Go back for default executor   DEF PAUSE Pause the default executor    ESC Escape from input or menu    EVEN Select even devices inside current selection    NEXT Select next device inside c
358. pages earlier  Creating  patching  and positioning groups with Scanners Dimmers    Adding new fixtures     Select    New     dark blue  and shortly press the Encoder  right to the Display     The    Create New Fixtures or Channels  window will open      Now  choose    From Library    Proceed as indicated 3 pages earlier  Creating  patching and positioning groups  with Scanners Dimmers    Exchanging fixtures     Select the fixtures to be exchanged in the    Type    column  dark blue   You can also select several or all  fixtures       Shortly press the Encoder  right to the Display   The    Choose Fixturetype    window will open      Select a fixture that was already present in the show by turning the Encoder  and accept it by shortly  pressing on the Encoder  The fixture still has to be patched    or      Select    From Library    for a new fixture  and shortly press on the Encoder  Proceed as indicated 3 pages  earlier  Creating  patching and positioning groups with Scanners Dimmers     Multipatch  assigning one DM X channel for multiple fixtures dimmers    M akes sense  if several fixtures are always to be triggered at the same time  but cannot be dimmed individually    To do so  you make a arbitrary number of    copies    of a fixture      select the fixture that you want to    copy        press Create Multipatch      in the entry window  enter the number of fixtures to be triggered by the same DM X channel  In the fixtures list  you will now find the copies below the fixt
359. position  a new event will appear and now you are ready to edit the event    When you are adding events on an executor command track  the timecode editor will try and predict the most  likely command at that particular point in the track    For example if you have an executor with a sequence  containing 3 steps  and you simply add one event after the  other  it is assuming    GOTO STEP1   GOTO STEP2   GOTO STEP3   OFF   Or if you are adding a new event after a FLASH UP ON command  it will predict the new event as FLASH UP OFF   For chaser  the editor never predicts GOTOs  instead it uses conventional Gos  The editor is also assumes  that you  only want to switch the chase on  and then off again  regardless of how many steps the chase has     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    Attention  mouse users    Please be aware that if you have chosen the ADD mouse tool  this tool stays active  So wherever you click with  the mouse   something will be added  If you switch on    always reset mouse tool    in the options menu  the risk of  accidentally adding something is reduced    Selecting Events   Events can be SELECTED individually  A selected event is displayed in red  All selected events together are called  the selection  You can MOVE  DELETE or COPY this selection    Selecting with the mouse in graphic mode      Choose the SELECT mouse tool  The cursor will show a selection frame      Left mouse click somewhere In a track  Keep mouse key 
360. pressed  and drag a frame      Upon release of the mouse key  all events inside the frame are selected    Selection with the mouse in text mode      Left mouse click somewhere in the list  Keep mouse key pressed  and drag vertically a frame      Upon release of the mouse key  all text lines  events  inside the frame are selected    With the CREATE SELECTION function      Press the CREATE SELECTION key  the CREATE SELECTION menu appears      Choose to either make a selection on the current  green  track only  or on all selected tracks      Choose one of the three commands     A BEFORETIME Events that are before the current time will be selected      B  ALL All events on given tracks will be selected     C  AFTER TIME Events that are after the current time will be selected    Selecting the Current Event   Only one event can be defined as the current event  In the graphic mode  this event will blink  In text mode  this  text line  event  will be yellow  Its position is shown in the timecode control bar    You can select the current event one way or the other    Graphically with the mouse      Choose the SELECT mouse tool      Make a selection that contains only one event  or click only on one event    With the encoders in the bar      Select the track with the track encoder  second one       Select the event with the event encoder  third one     With the XY encoder in text mode      Simply scroll through the list    Deleting Events   Graphically with the mouse      Select the DE
361. put  amp  Autofocus Enabled    Connection ID   1 32   1    40 MA    LIGHTING    DMX via Ethernet    If the Node is activated after having opened the menu  you can look for the Node by pressing the Scan for  Nodes button to be displayed in the table    In the left table  all found DM X outputs are indicated by a number  These are the assigned xDM X slots  PATHPORT    Node Configuration  next page   The outputs can be distinguished by these numbers    Select an address for the DM X output    In the right table  one line is displayed for each Node  The selected DM X output will be indicated by a green  background    If an output is indicated by a red background  this means that it is already assigned and cannot be used    If you press the Identify by Backlight button  the background lighting of the Display will blink    Pressing the Save button will save the changes    Press the X button  Now  the converter for this DM X port is configured and the menu will be closed    If additional ports are to be assigned  repeat all steps as indicated  After all settings have been made  press the SAVE  button in the DM X  OUTPUT CONFIGURATION menu  The changes made will be saved then  On the assigned  Ethernet  DM X converter  Active will be displayed for the assigned DM X outputs and inputs     PATHPORT   Node Configuration    First  choose a DM X converter to be adjusted in the table    By pressing the Edit Nodes button  open the menu for this DM X converter    The data will be read from t
362. r Selected Devices 88   ALL FULL 112   ALL OFF 131   ALLSCREENS 57   ALLOW EMBEDDED 76   ANGLE 132   ARC 132   ARRANGE IN CIRCLE 86   ARROW 132   Artistic Licence 39   AS  Adaptive Speed  128   ASCII  Format 44   ASSIGN 17  156  166   Assign Fader Button 108   ASSIGN menu 17  106   ASSIGN TIME 166   Assignments  deleting  151  152   AT 166    Attribut 30   ATTRIBUTE GROUPING 27   ATTRIBUTE MASK 62   ATTRIBUTE SETUP 27   Attribute Setup 27   ATTRIBUTE SORT 62   Attributes 28   AUTO 67   Auto Create 42   Auto Create Effects 44   AUTO FIX 110   AUTO GAIN 48   AUTO LOOP 101   Auto PrePos 111   AUTO SCROLL 116  118   AUTO SCROLL button 95   AUTO STOP 48   AUTO  SORT  Function 73   AUTO  SORT  Function   FIXTURE window 66   AUTO WRAP 74   AUTOBACKUP in a session  223   Autosave 46   AUTOSELECT  Timecode   142    Background Illumination  45  BACKUP 156  BASE 127  BASE VALUE 127  BASIC FADE 17  Battery 5  BeamAngle 30  BLACKOUT 9  47  BLIND 9  95  Blind Modus 82  BLOCK 118    Blue Buttons  pocket pc   216   Booting 15   BOUNCE 101  129   BPM 47  48  101  129   Break 30   Button  changing a 107   Button Page 119   Button Pages 55   BUTTONS OFF 121    C    Calculator 13  Calibrating Button 44  Change of Pages  within a  cue 100  CHANNEL 54  166  Channel expansion 37  CHANNELFADER 45  71  CHANNEL Mode 71  Channel Pages 55  Channel Start Id 19  CHANNELVALUES 33  Channel Values 33  CHANNEL window  colors  used for the screen  display  233  236  239  CHASE 124  Chase Fade 47  CHASER 115  C
363. r options  this is where global times can be changed   see EXECUTOR window     FADER  Selected dimmer channels can be displayed as either bar or figure within this window  Here you will also  have direct access to channels and values  See Accessing Dimmer Channels directly     FIXTURE  Displays all fixtures and their various functions  values  status etc  Here you will have direct access to  the fixtures  functions and values  See Accessing Fixtures directly     TRACKING  In this window you can display a Sequence that is assigned to an EXECUTOR fader or EXECUTOR button   Here  as opposed to the EXECUTOR Sheet  all values or times can be displayed separately for an entire sequence  Cues  are displayed vertically with channel and fixture data displayed horizontally  Any value time can be modified  separately for any channel  See TRACKING window     DMX  In this window  all DM X output channels are displayed as values  as they are actually patched  It is also  possible to perform drag and drop patching operations from within this window  See DM X Output window   CONTENT  This window can display a cue of a sequence with all values and times  It can display the current cue    the subsequent  or the previous cue    COM PACT CONTENT  The content is identical with the CONTENT window  more values can be displayed through   another mode of distribution         Pools      GROUPS  Displays  creates new  edits and calls up fixture and dimmer groups  See Creating and Calling up  Fixtures a
364. r values taking presedence over the earlier values   Latest Takes Presedence  LTP    In NON TRACKING mode values will return to their defaults unless they are specifcally given a value in that cue   Example  Cue 10 is made up of only the information in Cue 10  M odications to earlier cues will have no effect on  later cues  Essentially cues no longer have a relationship between each other  See TRACKING window       Private  Effects      _ aad    Default Button and Fader Assignment  Default Options    Normal    T       Haster       Edit  Load from p  default    Load from   Save as  default default    Apply to  all Exec                 Key A B or Split Xfade  If the    Split Xfade    key is pressed  displayed in dark   this function is active   item  5 1 3 Changing Faders  Fader XF A and XF B     Key Normal trigger If the    Normal Trigger    key is pressed  this Sequence Chaser will be execute with the  programmed triggers calls  Pressing this key  it will switch to    Trigger is GO     where after the Sequence Chaser can  only be controlled by the GO button and will ignore Follow  Sound and trigger times    LTP Dimmers key pressed  When playing back this sequence  dimmer channels programmed into this sequence  will override all other  LTP Dimmer  instances of these channels being played back  regardless of level  They will  overwrite all other dimmer channels of those Cues that were also called up in LTP mode  HTP Executors remain    110 MA    LIGHTING    MA Lighting Technolo
365. rame E Sheet   toggle  Fixture Sheet   Fader Sheet   Channel Sheet    Sheet   readout Only It Values   Short  Selection  i i i Only    Short  toggle between scroll   value  long  cursor mode    f short  shows name of Channel orFader  olumns    sas for Cursor Scroll     scrolling in the Sheet for Cursor Values     as to change the values of the marked Dimmers          AT EE zor  gt Preset    EREE E         for marked name  frame around the name blinks     press  OPTIONS will be displayed    MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn       214 MA    LIGHTING          Executer   Edit                           Input Default AT Level    Input Range      Technischer Service     E toggle   Run Run   Edit                                                    Ho   Name   Trig   1 1 Cue3s 3s   Os Erreuma long   Eee a l    Seq 1    to select the Executor  4 4Cue3s 3s  Os   a   5 5 Cues 3s    Os      i       Cues 3s   0s toggle    yo 7 Cue 3s s Os  Times   Loops    memes Changing values     press Edit Cue  ae   mark the relevant value with cursor      Center Press on Cursor    value input with the Calculator  confirm with ENTER    press Update    0 00 to 10000    SETUP    DUAL DIGIT VALUE ENTRY  Entries performed over the numeric block  have to be done in the  conventional way  entry 2_0 will yield a value of 20     SINGLE DIGIT VALUE ENTRY  Entries performed over the numeric block will be done in factors of ten   entry 2 will yield 20  0_5 will become 5  and 
366. rddisk does not only save a backup for the operating system  but leaves  enough space for countless shows with hundreds of sequences  Shows can  also be saved on disk for archive purposes or transfering to other grandMA  consoles  The floppy disk drive also allows you to update the software  which  can be downloaded from the MA Homepage  www malighting de  on the  internet     190 MA    LIGHTING    14 3 7 Setup Menu and Start Configuration    Basic configuration available on harddisk      Fixture library with more than 280 multifunctional fixtures      All fixtures and channels can be named individually      Free Softpatch with MIN  MAX and INVERT of all four DM X lines     Definition of new fixture types on screen     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    14 3 8 Display of output and data entry   Steps can include loops with counter or timer       Numeric dimmer channel listing     Channel fader symbols  a   14 3 14 Executor Faders and Buttons    Fixture parameter spreadsheets for status report on moving lights and dimmers  _ Executor faders and buttons with multiple assignment options    eau STEN EC aa tral apnonevelaie   Working mode of faders and buttons can be freely assigned     Optionally assignment of several executors for one single cue list     14 3 9 Selection and Data Input   A block of special function buttons can be applied to any executor     Selection via Group Keys with M ouse     Hold and Move Mode with middle mouse key
367. rds    If the new fixture has more features than the old one   these will not be accounted for    It is recommended to copy the show to another name  and test exchanging the fixture there    Under LOOPS   LINKS  possibly in a macro  too  only the    Group master moves on each page  even if the fader is fader number without page number has been entered      empty     or a group master moves  although it was not for the sequence   e g  fader 14 instead of 1 14  that is   Switched on  why fader 14 will be moved  disregarding the program  for this fader    In case of an  admittedly improbable  crash of the console  Best thing is to make use of the MA Lighting service    can   troubleshoot the cause  After the crash  reboot the console using the RESET    button  on the back of the console  or the POWER  switch  Have an empty floppy available  After booting   the following message will displayed        Please Confirm    Sawe log    Now you have 4 seconds to press the SAVE LOG TO  FLOPPY button  Insert the empty floppy and confirm  the next request with OK  It is advisable to email the  log file to our Service department     222 MA Lighting Technology GmbH    Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    LIGHTING    Question    Can   switch the console on and off using an powerline   integrated timer  to start a show automatically     Can   re  patch a fixture during a show  e g  because a  malfunction has occurred      Being in a specific sequence  can   start the cue of  another 
368. re completely embedded into the command line  So you can now start timecode show  number 5 from a macro     GOTO commands are supported and are used as the default when recording normal GOs  This means that the  timecode show Is referancing absolute cue numbers     Cue names and numbers are displayed in the timecode show     All kinds of executor fader movements are recordable  So you can now record the change of a chaser speed or a  manual crossfade     Automatic fader data reduction  reducing the amount of recorded fader movements dramatically and allowing  easier manual editing afterwards     Free choice of editing in graphic or text mode  Text mode supports filtering so that you can watch only the  executors that you want to     Blind programming     No restrictions to the number of timecode shows running at one time  memory permiting of course     No restrictions for    no mouse please  users     The timecode show can be fully edited with the encoders and or  the touchscreens     Timecode shows can be    write  protected    So if you only want to watch your show running  you will not  accidentally change something     Copy   Paste functions between different timecode shows is now possible  Timecode shows can be merged  together     Autostart feature for timecode shows  e g  the show will automatically load and run upon detection of the  correct SM PTE signal     Repeat function with definable number of repeats for timecode shows with internal synchronisation     Technisc
369. re than one key    By pressing the PAGE 1 key  you can open another page  PAGE 2  with keys     8 3 3 Deleting Assignments    To delete an assigned Playback key  press the DELETE key once  LED is on   Press the respective DM X IN key  once     8 3 4 Using the DMX Input   In the TOOLS menu  you can switch the DM X input function on or off using the ON   OFF key    If the DM X input is activated  you can use the assigned keys by switching on the respective DM X input  For clarity  when looking at this window  the keys in the DM X IN REM OTE CONFIGURATION menu will have a red background  when switching on the respective DM X channel     The assigned playback keys will always be executed directly    The assigned playback keys will be executed in combination with the previously selected commands    Example  If an OFF key is programmed on a DM X IN channel  but PAUSE is activated  See Layout and Controls  item  11   not the OFF command  but the PAUSE command will be executed when calling up this DM X IN channel     Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 gad HALL    Remote MIDI Configuration         a x lt     Fader Fader cr EREE ec  ia SE  ader T  e  F ader   oe Pp der Fader MENEE ade      a Grr  O Go Go Go Go Go    ma      _   sae oO  g    Fader  Eas Fader    2                                     EEE       TERRE       exer  B    B       Syntax fo ng keys  STORE  Remote Button    Executor Button 1    Remo
370. rees of Pan  a third set of  Pan and Tilt values is possible while still pointing to the same position on  stage  If the fixture only has 360 degrees of movment it will return to its  original position     Pressing 3x  The head will be returned to the original position When using head  Fixtures  the FIXTURE SHEET will show a yellow square left of the PAN value   symbolizing the current head position     Mirror Fitxures   The PAN TILT value will be inverted  the mirror will be positioned so to easily allow  the creatation of symetrical looks   Flip reacts as well to the Preset M aster Fader  see chap  3 7 3   Flip can be faded    156 MA    LIGHTING    either with a set time  Set Time setting  or cross  faded with the fader  M anual Fade setting        minus     Minus key  STORE  STORE key  EDIT  EDIT key    UPDATE  UPDATE key  ESCAPE  ESCAPE key  ENTER  ENTER key    ALL SELECTION  Reselects all FIXTURES and CHANNELS  this is normally used  after working with the NEXT PREV     ODD SELECTION  Selects all odd FIXTURES and CHANNELS   EVEN SELECTION  Selects all even FIXTURES and CHANNELS   INVERT SELECTION  Allows to invert the selection       If several fixtures are activated  values in red   but only some of those fixtures are currently  selected  fixture name in yellow   you can deselect those fixtures and reselect all other  fixtures will active values by pushing the INVERT SELECTION key and ENTER    DELETE  Delete key   MOVE  MOVE key   COPY  COPY key   BACKUP  BACKUP key   S
371. rent Selected Sequence     In the Selected Sequence  Cues can be played back directly      Press the GOTO key once  LED is on       Enter the Cue number on the numeric keypad and confirm with ENTER  The Cue will be played back with the  set duration   See Settings in the DEFAULTS menu     When played back Cues directly  you can enter a FADE or DELAY time using the TIME key    After having entered the Cue number  press the TIM E key for the FADE time once and enter the period of time  using the numeric keypad  or press the TIME key once more for the DELAY time  enter the duration using the  numeric keypad and confirm with enter  The Cue will be played back with the entered times     The Cue will always be played back as if the Sequence was run from the very beginning  That means  all  previous steps will be accounted for with regards to the tracking of values this depends on whether  Tracking had been activated in the ASSIGN menu  siehe 5 1 4 Executor Settings     Besides the Selected sequence  you can select multiple Executors as default sequences  These are indicated by a  dark  green title window   the Selected sequence  only possible for 1 Executor  has a light  green title window    A l default Sequences can be operated at the same time if using the yellow buttons  All default sequences can  also be operated by using a combination of a command  e g  GO   Pause  OFF  and simultaneously pressing    a  T      i  T         a m E ENTER    SI   ita   or   Hold the SELECT button
372. reset   PREVIEW PREV PREVIEW Preview something   PREVIOUS P PREVIOUS Previous device of current selection  SELECT SE SELECT Select  lt executor gt    select default executor  SEQU S SEQU Sequence  Cuelist    STORE ST STORE Store   SWOP SW CONSOLE Swop executor   SWOP_OFF SWOP_O CONSOLE End of swop   TEMP TE TEMP Temporary run executor   THRU i THRU Through  to enter ranges   TIMECODE Tl CONSOLE Timecode show   TOGGLE TOG CONSOLE Toggle running status of executor   TOP TOP TOP Call first cue of executor   TOUCH _BTN TO CONSOLE Remote Analog input button   UNPRESS UN CONSOLE Release of command   UPDATE U UPDATE Update   VALUE VA 3 x TIME return to value mode   VIEW V VIEW View  contents of one or multiple screens  VIEWBTN VIEWB 2 x VIEW Viewbutton  hardkey beside screens    MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    160 MA    LIGHTING    10 3 Command Reference  In this chapter  all commands are explained along with their syntax  demonstrating all possibilities of using  comand line entry     10 3 1 Key word classifications  In the following descriptions  the term starting keyword will appear often   This    starting keyword    is a keyword that you start anew command line operation with   Basic operational keywords  A basic operational keyword in the command line determins a basic operation   These keywords can only appear as starting keyword in the command line     The only exception from this rule is the AT command  AT can follow a list of ob
373. reset   the selected Preset will be activated and can no longer be modified by Cues  Sequences or  Chasers    In order to deactivate the FREEZE function  press the FREEZE key once more  LED Is off      3 7 5 Update Preset   In order to change presets     Press the EDIT key  LED is on       Click on or touch one of the Preset Keys  the LED will blink  the preset key will display EDIT   The used fixtures   channels are being selected and the values will be activated      Make your required modifications      Press the UPDATE key    A window appears  where you can either store the preset by pressing the OK key or cancel the modification by  pressing CANCEL    If you want to change more than one preset  you can select another preset by pressing the EDIT key right after  the modification  followed by the NEXT key  Before the activation of the new selected preset  a window will open   where you can store the 1st preset by pressing the OK key or where you can cancel the modification by pressing  CANCEL  The second preset can only be activated after this    Or    When executing sequences you can modify and store single values of presets directly      Play back a cue  in which presets are to be modified  Now you can modify this cue by direct access  the UP   DATE key LED is on   See Accessing fixtures directly  Accessing Dimmer Channels directly   Press the Update key once    The UPDATE window will open    By pressing this key  you can toggle between    only original contents  and    
374. reset and Executor Fader    Toggle buttons  function  SetTime   ManFade   Aus       Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand A229    Open Views  Create  store and assign views as usual  Open view either with the softbutton on the right rim of the screen or    RoSA       Preset Eec  Fac Of Fade  SetTase StTime  ManFade Man Fade         PEPY         poppee  Pei     4       ateata  zororo    or with the buttons below the monitor    szesz     with the buttons V4   V9 for the right monitor    prep  mome   naga       To empty a screen press V4 und V9 simultaneously  right monitor  or press buttons 11 11 or 26 26  picture above   simultaneously for center and left monitor        230 ME o Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr 16   D 97297 Waldb  ttelbrunn    LIGHTING    Mouse  Button Mouse has same function as button Pan Tilt  grandMA 1 light  or button TRACKERBALLON  grandM A1 full size      The button toggles the function according to setup in SETUP   DEFAULT   The 3 buttons next to the Mouse button acts as left  center and right mouse button         External monitors  If you connect external monitors  note this path to enter the screens with the mouse  Direct changeover between the two external monitors is not possible        Ultra  light  leave the monitor on the left and right Light  leave the monitors on the top side Full size  leave the left and right monitor on the top side    side to enter t
375. resets  Features and Attributes        F Attribute  Attributes are individual functions of Fixtures like Gobol  Focus  Iris  Pan  Tilt       MAC 500 M7 7ESASE    Open m Feature  Features are groups  in which several Attributes are combined  In the Fixture Sheet  the first line will       MAC 500 M   77  45      MAC 500 M   77     PEMA soo Me gA as   A perf E 2S Ooo wi A   display all Features available  Below the individual Features  the respective Attributes are displayed     Presets  In a preset  the value of one or more Attributes can be stored  Presets are divided in different Preset  Groups  Gobo  Colour       Features are allocated to the individual Preset Groups              By pressing a FEATURE key with the function  in this case  Dimmer   you can select the different Feature Groups  for the Preset Group selected to change the individual Attributes using the Encoder   Here  the individual Attributes are displayed that can be changed with the respective Encoder     2 4 1 Preset  Feature and Attribute Setup    Attention  This menu is important and can influence all of your programming       press Full  or Live Access     open Attribute Setup   The number of Preset groups is fix and cannot be modified  Furthermore  the names displayed in red can   t either be  changed or deleted     Changing the names of Preset groups  Features and Attributes  Click on a name  change it using the keyboard  and confirm with Enter  The modifications will only be executed  and saved after 
376. ress a empty executor button   the executor menue for this button opens     choose FUNCTION   MACRO and select the required macro  See picture left      close the menue with X  the selected macro is stored on this button    Store a macro to a executor fader button  with this function the fader is not active     press ASSIGN and press a empty executor fader   the executor menue for this executor opens      choose FUNCTION   MACRO and select the required macro  see picture left      close the menue with X  the selected macro is stored on this executor    Store GO  ON or OFF to a Executor button     press ASSIGN     press  hard  button GO  ON or OFF     press the executor button or one of the three executor fader button drucken   the rquired command is stored to  this button    Go and ON starts different actions   depends on the mode of the macro  timed or not timed    GO macro not timed   starts the macro  identical with ON   macro timed   starts the macro  If a cue has a GO in the DELAY column  the macro will have a break  there  continue with a GO command     ON macro not timed   starts the macro  identical with GO   macro timed   starts the macro  with every ON command  during the macro is running  the macro is  restarted with th efirst cue  If one cue has a GO in the DELAY column  the macro will have a break there  and can only be continued with a GO command     NOTE  If two or more commands schould be executed with the same channel  give time to the console to execute  all
377. ressing the  Key will move the selected cue and the cue indicated by the subsiquent number    Pressing the THRU kKey on the keypad will move the Cues from   to  including last Cue         Exec 1 1  Seq 4    Seq T                    No  Name  MIB Trig  Fade   Dutfade  Dela When pressing the  Key  the Cue with the next number will be excluded from the move operation   1 ie    o Se   Press the AT key once  LED is on     2 2Cue   G0 Os      Os   Enter the new number for the moved Cues using the keypad    3 3 Cue G0 Os   Os    Example  The Cues are to be inserted between Cue 10 and Cue 11  Number these Cues e g  as 10 1  possible Cue  aa numbers are 10 001   10 999   This way  up to 999 Cues can be inserted between two existing Cues       Confirm with ENTER    se When moving one Cue  the COPY window will open   After pressing the key on the left of Statuscopy  you can choose between   During the moving process  only the values and times actually stored in this Cue will be moved  Tracked  information will be ignored           The Cue will be moved as it would actually be realized on stage  That means  all previous steps will be taken into    Copy  What Do You Want to Copy        account and the result will be moved    By pressing the button on the left of Cue Only  you can choose between    Normal moving  with or without Status   ag Will copy the values of the step before into the step after  but only to a position having no value  this wouldn t be  a VA wise  The moved Cue will no
378. rge  Insert and Add on option    UPDATE function for fast correction of programs     SE E E e mons   EDIT function for direct modification of playback parameters    Optionally insert in Cue Only M ode  oe   WiCatl Playback p      14 3 18 Adjustment of Hardware      Software Equalizer for Audio Input      Preselection of certain settings  Defaults       Free grouping of functions for selective programming      Preselection of save mode  times and the standard operation of playback functions     14 3 12 Playback Options      Free assignment between Program Pool and Playback faders or Playback buttons     Playback via fader or GO  button with stored timings      Chaser effects with Auto Run  Audio or manual X  Fade      Auto Loop   Single   Reverse   Bounce   Random      Sequence with individual timings per step  S    Go button mode   Auto Timed   Sound  14 3 19 Connectivity      4 DMX 512 1990 Output Lines via 5  pin XLR Sockets     DM X Input with 5  pin XLR Socket and DM X Thru     Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 gad HAASI      Audio Input Line for Mono Audio Signals  gt 20 mV with 6 3mm socket      SMPTE Timecode Entry for LTC Timecode  gt 200 mV with 6 3mm socket      MIDI Interface with IN OUT THRU      External control input for direct voltage signals via 25  pin SUB D socket      2 SVGA Output Lines for one colour monitor and a service monitor via 15  pin sockets     Parallel printer por
379. riggered from the Command Line  This is the easier way to use shows created on the grandM A on smaller  consoles      By setting the soft key    Executor Layout    to    Wide     agrandMA light  ultralight oder RPU will use the same  executor numbering as the    big brother    grandMA does  Therefore the first button executor has number 21    Please have in mind  that in wide mode the printed labels on the consoles surface are wrong  The advantage of   wide mode is  that all executors can be accessed by the command line  This is useful when porting shows froma   grandM A into a smaller console      By clicking this key  four calibrating keys  numbered 1 to 4  will be displayed on the respective TFT display    Touch the keys using your finger or the supplied pen  special pen with soft rubber core   The display will   automatically switch back after the last key is touched  The touchscreen is now calibrated and the settings will   automatically be stored     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    Clone Fixture Data    ID C    ID F   1    Name    Type ID C  ID    MAC 2000 PERF MAC 200        gt  gt  gt    Clone    gt  gt  gt     To Fixtures    F  Hame    MAC 2000 PERF MAC 200   MAC 2000 PERF MAC 200   MAC 2000 PERF MAC 200   MAC 2000 PERF MAC 200              X  Menu      Effects  p  ASCII  SNOW je                                                                            Fixture Schedule Adjustments Lights Misc   ALEX4 Touchscreen Calibrati
380. rofile List    lt ec   profile   Name Used   Global   World Filter              4 Ho            Beside the users which are in the list  there is always one hidden administrator   id profie You can not delete or change this administrator           His user name is ADMIN and he is using the DEFAULT user profile    Login becomes enabled if at least one user is in the visible user list    The presence of the ADMIN user destroys any real security  On the other hand you will never really loose access  to your desk    2 16 4 Deleting an User   To delete a user  you need to have administrator privilege level      Go to TOOLS menu      Go to USER   CONFIGURATION      Select the user you want to delete      Press the DELETE USER key      The user will disappear  If he was the only one to use a certain user profile  this profile will also be deleted        Please note  that you can not delete yourself from the list     Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand AA  Ji       User List          sword   Aights_   Pra  Adminstrator DEFAULT  Administrator DEFAULT  Designer     idd        Administrep          Edit Presets  Edit General  Edit Worlds  Edit Setup    Administrator  oy ee foe aT Bd sy pet l    52 MIA    LIGHTING    2 16 5 User Rights    Only a user with Administrator privilege level can change the rights of a user  apart from his or her own  and   create new users  A newly created user is always allott
381. rogram will assign the changing of values to the very user who had actually made that specific change  That    CREE 192271 means  commands like CLEAR or STORE will only refer to the changes of the respective user  without affecting the    Cae  192 271 Fixt Gheet Ve      ewig  271 a e ara Wii   Programming work of another user     a  CREE isc  271 Pan Tilt Changes will be indicated by different colors in the Fixture  Channel and Fader sheet                                       eat i      FELE ETE a  en an Tit   red background   these values were set by the user of this console  only these values will be stored  OOPSed     2    SLaDR2   143 144   ay     3     SL300 344  743 144   ee JMA O   grey background   these values were set by the user of another console  these values cannot be changed    Ea E In order to modify grey  i e     alien    values  you have to select them in advance     ant     i  a TE A When chaning these values  they receive a red background and  thus  become    own    values  on the other    EENM LEETE EEE    consoles of this session  these values will then immediately be displayed in grey     Comp  Fixtures Sheet Values So  if fixtures of multiple users are selected  the last modification will be assigned to the executing user  sorted by Numbers        LTP mode      148   148    Tit   128   137   137   137   137   137    a E a  compact Fixture Sheet   oe a  The Compact Fixture Sheet works in parallel to the Fixture Sheet  i e  selections and changes are be
382. rogramming  if needed     MAC 2000 WASH 2 MAC 2000 WASH 21CH Yes Yes Mil  MAC 2000 PERFORI MAC 2000 PERFORM 3    Fixture or Channel Patch menu  A In both of these menus you can patch fixtures  And you can define standard settings for each fixtur    press SETUP          26 MA    LIGHTING    MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn      press FULL ACCES    press PATCH SHEET    press FIXTURE PATCH or CHANNEL PATCH      Listing of individual functions  ER are Tee x DMX  Shows the patched channel  If this is to be adjusted  click into the cell and rotate the Display Encoder  The  a eo Fixtures to Patch menu will open  See Patching Scanners Dimmers       Al  7 DIM8 DIHS 7   2 2 DM8 DM8  NoM aster  Ifa cell contains a No here  the function of the Grandmaster  Faders is not active for this fixture  See  CO B DMB DMB    Fixture Switching the M aster  GRANDM ASTER FADER  off  one page earlier     ra R ODMR IM   Pan Tilt Swap  Ifa cell contains a Yes here  the function will be inverted or completely exchanged  See       Inverting or changing PAN or TILT     2 4 Adjustments in the ATTRIBUTE SETUP menu     Ope   In the    Attribute Setup    menu  you can change the names of Preset and Features Groups  Furthermore  you can   ca Hs EE een   blue     Fandom   Rand 9 create or adapt new Features Groups  Furthermore  you can define  which attributes will be activated together or  ere  individually    But first a short explanation about the differences between P
383. rther problem  please feel free to contact your dealer or our HOTLINE  49 5251 688865  99    available  The DVD contain a guide to take your first Setup and start   steps with the grandMA  Please contact your local The easiest way is to use the BACKUP key and load a demo  show or start show  Alternatively    deale and order the DVD  1  SETUP key  Will allow you to select and patch the number of dimmers and fixtures  create presets  groups and  effects     2  Right click or touch in any empty display     creates  moves and resizes a FADER or CHANNEL window for dimmer control and FIXTURE  GROUP and different  Preset windows  PAN TILT  GOBO     for fixtures     Direct access   The grandM A offers many different ways of controlling dimmer values and fixture attributes  For speed  we give you  only one example for each of them    Setting values for dimmers    CHANNEL FADER         or         key toggles the motorised faders to control single dimmer channels           and         scrolls in blocks of 20  10 on the grandMA light  dimmers     Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand A  15    16    MIA    LIGHTING      The set fader values are shown in the dimmer display    Channels can also be selected and modified by the mouse  wheel  encoder and the keypad    With the LINK function  right on top of channel and fader sheets   the window will automatically scroll to show the  channels set for the faders
384. rver    press LOAD Show          click on the desired Show in the list  The Show is being loaded   usa ai  The Please Confirm window will open and offer you         YES to save the current Show before loading the new one     NO to load the new Show without saving the current one   Backup Menu ES    CANCEL will abort this process   Export Floppy  e    Archive Media The Show is being loaded                                    press BACKUP  we     press File Server       O press DELETE Show button  In the list  click on the Show that is to be deleted  the Show will be deleted   we  gt   immediately      If you press the Stay button  before deleting a Show  the Delete menu will not close automatically     11 12 Saving a Show on a USB stick  not micro and pico           Press BACKUP  STEET X   Insert the USB stick into the port  Eas B    eatarmashs   Press the IMPORT   EXPORT button  this will load the Show with all user specific profiles that you can also  cocal search for transfer to another console      Press the Save Show button and confirm with OK  If the directory is not displayed  chose USB      Enter a different name for the Show  or accept the Show name already given   The 2 directories for the shows are  createdd automatically     Confirm with ENTER and wait  until the procedure is completed  Remove the USB stick   or use the button USB DRIVE  This will load the show without user  specific profiles  11 13 Loading a Show from a USB stick  not micro and pico     Press BACKU
385. s     Auto PrePos key pressed  The automatic prepositioning system will perform a move in black upon executor  start  Therefore all non  dimmer channels come up with zero fadetime and delay if the corresponding fixture was  dark when the executor was started  Switching off an executor with the Auto PrePos function enabled  tries not  to destroy the    stage look     only dimmer channels are fading out    When deactivating this sequence  the channels will be altered only after the respective dimmer has been set to  0     LOOPS    NORMAL  use the GO command to execute the next Cue within the LOOP   breaking GO  use the GO command to cancel the LOOP and to execute the next Cue of the sequence  RESTART OPTIONS   If the    Restart with first cue    key is pressed  the Sequence will restart always with the first cue    If the    Restart with actual cue    key is pressed  the Sequence will restart exactly where it was switched off the  last time    If the    Restart with next cue    Key is pressed  the Sequence will restart one cue after where it was switched off    If the    Release from last to first cue    key is pressed  tracked values are released when the executor jumps back to  the first cue    PRIORITY OPTIONS   There are 3 priorities  Low  lowest   Normal  middle  and High highest   Executors having a higher priority  cannot  be overwritten by Executors of a lower priority  In general  this applies only for LTP functions    PRIVATE EFFECTS  Effects saved in this sequence wi
386. s    Active Network Sessions Stations in Network Session             ID   Session Name   _   Showfile      No    Name Status IP  H unconnected l 1 eduart 6e tandalo192 168 0 192 1    IP Address  Name  Prionitiy    Invitation    LOAD columns  numbers 0   100   Will show the workload of the  data output of the respective NSP  If the number in this column is  displayed in red  the NSP is temporarily overloaded  This will  somehow decrease the normal DM X repeat rate of approx  30 Hz  This  can be disturbing e g  with moving lamps or stroboscopes     204 MIA    LIGHTING       17 Channel extension with the NSP NETWORK SIGNAL  PROCESSOR    With a NSP  grandM A consoles  except MICRO and PICO  can be extended to 32 768 channels   16 384 parameters   The console can be connected to up to 16 NSP  so that you can control 32 768 channels  This way  you save cable  metres and can bridge greater distances easily  The NSP has to be connected to the console within a session  and has  to be adapted in the DM X   NSP configuration menu    NOTE  If more than 4096 channels are to be used  you absolutely need a network having a 100M bit transmission  rate  Make sure that there are no elements in the network potentially reducing your speed to 10M bit    No problems will occur in a network environment with consoles having the following serial numbers       grandMA as of SN 490 onwards    grandMA Light as of SN 317 onwards    grandMA UltraLight as of SN 232 onwards    grandMA Replay Unit as of SN 3
387. s  press LIST key      Default Button and Fader Assignment     Pressing the    Save as default  key will store the current settings as default settings in the Default Button Fa   der menu  For each option  1 5 Faders or 1 5 Buttons  Sequences or Chasers   there is a default that can be  stored      Pressing the    Load from default    key will load the stored default settings and use them for this Executor      Pressing the    Apply to all Exec    will overwrite all Fader or Button Executors  The prerequisite is  however  an  identical number of Fader and Button assignments     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn         Create A Window    Effects Sequence    PLAYBACK Fader and Buttons   To expand ist operational options and for a better access to Faders and Buttons  Special Shows programmed e g   on a grandma can now be controlled from the smaller consoles having only 10 Executor Faders and 20 Executor  Buttons    For internal or external monitors   especially consoles with one or no monitor like e g  the Replay Unit can now  be used more effectively    You can now operate Faders and Buttons using your finger  on a TouchScreen  or the M ouse    The virtual Faders and Buttons can be set and expanded like the mechanical ones in the Assign menu              Channel 1  Pan Tilt              Channel   Effects    Fader Bitmap parmmer    Timecode              DMX Forms Views 3  Gobo                Fixture Groups Worlds 4  Color                D
388. select it and press the Delete Profile button  Deleting a profile is only possible  when the profile is already deleted from the fixture  in Full Access   Fixture Types   Profiles       Pressing the X button will save the profiles and you leave the menu     Embedding self  created gobos  When using self  created Gobos  these graphics can be collected in a Gobo library  the Visualizer will  however     Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand ITA 35       STAGE PROFILE PLUS    Function Sets of Channel GOBO1    1 sotess onrrore       cobol maniaNNEY Vaio  Awos    show the    real    Gobos  In stage view on the console  the light is indicated in a very simplified form  i e  as a color  a  _ gobotes  st     Ox F OxFF      Gob    4   gobotest2 Osi OxtF  Gobol   ab Always Li line  and the Gobos do not appear                 Saving a self  created Bitmap graphics     create a graphics and save it as a BMP file to a floppy     FULL ACCESS     FIXTURE TYPES     activate the FIXTURETYPE menu  dark blue title bar  and the line of the fixture type     activate the CHANNELS of FIXTURETYPE menu  dark blue title bar      use the Encoder to jump to the attribute cell GOBO     FUNCTION SETS the FUNCTION SETS menu of the respective fixture type  Gobo 1 or Gobo 2  will appear     inthe empty bottom line  enter a name for the Gobo   the line will be numbered automatically       enter a range  environment in which t
389. select your Archive Medium  hard disk  on the console   file server  external memory  to be set using File  Server in Archive M edia     ect ee  rip Se       jr i    Select Show File to Save    Director    11 1 Saving the Current Show on the internal harddisk    press BACKUP     press INTERNAL ONLY     save Show       02 23 04 13 30         SCANMONSTER SCANMONO SHO 02 20 04 12 46  NEW SHOW NEWSHOWSHO 02 18 04 1631 SAVE Show As  Enter a name for the show and confirm with ENTER  The show will be saved under the new  NEW733 NEW7330 SHO_ 02 18 04 12 12 name         02 06 04 0933   SAVE Show  the Show is saved immediately with the current name     SAVE Show Enumerate  the Show is saved immediately and a consecutive number will be    added to the current name     NEW731SECOND NEW731S0 SHO       Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 gad HALTS          Show File to Delete                            LIGHTING       11 2 Loading a Show from the internal harddisk    press BACKUP     press INTERNAL ONLY     press LOAD Show      Press on the desired SHOW in the list  This will load the Show      The PLEASE CONFIRM window with the following options will open      YES  To save the current Show before loading the new one      NO  To load the new Show without saving the current one      CANCEL  To abort this process    The show will be loaded        11 3 Loading a empty Show     press BACKUP     press INTERNAL ONLY 
390. sequence     Can   run any show on any console     AUTOBACKUP in a session     The desk gets slower and slower when starting and  storing a show      can no longer perform tasks in the network with my  UltraLight    Answer    A timer does the same as an Interruption of the power  supply  i e  the grandM A  Light and the ReplayUnit will  immediately switch over to battery supply and will shut  down the console after 3 minutes  No problems here  as  all active applications will restart after a reboot  After  Switching on  the UltraLight will possibly try to access  the BIOS and not boot correctly    In general  it is advisable to let the console switched on  and have the show run via the AGENDA menu     In the Command line  you can patch fixtures or change  the patch number  without disturbing the show  Same  applies to the DM X sheet  when using the mouse     In the sequence  start the cue in the LINK column with gt   GOTO x  cue no   EXECUTOR x xx  Executor no      All shows will run on all grandMA consoles  only  exception with the Micro  the show may only have 1 024  channels  when loading a bigger show  the channels in  excess have to be deleted  as the performance would not  be able to handle it  and only 2 DM X universes could be  output     In a session only the M aster should have AUTOBACKUP   Slaves with AUTOBACHUP will cause problems with the  performance     If the ENUM ERATE button is on ON in the BACKUP   menu under QUICK SAVE  every saving procedure saves  anew c
391. ser Profile List   Global                  fi             2 16 9 Who is logged in at the moment     Go to the Tools menu      Look at the title bar of the window    It says    Tools M enue   current user Is       NOTE  IF POSSIBLE USE MAX 10 USER   MISFUNCTION CAN OCCURE IF  MORE USER ARE LOADED    If a user loads a show for the very first time  he has never used this show before   this show will be loaded with the  previously used profile and NOT with his personal user profile  If needed  the personal user profile can be loaded  afterwards  j    2 16 8 Saving  or Loading Profiles  User profiles are saved independently from the show and can thus be loaded for any other show afterwards     Go to the Tools menu and User   Setup     Under User Profile List in the New line  enter a name for a new profile     Select the user cell under User List in the Profile column  Press the Encoder   select the profile  and take  over by pressing it again   If this user is logged in  the siehetings will be saved to this profile when saving the profile  Save User Defaults    If this user is not logged in  he receives a message  that his profile is empty  Confirm this message and a selection  menue pops up   1  select a profile  2  select what to copy  button becomes dark green  or select Everthing for complete profile    confirm with LOAD SELECTED ITEMS  User with rights higher than PLAYBACK can press LOAD USER PROFILE from Show and change profiles of other  user  not his own profile   Save to 
392. set speed  Fade and Delay times will be adjusted in terms of percentage   m Ea DN    E of the steps  cues  via a sound signal  Fade and Delay times will be executed with the set  Speed   1  Speed Ime    a   BPM  Playback of the steps  cues  via automatic recognition of Beats Per M inute  Fade and Delay times will be  enu p adjusted in terms of percentage   Ei fi   FORWARD  Chaser runs forward                     REVERS  Chaser runs backwards   Exec 1 1  lt i a  gt    BOUNCE  Chaser runs forward  then backwards and so on   Speod Scale Spoed Fado Master Fade   RANDOMLY  Chaser plays back individual steps  cues  on random basis   ae Ce eo 22      AUTO LOOP   SINGLE ON   SINGLE OFF  Toggle by pressing the key    On AUTO LOOP  after the last step  the Chaser will jump back to the first and continue  With SINGLE ON  the  Chaser makes one run and stops at the last Cue  With SINGLE OFF  the Chaser makes one run and switches off  after the last Cue     SPEED INDV   On RUN  an individually set speed will be used    SPEED 1  4  On RUN  the respective SPEED  Group will be used  These set speeds can be used for all Chasers   5 1 6 Assigning Special M asters  Using the keys  you can either divide or double the set speed   HALF SPEED  Pressing 1x  the set speed will be divided in half   this can be done up to 8 times  The modification  will be displayed above the left Encoder    1 1  Resets the speed to the set value   DOUBLE SPEED  By pressing this once the set speed will be doubled   this
393. sing a profile  You can fade dimmers and   PAN TILT movements using individual profiles  In this version  it is irrelevant whether the PATH column contains no   entry or    linear    You can choose from 43 paths  16 of which are pre  defined  and 16 that you can assign self    created profiles to      Open the Cue overview     click onthe cell in the DIM PATH column  for the FADE profile of the dimmer  or MOVE PATH  for the FADE  profile of the PAN TILT movement  and press on the right Encoder    The SELECT FADE PATH menu will open     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    Select Fade Path    Name  NL Normal Low  NO Normal Over  HN High Normal  HH _ High High  HL High Low  HO High Over  LN Low Normal    LH Low High    LL Low Low  LO Low Over  ON Over Normal  OH Over High  OL Over Low  00 Over Over     gt L    Add  Profile          Hame  newnew  epecialDl  New Delete  Profile    Edit d  Choose Mo  Profile Profile    Add  Point  Delete  Point       Edit Profile    Toggle  Curve    Pre   _ Definedp   Mirror   gt           Profile Point In  Xx J Out   Y Jj      Pre   onset z oo Defined           Linear hdirror  Switch    Sinus            Minor Functions        Square  Power Correction    Invert Input     J  Invert Output   Y J                       select a ready  made profile     Select a profile from the menu  number or profile name has a blue background   which will display the profile  as a graphics and press     SELECT PATH   The select
394. ssing the  OFF key right of the EXECUTOR will switch off these Effect Groups  See Assigning Effect Groups to  EXECUTOR faders     The left part of the menu shows all Effect Groups that are playing back via Cues  Pressing the OFF key on the  right side of CUELIST  all these Effect Groups will be switched off      The lower part of the menu shows all Effect Group calls performed since the last Cue was stored  including  their respective playback parameters  When storing the next Cue  all calls in this Sheet will also be stored   It is also possible to modify individual calls  To do so  select the respective call  will be displayed with a blue  frame   The setting will be adopted  displayed above the Encoders and can be adjusted with them  You can  delete a complete call by making a right mouse click into the NAME column  If you only want to delete a single  parameter  make a right mouse click on the parameter     6 7 Creating and Storing Virtual Forms  EDIT FORMS   6 7 1 Creating Virtual Forms  From this menu  you can create two  dimensional forms for use with PAN TILT parameters  When creating Forms   the movements can directly be output to the Fixtures  The created Forms will automatically be stored in the Form  Pool   Calling up this menu  Creating an Effect Group  item 3  Editing Effects  item Table    Press the PREDEFINES key once  A window will open  where several prepared Forms will be displayed  Select  one of these Forms  this Form will now be displayed on the the blac
395. ssing this key will open the SPEED   GROUP menu  By pressing a key  you can designate a SPEED Group  Using the Fader of the assigned SPEED  Group  you can now adjust the speed for this Effect Group  See Assigning Special M asters  If INDIVIDUAL is selected  default setting   you can adjust the speed only by using the SPEED encoder      Bounce  If this key is pressed  dark background   the whole Effect Group will first run forwards and then  backwards  etc      BPM  If this key is pressed  dark background   the speed of the whole Effect Group will be controlled by the  automatic measure recognition  See Setting Sound signals     Start Speed  Pressing this key once will store the currently set speed  The key will display the stored speed   From now on  this Effect Group will be started with this speed  even if the speed was changed during the  execution  To delete the stored speed  use the Encoder to set the SPEED to STOP and press the START SPEED key  once  Now  no speed is stored and the key will display NONE      Off On Overwritten  This Effect Group will be switched off  when the OFF ON OVERWRITTEN key is pressed   dark background  and another Effect Group is started  in which the same Fixtures Dimmers are to be used   default setting     If this function is disabled  the Effect Group will not be switched off  It is still active  but does affect any Fix   ture Dimmer  The key of this Effect Group in the Effect Pool will display a white red flashing    2     The number  indi
396. st number group has to be unique for each device logged on this  network     Saving and printing reports      Create the desired report  see above       Connect PC and console via FTP      Cut out the file xx CSV in the REPORT folder of the console and paste it into a folder of on the PC  In the graphics  on the left  the folder overview of the console having the IP 192 168 177 114     Start the application MICROSOFT EXCEL and open the report file      Printing  saving  sending the report  etc  is as usual with Excel files     O    r     Create the desired report  see above      Storethe REPORT file on a floppy with SAVE  all created reports will be stored     Examples    Create the report of Cue No  2 3 4 and 5 of sequence 24      Enter the following on the CommandLine  report_sequ_24 cue 2 thru_5  confirm with ENTER     the report will appear on the right display  the Cue values are arranged in columns  the parameters of individual  fixtures in rows     To create the reports for sequences 1 2  and 3      enter the following on the CommandLine  report_sequ_1_thru_3  confirm with ENTER     the report for sequence 1 will appear on the right display the Cue values are arranged in columns  the parameters of  individual fixtures in rows  With the arrow  buttons  you can switch to the next or previous report  In the report folder   you find the 3 files containing the reports     To create the Report PRESET 1  PAN   TILT      enter the following on the CommandLine  report_preset_1 
397. suming operations  but essentially  the grandMA  is still an MA console   easy to operate  yet very powerful   Displays   The first remarkable feature of the grandMA are the contrast  rich  full color TFT touch  screens integrated into a panel with adjustable viewing angle  Optionally supported are  two external monitors  They allow for clear and precise control along with multiple visual  represenations of group and preset operations  interactive output displays and different  ways of cue listing   Colors and gobos can directly be selected by labeled preset keys and allow for a fast and  accurate control  while the encoders can be used anytime for fine tuning  By way of  presets  stored positions can quickly be adjusted to changed arrangements    M otorfaders   How can a console like the grandMA with just 20 faders  10 on the grandMA light and  micro pico  possibly claim to control 4000 and more channels  It   s not a trick  it   s motorised  faders  They automatically capture the actual values as soon as you switch over from one  program library to another  Further special features are explained in the respective chapters  following    Programming features and data input  At first  the flexibility of the grandMA may surprise  but you have always the choice to do  it    the old fashion way     Dealing with huge amounts of data will make you want to use  improved ways of programming and even an automatic effect synthesizer    Flexible Setup configuration  Because of the grand
398. swT Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr 16  D 97297 Waldbittelbrunn    LIGHTING    16 Full Tracking Backup on grandMA consoles   16 1 Why using a backup system    Anytime the grandMA or another member of the grandM A family is running a show it already provides a  maximum level of stability in operation based on its unique hardware concept and the built in UPS power supply   For applications like big theatre shows  live broadcasting or larger touring events even more security is sometimes  required    With other systems this is very often achieved by a second console loaded with the same show  This second desk      backup system     is then manually tracked to take over control whenever the main system fails  Sometimes  both consoles may be linked together via MIDI  MIDI Show Control or any other serial signal to perform a     olayback tracking    which keeps both systems on the same cue  In a backup situation only the DM X  outlets need  to be cross  switched    The grandM A now offers a complete concept of show backup for moving light and conventional controllers   16 2  grandMA with show backup   As the DM X signal distribution via EtherNet has been implemented to all grandM A systems the software release  brings full backup capability via EtherNet    16 2 1 Backup options via EtherNet   The Backup system can by used to combine multiple grandM A consoles  up to 10  to form a Master  Slave  configuration  The console having the Slave function will permanently be provid
399. t     Effect Group without assigned Fixtures or Dimmers  key of the Effect Group is displayed in red   a generic  effect     Temporary Effect Group  keys displayed in blue in the ALL RUNNING EFFECTS menu   If this Effect Group is not  stored after having been created  it will automatically be deleted after it is switched off      Sequence Effect Group  Effect Group key displayed in orange   A specific copy of a generic effect that has been  created automatically because a generic effect has been used when creating a cue    6 1 1 Creating an Effect Group   Create an EFFECT window  3 1 Creating windows     Select the Fixtures or Dimmers  for which an effect is to be used  selected Fixtures Dimmers are indicated by  yellow characters       Choose an empty Effect Group  New keys and Encoder names are displayed above the encoders  Pressing the  EDIT key for this Effect Group will open the EDIT EFFECT menu in the right TFT display     Or      Pressing the ADD LINE key once will open the SELECT PARAM ETER window  Now  select a function  e g  PAN   Af   ter selecting a function  the SELECT TABLE window will open  where you can select an Effect for the chosen  function      PWM  Pulse width modulation     RANDOM  Random fade  ins of individual channels of the selected function     CHASE  sequential flash to 100  function     SIN  Sinus function     COS  Co  sinus function     LIN   Saw tooth ascending     LIN    Saw tooth descending      TRIANGLE  Triangle function    PHASE1 PHASE2 PH
400. t Centronic via 25  pin SUB  D socket      Ethernet Interface for networking  Backup   DM X  transmission and Remote Control  with R  45  socket  10 100 Base T  according IEEE 802 4      2 Serial interfaces RS  232C for future extensions  only for GPS  receiver   9  pin SUB   D sockets       USB Port  not active      Connections for external Keyboard  Mini D  PS2  Type  and Mouse  Mini D  PS2   Type       Power Supply via IEC CEE 22 Inlet Mains Supply Plug  90   230V autoselecting     14 3 20 Operating system      Operating system for industrial applications named VXWORKS  no DOS  no WINDOWS      Fast cold boot time  approx 1minute       Software update via download from Internet      Off Line Editor available     14 3 21 Hardware      Pentium Processor with min  450 MHz Processor Speed and 256M Byte RAM      12 M Byte non volatile Flash Disk for Operating System  System Software and Instal   lation Data      Built in Hard Disk for Show Data  Library  etc       Integrated 3 5  Floppy Drive for easy software updating and external storage of Show  Data      Reset Keys on front and rear housing      Built in UPS  Un interruptable Power Supply  to withstand main power failures up to  10 minutes      Professional protection against electromagnetic interference in compliance with all  relevant European EMC regulations    14 3 22 Weight and Dimensions      Robust Steel Housing  485 x 430 x 140 mm      Weight  24 25 Ib   11 kg     192 MA    LIGHTING    MA Lighting Technology GmbH   D
401. t Chase Speed and Effect Speed    Readout  By pressing the key  you can here switch the Chaser Speed between BPM  beats per minute   Hz  beats  per second  and SEC  seconds      The default Chaser Speed is also used as the default for the Effect Speed     Crossfade Reload Permanent  Here  you can define whether manual cross fading should be performed just in  one direction  Reload  or in both directions  Permanent  when moving a fader set to cross fade   Remotes as stored   use commandline     as stored  Its unpossible to merge commands from the desk with commands coming from a remote  e g  MIDI or  Touchboard   E g  button GO  and command OFF Exec 2 7 from touchboard   the OFF   command will be execuded     use commandline  default   All remote commands  Touchboard  MIDI or REMOTE DM X  IN  not Pocket PC  will  be registered in the commandLine  E g  button GO  and command OFF Exec 2 7 from touchboard  the GO   command is assigned to the executor  the executor will be switched on     List Button normal  fixed   important for consoles having a monitor   fixed  you can now control the lower part of the monitor  on grandM As of the right monitor  using the List button only   Furthermore  you will not see any Encoder bars  and the PAGE buttons will be inaccessible     MA Default Colours  Theatrical Colours   Default Colours  the colours in the sheets as hitherto  Theatrical Colours  Colour pattern for theater use  e g  blocked values are are white  see chapter Colour Code   Sheet
402. t Middle  On d On    Right  On A       Access       Auto    External YGA Options     Left  Auto             System   Right  Off   Auto           Create        gt  Click  amp  Beep     Beep On       MSGBOX mode  1 screen             Trackball  Encoders    Encoder  amp  Fader Movement     Push is  Fast          Coarse   Fine 4       Wide  Executor  Layout         Wheel  Additive d    Faders  Auto d          Backlight     Bright       Adjustments    Lights    Defaults  p       Date  and Time p    Display  Language p    Oops  Settings p    Screensaver   Off       Update  Software p       Misc     SETUP                       ccess    Touchscreen Calibration    Calibrate           Touchscreen Options     On              Click  amp  Beep     Encoder  amp  Fader Movement    Beep On       Trackball  Coarse       Encoders  Coarse         Push is  Fast          ers Wheel  i Additive    SETUP menu on the MICRO    NOTE        Backlight       Bright         Defaults             Date  and Time      Display  Language pi    Screensaver  Off p          All text marked with    does not apply to the grandMA    MICRO     All buttons marked with     are located in the grandma  MICRO   s COMM AND WINDOW only     18    MIA    L IG HT IHIN 8    F Full        CCES5 p    fads  Trialit  F    2 Setup    The Setup menu is displayed only on the right screen  grandM a   In case of a failure of these screen press F3 to  display the menues of this screen on an external screen      2 1 Selecting  patching  cre
403. t its importance in todays  networking technology  Nevertheless as 10 Base  2 systems are very easy to configure and they do not require  additional networking nodes or hubs they might be used to easily link two or more grandMA consoles  As the  built in EtherNet card of the grandMA console autosenses the used connection media there is no need to  configure the console   s hardware at any time    The connection cable used for 10 Base  2 EtherNet is a 75 ohm coaxial cable  RG 58U  with male BNC  connectors on both ends  The maximum cable run is up to 180 metres from end to end     All connections to any kind of networking units  like consoles  PCs or Hubs  require the use of a    T     connector   which has to be connected to the BNC output of the console  Extension cords are not permitted      T    connector to be used with10 Base  2 network nodes    Any connection cable used for 10 Base  2 EtherNet has to be terminated on both ends with 75 ohm resistors  If  these resistors are disconnected or of the wrong value no network operation will be possible     Line termination on 10 Base  2 network  10 Base  2 EtherNet can be used for grandM A master slave connections when no ArtNet DM X  Nodes or other    distribution equipment is planned to be used  For longer cable runs or distributed networks 10 Base  2 EtherNet is  not recommended any more     Two grandMA consoles connected on a 10 Base  2 network    Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergen
404. tax for MIDI_ OUT commands in the CommandLine    MIDI Note  MiNote 0 127  0 127 Seperate numbers with comma e g  MiNote_ 13 122   MIDI Control  MiCtr 0 127  0 127 Seperate numbers with comma e g  MiCtr_ 11 123   MIDI Programm  Miprog 0 127   OPTION  type in the MIDI channel separated by a comma  1 16   If no channel is selected     the default channel is used   Seperate multiple commands with semi  colon          see lower line on picture left     9 Macros und QUIKEYS    9 1 Creating Macros   With macros  you can combine sets of command line entries and key strokes for recalling in batchs  These can  also be      Playback buttons  e g  GO  Fader  Pause  etc   incl  number of the Executor      Call  ups of Views     Call  ups of Delete operations     Other M acro calls     Call ups of Clear operations     Press the STORE key once  LED is on       Press the MACRO key once  LED Is on   The SELECT MACRO window will open      Enter a name for the M acro using the keyboard      Press the TIMED key  will turn dark  gray  if the M acro is to be executed over the same amount of time as it  takes to record it  The alternaitive is that the M acro will be played back as fast as possible      Confirm with ENTER    LED in the MACRO key flashes    Now  enter all operational steps to be executed by this M acro      To stop recording the macro press STORE  MACRO and then ENTER  LED in the MACRO key is now off    This completes the MACRO Programming procedure     9 1 1 Calling up macro     Cal
405. tch on grandM A2  set key switch on the back panel on    l    and press button  1  on the front panel   selection menue appears after approx 20 seconds       with the 41T  buttons  keyboard  select GM 1 Compatibility M ode  and confirm with PLEASE   The console automatically starts with grandM A1  Software Version 6 x     Load show as usually from USb   storage device  Due to the new hardware of grandM A2  Konsole some fader and button functions and locations have changed   The small monitor  M ultiTouch Screen  is not active  it displayes the debug monitor  press V10 button   Information from this screen are not relavant for programming shows   Fader allocation  full  size and light  faders 11   15 and 26   28 of grandM A2 are not active in GM 1  mode   29 and 30 see Preset  and Executorfader    Set Time   Man Fade     Full size  faders 1   10 are displayed on the left screen  faders 16   25 are displayed on the center screen  Light  faders 1   10 are displayed on the left screen  ultra  light  faders 11   13 of the grandM A2 are not active in GM 1  M ode  faders 14 and 15 see Preset  and Executorfader    Set Time   Man Fade          light   ultra  light  faders 1   10 are displayed on the screen full  size  faders 1   10 are displayed on the left screen  faders 16   25 are displayed  faders 11   13 are not active  faders 14 and 15 works as on th ecenter screen  faders11   15 and 26   28 are not active  faders 29 and 30 work as  Preset  and Executorfader    Set Time   Man Fa
406. te  MIDI    152 MA    LIGHTING       TOOLS    Remote  MIDI    STORE    Oft    DELETE    8 4 Remote Control by MIDI   On the rear of the grandMA  you will find the MIDI IN  MIDI THRU and MIDI OUT sockets  Assigned commands can  be called up using e g  an external MIDI keyboard or sequencer  Devices like these can be plugged into the Midi IN  socket  Only note commands are currently supported  The incoming signals will be automatically transferred to  MIDI THRU  Also Midi Show Control  MSC  can be processed or sent     8 4 1 Midi Show Control   The console can receive MSC commands which will be used to trigger the M aster sequence only    Push the key    M idi Show Control  within the Tools menu  the menu Configuraton Midi Show Control will be  opened    To receive M SC  set the device or the groups into the window    M idi IN    You can switch between M idi Enabled  and Midi via Ethernet via the key below the window    Midi IN    After pushing the key    Store    all settings will be  stored and the function will be started   To send MSC  set the device or the group into the window    M idi OUT    By the key    Send    you can change  between sending Device  Group or ALL   You can switch between Midi Enabled and M idi via Ethernet via the key  below the window    Midi OUT  After pushing the key    Store    all settings will be stored and the function will be  started     8 4 2 Assigning Playback Buttons     Press the TOOLS key once      Call up the MIDI REM OTE CONFIGURATION m
407. tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand A        Channel    Effects    Sequence    1  Pan Tilt    MACRO   VIEW          Channel  Fader    DMX    Fixture    Fixture  Compact    Effects  Bitmap    Forms  Groups    Macros       Sequence  Content  Compact    MAtricks       Sequence  Content    Sequence  Executor    Sequence  Tracking    Pages  Channel  Pages  Fader  Pages  Button       54    Quikey    MJA    LIGHTING       Timecode    Views    Worlds       2  Dimmer  B   amp       amp    amp  F  3  Gobo  4  Color    5  Beam    Status       6  Focus    Info       Z Control    B E     8  Shapers  9  Video    10  All       Layout  View    Network  Dimmer       3 Creating a Show    3 1 Creating a window     Clear the current screen content with Clear View  briefly press top and bottom View buttons simultaneously    If the two Clear View buttons are held longer than 2 seconds  all screens  also the external screens  are cleared     Pressing an    empty    space on one of the three TFT displays or the external monitors  The CREATE A WINDOW  menu will open     3 1 1Listing of individual windows and functions   Sheets      CHANNEL  This window will display dimmer channels as figures  You have direct access to channels and values  here  see Accessing Dimmer Channels directly     EXECUTOR  Within this window  you will have the option to display a sequence  which is assigned to an  EXECUTOR fader or an EXECUTOR button  Among othe
408. ted    If you select a Preset  it will be displayed in the upper bar  and you can select it pressing the OK key    Entries can be deleted using the OOPS  key     KEYBOARD SOFT  TOUCH  Keyboard  On the grandMA light and ultra light and micro pico you can call it up by pressing the KEYBOARD key   In the upper left cell  the entered text will be displayed    LEFT   RIGHT DOWN  POS   Using the touch screen  you can select individual keys   Pressing RETURN will accept your entry       mm i i    COMMAND WINDOW    On the grand MA  grandMA light and the ultra  light  you can open the Command Window using function key F7  On  the MICRO  you ll find a dedicated COMMAND button  This window contains the most important buttons  here  displayed as Softkeys  on the grand MA full size  grandM A light and ultra  light  the buttons can be used as alterna   tive means of entry  on the micro pico  you can only use the Command Window        MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    14 MIA    LIGHTING    1 10Quick Reference    After many years of experience we have lost our illusions about any user to be willing to read an entire manual  Pact playing with a new toy  But here are some tips which may help you to find your way around   asics  The grandMA is a highly specialised computer with up to 5 monitors  M any functions will work as you are used to  from your PC or M AC   Main supply  90 230V  The mouse in its drawer  grandM A only  or trackball on the grandMA 
409. ted button will be backlit in dark grey    Store Source     Normal  Will store all values contained in the Programmer  mind the settings under STORE VALUES        Output  Will store all values output  as displayed in the DM X Sheet   i e  also the position of the M aster   Groupmaster will be accounted for  Asssignments  e g  to Presets  will be lost  as only the output value will be  stored  not the source       DMXIN  DMX Capture   With this setting  you can store DM X signals coming in via the DM X  IN jack  e g  to store  a non  compatible Show of another console  You can also call up individual Cues on other consoles  if the SETUP  and the patched channels on the grandma are identical  and store a new Cue on the grandMA     You can set the DM X  IN in the TOOL menu   DM X amp NSP configuration   Local DM X Input  The incoming DM X has to  be merged with the DM X line  on which the fixtures of the imported Show were patched     Filter       Define  Will open the attribute filter  all attributes having a green background will be saved  The settings in this  filter will only be active for the following STORE process  afterwards  the filter will be reset to default again     Store Values     Active Values  Will store only the active values  all values that have a red background in the FIXTURE  or CHANNEL window      All  Will store all current settings  all values of all Scanner and Dimmer channels    Very memory  demanding   problems when saving presets   only recommendable
410. tensity wheel     Cursor keys NEXT  PREV  Groupwise Calling  up of scanner or dimmer channels one after  the other     PAN   TILT key  changing over the  function of the trackball to mouse functions   LED off  or to Pan   Tilt functions  LED on     Left   Middle   Right key for Mouse  functions    25 Trackball for Mouse or Pan   Tilt functions    26    Socket for console lamp 12V 5W    Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand  TA l    1 7 2 Layout and Controls grandMA full size  T TFT Display Touchscreen  View Macro keys    Encoders   To move scroll the respective window  contents    Encoders   To set the attribute values such as Gobo   Pan Tilt  times etc     Manual Time Setting for Presets    Yellow Knob   To adjust the Touchscreen  Panel    Playback buttons   Can be defined as Go t  Go     TT    oy aE BE 7 88 TT    Pause  Flash etc  E   F E E E     F F 7  E m     e   E    Executor faders   Can be defined as Master  Swap  M aster  X  Fader etc     O Oo N QU Ah ON    Go   Go   Pause buttons   Only effective for the  selected sequence  The selected sequence can be  assigned using the Select key  recognisable by the  green title bar of the small EXECUTOR window above it      Ports and connections on the rear side   a m Lamps  1x on the top at micro pico  light and ultra light    b LTCIN  AUDIOIN   c 4x DMX Out  2x at Micro and UltraLight   1x DMX In and 1x DMX Thru   not at Micro and UltraLight  
411. tents is not destroyed but  using Preview    Preview will be indicated by all sheets  showing PREVIEW in their titles   Preview is cancelled by the next command line operation     PREVIOUS    Create a subselection from the current selection    If you have selected more than one fixture and then say PREVIOUS  only the  last fixture of the selection actually stays selected  The others become     temporarily deselected    The next time you say PREVIOUS  only the 2    last  fixture within the current selection is actually selected and so on  The ALL  command will clear this subselection    Continue EDIT   UPDATE procedure with PREVIOUS object    See EDIT    Cursor Left in open dialog windows    In all temporary dialog windows and message boxes  you can use the PREVIOUS  key to move the input focus in that window to the left  Together with NEXT and    SELECT hit executor   SELECT EXEC X ENTER   The default executor can be identified by its green title in the executor mini  displays    The default executor is reacting to the DEF_GO DEF_ GO  and DEF_ PAUSE  commands and to their physical counterpart  the three big yellow buttons   During programming it can be very convenient to make the executor you are  working on the default one  Many commands assume to work with the default  executor if no other executor is given    In an assign command  this function can be put on an executor button  see  ASSIGN     Pushing this button will select the executor of the button as default executor  
412. terms of percentage     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn      Phase  Here  an angle for moving individual modulators can be set     Rate  Display of the set ratio between the speed for this individual Modulator as to that of the whole Effect  Group      Base  You can also set an average value for each Effect using the BASE VALUE option  The set value will  overwrite all previously modified values of this function and by this  will control all Fixtures Dimmers evenly   The value can be set to between 0 and 100    Before modifying the BASE VALUE  select the Effect first  Press the BASE VALUE key once  green background    Now  you can set an average value using the Encoder below  Clicking the Encoder once will automatically set  the value to 50   default value   Pressing the Encoder a second time  the value will be deleted and set to NONE   no BASE VALUE   If no BASE VALUE ist set  the Cue that is playing back or a direct access value will take effect   Edit Eff 43  Eff 43  You can also use the ALIGN function to set this value  See ALIGN function  SESE Size EE Base E Offset  Pate S EEEE   Offset  By modifying the Offset  the starting points for the selected Fixtures and Dimmers will change  Default  aS UE aaa   i setting is between 0   and 360    i e  the first Fixture Dimmer starts with an offset of 0    the last with a  A maximum offset of 360    all Fixtures Dimmers in between will be distributed evenly  The maximum limit for  Offset m
413. terval   1    9999    as target for the following executing commands     ON activate all feature values in programmer    OFF deactivate all feature values in programmer and deselect fixture   PAUSEPARK all features of fixture    GO  UNPARK all features of fixture     FLASH_ DOWN    As starting keyword  every executor that follows after FLASH DOWN reduces  its intensity channels to zero with no time    FLASH DOWN  executor list   ENTER    As starting keyword combined with UNPRESS  every executor that follows  returns its intensity channels to their previous levels    FLASH DOWN  executor list  UNPRESS  ENTER    In an assign command  this function can NOT be used  You have to use the  Assign menu for putting it on an executor button  It is simply called FLASH  there    Note  It is almost impossible to use this command by typing it into the  command line  Rather use it when it is assigned to a button or as part of a  macro     FLASH_DOWN_OFF    Same as FLASH DOWN    UNPRESS   Please look at the FLASH DOWN command description     FLASH UP    As starting keyword  every executor that follows after FLASH UP outputs all  intensity channels of the current cue to 100  of their programmed value   FLASH_UP  executor list   ENTER    As starting keyword combined with UNPRESS  every executor that follows  after FLASH UP returns all intensity channels of the current cue back to their  previous state    FLASH_UP  executor list  UNPRESS  ENTER    In an assign command  this function can NOT be 
414. the AUTOSAVE key  you can set an automatic save according to the time displayed on the key  Avoid using  for Quick Sve for Muto Save     this during a live Show or in very loud environments  When using the AUTOSAVE function a BACKUP of the Show  will be made with each saving operation  max  10   These backups can be used to restore previously saved  Shows  You can display these backups using the SHOW BACKUP key       press BACKUP     press AUTOSAVE  until the desired time is set  With OFF  you switch off Autosave      select your Archive Medium  hard disk  on the console   file server  external memory  to be set using  FileServer in Archive M edia    When Autosave is active  the time to the next saving point will be indicated on the bottom margin               Backup Menu r X  Local Drive chive Media                  LOAD Show   SAVE Show Local Dne  Quick save           AS   press twice BACKUP   the fastest way to save the show  SAVE Show    SAVE Show   jema shows       select Enumerate  AS Enumerate E Show    read hnly   gt   Ja er alll Shad   set Enumerate to OFF  you can save the Show immediately       set Ennumerate to ON  you can save the Show immediately  plus a consecutive number will be added to the  current name    If the ENUM ERATE button is on ON in the BACKUP menu under QUICK SAVE  every saving procedure saves a new   copy of the show   with AUTO SAVE  this happens automatically  In this way several 100 versions of the show can    quickly burden the hard disk     
415. the Fixtures Sheet  The focus will be kept even if you change the fixture position  and the respective PAN TILT  values will automatically be adapted       Enter the virtual axes in SETUP   FIXTURE TYPE   CHANNELS of FIXTURE TYPES using the SPECIALS button SPECIALS    Select the fixtures in NORMAL mode     Use the mouse or the touch screen to define the position on the stage floor  the Z value will always jump to 0    or   set the spacial coordinates using the Encoders   in this version  AREA is not yet assigned   In the Fixture Sheet  the  values will be displayed in a separate column  STAGE X Y Z  and can be set here  too    The values do always refer to the stage siye  definable in SETUP   FULL ACCESS   SETUP STAGE   50  of the definable  area are always the middle of the stage front edge    If you create multiple intersections  See graphics on the left   the Encoders will always show the last entered value        Note regarding DMX   STAGE values  may not be mixed within one Cue or Sequence     Effects using the X  Y  and Z parameters    For creating effects  you can also use the stage parameters X Y  and Z  They can help you  e g  to easily create circles  as effect outputs  Procedures as given in chapter 6 Effects and M odulators    NOTE  you have to enter all 3 parameters for the effect  as otherwise  no vector can be created and the effect cannot  run  Within an effect  stage values may not be mixed with other features       When editing the effect  enter the attribut
416. the SETUP   DEFAULTS menu     Target type Operation   EXEC Switch off executor   EFFECT Switch off effect  fading out    TIM ECODE Stop timecode show   PAGE Does OFF on all its executors    SPEEDM ASTER Does OFF on all programs using this speed master   executor assigned to a soeedmaster    SUBM ASTER    Knock out    all channels involved in this group     CHANNEL FIXTURE and GROUP Knock out    all given devices    PRESET X  Preset Type  Knock out    all channels of current selection of  that preset type       Knock out    means to clear the programmer completely for a channel     As starting keyword  every object that follows after the ON will be switched  ON without changing the current step    ON  target object list   FADE X   DELAY Y   ENTER    If fade or delay are given  they overwrite the pre  programmed times     Target type Operation   EXEC Switch on executor   EFFECT Switch on effect  fading in in last direction    PAGE Does On on all its executors    SPEEDM ASTER Does On on all chasers using this soeed master   executor assigned to a speed master    SUBM ASTER    Knock in    all channels involved in this group    CHANNEL FIXTURE and GROUP    Knock in    all given devices     PRESET X  Preset Type     Knock in    all channels of current selection of  that preset type      Knock in    means to activate the programmer for a channel with its current    value  This function can also be used to make    snapshots    of running programs       not Micro   OOPS    made a mist
417. the cell  here Normal   you can switch between Low  Normal or High  The unit with the highest priority will  always have the M aster function in a session  no matter  regardless of which device the session was started    ATTENTION  Bei der Einstellung NEVER   bernimmt dieses Pult keine M asterfunktion     This is where the current status will be displayed  M aster  Slave or Standalone     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    MA Network Connmectons    Standalone  gt     Arhuwe Nebenrk hessinna Sintinns m Network Hessin    ID   Saesion Mame   Shovwfia  u be      Status IF   Wears    Troe  Standal 192 168 0 114 5 534 GMA      Mo    Name  Ti False       By  Station Wi Soscion    IP  Address 197 IANN 114 IDs  Name fullsire Mame    Priwitiy Phinrmrl Partrsword    Invit ation Pnoabled Style    Local Hiabon                                         Acmoie Station  rL d o Leave D invio  Seesecion al Seesion                 Gta thon    MA Network Connections    Active Sessions  No  Name IP Version  0 Unconnected  1 GMA Demo    Stations in Session  Unconnected   No  Name Status IP Vers   GMA UL Demo Idle 192 168 177 11 3 950    192 168 177 11 3 950 2 Offline Idle    192 168 177 20 3 950    Commands    F start F Join  New Session    Session    MA Network Connections        Sessions stations in Session    GMA Demo           No   Hame IP   Version  Ho  Name a Status  IP Vel      Unconnected       GA Demo Master 192 168 0 111 3 9   192 168 0111 3 940   
418. the current show to a floppy in advance or make a backup   Take care that the maximum number of channels that the console can handle will not be exceeded       press BACKUP                        choose the Medium   internal disk  Hard Disk   external memory  FILE SERVER  or removable disk  FLOPPY  ee LocalHaddsk oo O arais DISK      ATChIVE jedia  LOAD show  SAVE Show   press INITIALIZE   the SELECT SHOW for PARTIAL SHOW READ will open      select the show  you want to load elements from  and confirm by pressing on the Encoder    Backup Menu                SAVE Show SAVE Show  AS pl Enumerate    Partial Show Re Ad                   Mind the limitations  number of parameters                        Initialise open In the DEVICE MATCHING TABLE  the current Setup  green background  and the Setup of the imported Show  grey  m background  will now be displayed  Fixtures appearing in the same line  have the same ID number   here  the user has  File Server 4 to decide whether to keep the current fixture or to take the imported fixture  It is possible that the settings of fixtures    of the same type will change  position in the Stage view  defaults   Effects  Cues  etc  will  however  not be changed   And it can happen that for fixtures of different types  programs change  If e g  some imported fixture   s features  a Cue  refers to  are missing       select VIEW  you can select fixtures in all views     with ALL  all fixtures of the current Show  on the left  and of the imported Sh
419. the matrix outside the graphics    COLOR  color values are assigned to the graphics element    define the order using the 4 Encoders    MASTER here  you can set the dimmer value      SPEED here  you can set the effect speed   however  the graphic   s movements also depend on the settings FROM    TO  SPEED SCALE  and RATE       FADE here  you can    MASTER FADE here  you can set the time to fade out and fade in the effect after start and stop    enter a name for the BITM AP EFFECT in the LABEL line and confirm with ENTER     Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand HAAS    Placing a BITMAP EFFECT on a fader   button      press ASSIGN once     press on an Executor button not yet assigned   or     press on an Executor fader  small Executor window EM PTY      inthe ASSIGN menu  press the BITMAP EFFECT button     inthe overview  select the desired effect using the Encoder  and leave the menu by pressing    X       sree     2    ae    Mee  eee  Adr    7 3 Starting the Effect  T     n aan    nie ait ae         open the BITMAP EFFECTS WINDOW    press the button in the BITMAP EFFECTS pool  Or  if the effect had been placed on a fader or a button     start the effect using the fader or button  As is the case with the effects  you can modify the speed while the effect is running    WARNING  If you open the BITMAP WIZARD in the EDIT menu  the effect will stay active     Euan   ci   T   he  Lie  a       140 
420. the selected dimmer channels using the left encoder   Individual Fade Delay Time               When carrying out modifications  different options can be used  These options can be necessary when times for   Scanners and Dimmers are changed simultaneously    Selecting options    Above the left decoder  a second additional button will be displayed showing the currently selected option    By pressing this button  you can select the next option available    Or    Pressing on the right arrow will open a menu  in which all options are displayed and can be selected directly      Single  For Active   The time can be adjusted for each individual Function  Attribute   If    Single For Active    is  chosen  only times for activated values can be changed      Feature  For Active   The time can be adjusted for the chosen Feature  e g   Gobo1  containing e g   Gobo1  and Gobo1 Rotation   If    Feature For Active    is chosen  only times for activated values can be changed      All  For Active   All times for all Attributes are adjusted  If    All For Active    is chosen  only times for activated  values can be changed      Defined  For Active   The time can be adjusted for the fixed Attributes  Pressing the left arrow on the side of  the Defined button will open the    Define Attributes to Set Time    menu     Selecting individual Attributes     In this menu  all Attributes are displayed with a green  selected  or black  deselected  background  Pressing on  one of the functions will select
421. ther it is the Blind mode or the stage output     To switch off the Blind mode       Hold the BLIND key  until you hear the beep and the key LED goes out   After switching over  all changes made in Blind mode will immediately be active in the stage output     Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand  TA 83                Chace  of Fialure Type Land   ik Atinbuls Troe Snap Inv  Tina 3 IE hEa   Tae ne Pedi   Diala   p r oot    X   Sand Pele az   Y Wahid pi   Z Virtual Hemove KY Suppest from all hule types Spevnly   CALUT hai  leke Sw Supper he Gill helu  lpia a  Sa   CODON Tt Coase   J   GUHUT  Coarse   Fat Cia oH Expr   MAH Coarse          Fixtures  Values  sorted by Numbers       Pan Tit W Dimmer  Pan Tit Dim          LIGHTING    3 11 Stage window with SETUP and FOLLOW modes  The stage window can be used in the 3 different modes NORM AL   FOLLOW   SETUP     NORMAL mode   The window will display all fixtures in their stage positions  white lines indicating the direction and intensity of  the light  The fixtures can only be selected here     FOLLOW mode    In this mode  you can focus individual fixtures or groups having virtual X  Y and Z axes  on a deliberate point on  the stage  These values will always refer to the stage geometry and will be displayed in the STAGE column on the  Fixtures Sheet  The resulting PAN TILT values will be calculated from the fixture position and also be displayed in  
422. this  the currently installed ArtNet  and PathPort protocols will be used   In  order not to have to switch the DM X signals from the M aster system to the Backup system in case of an  emergency  the grandMA Master and the Slave console can be connected in a network via an Ethernet  DM X  converter    As long as the M aster  Slave connection remains established in the network  the grandMA Master will actively  transmit DM X data via the protocol  the Slave system will ignore the DM X  Ethernet settings  As soon as the Slave  system is switched over into M aster mode  it will immediately activate ArtNet protocol and start transmitting DM X  data  All internal DM X interfaces will be active at any time     Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand HAAID    16 3 Setting up a Network System   In order to set up a network configuration within the grandMA family  you can connect consoles of different types  or with different numbers of DM X channels  The grandMA software is very flexible and can    correct    possible  differences in the current hardware     16 3 1 Connecting consoles of different types   The master console always demands the slave s  to behave like the master hardware  This means a    full    grandMA  master forces a grandM A light slave to be a    full    grandM A temporarily  This results in phantom executor faders  and buttons as the grandMA light  or grandMA replay unit  has a red
423. tible  As target for the following operational commands   Source object types Compatible destination AT Extract data from cue  object types COPY Copy one cue to another  EXEC EXEC DELETE Delete a cue  FADERBUTTION 123 FADERBUTTON 1 2 3 EDIT Edit a cue    DMX BUTTON DMX BUTTON IF Select devices which are Part of the cue   MIDI BUTTON MIDI BUTTON  FOUTPUT Search for stage output of cue  TOUCH BTN TOUCH BTN INVERT Invert selection of cue  7 E LABEL Change name of cue  MOVE Move cue to another position    Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 gad HAAGI    PREVIEW Preview cue  as target for the following executing commands   ON activates content of cue in programmer   OFF deactivate content of cue in programmer   PAUSE PARK all features included in cue   GO UNPARK all features included in cue   LOAD Prepare cue X as next cue for executor Z   GOTO Executor Z is calling cue X   DEF_GO    Is performing a GO on the default executor     DEF_GO     Is performing a GO  on the default executor     DEF PAUSE    Is performing a PAUSE on the default executor     DELAY    168    With executing keywords and executors    Executing keyword   Executor List  DELAY X X ENTER   The execution command is performed on all listed executors with a snap delay  overwrite of X X seconds  Does not work with PAUSE or flashing commands   Giving individual delay times to fixtures or channels     Selection  AT DELAY X X  TRHU Y Y  ENT
424. time can be adjusted for each individual Function  Attribute   If    Single For Active  is  chosen  only times for activated values can be changed      Feature  For Active   The time can be adjusted for the chosen Feature  e g   Gobol  containing e g   Gobol and  Gobol Rotation   If    Feature For Active  is chosen  only times for activated values can be changed      All  For Active   All times for all Attributes are adjusted  If    All For Active  is chosen  only times for activated  values can be changed      Defined  For Active   The time can be adjusted for the fixed Attributes  Pressing the left arrow on the side of the  Defined button will open the    Define Attributes to Set Time    menu    Selecting individual Attributes    In this menu  all Attributes are displayed with a green  selected  or black  deselected  background  Pressing on   one of the functions will select or deselect it  respectively     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    Technischer Service             Fades  Delays       Modulator Table  Modulator Size        Modulator Speed        Modulator Phase    GOBOI    Input range   0 00 to 100 00         3 4 4 Modulator values in the Fixtures window   The 4 modulator columns of the respective features show the values on which the effects are based   the column  having a violet background  The values will be inserted automatically when an effect is transferred to the  modulators using the TOP command  You can  however  e
425. tions  e g   Dimmer        variable functions  e g   Strobe  Pan  Rotation         and functions with fix values  Gobo  Colors        You can sign on different fixtures for a trial  of course  or havea   look at the given names and settings and use them for your own fixtures      Standard function  Closed will be displayed  if the set value is    O     Open  if on 255  Between 1  and 254  only  the value will be displayed      Variable function   Discrete Values  The set value will be displayed  Furthermore  a value indication will  bedisplayed together with    Degrees    as unit  In this case   270   to 270   would be displayed  For Strobe     Hz    and  for Gobo_Rotate    RPM     would appear here      Fixed values  Open will be displayed  if the set value is    O      Red between    8    and    24    and additionally a color will be displayed on the side  This color can be set in the Extra  column  Sames applies for the other colors    Between the given values  e g   here 1   7   the color would be displaced by Open  and the color be inserted for  Red  Only after reaching the value    8    would the color be displayed completely for Red     2 8 Creating  Assigning and Deleting Profiles  see also  TOOLS  M enu      In the PROFILE TOOL menu  you can create individual profiles  The profiles created can be assigned to any Fixture  parameter or dimmer channel     Assigning a profile to a DMX channel      press Setup     Open the FIXTURE TYPES menu  Modifying scanners  EDIT FIXT
426. tive Cue are displayed  only valid for Executor Keys       Automatic  If this key is pressed  the display will automatically swap in this window when using the TIME key      Layer Control  If    On    is chosen  a control bar appears below the Scanners  By pressing on the individual  buttons on the control bar  the display in the window will be switched accordingly      Preset Control  If    On    is chosen  a control bar appears below the Scanners  For each function  there is a se   parate button  By pressing on the individual buttons on the control bar  the appropriate function will be  activated and can be modified using the Encoders    In the right upper corner of each button  you ll find a small square  If this square has a black background  the   respective function has not been modified  If the background is red  something has been changed in this   function    The Sorting  amp  Readout button must be pressed  displayed with a green font      sorting  amp  Sort by   Readout l y  l            With the respective key  you can define the channels    sorting order in the window       Numbers  Within the CHANNEL window channels are sorted by numbers     Names  Channels will be sorted by name      Selected  The selected channels will be moved to left above      Active  Channels for which a value is activated  will be moved upwards     Values  Channels will be sorted by highest value     Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49
427. to Stop key to OFF  the Chaser or effect will continue with the latest BPM value measured   The AUTO GAIN function can be used for grandM As from serial no  0055 and later  key will turn dark  grey key   HARDWARE modification   grandM A ultra light allows only Auto Gain     MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn                              Time  amp  Date Setup   eo TX       Day   os      Month    Timezone  GTM 0  1 0  East  i  E positive  Longitud fe  Vanna g 9 95  East   Latitud  patitude    49 80  North        t     e e  s                 December    Year 2002  P Daylight Savings   Enabled                                                    Longitude  Input Range    180 00 to 180 00             lt  oo    5 f  Location Auto    wt  1 0  East    9 95  East    43 80  North        Longitude  Wpositive       E positive    Longitude  Wepositive       Latitude  Nepositive          For grandMAs with serial no  up to 0054  this key can not be used     You can leave this menu by pressing the X key  all settings will be stored     2 15 TIME  amp  DATE Menu      Pressing the TIME and DATE key in the SETUP M enu will open the following menu     You can set TIME and DATE with the encoders below the display   You can switch encoder functions by  pressing the button Time      Manual or automatic positioning via GPS    The times of sunrise and sunset change according to your geographical position  If you know your position  you  can enter it in the LOCATIO
428. to be selected first  Now  press the    Delete Group    key  The group will be  deleted  the Attributes will automatically be added to the Free Attributes      In this column  the Attributes of the selected group will be displayed  By selecting an Attribute  this will be  removedfrom this group and added to the Free Attributes      In order to assign Free Attributes to another group  this group has to be selected first  Selecting the Attribute will  add it to the currently selected group      By pressing the    Default    key  all groups except 3 will be deleted  Almost all Attributes will be displayed as Free  Attributes in the right column  In the remaining 3 groups  the fixed Attributes  Pan Tilt  Col M ix1 4 and BladelA   4B  are allocated  These Attributes can not be moved into other groups  indicated by    fix    next the Attribute   s  name      The changes will take effect and will be saved only after leaving the Full or Live Access menu and pressing the  SAVE button     2 5 Modifying Scanners  FIXTURE TYPES     In the Full Access menu  open this menu by pressing the Fixture Types button   The upper part of the Display shows all fixtures that are currently used in the Show       No  Numerical of the individual fixtures currently signed  on in this Show  If this number is displayed in red and with  an asterisk  this fixture has been modified       Qty  Number of fixtures of this type      Name  Name of the fixture from the Library  By selecting it  you can change the n
429. to set DMIX Address    Remote  DMX in   ti    DELETE    8 3 Remote Control by DMX IN   DM X IN can be used to MERGE the signals of a second control board with those of the grandM A and transmit them  to the stage via the same data line  If  during this process  channels from the grandM A and from the second control  board are mixed up  only the higher value will be transmitted  DM X IN will only be linked to DM X OUTA and will not  be output via Ethernet     Via the DM X IN socket  assigned commands can be called up from an external DM X console  The DM X input has  only the function of a switch that will release at approx  50      8 3 1 Assigning Playback Keys     Press the TOOLS key once      Call up the DM X IN REM OTE CONFIGURATION menu using the REM OTE key      Press the STORE key once  LED is on       Select a key in the DM X IN REM OTE CONFIGURATION menu      Press the Playback button that you want to assign  The selected button will now be assigned    Or      Enter the Executor Fader to be assigned using the Command Line  e g      Executor Executor 1 5    means Exe  Fa   der 5 on Page 1  and confirm with Enter    The assigned Playback buttons Fader will be displayed on the individual keys  Only EXECUTOR buttons and faders   can be assigned to the respective DM X channel     8 3 2 Assigning DMX Channels   Make a right mouse click on the key  A menu will open in which you can assign one of the 512 DMX channels to  this key  Identical DM X channels can be assigned to mo
430. ts button  you can load saved effects from floppy    By pressing the Export Effects button  you can save the created effects to a floppy     2 11 5 ASCII Show Import   If the Ascii Show button is pressed  green background   you are in the ASCII Show Import   Export menu   Before you load an ASCII Show  you should save the Current Show  as it could be overwritten    If the FDD contains a floppy with a Show in ASCII format  file with the ALQ extension   you can load the Show by  pressing the button  It is not possible to transfer Scanner data  The Default User Settings   see Saving or Loading  Profiles  will be loaded  The Show will be saved under the name AssciiShow and should be renamed and saved  again  See Saving and Loading a Show   The data will only be saved to the RAM   permanently only when saving the complete Show to disk or floppy    Saving and Loading a Show    2 11 6 ASCII Show Export   Export an ASCII   show  on floppy disc      press button EXPORT SHOW FILE     insert empty floppy and confirm with OK     Use the X button to leave the Auto CREATE menu     2 12 Settings in the Setup Menu   By pressing this key MSDBOX M ode  you can set the confirmation menus  e g  STORE  to be displayed on just the   right  side TFT touchscreen or on all displays      Using the Executor Layout button on the grandM A light  ultralight or RPU  simulate the numbering of the  grandM A   s executors  Executor Fader 1   20  Executor Button 21   60  the additional executors can only be  t
431. ual    2_port Node    you can  download from our homepage www malighting com    Saving the 2  Port Nodes configuration      press TOOLS     press MA NETWORK CONFIGURATION     press 2  Port     press the SAVE CONFIG button     Press OK to load the configuration in the Showfile  This will make the configuration part of the Show  variances  like e g  the failure of a 2  Port Node will be displayed in the Desk Status     This will automatically bring up the next request  if the configuration is to be saved as a backup on the console or  to an external disk       Press OK and use the Filebrowser to save the configuration on the console or to a floppy disk  chose this option  by touching HARD DISK      Enter the name of the configuration and confirm with ENTER     Loading the 2  Port Nodes configuration      press TOOLS     press MA NETWORK CONFIGURATION     press 2  Port     press the LOAD CONFIG button     inthe Filebrowser  select the source  chose this option by touching HARD DISK      select the configuration and confirm with ENTER     confirm the request Upload  with OK  This will overwrite the Nodes with the new configuration     NOTE  Some settings of the 2  port can cause flickering output  See manual of the 2  port node     17 3 grand MA Videol7 3 grand MA Video    This menu can only be used in connection with the grandM A Video software   For further information on the installation an operation  please refer to the grandM A Video manual that you can  download from our we
432. ubtrack  like executor command track   the whole track with all its subtracks will be  deleted     Expanding   Collapsing Tracks   Tracks can be EXPANDED or COLLAPSED  An expanded track will show all of its subtracks  while a collapsed  track will hide all its subtracks except for the first one  For an executor track  the first subtrack is always the  executor command subtrack    This functionality only affects the display     Hidden    subtracks are always played back     Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand HAAAD    146    MIA    LIGHTING    An expanded track is marked with a         in front of it  a collapsed track indicated by a           Click on this mark to change the expand collapse status of the track    The TRACK FUNCTIONS menu contains functions to expand collapse all tracks simultaneously    Selecting Tracks   Tracks can be SELECTED individually  A selected track is displayed in a darker colour    Only selected tracks are shown in TEXT display mode  For some functions it is important whether a  track is selected or not  For normal operations however  in graphic display mode  you do not have to worry about  this    Click on the track name cell  you may have to do this twice  because the first click is chooses the current track  or  press the track encoder within the bar to change the selection status of a track    The TRACK FUNCTIONS menu contains functions to select deselect all
433. uced hardware platform  Switching executor  pages will then renumber the executors as given by the first executor on the master console    When the connection is either manually or automatically  by a user  definable timeout  broken the slave console  can be switched to M aster mode with maintaining the setup and configuration of the    lost    master  For example  a  grandM A master connected to a grandMA light slave will force the    light    to operate like a grandM A  even when  the connection is lost and the grandM A light is forced to solo mode    The table shows what master slave connections are possible and how many and which executor faders and  buttons are available on the slave during Tracking Backup and in solo mode afterwards    Please note that the slave s assignment of executor faders and buttons restores to the hardware default after the  console is once re  booted    16 3 2 Connecting consoles with different DMX channel count   In a Full Tracking Backup system the DM X channel count of the master console demands a temporary update or  downgrade of the connected grandM A slave automatically  If a 4096 channel master is connected to a 2048  channel slave the grandM A slave will take over the 4096 channels and process them in all conditions even when  the connection is broken regardless of what the original installed channel count    Rebooting the slave will restore the installed channel count immediately  In a Full Tracking Backup situation  where the master is
434. ues  magenta        REMOVE MODULATORS  Deletes the modulators in the selected sequences    18 otwtwss Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr 16 D 97297 Waldbittelbrunn    LIGHTING    CHANNEL EXECUTOR 2 Page Administration  ee  ee  ee If you are in Channel Mode  the name of the currently accessible PAGE of channel faders appears on the touchscreens between   the small channel windows above your faders  See CHANNEL M ode        If you are in Executor Mode  the name of the currently accessible PAGE of executor faders appears on the touchscreens between  the small executor windows above your faders  After pressing the LIST key once  the currently accessible PAGE of EXECUTOR BUTTONS appears at the bottom of the right display       including the name between the small executor windows   Using the PAGE    amp    keys you can open the access PAGES  Remember all pages output at once so changing page so no effect on  playback  only on what you currently have access to     Or   PAGE Hold a PAGE button down  for which another is to be called up  While holding down a button  the EXECUTOR Button LEDs will  indicate the current PAGE you are on  Example  If LED 28 is flashing  PAGE 8 is selected   By pressing another button you can  Switch to a different PAGE     5 5 1 Channel Page   When pressing both PAGE keys of the Channel M ode simultaneously the display will show a summary of the CHANNEL PAGES   Or    If in Channel Mode  you can call up the summary for all Channel Pages by pressing t
435. ultaneously select individual  but also several Fixtures or Channels by clicking and dragging with the  mouse on touch screen      Directly activating title bars of windows or opening options for the individual window by touching the corner icon    Encoder on the right of the Display     Inthe active window  the focus  coloured frame  or a highlighted cell  red blue background  can be moved  upwards or downwards  By pressing the Encoder when turning it  you can move the focus to the left or to the right      If a pulldown menu is opened  you can use the Encoder to scroll through the list  When you reach the desired  value  you can select it by a pressing the Encoder      If in a chart  a cell is selected with a value or a time  you can open an entry window by pressing the Encoder  In this  window  you can also use the Encoder to adjust the value  pressing the Encoder again will accept the new value      If a Fixture or a Channel is selected  coloured frame   you can open the options by shortly pressing the Encoder    Encoder below the TFT Display   The currently chosen function is displayed above the appropriate Encoder    The currently set value for the last activated lamp is displayed below the respective function  The values displayed    percent  decimal       do always refer to the active window  e g   Fixture  or Channel  Sheet     Use the encoder to modify the values of this function  If you press the Encoder while turning it  you can modify its   sensitivity      By pr
436. ure  In the TYPE column  you will find    M ultipatch    Dummies  for the copies  And you can position the fixtures  to use them in the Stage window or on the grandMA  3D     Note  After a M ultipatch  you ll find no DM X addresses for the dummies  as these will automatically be given the  same DM X address  name and ID as the original fixture    It is not possible  to enter the same address for different fixtures in the Layer Sheet  In the fixtures    Settings  menu  the same addresses have also to be entered  see manual of the fixture manufacturer      TIP  If you want to multipatch fixtures with different addresses  set on the fixture itself   you can enter these    after the Multipatch in the Layer Sheet  of course only  if not used by other fixtures      Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand  TA 23    Fixture Layer     KK    gt  gt  gt     Name Qty ID Cha ID Fix    frontO1 10 1  10                back01 10    11  20  dimmer01 2  a eer Add  blinder 1 TRE    5  103     DO        dimmerneu 99  New l           Name Type ID Ch  ID Fix Patch Mas  Func Pan Func Till Swap DMX Pan DMX Tilt      L300 Al Invert           SL300 2 SL300 All   Invert Create                   1  2    SL300 3 SL300 3 A21 Invert Multipatch  SL300 4  SL300 4 ABT Invert  SL300 5 SL300 5 AAI   Invert  SL300 6  SL300 6 ASI   Invert  SL300 7 SL300 7 AMI   Invert Patch  SL300 8     SL300 8 AI   Invert Sheets j    SL300 9  SL30
437. urrent  show       This column will show the individual  addressed DM X channel            Library setting will be used  and accept them by pressing the Encoder one more time  An inverted channel will  be indicated by a YES in the respective cell  These inverted channels are not used for the visualizer  this  means  that movements in the visualizer and on stange will differ      DEFAULT  This value will be output if no CUE  Sequence  Preset or Direct Access addresses the fixture or  dimmer channel    This setting can be used for PAN TILT so that a moving light can start being manipulated from a sensible and   optimum position  You can change values by selecting the cell and adjust it by using the right Encoder  below   the Display   These values can be set by selecting the respective cell with a click  n      The HIGHLIGHT function is used to temporarly override a fixtures current settings making it easier to see on  stage and speed up the procedure of programming positions of the selected fixtures  The HIGHLIGHT values for  individual DM X channels can be set by selecting the respective cell with a click  A value can then be entered  within the activated window  You can adjust the value by using the second Encoder  below the Display       STAGE  not yet available in version      SNAP  New values for this channel will ignore cue timing and will execute in 0 seconds  Activate by a click on  the cell  Press the Encoder  right of the Display   Select Yes for SNAP or No for FADE 
438. urrent selection    ODD Select odd devices inside current selection    OOPS Oops    mad a mistake    gt  Undo   PREVIOUS Select previous device inside current selection  VALUE Switch back from fade or delay to value mode   UPDATE Update data of active object  Active objects create stage output     The DEFAULT keyword    The command line has a DEFAULT keyword   Whenever you start a new command line with numeric values  this default keyword will be used     Assume that the default keyword is CHANNEL  When you type in     Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand HALOS    1 ENTER  In the command line will appear CHANNEL 1 ENTER     If the command line is empty  the current default keyword is shown by   a  LED in the physical key  b  the command line window    The following keywords can be the default keyword     CHANNEL  PAGE  FIXTURE   MACRO  GROUP PRESET  SEQU VIEW  CUE EFFECT  EXEC    The default keyword is also used by operational keywords   Assuming that the default keyword is GROUP  Then you are typing in   DELETE 1 ENTER  Asa result  GROUP 1 will be deleted      An exception to this are the keywords CHANNEL and FIXTURE  If they are the default keywords  operational  keywords will use CUE as the default keyword    If CHANNEL is the default keyword  STORE 5 ENTER will do STORE CUE 5      MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    164 MA    LIGHTING    10 3 2   
439. use click on the individual fixtures    Select the requested function by clicking on the relevent key on the Preset Control Bar  Switch on the Preset  Control Bar  See Options in the Fixture Window    Values can now be changed via the encoders  located below the right TFT display  all functions of the  encoders will be displayed directly on the screen       The various functions can now be toggled by pressing the FEATURE key    Or      The Trackball affects the PAN TILT function only  if switched to Pan  amp  Tilt  NOTE  Fixtures  the beams of which  cannot reach the preset position  will go to Blackout  this way  no undefined positions will be triggered    Or      The wheel affects dimmer values only    Or      Any value may be altered by clicking and holding on it with the middle mouse key and moving the mouse   For storing settings  See Cues and Sequences   For creating Presets  See Creating and calling up Presets   To call up or create Effects  See Effects   If you wish to modify the selection or the activated values of the fixtures      Press the CLEAR key    When pressing the CLEAR key the first time  the selection of fixtures will be deselected from the OUTPUT window   yellow characters turn grey     The modified  active  values will be kept and displayed with red background      Press the CLEAR key again    When pressing the CLEAR key the second time  the activation of modified values will be canceled  they will no  longer have a red background       Press the CLEAR k
440. used  You have to use the  Assign menu for putting it on an executor button  It is simply called OUT there   Note  It is almost impossible to use this command by typing it into the  command line  Rather use it when it is assigned to a button or in a macro      FLASH UP_OFF    Same as FLASH _UP     UNPRESS   Please look at the FLASH UP command description     FORM    As starting keyword it has no function   FORM  range list  ENTER  Form numbers in the range list must be in the interval   1    999      Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 gad MAL    As target for the following commands     COPY Copy one form to another  DELETE Delete a form   EDIT Open edit menu for form  INSERT M OVE Change visible number of form     FULL  Full is an alias for 100  dimmer value  open    As starting keyword  it is immediate  opening all dimmers of the current  selection   FULL  After the AT command in value ranges like        AT FULL ENTER        ATO THRU FULL ENTER    FULL  2x FULL will transfer the Highlight value into the Programmer  GO  As starting keyword  every object that follows after the GO will try to go  forward one step   GO  target object list   FADE X   DELAY Y   ENTER   If fade or delay are given  they overwrite the pre  programmed times   Target type Operation  EXEC Go forward one step  EFFECT Start running forward  TIMECODE Start playing forward  PAGE GO on all its executors   SPEEDM ASTER GO on all
441. uttelbrunn    FADE ENTER   All sheets wich are set to AUTO display mode  will display fades instead of  values  This effect is only temporary  All sheets will switch back to value  mode upon ending of the next command line operation     FADER  Format Meaning  FADER X  THRU  Y   Fader X to Y of current page  FADER P X  THRU  Q Y   Fader X of page P to fader Y of    page Q  FADER X  THRU  Y   PAGE P  THRU  Q   Fader X to Y of page P to Q  Fader number X Y must be in the range of  1    20    Page numbers P Q must be in the range of  1    64 J   Only one command is implemented for the fader keyword   FADER  list of faders  AT  value list   ENTER   This command will set the motorized faders to the given values     FADERBUTTON1  The same as EXEC  but in case of ASSIGNMENTS it is explicitely pointing to the  MIDDLE button     FADERBUTTON2  not Micro   The same as EXEC  but in case of ASSIGNMENTS it is explicitely pointing to the  LOWER button     FADERBUTTON3  not Micro   The same as EXEC  but in case of ASSIGNMENTS it is excplicitely pointing to the  UPPER button     FIX  As starting keyword  it is used to fix   unfix EXECUTORS  A fixed executor  is physically present on all pages   FIX  executor list   ENTER     FIXTURE  As starting keyword   FIXTURE ENTER  FIXTURE becomes the DEFAULT KEYWORD   FIXTURE  range list  ENTER  Select fixtures in range list   FIXTURE  range list  AT     see AT   Apply values to fixtures in range list   Fixture numbers in the range list must be in the in
442. utton  is a remote function triggert by incoming midi note  on note off signals   The MIDI BTN simulates an executor keypress  therefore it is working only in  combination with an assigned executor  MIDI_ BTNs can be seen under TOOLS    REM OTE MIDI menu   Calling a MIDI_ BTN manually   MIDI BTN X ENTER  Linking a MIDI_ BTN to an executor   STORE MIDI BTN X EXEC FADEREBUTTON1 2 3 Y Z ENTER  Using EXEC in this command will always link the remote to the middle executor  button   X must be in the range from 1 to 72     MOVE    174    MIA    L   G HT dIN G    NEXT    NEXT    ODD    OFF    M OVE  source objects  AT  destination objects    ENTER     Source objects   a range list of objects which are all of type X   Destination objects  a range list of objects which are all of type Y   Object types X and Y must be equal or compatible  see COPY    If object type is sortable  MOVE object_a AT object_b will exchange objects   If object type in not sortable  object_b will be overwritten with object_a  then  the original object_a will be deleted    Sortable objects are    PRESET  GROUP M ACRO VIEW EFFECT FORM  TIMECODE SEQUENCE  Nonsortable objects are    EXEC CUE PAGE VIEW BTN DM XBTN MIDIBTN  TOUCHBTN   The following objects can not be moved    CHANNEL FIXTURE DM X FEATURE FADER    Create a subselection from the current selection    If you have selected more than one fixture and then say NEXT  only the first  fixture stays selected and the others become    temporarly deselected       T
443. ve  Can only be used for those Scanners  for which it was saved  Will be indicated by a red triangle in  the left upper corner of the saved Preset button      Universal  Can be used for all Scanners of the same type  even if not all will be saved    Additionally you can store presets including several functions on one key  These presets can be created in any  preset group  Preset Filter ON  only the functions  Attributes  of this Preset group will be stored into this preset   with Preset Filter OFF  all currently active functions will be stored into this Preset       Foreign  values that are stored in a preset are indicated through a white point on the bottom edge of the preset  button  Each white point corresponds to a certain    foreign    value  according to the relevant position  The points  correspond from left to right to the following parameters  PAN TILT  DIMMER   GOBO   COLOR   BEAM   FOCUS    CONTROL  SHAPERS   VIDEO analog to the numerals in the preset windows     tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand   A  ID    SET MANUAL  FADE    Icons small Icons big Icons off    76 MA    LIGHTING       Example  this PAN TILT preset only contains values for dimmers and colors       ALLOW EM BEDDED  If the values contains a preset  an Embedded Preset will be stored      ONLY DIRECT  Embedded Presets are not possible     While holding down the STORE key  make a preselection by pressing the appropriate button  Universa
444. vement  gt         background and yellow frame  Default   value red with dark re manual activation or fader Encoder movement  background and yellow frame Thetrical   valuewhitewith      not selected  but changed manually selection deleted with CLEAR    dark red background  Default   value red with darkred         not selected  but changed manually selection deleted with CLEAR  background  Theatrical   value white with black              __ not selected  but changed manually activation deleted with CLEAR  background  Default   value red with dark re not selected  but changed manually activation deleted wit  background Theatrical   ackground blac empty   channel is not patche  background dark blue with dash DM X channel is patched  no values will be output by the current   cue  blueframe    Valuers parked  yellow fam    fixtureis selected 00000    Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand HA235          T ma    a    1 a ie    1 SL22 SL299 SL4 SLZ             Ho  Hame    1 1 Cue  2 2 Cue  3 3 Cue  4 4 Cue  5 5 Cue    al    3 oP reirsyeirir    E  i EEL mt    Bio   1 SLS2 SLE99 SL4 SL     Dim Dim   Dim    CE F    a ee    z n       Dim      TZ hl hmm ie  arr rr Fr ff     FF rr rr sf     FF EF    r a pae        me p   LiD N U a N    10       LIGHTING    Colors used for the screen display in the Tracking Sheet  Color or symbol    as o value entered  the default value will be output   value cyan Entered v
445. ven after switching the pages  will be visible   for several Sequences  Sequences or chasers that are on this position  but on a different page  will only    be covered  but otherwise not affected  even if they are currently running     e selected sequence can also be fixed  green   orange    When scrolling through the pages  fixed sequences can cover other sequences on the same position   this will  not affect the operation as such  After resetting the fixed sequence  sequences that had    disappeared    can be  reloaded from the pool   T When the letter T Is displayed   these sequence Is in Tracking  Mode          Te ee    E                 Ti    Es F  I   Ln   J i  terse   tt ol te   pa      i Tones pele  e   gt  Morr   or    W j  x   Eo a    J    matriy   BMR 1      I    60 0 BPM satik ST        STOP        1 Fader    HALF    Colors used for the screen display in the Group Master                                                 a ee olor or symbo  24 Ja 1 e ee  Text white  starting with a   sign name of the group master  Hechts    zwerer h back   l E ext pink  starting with a   sign or this group master  the option has been selecte   salFix  501  2  INK bar   blinking e motoriyed tader nas been blocked when adjusting it and has not    y Hy Fade reached the given value lt   B F i Full a a RUN    i pink bar is on zero  only the dark red background can be  e   5 L       Out Out  a Yellow bar shows the position of the group master       if the yellow bar is on yero  only the b
446. view  Here comes the complete list of all possible keywords in the command line     Special Short cuts    2  OFF  Feo    POH   CHANNE     MECENAS  HIGHLIGHT lono     2 x BACKUP    INEXT      PREV       ELEAR    long     GoTo     ENTER     2 SOTO     ENTER     Displays an overview of all running playbacks  Sequences   Effects  Chasers  Macros and Timecodes     Shut off all running playbacks  Activated the selected    parked    Channel   Fixture       Parking    the selected Channel   Fixture    The dimmer channel pulses  for better dentification  Stores the current show     without prior selection of Fixtures or Dimmers  selects the  first  NEXT  or last  PREV  Dimmer or Fixture  depends on  default  command  see10 3 1     Clears the programmer totally  all selections  activations   values         identical with 3x CLEAR    The Overview of the selected cue opens and a cue can be  started with the GOTO button    The Overview of the selected cue opens and a cue can be  loaded with the LOAD button    Keyword   As it appears in  the command line           lt  lt  lt     gt  gt  gt    ALL   ALL CHASES  ALL SEQUENCES  ASSIGN   AT   CHANNEL  CLEAR   CLEAR ACTIVE  CLEAR ALL  CLEAR SELECTION  COPY   CUE   DEF_GO   DEF GO    DEF PAUSE  DELAY   DELETE   DMX   DMX BTN   EDIT   EFFECT   ESC   EVEN   EXEC   FADE   FADER  FADERBUTTON1  FADERBUTTON2  FADERBUTTON3  FEATURE   FIX   FIXTURE   FLASH DOWN  FLASH DOWN_OFF  FLASH UP  FLASH_UP_OFF    Shortcut     Hard key     Shortest possible formHo
447. w   the creation date of this element is added in brackets   Displays    ii A A      ss fons   the text note    has changed  It is newer    in green  This element is newer than that having the same name in    the current show   the creation date of this element is added in brackets     184 WN otwstTws Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr 16 D 97297 Waldbittelbrunn    LIGHTING      select a User Profile            User       Leer Bata  Ke   User Data is merged into my profile  The profile elements of the selected profile will be loaded into the profile  Merged Irto of the current user   The Onginal   User Data is merged into the original profile  The profile elements of the selected profile will be loaded into  Protle   BR i        the profile of the user having the same name  or  if the user does not exist in the current show  the user will be    User    created   User Data l    Merged Into If MY PROFILE  yellow button  is chosen  after multiple profiles were selected  the current user s profile will  te   successively be overwritten by the selected profiles   not a good deal       Load parts of a Show     COPY  the selected elements will be inserted into the current show  or  if there are elements having the same  name  the current elements will be overwritten by the copied elements      MERGE  the selected elements will be inserted into the current show  if there are elements having the same  name  the current elements will be merged with the copied elements     Here a 
448. w be a    Cue Only         Fao COPY will move the Cue  CANCEL will abort the process        4 3 5 Copying Cues     Press the COPY Key once  LED is on       Press the SEQUENCE Key once  LED is on       Using the keypad  enter the number of the Sequence from which the Cues are to be copied      Press the CUE Key once  LED is on       Using the keypad  enter the number of the first Cue to be copied  If only one Cue is to be copied  continue with  the AT Key    Pressing the  Key will copy the selected cue and the cue indicated by the subsiquent number    Pressing the THRU Key on the keypad will copy the Cues from   to  including the last Cue      When pressing the  Key  the Cue with the next number will excluded from the copying operation   Press the AT key once  LED is on      Enter the new  destination  number for the copied Cues using the keypad   Example  The Cues are to be inserted between Cue 10 and Cue 11  Number these Cues e g  as 10 1  possible Cue    numbers are 10 001   10 999   This way  up to 999 Cues can be inserted between two existing Cues   Confirm with ENTER     When copying one Cue  the COPY window will open   After pressing the key on the left of Statuscopy  you can choose between     Only the values and times actually stored in this Cue will be copied  The tracked information will be       disregarded     The Cue will be copied as it would actually be realized on stage  That means  all previous steps will be taken into  account and the result will be copied  
449. w to enter the  of the keyword when keyword into the    using PC keyboard         lt     gt    ALL   ALL C   ALL S   AS   A   C   CL   CLEAR A   CLEAR ALL  CLEAR S   CO   CU   DEF   DEF_GO    DEF P   DELA   D   DMX   DM   ED   EF   ES   EV   E   FADE   FADER  FADERBUTION1  FADERBUTION2  FADERBUTION3  FE   FIX   F   FLASH_D  FLASH_DOWN_O  FLASH U  FLASH UP_O    command line         lt  lt  lt     gt  gt  gt    QUIKEY  CONSOLE  CONSOLE  ASSIGN   AT  CHANNEL  CLEAR  QUIKEY  QUIKEY  QUIKEY  COPY   CUE   Yellow GO  Yellow GO   Yellow Pause  2 xTIME  DELETE   DMX  CONSOLE  EDIT   EFFECT  ESCAPE  QUIKEY  EXECUTOR  1xTIME   2 x EXEC   Hit Executor  Hit Executor  Hit Executor  2 x PRESET  FIX   FIXTURE  CONSOLE  CONSOLE  CONSOLE  CONSOLE    Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99    Operation   Short description of the meaning   For a more detailed explanation see chapter 3     Plus   Minus   Go Back with no time   Go Forward with no time   All selection  with ODD EVEN   Accessing all executors with chases  Accessing all executors with sequences  Assign  lt source gt   lt destination gt   At   give value   Channel   Progressively clear programmer  Deactivate programmer   Total clear of programmer   Clear selection   Copy  lt source gt  at  lt destination gt   Cue   Go forward for default executor  Go back for default executor  Pause for default executor   Enter delay mode or give delay time  Delete  lt destination gt    
450. will be displayed  but without taking any profiles into account   Selected __ Bases   Executor ID  The Executor   s number and page will be displayed   Active   Settings   Cue ID  The sequence   s number and the respective Cue will be displayed      Alles     Automatic  If this key is pressed  the display will automatically toggle between the different options when  i Display toggling with the TIM E key   Percent   Small eater   Layer Control  If    On    is chosen  a control bar appears below the Scanners  By pressing on the individual buttons  Percent onthe control bar  the display in the window will be switched accordingly   Huge   Preset Control  If    On    is chosen  a control bar appears below the Scanners  For each function  there is a separa   HEX te button  By pressing on the individual buttons on the control bar  the appropriate function will be activated and    can be modified using the Encoders   In the right upper corner of each button  you ll find a small square  If this square has a black background  the  respective function has not been modified  If the background is red  something has been changed in this function     If pressing the Sorting  amp  Readout button  displayed with a green font      Sorting  amp  ort by   Readout Sr the respective key  you can determine according to which criteria the fixtures within the column are to be    sorted      Numbers  Fixtures will be sorted by numbers in the FIXTURE window      Names  Fixtures will be sorted by name  
451. will open a sheet  where the calculated times for Dawn  Sunrise  Sunset and Dusk for yesterday   today and tomorrow are listed      Leave this menu with the X key     Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand A  49    TITA    EErEE    a       DESK LOCKED       50 MA          LIGHTING    2 16 User Management     The new user management and security features include      Temporary simple desk locking mechanism      User management for up to 32 users      Users have privilege levels      These levels of privilege can prevent an inexperienced user from destroying show data      Users can have their own user profile      User profiles include views and default settings  even a set of default views that can be loaded into any show     Multiple users can share one user profile   although they can have different privilege levels       Forced login when the desk starts up as an option    When you get a new desk  or you update your old version    All user management features are disabled by default  If you do not touch them  you will not notice a difference  to the older versions of grandM A software  Internally you will be automatically logged in as administrator   working with a default user profile    The user management is not show  dependent  It is affecting all shows on your desk    The Micro has only one default  user  no login and no User  profiles  Parts of the user profles can be added from  the 
452. xtures or single functions internally  Output is shown In the STAGE   window  but not on the real  stage    You can park single fixtures with all parameters  Parked fixtures are displayed by a blue bar on the side of the  name and all functions       Press PAUSE key 1x  LED is on      Click on fixture or fixture key in the Group Window or click on fixture in the Fixture Sheet     You can also park single parameters of the fixtures  Parked parameters are displayed by a blue bar on the side of  the name and all functions      Press PAUSE key 1x  LED is on       Click on the functions in the Preset Control Bar  Switch on Preset Control Bar  See Options in the Fixture  Window  or directly on the parameters in the Fixture Sheet     Parked fixtures  functions or parameters can be released again either individually or together      Press GO  key 1x  LED is on       Click on fixture or fixture key in the Group window or click on fixture in the Fixture Sheet    Or      Click on the functions within the Preset Control Bar or directly on the parameters in the Fixture Sheet     Technischer Service  tech support  malighting com   49 5251 688865 30 Emergency Line   49 5251 688865 99 Version 6 0 grand  TA 63                Panj Tilt Dimmer Gobo Color a    G1 Rot C1 Frost                single   Single For Active  Feature   Feature For Active  All   All For Active  benned  Defined For Active    a Detined     gt  g    Define Attributes To Set Time  x lt           Pan  Tilt    Dimmer Dim     G
453. you use the Encoder to increase the SOFTNESS value  the Effect will be faded in and out more softly  SOFTNESS    MA Lighting Technology GmbH   Dachdeckerstr  16   D 97297 Waldbuttelbrunn    can be used for PWM    RANDOM   and CHASE Effects    Using the right FADE TIME Encoder  you can now globally set a fade in and fade out time for this Effect Group   When switching the Effect Group on or off  this Fade Time will be faded in or out with the set duration   Pressing the EDIT key will call up the Edit menu for this effect  See Editing Effects   Pressing the LIST key will open the VIEW ALL RUNNING EFFECTS window  where you have an overview on all  currently active Effect Groups  See View ALL RUNNING EFFECTS menu    6 4 Customizing an Effect Group  i The global settings like e g  Bounce  BPM  Intensity  Speed etc   are automatically stored in the Effect Group  You can customize the individual sequences of the Effect Groups by using the respective keys     Speed Scale  The current ratio of the SPEED setting will be displayed on the key  Pressing this key will open the  SPEED SCALE menu  Pressing a key will re  adjust the Speed setting  With MUL BY 2 or M UL BY 4  the SPEED  setting will by multiplied by 2 or 4  with DIV BY 2  4 or 8  the SPEED setting will be divided by 2  4 or 8  Pressing    Speed G Off 0  eaiier      the 1 1 key will recall the default setting again     INTENSITY SPEED SOFTNESS FADE TINE   Speed Group  The key will display the currently assigned SPEED group  Pre
    
Download Pdf Manuals
 
 
    
Related Search
    
Related Contents
StarTech.com 4 Port PCI RS232 Serial Adapter Card with 16550 UART  Académie :  Installation & Operations (T1)  Tivoli Audio Speaker Model Ten  EMC VSPEX PRIVATE CLOUD:  Warranty Registration System    Manual  T070 400V 3A TORNIO PARALLELO FERVI CON  Optim User Manual v1.5.4    Copyright © All rights reserved. 
   Failed to retrieve file